You are on page 1of 1279

SERVICE

MANUAL SERVICE MANUAL


B90B B90B / B90BLR / B100B / B100BLR / B100BTC
B90BLR B110B / B110BTC / B115B
B100B Backhoe Loaders
B100BLR
B100BTC
B110B
B110BTC
B115B
Backhoe Loaders

Print No. 84428663B Print No. 84428663B


TO READER
This manual has been printed for a skilful engi- CNH ITALIA S.p.A.
neer to supply necessary technical information to Technical Information
carry out service operations on this machine. Viale delle Nazioni, 55
41100 MODENA - Italy
Read carefully this manual to collect correct infor-
mation relevant to repair procedures.
For any question or remark, or in case of any
error relevant the contents of this manual, please
contact:

REFERENCES
Beyond this Service Manual, also refer to the
documents listed below:
- Operator’s Manual
- Service Parts Catalogue

SERVICE MANUAL The Service Manuals for “Loader backhoe” and


“Engine” contain the necessary technical informa-
The Service Manual consists of two volumes:
tion to carry out service and repair on machine
- B90B - B90BLR - B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC and on engine, necessary tools to carry out those
- B110B - B110BTC - B115B operations and information on service standard,
Service Manual for “Loader backhoe” on procedures for connection, disconnection, dis-
- B90B - B90BLR - B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC assembly and assembly of parts.
- B110B - B110BTC - B115B The Service Manual which covers the loader
Service Manual for “Engine” backhoe models B90B - B90BLR - B100B -
B100BLR - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC -
B115B consists of the following volumes, which
can be identified by their print number as stated
below:

VOLUME MACHINE TYPE PRINT NUMBER


Service Manual for “Loader backhoe” B90B - B90BLR - B100B - B100BLR - 84428663A1
B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B
Service Manual - “Engine” B90B - B90BLR - B100B - B100BLR - 87659057A
B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B
PREVENT ACCIDENTS
The majority of accidents and injuries which occur in the workshop, at the worksite or on the road, are caused
by the failure of some individual to follow simple and fundamental safety rules or precautions. For this reason
most accidents can be prevented by recognizing the real cause and taking the necessary precautions, before
the accident occurs.

Regardless of the care used in design and construction of any type of equipment, there may be conditions
that cannot be completely safeguarded against, without interfering with reasonable accessibility and efficient
operation.

A careful operator and / or technician is the best insurance against accidents.


The careful observance of this single safety rule would be sufficient to prevent serious injuries:

Never attempt to clean, lubricate or adjust a machine while it is in motion.

S WARNING S
Before carrying out any maintenance operation, adjustment and or repair on machines equipped with attach-
ments, controlled hydraulically or mechanically, make sure that the attachment is lowered and safely set on
the ground. If it is necessary to have the equipment partially or fully raised to gain access to certain items, be
sure the equipment is suitably supported by means other than the hydraulic lift cylinders, cable and /or
mechanical device used for controlling the equipment.

CNH ITALIA S.p.A.


Technical Information
Viale delle Nazioni, 55
41100 MODENA - Italy

All rights reserved. Reproduction of text or illustrations, in whole or in part, is strictly prohibited.
LOADER BACKHOE MODELS
The complete range of Loader Backhoe models described in this manual are identified below:

B90B B100B B110B B115B


B90BLR B100BLR B110BTC
B100BTC
Powershift / / O O

Powershuttle O O O /
Stabilizer sideshift O O O O

Stabilizer center pivot / / O O

Cab O O O O

Rops O / / /
2WD O / / /
4WD O O O O

4WS / / / O

“Pilot” backhoe attachment controls O O O O

Backhoe attachment mechanical


O O O O
controls
Engine Iveco 72 kW - 97 HP model
O / / /
F4GE9484C*601 (mechanical)
Engine Iveco 72 kW - 97 HP model
/ O / /
F4HE0484G*J102 (electronic)
Engine 82 kW - 110 HP model
/ / l /
F4HE9484C*J102 (electronic)
Engine 82 kW - 110 HP (4WS) model
/ / / O
F4HE9484C*J103 (electronic)
Short backhoe dipper O O / /
Long backhoe dipper / O O O
INDEX

SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES


FOREWORD..................................................................................................................................................... 4

SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS ................................................................................................................................ 6

PREVENTION OF FIRE OR EXPLOSIONS..................................................................................................... 8

PREVENTION OF BURNS ............................................................................................................................... 9

PRECAUTIONS FOR WASTE DISPOSAL..................................................................................................... 10

SECTION 01 - MAINTENANCE

SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS


MODELS........................................................................................................................................................... 3

IDENTIFICATION OF MAIN COMPONENTS................................................................................................... 4

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS....................................................................................................................... 7
DIESEL ENGINE ......................................................................................................................................... 7
TRANSMISSION........................................................................................................................................ 10
AXLES ....................................................................................................................................................... 11
BRAKES .................................................................................................................................................... 11
STEERING................................................................................................................................................. 12
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM .............................................................................................................................. 12
FRONT COUNTERWEIGHT ..................................................................................................................... 13
NOISE AND VIBRATION LEVELS ............................................................................................................ 13
BUCKETS .................................................................................................................................................. 13
TYRES ....................................................................................................................................................... 14

DIMENSIONS AND PERFORMANCE............................................................................................................ 15


DIMENSIONS - 2WS SIDESHIFT ............................................................................................................. 15
DIMENSIONS - 2WS CENTER PIVOT...................................................................................................... 16
DIMENSIONS - 2WS TC - SIDESHIFT ..................................................................................................... 17
DIMENSIONS - 4WS SIDESHIFT ............................................................................................................. 18
DIMENSIONS - 4WS CENTER PIVOT...................................................................................................... 19
LOADER ATTACHMENT PERFORMANCE.............................................................................................. 20
PERFORMANCE OF LOADER ATTACHMENT WITH FORKS ................................................................ 30
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT PERFORMANCE........................................................................................... 35

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LIFTING CAPACITY ........................................................................................... 55

MAXIMUM LIFTING LOADS........................................................................................................................... 61


LOADER ATTACHMENT MAXIMUM LIFTING LOAD TABLE .................................................................. 61
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MAXIMUM LIFTING LOAD TABLE ............................................................... 62

SUPPLY SUMMARY TABLE .......................................................................................................................... 63


INDEX

SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION
POWERSHUTTLE TRANSMISSION................................................................................................................ 3
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 4
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM............................................................................................................................... 7
CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................... 13
LUBRICATION ........................................................................................................................................... 17
GREASING ................................................................................................................................................ 20
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 22
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 23
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................. 148
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 152
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 153

POWERSHIFT TRANSMISSION.................................................................................................................. 154


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 154
CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................. 165
LUBRICATION ......................................................................................................................................... 167
GREASING .............................................................................................................................................. 169
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................. 170
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY........................................................................................................... 171
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................. 335
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 339
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 340

SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES


2WD - 2WS FRONT AXLE................................................................................................................................ 3
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 3
LUBRICATION AND GREASING ................................................................................................................ 4
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE ...................................................................................................................... 6
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................... 7
TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................................................................................. 7

4WD - 2WS FRONT AXLE.............................................................................................................................. 10


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 10
LUBRICATION AND GREASING .............................................................................................................. 11
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 13
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 14
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................... 57
SPECIAL TOOLS....................................................................................................................................... 61

4WS FRONT AXLE......................................................................................................................................... 62


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 62
LUBRICATION AND GREASING .............................................................................................................. 63
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 65
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 66
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................. 131
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 137
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 138
INDEX

SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE


2WS REAR AXLE
(B90B - B100B - B100BTC) .............................................................................................................................. 3
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 3
LUBRICATION AND GREASING ................................................................................................................ 5
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE ...................................................................................................................... 7
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................... 8
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................... 61
REPAIR TIMES.......................................................................................................................................... 67
SPECIAL TOOLS....................................................................................................................................... 68

2WS REAR AXLE


(B110B - B110BTC) ........................................................................................................................................ 69
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 69
LUBRICATION AND GREASING .............................................................................................................. 71
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 73
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 74
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................. 127
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 133
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 134

4WS REAR AXLE


(B115B)......................................................................................................................................................... 135
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 135
LUBRICATION AND GREASING ............................................................................................................ 138
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................. 140
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY........................................................................................................... 141
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................. 219
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 225
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 227

SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM


PARKING BRAKE............................................................................................................................................. 3
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 3
OPERATION................................................................................................................................................ 3
ADJUSTMENT............................................................................................................................................. 4
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................... 5

SERVICE BRAKE ........................................................................................................................................... 14


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 14
OPERATION.............................................................................................................................................. 14

SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM


HYDRAULIC DIAGRAMS ................................................................................................................................. 3
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS SIDESHIFT MECHANICAL MODELS....................................................... 3
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS SIDESHIFT PILOT MODELS .................................................................... 5
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS CENTER PIVOT PILOT MODELS ............................................................ 7
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS SIDESHIFT MECHANICAL MODELS....................................................... 9
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS SIDESHIFT PILOT MODELS .................................................................. 11
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS CENTER PIVOT PILOT MODELS .......................................................... 13
INDEX

HYDRAULIC PUMP ........................................................................................................................................ 15


HYDRAULIC FIXED-FLOW-RATE GEAR PUMP...................................................................................... 15
HYDRAULIC VARIABLE-FLOW-RATE PISTON PUMP............................................................................ 26

CONTROL VALVES........................................................................................................................................ 40
LOADER CONTROL VALVE ..................................................................................................................... 49
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE......................................................................................... 53
RELIEF VALVES........................................................................................................................................ 65

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE PILOT SOLENOID VALVE .................................................. 74

ACCUMULATOR “GLIDE RIDE” PARKER..................................................................................................... 77


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 77
MAINTENANCE ......................................................................................................................................... 77
SAFETY ..................................................................................................................................................... 77
CHECKING AND ADJUSTING THE PRECHARGE PRESSURE ............................................................. 78

HYDRAULIC SWING SYSTEM ...................................................................................................................... 80


OPERATION .............................................................................................................................................. 80

HYDRAULIC CYLINDERS.............................................................................................................................. 83
LOADER ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER............................................................................................ 84
LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER.................................................................................................................. 91
4X1 LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER .......................................................................................................... 97
BACKHOE BOOM CYLINDER ................................................................................................................ 100
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DIPPER CYLINDER .................................................................................... 104
BACKHOE BUCKET CYLINDER............................................................................................................. 108
TELESCOPIC CYLINDER ....................................................................................................................... 112
STABILIZER CYLINDER - CENTER PIVOT............................................................................................ 116
STABILIZER CYLINDER - SIDESHIFT ................................................................................................... 120
SWING CYLINDER.................................................................................................................................. 124
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LOCK CYLINDER - SIDESHIFT .................................................................. 128
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 129

HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVERS................................................................................................................ 130


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 130
CONTROLS AND OPERATION .............................................................................................................. 131
COMPONENTS ....................................................................................................................................... 132
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY........................................................................................................... 134
CONTROL LEVER VALVE ...................................................................................................................... 137

TROUBLESHOOTING .................................................................................................................................. 139


PRELIMINARY CHECKS......................................................................................................................... 139
TROUBLESHOOTING (WITH “REXROTH” CONTROL VALVES).......................................................... 140
SWING ..................................................................................................................................................... 142
HYDRAULIC PUMP ................................................................................................................................. 143

SECTION 39 - CHASSIS
DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................................................................. 3

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF COMPONENTS..................................................................................... 6


COMPONENTS WITHIN THE CHASSIS..................................................................................................... 6
COMPONENTS OF THE LOWER PART OF THE CHASSIS ..................................................................... 7
COMPONENTS ATTACHED OUTSIDE THE CHASSIS ........................................................................... 11
INDEX

COMPONENTS OF THE UPPER PART ................................................................................................... 12

SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM


DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................. 3

2WS STEERING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................... 4

4WS STEERING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................... 7

POWER STEERING ....................................................................................................................................... 11


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 11
COMPONENTS ......................................................................................................................................... 13
DISASSEMBLY.......................................................................................................................................... 15
ASSEMBLY................................................................................................................................................ 18

SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS....................................................................................................................... 3
GENERAL.................................................................................................................................................... 3

CAB HEATING.................................................................................................................................................. 5
CONTROLS ................................................................................................................................................. 5
OPERATION................................................................................................................................................ 6
OVERHAUL ................................................................................................................................................. 9
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................... 11

AIR CONDITIONING ...................................................................................................................................... 12


PRINCIPLES OF AIR CONDITIONING ..................................................................................................... 12
CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................... 17
OPERATION.............................................................................................................................................. 18
TROUBLESHOOTING AND TESTING...................................................................................................... 25
FLUSHING THE SYSTEM......................................................................................................................... 44
DRAINING THE SYSTEM ......................................................................................................................... 46
CHARGING THE SYSTEM........................................................................................................................ 47
OVERHAUL ............................................................................................................................................... 48

COMPRESSOR .............................................................................................................................................. 53
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 53
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION .............................................................................................................. 54
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 57
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................... 66

SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM


ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS .................................................................................................................................... 3
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE ROPS (B90B) ...................................................................... 3
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE CAB (B90B) ....................................................................... 19
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE CAB
(B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC) ....................................................................................................... 36
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHIFT CAB (B110B - B110BTC) ........................................................ 52
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - 4WS POWERSHIFT CAB (B115B) .................................................................. 70

CONTROLS AND INSTRUMENTS ................................................................................................................ 88


INDEX

FRONT INSTRUMENT PANEL ................................................................................................................. 88


SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER PANEL (B90B) ....................................................................................... 91
SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER PANEL (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B).................... 93
SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (B90B) .................................................................................................... 95
SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)................................. 97
ANTI-START SYSTEM .............................................................................................................................. 99

DIAGNOSTIC DISPLAY (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)................................................ 100


SYMBOLS................................................................................................................................................ 102
SETUP MENU.......................................................................................................................................... 103
PROCEDURE ABOUT SELF TEST......................................................................................................... 104
ON BOARD ERROR CODE RETRIEVAL................................................................................................ 105
BACKLIGHTING AND DIMMING............................................................................................................. 106
WORK HOURS ........................................................................................................................................ 107
OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................ 108
WARNING SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................ 112
MAINTENANCE ....................................................................................................................................... 113
WARNING MESSAGES........................................................................................................................... 114

STARTING SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................... 121


OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................ 121
STARTER MOTOR .................................................................................................................................. 124
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................. 129

ALTERNATOR .............................................................................................................................................. 131


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 131
OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................ 131
COMPONENTS ....................................................................................................................................... 133
REMOVAL................................................................................................................................................ 134
PRELIMINARY CHECKS AND TESTS.................................................................................................... 135
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................. 144

BATTERY...................................................................................................................................................... 145
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 145
OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................ 145
REPLACEMENT ...................................................................................................................................... 146
CHARGE AND ELECTROLYTE LEVEL CHECK .................................................................................... 147
CONNECTING A BOOSTER BATTERY ................................................................................................. 148
BATTERY MASTER SWITCH ................................................................................................................. 148

TROUBLESHOOTING .................................................................................................................................. 149

SECTION 82 - LOADER
LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROLS............................................................................................................. 4
LOADER ATTACHMENT OPERATION....................................................................................................... 4
4x1 LOADER BUCKET CONTROL (Optional)............................................................................................. 7
LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROL LOCK
(Specific to certain countries)............................................................................................................................ 8

LOADER BUCKET SELF-LEVELLING ............................................................................................................. 9

LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT.................................................................................................... 12


LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT
INDEX

(B90B - B100B - B110B)................................................................................................................................. 12


LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT
(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B) ..................................................................................................................... 14

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF LOADER BUCKET .............................................................................. 15


LOADER BUCKET (B90B - B100B - B110B) ............................................................................................ 15
LOADER BUCKET (B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B)................................................................................. 16
LOADER BUCKET WITH FORKS (Optional) ............................................................................................ 17
BUCKET TEETH REPLACEMENT............................................................................................................ 18

LOADER REMOVAL....................................................................................................................................... 19
LOADER ATTACHMENT (B90B - B100B - B110B) .................................................................................. 19
LOADER ATTACHMENT
(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B) ..................................................................................................................... 21

SECTION 84 - BACKHOE
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION................................................................................................................... 3

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROLS.......................................................................................................... 6


BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MECHANICAL CONTROLS ............................................................................ 7
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT HYDRAULIC CONTROLS ............................................................................. 17
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT (Sideshift version) ...................................................................... 23

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY .................................................................................................. 25


CENTER PIVOT BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY.................................................................. 25
SIDESHIFT BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY.......................................................................... 28
BACKHOE BUCKET REPLACEMENT...................................................................................................... 30
BUCKET TEETH REPLACEMENT............................................................................................................ 31
DIPPER REMOVE ..................................................................................................................................... 32

TELESCOPIC DIPPER REVISION................................................................................................................. 35


OVERHAUL ............................................................................................................................................... 35

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT HYDRAULIC HANDLING ................................................................................... 38


CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................... 38
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM ............................................................................................................................ 38
HANDLING CYLINDER ............................................................................................................................. 39
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 40
INDEX
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES


2 SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES
SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES 3

SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS

S WARNING S
This warning symbol points out important mes-
sages involving your safety.
Carefully read the safety rules contained herein
and follow advised precautions to avoid potential
hazards and to safeguard your safety and personal
integrity.
In this manual you will find this symbol together
with the following keywords:

S WARNING S
This symbol warns about the possibility of potential
damages to the machine that can involve the oper-
ator’s safety.

S WARNING S
With specific warnings about potential dangers for
the operator’s or other persons integrity directly or
indirectly involved.

The non-compliance with the warnings preceded by


the above-mentioned keywords (WARNING and
DANGER) can cause serious accidents or even the
death of the persons involved.
Moreover, in the present Manual, some instructions
are given with text in italics, preceded by the words
NOTE and CAUTION.
NOTA: it emphasizes and underlines to the operator
the correct technique or correct procedure to follow.

S WARNING S
This symbol warns about the possibility of potential
damages to the machine that can involve the oper-
ator’s safety.
4 SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES

FOREWORD
Loader backhoes B90B - B90BLR - B100B -
B100BLR - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B
have been designed to perform most earth-moving
operations.
If you use this machine for duties involving the use
of attachments, accessories, or special tools, con-
sult your Dealer to make sure that the adaptations or
modifications carried out are in conformity with the
machine’s technical specifications and with current
regulations on safety.
Any modifications or adaptations which are not
approved by the manufacturer may invalidate the
machine’s original conformity with safety require-
1
ments.
The machine must be used according to its intended
use, respecting the safety and precautionary rules
and strictly following the operating instructions.
Any functional disorders, especially those affecting
the safety of the machine, should therefore be recti-
fied immediately.

S DANGER S
A different use of the excavator or of its working
equipment:
- for lifting or transporting persons;
- as working platform;
- for lifting loads without the attachment being
approved for this purpose;
- for pulling loads;
- is considered unintended use.
Unintended use may cause injury or life-threatening
risks for the operator and for other persons.

The manufacturer/supplier cannot be held responsi-


ble for any damage resulting from unintended use.
The risk involved in such misuse lies entirely with
the user.

S DANGER S
It is absolutely forbidden to tamper with and/or
change the setting of any of the hydraulic system
valves to avoid damaging machine components,
with a consequent risk for personal safety.

The current Operator’s Manual is the user’s guide


for correct run-in, use and maintenance of the
machine.
SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES 5

Carefully read this Operator’s Manual and store it in SPARE PARTS


the cab for quick location and reference. The “non-genuine” spare parts have not been
Instructions concerning safety, operation and main- checked and authorized by the Manufacturer.
tenance have been developed to permit safe serv- The assembly and/or use of such products may
ice and repair of this machine without any risk. have negative effects on the machine design fea-
In the event of queries or suggestions relevant to tures and could impair its operation safety.
your machine do not hesitate to address to your
The Manufacturer is not liable for any damage
Dealer.
caused by “non-genuine” spare parts or accesso-
Dealers have qualified and trained personnel at dis- ries.
posal as well as Original Spares, means and equip-
ment suitable to carry out all necessary
maintenance. WARRANTY
Any modifications or adaptations which are not ap- This machine is under warranty according to the
proved by the manufacturer may invalidate the ma- regulations in force in Your Country and in compli-
chine’s original conformity with safety requirements. ance with the sales agreement drawn up with the
IMPORTANTE: the engine and fuel system on your Dealer.
machine are designed and built to government The warranty, however, expires if the operation and
emissions standards. Tampering by dealers, cus- maintenance instruction for this machine and con-
tomers, operators and users is strictly prohibited by tained in this manual, have not been followed.
law. Failure to comply with this prohibition could
result in government fines, rework charges, invalid
warranty, legal action and possible confiscation of
the machine until rework to original condition is
completed. Engine service and/or repairs must be
carried out by a certified technician only.
NOTA: each machine is supplied complete with a
copy of this Manual. Descriptions and illustrations
provided herein are not binding. The Manufacturer,
provided that the basic characteristics of machine
types described and shown in this Manual remain
the same, reserves the right to change compo-
nents, parts and accessories supplied without any
commitment to timely update this publication; and
this any time it deems it convenient for improve-
ment purposes or due to commercial or manufac-
turing requirements. For exact information, please
consult your Dealer or contact the Manufacturer’s
Branch Offices, who remain at your disposal for fur-
ther help.
6 SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES

SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
Carefully read the safety rules contained herein and
follow advised precautions to avoid potential haz-
ards and to safeguard your safety and personal
integrity.
Your safety and that of the people around you
depends on you.
It is essential that you understand this manual for a
correct inspection, lubrication and repair of this
machine.
Read this manual carefully and check that:
- you understand fully the symbols on the controls
and the safety signs used in this manual and on
the machine;
- you understand fully the speed, stability, braking
and steering characteristics of the machine. If you
are in any doubt, consult your Dealer.
The safety messages in this section concern situa-
tions which may arise during normal machine opera-
tion, servicing and repair. These safety messages
also indicate the different ways of coping with these
situations. Other safety messages are used
throughout the manual to indicate specific dangers.
The information given in this chapter is a summary
of the basic rules to respect at all times and does
not exempt you from observing traffic regulations or
the requirements of insurance companies.
The presence of grease, oil, mud or (in winter) ice
on the steps and access handles can cause acci-
dents. Make sure they are always clean.
When mounting or dismounting from the machine
always face the machine and use the steps and
access handles on the left-hand side of the
machine.
SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES 7

Wear close fitting clothing and safety equipment


appropriate for the job:
- safety helmet;
- safety shoes;
- heavy gloves;
- reflective clothing;
- wet weather clothing.
If the environment conditions make it necessary, the
following personal safety equipment should be at
hand:
- respirators (or dustproof masks);
- ear plugs or acoustic ears protections;
- goggles with lateral shield or masks for eyes pro-
tection.
Do not wear rings, wristwatches, jewels, unbuttoned
or flapping clothing such as ties, torn clothes,
scarves, open jackets or shirts with open zips which
could get caught into moving parts.
Do not use this machine for any applications or pur-
poses other than those described in this manual.
If you use this machine for duties involving the use
of attachments, accessories, or special tools, con-
sult your Dealer to make sure that the adaptations
or modifications carried out are in conformity with
the machine’s technical specifications and with cur-
rent regulations on safety.
Any modifications or adaptations which are not
approved by the manufacturer may invalidate the
machine’s original conformity with safety require-
ments.
Any functional disorders, especially those affecting
the safety of the machine, should therefore be recti-
fied immediately.
Make sure that you fully understand the symbols of
the safety decals applied on the machine. Make
sure that they are always clean and perfectly legi-
ble.
Be prepared for emergencies.
Always keep a first aid kit and a fire extinguisher
close at hand on the machine.
Make sure that the fire extinguisher is serviced in
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
8 SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES

PREVENTION OF FIRE OR EXPLOSIONS


The engine fuel can originate an explosion or a fire.
Never refuel when the engine is running.
Do not smoke during refuelling.
Take all the necessary safety measures when weld-
ing, grinding or when working near a naked flame.
Use a non-inflammable product for cleaning parts.

A spark or a flame can cause the electrolyte of the


battery to explode.
To prevent any risk of explosion, observe the follow-
ing instructions:
- when disconnecting the battery cables, always
disconnect the negative (-) cable first;
- to reconnect the battery cables, always connect
the negative (-) cable last;
- never short-circuit the battery clamps with metal
objects;
- do not weld, grind or smoke near a battery.
The engine exhaust may produce sparks.
Before using the machine in an area which may
contain inflammable vapours, ensure that there is
good ventilation.
Always keep a fire extinguisher available on the
machine.
Make sure that it is properly maintained in conform-
ity with the manufacturer’s instructions.
SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES 9

PREVENTION OF BURNS
The battery electrolyte generates severe burns.
The battery contains sulphuric acid.
Avoid any contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Antidote:
- EXTERNAL: rinse well with water, removing any
soiled clothing.
- INTERNAL: avoid vomiting. Drink water to rinse
your mouth. Consult a doctor.
- EYES: rinse thoroughly with water for 15 minutes
and get prompt medical attention.
When the electrolyte of a battery is frozen, it can
explode if you attempt to charge the battery or if you
try to start the engine using a booster battery.
Always keep the battery charged to prevent the elec-
trolyte freezing.
Batteries generate explosive gases.
Keep all flames, sparks and cigarettes away.
Provide good ventilation when changing a battery or
using a battery in an enclosed space.
Always protect your eyes when working near a bat-
tery.
Never touch the battery terminals with your hands.
This can induce a state of electrolysis and impair the
main organs of the body.

Hot coolant could spray out if the radiator cap is


removed while the system is still hot.
To remove the cap: allow the system to cool down,
turn the cap to the first notch and wait until there is
no more pressure.
Then remove the cap.
10 SECTION 00 - SAFETY RULES

PRECAUTIONS FOR WASTE DISPOSAL


Improperly disposing of waste can threaten the envi-
ronment.
Each country has its own Regulations on this sub-
ject. It is therefore advisable to prepare suitable con-
tainers to collect and store momentarily all solid and
fluid materials that must not be scattered in the envi-
ronment to avoid pollution.
At preset intervals these products will be delivered
to disposal stations legally recognized and present
in this Country.
Here below is a list of the products in the machine
which require disposal:
- hydraulic oil;
- brake system oil;
- coolant mixture, condensation residue and pure
anti-freeze;
- diesel oil;
- oil and diesel oil filter elements;
- engine and air conditioning air filter elements;
- battery.
Also polluting rags, paper, sawdust and gloves must
be disposed in compliance with the same proce-
dures.
Do not use food or beverage containers that may
mislead someone into drinking from them.
Do not pour waste onto the ground, down a drain, or
into any water source.
Air conditioning coolant escaping into the air can
damage the Earth’s atmosphere.
Government regulations may require a certified air
conditioning service centre to recover and recycle
used air conditioning coolant.
Obtain information on the proper way to recycle or
dispose of waste from your local environmental or
recycling centre, or from your Dealer.
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 01 - MAINTENANCE
2 SECTION 01 - MAINTENANCE
SECTION 01 - MAINTENANCE 3

Do not carry out any service operation until you


have read and understood the instructions and
warnings given in this manual.
Observe the adjusting, maintenance and inspection
activities and intervals set out in the operating
instructions, including information on the replace-
ment of parts and equipment as this service con-
cerns exclusively the qualified personnel.
Wear safety equipment and suitable clothing to per-
form maintenance operations on the machine.
During maintenance operations, apply a warning
plate.

Always wear eye protection when using a tool which


might project metal particles. Use a hammer with a
soft face, such as copper, for pin assembly.
Incorrectly performed maintenance or adjustments
can cause serious injury. If you do not understand a
maintenance or adjustment procedure, consult your
Dealer.
Before performing any maintenance operation on
this machine, make sure it is in a safety condition.

Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away


from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Rest the loader attachment on the ground if no
maintenance operation is to be performed on it. Oth-
erwise, raise the attachment and block the support
strut.
Place the backhoe attachment in road travel posi-
tion if no maintenance operation is to be performed
on it. Otherwise, rest it on the ground.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Completely raise the stabilizers and lock them
mechanically.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Open the oil tank plug.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions. On hydraulically con-
trolled machines, turn the key to ON and release the
pressure by moving the hydraulic control levers in
all directions.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
4 SECTION 01 - MAINTENANCE

Place some wedges under the wheels so as to pre-


vent the machine from moving.
Unauthorized modifications of the machine can
cause serious injuries.
Do not carry out any modification on this machine
without obtaining prior authorization from your
Dealer.
Any modification carried out must be in conformity
with the machine’s technical specifications and must
conform to current safety regulations.
Do not carry out any welding operation on the
machine without prior authorization from your
Dealer.
Some of the machine’s components are subject to
type approvals. It is mandatory when replacing
those components to ensure that they are in con-
formity with regulations.
Hydraulic fluid or grease under pressure which pen-
etrates the skin can cause serious injury.
Take the necessary safety precautions (protective
clothing and face and hand protection) to prevent all
such risks.
In addition, before handling these products, read the
manufacturer’s specific instructions for their use.
If hydraulic fluid penetrates the skin a doctor must
be called immediately.
When carrying out a welding operation on the
machine, as authorized by the manufacturer and in
accordance with his specifications, disconnect the
electric system by means of the battery master
switch, connect the welding set earth lead to the
component on which the welding is to be carried out
(never connect the ground lead to a hydraulic sys-
tem component) and disconnect the electric cables
of the motor control unit (in case of electronic
motors).
A burst tyre can cause serious injury.
Regularly check the condition of tyres and always
observe the inflation pressures defined in accord-
ance with the type of tyre and ground conditions.
SECTION 01 - MAINTENANCE 5

When checking the tyre pressure or during an infla-


tion operation, never stay in front of the tyre but
always keep to the tread side.
Always use an inflation cage when the wheel is
removed from the machine.
Keep all other persons away from the area.
Never weld near a tyre. It is essential to remove the
tyre before any welding operation.
Take the necessary safety measures to protect your
face when using compressed air.
The machine’s structure is in conformity with the
FOPS and ROPS protection standards.
Any modification (drilling, welding, etc.) may cause
that conformity to be invalidated.
6 SECTION 01 - MAINTENANCE

NOTE:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL
SPECIFICATIONS

MODELS........................................................................................................................................................... 3

IDENTIFICATION OF MAIN COMPONENTS................................................................................................... 4

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS....................................................................................................................... 7
DIESEL ENGINE ......................................................................................................................................... 7
TRANSMISSION........................................................................................................................................ 10
AXLES ....................................................................................................................................................... 11
BRAKES .................................................................................................................................................... 11
STEERING................................................................................................................................................. 12
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM .............................................................................................................................. 12
FRONT COUNTERWEIGHT ..................................................................................................................... 13
NOISE AND VIBRATION LEVELS ............................................................................................................ 13
BUCKETS .................................................................................................................................................. 13
TYRES ....................................................................................................................................................... 14

DIMENSIONS AND PERFORMANCE............................................................................................................ 15


DIMENSIONS - 2WS SIDESHIFT ............................................................................................................. 15
DIMENSIONS - 2WS CENTER PIVOT...................................................................................................... 16
DIMENSIONS - 2WS TC - SIDESHIFT ..................................................................................................... 17
DIMENSIONS - 4WS SIDESHIFT ............................................................................................................. 18
DIMENSIONS - 4WS CENTER PIVOT...................................................................................................... 19
LOADER ATTACHMENT PERFORMANCE.............................................................................................. 20
PERFORMANCE OF LOADER ATTACHMENT WITH FORKS ................................................................ 30
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT PERFORMANCE........................................................................................... 35

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LIFTING CAPACITY ........................................................................................... 55

MAXIMUM LIFTING LOADS........................................................................................................................... 61


LOADER ATTACHMENT MAXIMUM LIFTING LOAD TABLE .................................................................. 61
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MAXIMUM LIFTING LOAD TABLE ............................................................... 62

SUPPLY SUMMARY TABLE .......................................................................................................................... 63


2 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

1.
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 3

MODELS

B90B B100B B110B B115B


B90BLR B100BLR B110BTC
B100BTC
Powershift / / • •
Powershuttle • • • /
Stabilizer sideshift • • • •
Stabilizer center pivot / / • •
Cab • • • •
Rops • / / /
2WD • / / /
4WD • • • •
4WS / / / •
“Pilot” backhoe attachment controls • • • •
Backhoe attachment mechanical controls • • • •
Engine Iveco 72 kW - 97 HP model
• / / /
F4GE9484C*601 (mechanical)
Engine Iveco 72 kW - 97 HP model
/ • / /
F4HE0484G*J102 (electronic)
Engine 82 kW - 110 HP model
/ / • /
F4HE9484C*J102 (electronic)
Engine 82 kW - 110 HP (4WS) model
/ / / •
F4HE9484C*J103 (electronic)
Short backhoe dipper • • / /
Long backhoe dipper / • • •
4 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

IDENTIFICATION OF MAIN COMPONENTS


SIDESHIFT VERSION

1. Loader bucket 8. Backhoe attachment boom


2. Loader arm 9. Dipper or telescopic dipper
3. Front axle 10. Backhoe bucket
4. Fuel tank 11. Backhoe attachment sideshift carriage
5. Rear axle 12. Stabilizers
6. Operator’s compartment - Cab 13. Battery box
7. Engine guard 14. Hydraulic oil tank
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 5

TC VERSION

1. Loader bucket 8. Backhoe attachment boom


2. Loader arm 9. Dipper or telescopic dipper
3. Front axle 10. Backhoe bucket
4. Fuel tank 11. Backhoe attachment sideshift carriage
5. Rear axle 12. Stabilizers
6. Operator’s compartment - Cab 13. Battery box
7. Engine guard 14. Hydraulic oil tank
6 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

CENTER PIVOT VERSION

1. Loader bucket 8. Backhoe attachment boom


2. Loader arm 9. Dipper or telescopic dipper
3. Front axle 10. Backhoe bucket
4. Fuel tank 11. Stabilizers
5. Rear axle 12. Battery box
6. Operator’s compartment - Cab 13. Hydraulic oil tank
7. Engine guard 14. Swing cylinders
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 7

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

DIESEL ENGINE
72 kW - 97 HP ENGINE (B90B)
Specifications (ISO 14396) ..................................................................................... 72 kW - 97 HP @ 2200 rpm
Model ....................................................................................................................................... F4GE9484C*601
Type ....................................................................................................................................... diesel, mechanical
No. of cylinders ................................................................................................................................................. 4
Valves per cylinder............................................................................................................................................ 2
Bore .............................................................................................................................................. 104 mm (4 in)
Stroke......................................................................................................................................... 132 mm (5.2 in)
Displacement ................................................................................................................... 4485 cm3 (237.69 in3)
Compression ratio..................................................................................................................................... 17.5:1
Maximum torque (EC).......................................................................................420 Nm (309 lbf·ft) @ 1250 rpm
Low idle speed at no load ............................................................................................................ 1000 ± 50 rpm
High idle speed at no load (engine not installed) ......................................................................... 2430 ± 50 rpm
High idle speed at no load (engine not installed on the vehicle).................................................. 2380 ± 60 rpm
Maximum speed at full load ................................................................................................................. 2200 rpm
Air intake .................................................................................................... TAA (turbocharged with aftercooler)

Supply
Type ............................................................................................................................................. direct injection
Injection pump..............................................................................................BOSCH ROTARY VE 4/12 F1100L
Injection sequence ................................................................................................................................... 1-3-4-2
Cold-start device ..............................................................................................................“grid heater” (optional)

Cooling
Pump type.......................................................................................................................................... H2O pump
Pump drive............................................................................................................................................ belt drive
Temperature switch (opening start) ......................................................................... 81 ± 2 °C (177.8 ± 35.6 °F)
8 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

72 kW - 97 HP ENGINE (B100B - B100BTC)


Specifications (ISO 14396) ..................................................................................... 72 kW - 97 HP @ 2200 rpm
Model ..................................................................................................................................... F4HE0484G*J102
Type ......................................................................................................................................... diesel, electronic
No. of cylinders ................................................................................................................................................. 4
Valves per cylinder............................................................................................................................................ 4
Bore............................................................................................................................................... 104 mm (4 in)
Stroke......................................................................................................................................... 132 mm (5.2 in)
Displacement ................................................................................................................... 4485 cm3 (237.69 in3)
Compression ratio ..................................................................................................................................... 17.5:1
Maximum torque (EC) .......................................................................................453 Nm (334 lbf·ft) @ 1400 rpm
Low idle speed at no load ............................................................................................................ 1000 ± 50 rpm
High idle speed at no load (engine not installed) ......................................................................... 2430 ± 50 rpm
High idle speed at no load (engine not installed on the vehicle) .................................................. 2380 ± 60 rpm
Maximum speed at full load ................................................................................................................. 2200 rpm
Air intake .................................................................................................... TAA (turbocharged with aftercooler)

Supply
Type .........................................................................................................................high-pressure, common rail
Injection pump............................................................................................................. CP3 high-pressure pump
Control unit.................................................................................................................................................EDC7
Injection sequence ...................................................................................................................................1-3-4-2
Cold-start device ..............................................................................................................“grid heater” (optional)

Cooling
Pump type .......................................................................................................................................... H2O pump
Pump drive ............................................................................................................................................belt drive
Temperature switch (opening start) ......................................................................... 81 ± 2 °C (177.8 ± 35.6 °F)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 9

82 kW - 110 HP ENGINE (B110B - B110BTC - B115B)


Specifications (ISO 14396) ................................................................................... 82 kW - 110 HP @ 2200 rpm
Model (B110B-B110BTC) ...................................................................................................... F4HE9484C*J102
Model (B115B) ....................................................................................................................... F4HE9484C*J103
Type ..........................................................................................................................................diesel, electronic
No. of cylinders ................................................................................................................................................. 4
Valves per cylinder............................................................................................................................................ 4
Bore .............................................................................................................................................. 104 mm (4 in)
Stroke......................................................................................................................................... 132 mm (5.2 in)
Displacement ................................................................................................................... 4485 cm3 (237.69 in3)
Compression ratio..................................................................................................................................... 17.5:1
Maximum torque (EC)..................................................................................516 Nm (380,58 lbf·ft) @ 1400 rpm
Low idle speed at no load ............................................................................................................ 1000 ± 50 rpm
High idle speed at no load (engine not installed) ......................................................................... 2430 ± 50 rpm
High idle speed at no load (engine not installed on the vehicle).................................................. 2380 ± 60 rpm
Maximum speed at full load ................................................................................................................. 2200 rpm
Air intake .................................................................................................... TAA (turbocharged with aftercooler)

Supply
Type ......................................................................................................................... high-pressure, common rail
Injection pump............................................................................................................. CP3 high-pressure pump
Control unit................................................................................................................................................. EDC7
Injection sequence ................................................................................................................................... 1-3-4-2
Cold-start device ..............................................................................................................“grid heater” (optional)

Cooling
Pump type.......................................................................................................................................... H2O pump
Pump drive............................................................................................................................................ belt drive
Temperature switch (opening start) ......................................................................... 81 ± 2 °C (177.8 ± 35.6 °F)
10 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

TRANSMISSION
2WD/2WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHUTTLE (B90B)
Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB1 MPB 2WD
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 5.603:1 reverse travel 4.643:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 3.481:1 reverse travel 2.884:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.585:1 reverse travel 1.313:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.793:1 reverse travel 0.657:1

4WD/2WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHUTTLE (B90B - B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC)


Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB1 MPB 4WD
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 5.603:1 reverse travel 4.643:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 3.481:1 reverse travel 2.884:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.585:1 reverse travel 1.313:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.793:1 reverse travel 0.657:1

4WD/2WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHIFT (B110B - B110BTC)


Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB2 MPB 4WD
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 5.533:1 reverse travel 4.549:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 3.359:1 reverse travel 2.762:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.553:1 reverse travel 1.260:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.811:1

4WD/4WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHIFT (B115B)


Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB2 MPB 4WS
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 4.448:1 reverse travel 3.657:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 2.700:1 reverse travel 2.220:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.232:1 reverse travel 1.013:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.652:1
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 11

AXLES
FRONT AXLES
Front 2WD/2WS axle (B90B)
Model ...........................................................................................................................................................CNH
Type ........................................................................................................................................................steering
4WD/2WS front axle (B90B - B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC)
Model ...........................................................................................................................................................CNH
Type ........................................................................................................................................................steering
4WD/4WS front axle (B115B)
Model ...................................................................................................................................... CARRARO 26.32
Type ........................................................................................................................................................steering

REAR AXLES
2WS rear axle
Model (B90B - B100B - B100BTC) ......................................................................................... CARRARO 28.44
Model (B110B - B110BTC) ..................................................................................................... CARRARO 28.50
Type ..............................................................................................................................................................rigid
4WS rear axle (B115B)
Model ................................................................................................................................... CARRARO 26.32M
Type ........................................................................................................................................................steering
Differential lock ........................................................................................................................................ electric

BRAKES
SERVICE BRAKES
2WS
Type ........................................................................................................ wet multi-discs, 4 x axle (2 x half axle)
Braking surface .................................................................................................................... 1236 cm2 (191 in2)
4WS
Type ........................................................................................................ wet multi-discs, 6 x axle (3 x half axle)
Braking surface ..................................................................................................................... 1092 cm2 (169 in2)

PARKING BRAKE
Type ...................................................................................................................................... manual, with lever
Maximum lever pull ...................................................................................................................1650 N (371 lbf)
Lever stroke .............................................................................................................................. 21 mm (0.87 in)
Maximum torque - POWERSHUTTLE ...................................................................................2000 Nm (450 lbf)
Maximum torque - POWERSHIFT .........................................................................................1500 Nm (337 lbf)
12 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

STEERING
2WS ............................................................................................................................................... 2 wheel steer
4WS ............................................................................................................................................... 4 wheel steer
System pressure .............................................................................................. 170 ÷ 175 bar (2465 ÷ 2538 psi)

POWER STEERING
2WS (with variable-flow-rate pump)
Model ........................................................................................................................ EATON P/N 403 -8754-04
Flow rate .................................................................................................................... 160 cm3/rev (9.76 in3/rev)
Shock valve adjustment ......................................................................................................... 235 bar (3408 psi)
Load-sensing pressure relief valve adjustment...................................................................... 175 bar (2538 psi)
2WS (with gear pump)
Model ........................................................................................................................ EATON P/N 403 -8754-08
Flow rate .................................................................................................................... 160 cm3/rev (9.76 in3/rev)
Shock valve adjustment ......................................................................................................... 235 bar (3408 psi)
Load-sensing pressure relief valve adjustment...............................................................................................No
4WS
Model ........................................................................................................................ EATON P/N 403 -7754-04
Flow rate .................................................................................................................... 160 cm3/rev (9.76 in3/rev)
Shock valve adjustment ......................................................................................................... 235 bar (3408 psi)
Load-sensing pressure relief valve adjustment...................................................................... 175 bar (2538 psi)

HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
GEAR PUMP
72 kW - 97 HP Pump (B90B - B100B - B100BTC)
Model .......................................................................................................... CASAPPA KP 30.34 - 05 S6 - LMF
Type ....................................................................................................................................... double gear pump
Flow rate ....................................................................................35.427 + 35.427 cm3/rev (2.16 + 2.16 in3/rev)
82 kW - 110 HP Pump (B110B - B110BTC - B115B)
Model .......................................................................................................... CASAPPA KP 30.38 - 05 S6 - LMF
Type ....................................................................................................................................... double gear pump
Flow rate ....................................................................................40.258 + 35.427 cm3/rev (2.45 + 2.16 in3/rev)

VARIABLE-FLOW-RATE PUMP
72 kW - 97 HP Pump (B90B - B100B - B100BTC)
Model ....................................................................................................................... DANFOSS J71C Series 45
Type ......................................................................................................................................... with axial pistons
Flow rate ..................................................................................................................... 71 cm3/rev (4.33 in3/rev)
82 kW - 110 HP Pump (B110B - B110BTC - B115B)
Model ....................................................................................................................... DANFOSS J75C Series 45
Type ......................................................................................................................................... with axial pistons
Flow rate ..................................................................................................................... 75 cm3/rev (4.57 in3/rev)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 13

FRONT COUNTERWEIGHT
COUNTERWEIGHT - 2WS
Standard .................................................................................................................................. 127.3 kg (281 lb)
Medium ....................................................................................................................................... 370 kg (816 lb)
Big.......................................................................................................................................... 483.7 kg (1066 lb)

COUNTERWEIGHT - 4WS
Standard .................................................................................................................................. 125.5 kg (276 lb)
Medium ....................................................................................................................................... 333 kg (733 lb)

NOISE AND VIBRATION LEVELS


NOISE LEVEL
Certified by the Manufacturer.
In compliance with European Directive 2000/14/EC - Stage II.
Internal noise level (LpA) ........................................................................................................................... 77 db
External noise level (LwA) (B90B - B100B - B100BTC) .......................................................................... 102 db
External noise level (LwA) (B110B - B110BTC - B115B) ........................................................................ 103 db

VIBRATION LEVEL INSIDE THE CAB


Upper limbs.................................................................................................................. level lower than 2.5 m/s2
Abdomen...................................................................................................................... level lower than 0.5 m/s2

BUCKETS
LOADER BUCKETS

Type 0.88 m3 (31.07 ft3) 1 m3 (35.3 ft3) 4x1 6x1 (with forks)
standard standard

2WS Heaped capacity 0.88 m3 (31.07 ft3) 1.0 m3 (35.3 ft3) 1.0 m3 (35.3 ft3) 1.0 m3 (35.3 ft3)
Width 2250 mm (88.58 in) 2250 mm (88.58 in) 2250 mm (88.58 in) 2250 mm (88.58 in)
Weight 310 kg (682 lb) 400 kg (880 lb) 750 kg (1650 lb) 950 kg (2090 lb)
Heaped capacity - 1.15 m3 (40.6 ft3) 1.15 m3 (40.6 ft3) 1.15 m3 (40.6 ft3)
4WS Width - 2350 mm (92.52 in) 2350 mm (92.52 in) 2350 mm (92.52 in)
Weight - 415 kg (913 lb) 770 kg (1694 lb) 970 kg (2134 lb)

BACKHOE BUCKETS

305 mm 457 mm 610 mm 762 mm 910 mm


Width
(12 in) (17.99 in) (24.01 in) (30 in) (35.82 in)
2WS 0.067 m3 0.108 m3 0.149 m3 0.190 m3 0.231 m3
+ Capacity
(2.36 in3) (3.81 in3) (5.26 in3) (6.70 in3) (8.15 in3)
4WS
0.081 m3 0.137 m3 0.198 m3 0.260 m3 0.323 m3
Heaped capacity
(2.86 in3) (4.83 in3) (6.99 in3) (9.18 in3) (11.4 in3)
14 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

TYRES
TYRE TYPES
Tyres - 2WS

Front tyres Rear tyres

2WD 11L-16 F3 12PR 18.4-26 R4 10PR

11L-16 F3 12PR 16.9-28 R4 10PR

4WD 12.5/80 - 18 I3 18.4-26 R4 10PR

12.5/80 - 18 I3 16.9-28 R4 10PR

320/80 R18 IT 520 480/80 R26

Tyres - 4WS

Front and rear tyres

16.9/24 R4 12PR

16.9/28 R4 12PR

440/80 R28 IT520

440/80 R28 IT530

NUT TORQUES
Front nuts (2WS).................................................................................................................. 330 Nm (243 lbf·ft)
Rear nuts (2WS) .................................................................................................................. 540 Nm (398 lbf·ft)
Front and rear nuts (4WS) .................................................................................................... 700 Nm (516 lbf·ft)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 15

DIMENSIONS AND PERFORMANCE

DIMENSIONS - 2WS SIDESHIFT

Front tyres ..................................................................................................................................... 12.5/80-18 I3


Rear tyres ..........................................................................................................................................18.4-26 R4
Standard loader bucket.......................................................................................................... 0.88 m3 (31.07 ft3)
Standard backhoe bucket ...................................................................................................... 910 mm (35.82 in)

A Overall machine length 5825 mm (229.33 in)


B Loader bucket reach 1870 mm (73.62 in)
C Wheel base 2175 mm (85.62 in)
D Backhoe bucket dimensions 1780 mm (70.07 in)
E Rear wheel base - backhoe attachment swing support 1321 mm (52 in)
F Maximum machine height 3875 mm (152.55 in)
G Stabilizer width 2275 mm (89.56 in)
H Cab height 2940 mm (115.74 in)
I Loader bucket width 2250 mm (88.58 in)
16 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

DIMENSIONS - 2WS CENTER PIVOT

Front tyres ..................................................................................................................................... 12.5/80-18 I3


Rear tyres.......................................................................................................................................... 18.4-26 R4
Standard loader bucket ..........................................................................................................0.88 m3 (31.07 ft3)
Standard backhoe bucket ...................................................................................................... 910 mm (35.82 in)

A Overall machine length 6985 mm (274.99 in)


B Loader bucket reach 1870 mm (73.62 in)
C Wheel base 2175 mm (85.62 in)
D Backhoe bucket dimensions 2940 mm (115.74 in)
E Rear wheel base - backhoe attachment swing support 1120 mm (44.09 in)
F Maximum machine height 3875 mm (152.55 in)
G Stabilizer width 2290 mm (90.15 in)
H Cab height 2940 mm (115.74 in)
I Loader bucket width 2250 mm (88.58 in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 17

DIMENSIONS - 2WS TC - SIDESHIFT

Front tyres ..................................................................................................................................... 12.5/80-18 I3


Rear tyres ..........................................................................................................................................18.4-26 R4
Standard loader bucket..........................................................................................................0.88 m3 (31.07 ft3)
Standard backhoe bucket ...................................................................................................... 910 mm (35.82 in)

A Overall machine length 5928 mm (233.38 in)


B Loader bucket reach 1973 mm (77.68 in)
C Wheel base 2175 mm (85.62 in)
D Backhoe bucket dimensions 1780 mm (70.07 in)
E Rear wheel base - backhoe attachment swing support 1321 mm (52.00 in)
F Maximum machine height 3875 mm (152.55 in)
G Stabilizer width 2275 mm (89.56 in)
H Cab height 2940 mm (115.74 in)
I Loader bucket width 2250 mm (88.58 in)
18 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

DIMENSIONS - 4WS SIDESHIFT

Front and rear tyres................................................................................................................ 440/80-R28 IT530


Standard loader bucket ..........................................................................................................1.15 m3 (40.61 ft3)
Standard backhoe bucket ...................................................................................................... 910 mm (35.82 in)

A Overall machine length 5945 mm (234.05 in)


B Loader bucket reach 1965 mm (77.36 in)
C Wheel base 2200 mm (86.61 in)
D Backhoe bucket dimensions 1780 mm (70.07 in)
E Rear wheel base - backhoe attachment swing support 1321 mm (52.00 in)
F Maximum machine height 4010 mm (157.87 in)
G Stabilizer width 2275 mm (89.56 in)
H Cab height 3060 mm (120.47 in)
I Loader bucket width 2400 mm (94.48 in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 19

DIMENSIONS - 4WS CENTER PIVOT

Front and rear tyres ...............................................................................................................440/80 R28 IT530


Standard loader bucket.......................................................................................................... 1.15 m3 (40.61 ft3)
Standard backhoe bucket ...................................................................................................... 910 mm (35.82 in)

A Overall machine length 7080 mm (278.73 in)


B Loader bucket reach 1970 mm (77.55 in)
C Wheel base 2200 mm (86.61 in)
D Backhoe bucket dimensions 2910 mm (114.56 in)
E Rear wheel base - backhoe attachment swing support 1120 mm (44.09 in)
F Maximum machine height 4000 mm (157.48 in)
G Stabilizer width 2380 mm (93.70 in)
H Cab height 3065 mm (120.66 in)
I Loader bucket width 2400 mm (94.48 in)
20 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

LOADER ATTACHMENT PERFORMANCE

B90B, B100B AND B110B [WITH STANDARD BUCKET 1 m3 (35.3 ft3)]

4 Front counterweight
A. Maximum height/dimensions
B. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot
C. Maximum dumping height
D. Digging depth
E. Loader attachment reach when raised in
dumping position
F. Loader attachment reach when lowered with
retracted bucket
G. Attachment reach in digging position
H. Attachment reach when lowered
α. Angle of lowered closed bucket
β. Angle of closed bucket at maximum height
χ. Dumping angle
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 21

12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18


Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
4309 4310 4309 4302 4227 4228 4333 4328
A
(169.64) (169.68) (169.64) (169.37) (166.41) (166.45) (170.59) (170.39)
3481 3482 3481 3474 3400 3400 3505 3501
B
(137.04) (137.08) (137.04) (136.77) (133.85) (133.85) (137.99) (137.83)
2749 2750 2749 2742 2654 2655 2778 2771
C
(108.22) (108.26) (108.22) (107.95) (143.85) (104.52) (109.37) (109.09)
100 98 99 106 187 187 73 79
D
(3.93) (3.85) (3.89) (4.17) (7.36) (7.36) (2.87) (3.11)
783 780 782 782 838 837 759 771
E
(30.82) (30.70) (30.78) (30.78) (32.99) (32.95) (29.88) (30.35)
1423 1423 1423 1427 1467 1466 1410 1413
F
(56.02) (56.02) (56.02) (56.18) (57.75) (57.72) (55.51) (55.62)
1416 1417 1417 1417 1399 1400 1423 1420
G
(55.74) (55.78) (55.78) (55.78) (55.07) (55.11) (56) (55.90)
1491 1491 1491 1496 1541 1541 1477 1479
H
(58.70) (58.70) (58.70) (58.89) (60.66) (60.66) (58.14) (58.22)
α 39.4° 39.4° 39.4° 39.6° 40.4° 40.4° 39.3° 39.1°

β 49.9° 50° 50° 50° 48.4° 48.4° 50.6° 50.3°

χ 43.4° 43.3° 43.4° 43.4° 44.9° 44.9° 42.7° 43.1°


mm (in)
22 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

[WITH STANDARD BUCKET 1 m3 (35.3 ft3)]

4 Front counterweight
A. Maximum height/dimensions Front tyres 12.5-18 SLR4

B. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot Rear tyres 18.4-28 SLR4


C. Maximum dumping height A 4250 (167.32)
D. Digging depth B 3458 (136.14)
E. Loader attachment reach when raised in dump-
ing position C 3218 (126.69)

F. Loader attachment reach when lowered with D 120 (4.72)


retracted bucket E 829 (32.64)
G. Attachment reach in digging position
F -
H. Attachment reach when lowered
G -
α. Angle of lowered closed bucket
β. Angle of closed bucket at maximum height H -
χ. Dumping angle α 43.4°

β -

χ 45°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 23

B90B, B100B AND B110B [WITH 4x1 BUCKET 1 m3 (35.3 ft3)]

4 Front counterweight
A. Maximum height/dimensions
B. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot
C. Maximum dumping height
D. Digging depth
E. Loader attachment reach when raised in
dumping position
F. Loader attachment reach when lowered with
retracted bucket
G. Attachment reach in digging position
H. Attachment reach when lowered
α. Angle of lowered closed bucket
β. Angle of closed bucket at maximum height
χ. Dumping angle
24 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18


Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
4461 4462 4461 4454 4379 4379 4484 4480
A
(175.62) (175.66) (175.62) (175.35) (172.40) (172.40) (176.53) (176.37)
3481 3482 3481 3474 3400 3400 3505 3501
B
(137.04) (137.08) (137.04) (136.77) (133.85) (133.85) (137.99) (137.83)
2777 2779 2777 2770 2677 2678 2808 2800
C
(109.33) (109.40) (109.33) (109.05) (105.40) (105.43) (110.55) (110.23)
147 146 147 154 235 234 120 126
D
(5.78) (5.74) (5.78) (6.06) (9.25) (9.21) (4.72) (4.96)
970 967 969 969 1026 1025 946 958
E
(38.18) (38.07) (38.14) (38.14) (40.40) (40.35) (37.24) (37.71)
1559 1558 1558 1562 1601 1601 1546 1548
F
(61.37) (61.33) (61.33) (61.49) (63.03) (63.03) (60.86) (60.94)
1502 1503 1503 1503 1485 1486 1509 1506
G
(59.13) (59.17) (59.17) (59.17) (58.46) (58.50) (59.40) (59.29)
1610 1610 1610 1615 1659 1659 1596 1598
H
(63.38) (63.38) (63.38) (63.58) (65.31) (65.31) (62.83) (62.91)
α 38.6° 38.7° 38.6° 38.8° 39.6° 39.6° 38.5° 38.4°

β 47.8° 47.9° 47.8° 47.8° 46.3° 46.3° 48.5° 48.2°

χ 31.7° 31.6° 31.6° 31.6° 33.2° 33.2° 31° 31.3°


mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 25

B100BTC AND B110BTC [WITH STANDARD BUCKET 4x1 1 m3 (35.3 ft3)]

4 Front counterweight
A. Maximum height/dimensions Front tyres 12.5-18 SLR4

B. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot Rear tyres 18.4-28 SLR4


C. Maximum dumping height A 4405 (173.42)
D. Digging depth B 3458 (136.14)
E. Loader attachment reach when raised in dump-
ing position C 2693 (106.02)

F. Loader attachment reach when lowered with D 125 (4.92)


retracted bucket E 813 (32.01)
G. Attachment reach in digging position
F -
H. Attachment reach when lowered
G -
α. Angle of lowered closed bucket
β. Angle of closed bucket at maximum height H -
χ. Dumping angle α 43.4°

β -

χ 45°
mm (in)
26 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

B115B [WITH STANDARD BUCKET 1.15 m3 (40.6 ft3)]

4 Front tyres
A. Maximum height/dimensions
B. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot
C. Maximum dumping height
D. Digging depth
E. Loader attachment reach when raised in
dumping position
F. Loader attachment reach when lowered with
retracted bucket
G. Attachment reach in digging position
H. Attachment reach when lowered
α. Angle of lowered closed bucket
β. Angle of closed bucket at maximum height
χ. Dumping angle
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 27

Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 4281 (168.54) 4345 (171.06) 4335 (170.66) 4342 (170.94)
B 3424 (134.80) 3488 (137.32) 3478 (136.92) 3485 (137.20)
C 2613 (102.87) 2677 (105.39) 2667 (105) 2674 (105.27)
D 181 (7.12) 117 (4.60) 127 (5) 120 (4.72)
E 728 (28.66) 665 (26.18) 662 (26.06) 661 (26.02)
F 1340 (52.75) 1234 (48.58) 1238 (48.74) 1232 (48.50)
G 1280 (50.39) 1217 (47.91) 1214 (47.79) 1213 (47.75)
H 1415 (55.70) 1307 (51.45) 1311 (51.61) 1305 (51.37)
α 44.2° 43.9° 44° 43.9°

β 59.6°

χ 50.3°
mm (in)
28 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

B115B [WITH 4x1 BUCKET 1.15 m3 (40.6 ft3)]

4 Front tyres
A. Maximum height/dimensions
B. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot
C. Maximum dumping height
D. Digging depth
E. Loader attachment reach when raised in
dumping position
F. Loader attachment reach when lowered with
retracted bucket
G. Attachment reach in digging position
H. Attachment reach when lowered
α. Angle of lowered closed bucket
β. Angle of closed bucket at maximum height
χ. Dumping angle
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 29

Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 4413 (173.74) 4477 (176.25) 4467 (175.86) 4474 (176.14)
B 3424 (134.80) 3488 (137.32) 3478 (136.92) 3485 (137.20)
C 2583 (101.69) 2647 (104.21) 2637 (103.81) 2644 (104.09)
D 208 (8.18) 144 (5.66) 154 (6.06) 147 (5.78)
E 893 (35.15) 830 (32.67) 827 (32.55) 826 (32.51)
F 1449 (57.04) 1344 (52.91) 1348 (53.07) 1342 (52.83)
G 1381 (54.36) 1318 (51.88) 1315 (51.77) 1314 (51.73)
H 1534 (60.39) 1427 (56.18) 1431 (56.33) 1425 (56.10)
α 44.3° 44° 44° 44°

β 59.6°

χ 42.3°
mm (in)
30 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

PERFORMANCE OF LOADER ATTACHMENT WITH FORKS


B90B, B100B AND B110B

4 Front counterweight
A. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot
B. Fork maximum height
C. Height of loader bucket pin/pivot with lowered
forks
D. Fork reach when raised
E. Fork reach when lowered
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 31

12.5/80- 12.5/80- 12.5/80- 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18


Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
18 I3 18 I3 18 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
A (standard 3209 3211 3210 3203 3121 3121 3236 3230
bucket) (126.33) (126.41) (126.37) (126.10) (122.87) (122.87) (127.40) (127.16)
3370 3372 3371 3364 3286 3286 3396 3391
A (6x1 bucket)
(132.67) (132.75) (132.71) (132.44) (129.37) (129.37) (133.7) (133.50)
B (standard 2770 2772 2771 2764 2682 2683 2797 2792
bucket) (109.05) (109.13) (109.09) (108.81) (105.60) (105.63) (110.11) (109.92)
2973 2974 2973 2966 2889 2889 2998 2993
B (6x1 bucket)
(117.04) (117.08) (117.04) (116.77) (113.74) (113.74) (118.03) (117.83)
C (standard
479 (18.85)
bucket)
C (6x1 bucket) 437 (17.20)
D (standard 2462 2459 2461 2461 2530 2528 2433 2447
bucket) (96.92) (96.81) (96.88) (96.88) (99.60) (99.52) (95.78) (96.33)
2304 2300 2303 2303 2376 2374 2273 2288
D (6x1 bucket)
(90.71) (90.55) (90.66) (90.66) (93.54) (93.46) (89.49) 890.08)
E (standard 2719 2718 2719 2722 2763 2762 2706 2708
bucket) (107.04) (107.00) (107.04) (107.16) (108.77) (108.74) (106.53) (106.61)
2679 2678 2679 2683 2723 2723 2666 2668
E (6x1 bucket)
(105.47) (105.43) (105.47) (105.63) (107.20) (107.20) (104.96) (105.03)
mm (in)
32 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

B100BTC AND B110BTC

4 Front counterweight
A. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot with Front tyres 12.5-18 SLR4
lifted forks Rear tyres 18.4-28SLR4
B. Fork maximum height A 3458 (136.14)
C. Height of loader bucket pin/pivot with lowered
B 2340 (5148)
forks
D. Fork reach when raised C 460 (18.11)
E. Fork reach when lowered D 2320 (91.34)
E 4245 (167.12)
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 33

B115B

4 Front tyres
A. Maximum height of loader bucket pin/pivot with
lifted forks
B. Fork maximum height
C. Height of loader bucket pin/pivot with lowered
forks
D. Fork reach when raised
E. Fork reach when lowered
34 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A (standard bucket) 3424 (134.80) 3488 (137.32) 3478 (136.92) 3485 (137.20)
A (6x1 bucket) 3424 (134.80) 3488 (137.32) 3478 (136.92) 3485 (137.20)
B (standard bucket) 3036 (119.52) 3100 (122.04) 3090 (121.65) 3097 (121.92)
B (6x1 bucket) 3032 (119.37) 3096 (121.88) 3086 (121.49) 3093 (121.77)
C (standard bucket) 428 (16.85)
C (6x1 bucket) 432 (17)
D (standard bucket) 2282 (89.84) 2219 (87.36) 2216 (87.24) 2215 (87.20)
D (6x1 bucket) 2255 (88.77) 2192 (86.29) 2189 (86.18) 2188 (86.14)
E (standard bucket) 2593 (102.08) 2493 (98.14) 2496 (98.26) 2491 (98.07)
E (6x1 bucket) 2568 (101.10) 2468 (97.16) 2471 (97.28) 2466 (97.08)
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 35

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT PERFORMANCE


B90B, B100B AND B100BTC SIDESHIFT (WITH SHORT STANDARD DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
36 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18


Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
5555 5545 5517 5550 5687 5651 5637 5545
A
(218.70) (218.31) (217.20) (218.50) (223.90) (222.48) (221.93) (218.31)
3692 3682 3655 3687 3821 3785 3773 3683
B
(145.35) (144.96) (143.90) 8145.16) (150.43) (149.02) (148.54) (145)
4255 4265 4291 4260 4125 4162 4175 4264
C
(167.51) (167.91) (168.93) (167.61) (162.40) (163.85) (164.37) (167.87)
3865 3875 3901 3871 3743 3779 3787 3874
D
(152.16) (152.56) (153.58) (152.40) (147.36) (148.77) (149.09) (152.51)
1760 1769 1793 1759 1569 1602 1703 1783
E
(3872) (69.64) (70.59) (69.25) (61.77) (63.07) (67.05) (70.20)
1173 1179 1194 1173 1050 1071 1136 1188
F
(46.18) (46.42) (47.01) (46.18) (41.34) 842.16) (44.72) 846.77)
5174 5175 5178 5175 5165 5169 5166 5175
G
(203.7) (203.74) (203.85) (203.74) (203.34) (203.50) (203.38) (203.74)
α 204.7°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 37

B100B, B100BTC, B110B AND B110BTC SIDESHIFT (WITH LONG STANDARD DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
38 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18


Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
5732 5721 5693 5727 5874 5836 5817 5722
A
(225.67) (225.23) (224.13) 8225.47) (231.26) (229.76) (229.01) (225.27)
3869 3858 3830 3864 4007 3969 3953 3858
B
(152.32) (151.88) (150.79) (152.12) (157.75) (156.26) (155.63) (151.88)
4557 4566 4592 4562 4428 4465 4477 4565
C
(179.40) (179.76) (180.78) (179.60) (174.33) (175.78) (176.25) (179.72)
4189 4198 4224 4194 4068 4103 4111 4197
D
(164.92) (165.27) (166.30) (165.11) (160.15) (161.53) (161.85) (165.23)
2010 2019 2043 2008 1811 1846 1950 2033
E
(79.13) (79.48) (80.43) (79.05) (71.30) (72.68) (76.77) (80.04)
1435 1441 1457 1434 1305 1327 1396 1450
F
(56.50) (56.73) (57.36) (56.46) (51.37) (52.24) (54.96) (57.09)
5440 5441 5443 5440 5431 5434 5432 5440
G
(214.17) (214.21) (214.30) (214.17) (213.81) (213.93) (213.85) (214.17)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 39

B90B, B100B AND B100BTC SIDESHIFT (WITH SHORT TELESCOPIC DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
40 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

RETRACTED DIPPER
12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18
Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
5647 5636 5608 5641 5785 5747 5731 5636
A
(222.32) (221.89) (220.78) (222.09) (227.75) (226.25) (225.63) (221.89)
3788 3778 3750 3783 3922 3885 3871 3778
B
(149.13) (148.74) 8147.64) (148.94) (154.41) (152.95) (152.40) (148.74)
4415 4425 4451 4420 4286 4323 4335 4424
C
(173.81) (174.21) (175.23) (174.01) (168.74) (170.19) (170.66) (170.17)
4038 4048 4073 4043 3916 3952 3960 4046
D
(158.97) (159.37) (160.35) (159.17) (154.17) (155.60) (155.90) (159.29)
1928 1937 1961 1927 1733 1766 1869 1951
E
(75.90) (76.26) (77.20) (75.87) (68.23) (69.53) (73.58) (76.81)
1283 1289 1305 1282 1155 1177 1245 1298
F
(50.51) (50.75) (51.37) (50.47) (45.47) (46.34) (49.01) (51.10)
5316 5317 5319 5316 5307 5310 5307 5316
G
(209.30) (209.33) (209.40) (209.30) (208.93) (209.05) (208.93) (209.30)
α 204°
mm (in)

EXTENDED DIPPER
12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18
Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
6303 6291 6260 6298 6469 6426 6395 6289
A
(248.15) (247.68) (246.45) (247.95) (254.68) (252.99) (251.77) (247.60)
4434 4422 4391 4429 4600 4557 4527 4420
B
(174.57) (174.09) (172.87) (174.37) (181.10) (179.40) (178.23) (174.01)
5454 5464 5489 5460 5330 5366 5376 5462
C
(214.72) (215.11) (216.10) (214.96) (209.84) (211.25) (211.65) (215.03)
5144 5153 5178 5149 5027 5062 5067 5151
D
(202.51) (202.87) (203.85) (202.71) (197.91) (199.29) (199.48) (202.80)
2111 2118 2137 2110 1957 1984 2065 2129
E
(83.11) (83.38) (84.13) (83.07) (77.04) (78.11) (81.30) (83.82)
2756 2766 2793 2754 2535 2573 2690 2781
F
(108.50) (108.90) (109.96) (108.42) (99.80) (101.30) (105.90) (109.49)
6267 6268 6270 6268 6259 6262 6260 6267
G
(246.63) (246.77) (246.85) (246.77) (246.41) (246.53) (246.45) (246.73)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 41

B100B, B100BTC, B110B AND B110BTC SIDESHIFT (WITH LONG TELESCOPIC DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
42 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

RETRACTED DIPPER
12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18
Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
5728 5717 5688 5723 5872 5833 5814 5716
A
(225.51) (225.08) (223.93) (225.31) (231.18) (229.64) (228.90) (225.03)
3871 3860 3832 3866 4010 3792 3955 3860
B
(152.40) (151.97) (150.87) (152.20) (157.87) (149.29) (155.71) (151.97)
4564 4574 4600 4569 4436 4473 4485 4573
C
(179.68) (180.07) (181.10) (179.88) (174.64) (176.10) (176.57) (180.03)
4196 4206 4231 4201 4076 4111 4119 4204
D
(165.19) (165.60) (166.57) (165.40) (160.47) (161.85) (162.16) (165.51)
2064 2074 2098 2063 1866 1900 2005 2088
E
(81.26) (81.65) (82.60) (81.22) (73.46) (74.80) (78.94) (82.20)
1407 1413 1429 1406 1276 1298 1368 1422
F
(55.39) (55.62) (56.26) (55.35) (50.24) (51.10) (53.86) (55.98)
5445 5446 5448 5446 5436 5473 5437 5445
G
(216.36) (214.40) (214.48) (214.40) (214.01) (215.51) (214.05) (214.36)
α 204°
mm (in)

EXTENDED DIPPER
12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18
Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
6459 6447 6413 6454 6640 6595 6556 6443
A
(254.29) (253.82) (252.48) (254.09) (261.42) (259.64) (258.11) (253.66)
4602 4590 4557 4597 4777 4733 4697 4587
B
(181.18) (180.71) (179.40) (180.98) (188.07) (186.34) (184.92) (180.59)
5751 5760 5785 5756 5629 5665 5673 5659
C
(226.42) (226.77) (227.75) (226.61) (221.61) (223.03) (223.35) (222.79)
5452 5462 5486 5458 5337 5372 5376 5460
D
(214.64) (215.03) (215.98) (214.88) (210.12) (211.50) (211.65) (214.96)
3016 3026 3054 3014 2788 2828 2948 3042
E
(118.74) (119.13) (120.24) (118.66) (109.76) (111.34) (116.06) (119.76)
2358 2366 2386 2357 2198 2226 2310 2377
F
(92.83) (93.15) (93.94) (92.79) (86.53) (87.64) (90.94) (93.58)
6540 6540 6542 6540 6532 6535 6533 6540
G
(257.48) (257.48) (257.56) (257.48) (257.16) (257.28) (257.20) (257.48)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 43

B110B CENTER PIVOT (WITH LONG STANDARD DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
44 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18


Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
5761 5751 5724 5756 5892 5855 5843 5752
A
(226.81) (226.42) (225.35) (226.61) (231.97) (230.51) (230.04) (226.46)
3893 3882 3855 3887 4023 3987 3974 3883
B
(153.27) (152.83) (151.77) (153.03) (158.38) (156.97) (156.46) (152.87)
4533 4542 4567 4538 4413 4448 4456 4541
C
(178.46) (178.81) (179.80) (178.66) (173.74) (175.11) (175.43) (178.77)
4165 4174 4199 4170 4052 4086 4086 4172
D
(163.97) (164.33) (165.31) (164.17) (159.52) (160.86) (160.86) (164.25)
2010 2019 2043 2008 1811 1846 1950 2033
E
(79.13) (79.48) (80.43) (79.05) (71.30) (72.68) (76.77) (80.04)
1435 1441 1457 1434 1305 1327 1396 1450
F
(56.50) (56.73) (57.36) (56.46) (51.37) (52.24) (54.96) (57.09)
5437 5438 5440 5437 5429 5432 5429 5437
G
(214.05) (214.09) (214.17) (214.05) (213.74) (213.85) (213.74) (214.05)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 45

B110B CENTER PIVOT (WITH LONG TELESCOPIC DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
46 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

RETRACTED DIPPER
12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18
Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
5752 5741 5713 5746 5887 5850 5835 5741
A
(226.46) (226.02) (224.92) (226.22) (231.77) (230.31) (229.72) (226.02)
B 3894 3884 3857 3889 4025 3989 3976 3885
4541 4550 4575 4546 4420 4456 4464 4548
C
(178.77) (179.13) (180.11) (178.80) (174.01) (175.43) (175.74) (174.05)
4173 4182 4206 4178 4060 4094 4097 4180
D
(164.30) (164.64) (165.60) (164.48) (154.84) (161.18) (161.30) (164.56)
2064 2074 2098 2063 1866 1900 2005 2088
E
(81.26) (81.65) (82.60) (81.22) (73.46) (74.80) (78.94) (82.20)
1407 1413 1429 1406 1276 1298 1368 1422
F
(55.39) (55.62) (56.26) (55.35) (50.24) (51.10) (53.86) (55.98)
5442 5443 5445 5443 5434 5438 5434 5442
G
(214.25) (214.30) (214.36) (214.30) (213.93) (214.09) (213.93) (214.25)
α 204°
mm (in)

EXTENDED DIPPER
12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 12.5/80-18 320/80 12.5-18 12.5-18
Front tyres 11L-16 F3 11L-16 F3
I3 I3 I3 R18 IT520 SLR4 SLR4
18.4-26 18.4-26 16.9-28 480/80 18.4-26 16.9-28 18.4-26 16.9-28
Rear tyres
R4 R1 R4 R26 IT520 R4 R4 SLR4 SLR4
6483 6471 6438 6478 6655 6612 6577 6468
A
(255.24) (254.76) (253.46) (255.03) (262.00) (260.31) (258.94) (254.64)
4626 4614 4582 4621 4793 4750 4718 4612
B
(182.12) (181.65) (180.39) (181.93) (188.70) (187.01) (185.75) (181.57)
5227 5736 5760 5732 5613 5648 5652 5734
C
(205.79) (225.83) (226.77) (225.67) (220.98) (222.36) (222.52) (225.75)
5429 5438 5461 5434 5322 5355 5355 5435
D
(213.74) (214.09) (215) (213.93) (209.53) (210.83) (210.83) (213.98)
3016 3026 3054 3014 2788 2828 2949 3042
E
(118.74) (119.13) (120.24) (118.66) (109.76) (111.34) (116.10) (119.76)
2358 2366 2386 2357 2198 2226 2310 2377
F
(92.83) (93.15) (93.94) (92.79) (86.53) (87.64) (90.94) (93.58)
6537 6538 6540 6538 6530 6533 6530 6537
G
(257.36) (257.40) (257.48) (257.40) (257.09) (257.20) (257.09) (257.36)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 47

B115B SIDESHIFT (WITH LONG STANDARD DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
48 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 5735 (225.79) 5798 (228.26) 5801 (228.39) 5802 (228.42)
B 3873 (152.48) 3936 3936 (154.96) 3940 (155.11)
C 4547 (179.01) 4484 (176.57) 4481 (176.41) 4480 (176.37)
D 4177 (164.44) 4114 (161.96) 4111 (161.85) 4110 (161.81)
E 2065 (81.30)
F 1471 (57.91)
G 5436 (210.07) 5428 (213.70) 5427 (213.66) 5427 (213.67)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 49

B115B SIDESHIFT (WITH LONG TELESCOPIC DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
50 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

RETRACTED DIPPER
Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 5731 (225.63) 5794 (228.11) 5797 (228.23) 5798 (228.26)
B 3875 (152.55) 3938 (155.03) 3941 (155.15) 3942 (155.20)
C 4555 (179.33) 4492 (176.85) 4489 (176.73) 4488 (176.70)
D 4185 (146.76) 4122 (162.28) 4119 (162.16) 4118 (162.12)
E 2120 (83.46)
F 1444 (56.85)
G 5442 (214.25) 5433 (213.90) 5433 (213.90) 5433 (213.90)
α 204°
mm (in)

EXTENDED DIPPER
Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 6451 (253.98) 6514 (256.45) 6517 (256.57) 6518 (256.61)
B 4596 (180.94) 4659 (183.42) 4662 (183.54) 4663 (183.58)
C 5739 (225.94) 5676 (223.46) 5673 (223.34) 5672 (223.31)
D 5439 (214.13) 5376 (211.65) 5373 (211.53) 5372 (211.50)
E 3079 (121.22)
F 2403 (94.61)
G 6537 (257.36) 6530 (257.09) 6529 (257.05) 6529 (257.05)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 51

B115B CENTER PIVOT (WITH LONG STANDARD DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
52 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 5768 (227.09) 5831 (229.56) 5834 (229.68) 5835 (229.72)
B 3899 (153.50) 3962 (155.98) 3965 (156.10) 3966 (156.14)
C 4521 (178.00) 4458 (175.51) 4455 (175.40) 4454 (175.35)
D 4152 (163.46) 4089 (160.98) 4086 (160.86) 4085 (160.82)
E 2065 (81.30)
F 1471 (57.91)
G 5392 (212.28) 5383 (211.92) 5383 (211.92) 5383 (211.92)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 53

B115B CENTER PIVOT (WITH LONG TELESCOPIC DIPPER)

A. Maximum digging height


B. Maximum height at full load
C. Maximum digging depth
D. Digging depth [L = 2438.4 mm (95.99 in)]
E. Digging reach at maximum height
F. Maximum reach when loaded
G. Maximum digging reach with lowered bucket
α. Bucket digging angle
54 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

RETRACTED DIPPER
Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 5756 (226.61) 5819 (229.09) 5822 (229.21) 5823 (229.25)
B 3901 (153.58) 3964 (156.06) 3967 (156.18) 3968 (156.22)
C 4529 (178.30) 4466 (175.82) 4463 (175.70) 4462 (175.66)
D 4159 (163.74) 4096 (161.25) 4093 (161.14) 4092 (161.10)
E 2120 (83.46)
F 1444 (56.85)
G 5439 (214.13) 5430 (213.77) 5429 (213.74) 5429 (213.74)
α 204°
mm (in)

EXTENDED DIPPER
Front tyres
16.9-24 R4 16.9-28 R4 440/80 R28 IT530 440/80 R28 IT520
Rear tyres
A 6477 (255.00) 6540 (257.48) 6543 (257.60) 6544 (207.63)
B 4622 (181.97) 4685 (184.45) 4688 (184.57) 4689 (184.60)
C 5713 (224.92) 5650 (222.44) 5647 (222.32) 5646 (222.28)
D 5414 (213.15) 5351 (210.67) 5348 (210.55) 5347 (210.51)
E 3079 (121.22)
F 2403 (94.61)
G 6534 (257.24) 6527 (256.97) 6526 (256.93) 6526 (256.93)
α 204°
mm (in)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 55

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LIFTING CAPACITY


LIFTING CAPACITY - MODELS B90B, B90BLR
Lifting capacity in normal operating mode - SAE
rated
The following table reports the lifting capacities of
the dipper (A) and the boom (B).
NOTE: the capacities indicated may slightly vary
from one machine to another, according to the
accessories mounted, the pressure settings and the
market requirements.
Lifting capacities are given in kg (lb) for a standard
dipper and a telescopic dipper.

Dipper Telescopic dipper (retracted) Telescopic dipper (extended) Height/Depth


Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B m (ft)
590 (1301) +5.4 (18)
1230 (2712) 1035 (2282) 830 (1830) +4.9 (16)
1515 (3340) 1345 (2965) 1610 (3549) 975 (2150) +4.3 (14)
2180 (4806) 1670 (3682) 1920 (4233) 1455 (3208) 1535 (3384) 1040 (2293) +3.6 (12)
2105 (4641) 1690 (3726) 1855 (4090) 1465 (3230) 1515 (3340) 1065 (2348) +3.0 (10)
2165 (4773) 1690 (3726) 1895 (4478) 1445 (3186) 1545 (3406) 1075 (2370) +2.4 (8)
2425 (5346) 1600 (3527) 2070 (4564) 1410 (3109) 1625 (3583) 1075 (2370) +1.8 (6)
3620 (7981) 1540 (3395) 2725 (6008) 1355 (2987) 1800 (3968) 1065 (2348) +1.2 (4)
1520 (3351) 3495 (7705) 1330 (2932) 2215 (4883) 1060 (2337) +0.6 (2)
1525 (3362) 1305 (2877) 3635 (8014) 1050 (2315) 0 (ground)
1495 (3296) 1275 (2811) 1040 (2293) -0.6 (2)
1470 (3241) 1255 (2767) 1040 (2293) -1.2 (4)
1465 (3230) 1240 (2734) 1040 (2293) -1.8 (6)
1485 (3274) 1250 (2756) 1050 (2315) -2.4 (8)
1590 (3505) 1315 (2899) 1080 (2381) -3.0 (10)
1735 (3825) 1500 (3307) 1155 (2546) -3.6 (12)
1385 (3053) -4.2 (14)
1725 (3803) -4.8 (16)
56 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

LIFTING CAPACITY - MODELS B100B, B100BLR AND B100BTC


Lifting capacity in normal operating mode - SAE
rated
The following table reports the lifting capacities of
the dipper (A) and the boom (B).
NOTE: the capacities indicated may slightly vary
from one machine to another, according to the
accessories mounted, the pressure settings and the
market requirements.
Lifting capacities are given in kg (lb) for a standard
dipper and a telescopic dipper.

Dipper Telescopic dipper (retracted) Telescopic dipper (extended) Height/Depth


Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B m (ft)
600 (1323) +5.4 (18)
1165 (2568) 1090 (2403) 900 (1984) +4.9 (16)
1560 (3439) 1460 (3219) 1455 (3208) 1030 (2271) +4.3 (14)
1925 (4244) 1680 (3704) 1815 (4001) 1570 (3461) 1400 (3087) 1095 (2414) +3.6 (12)
1865 (4112) 1700 (3748) 1755 (3869) 1585 (3494) 1380 (3042) 1125 (2480) +3.0 (10)
1900 (4189) 1560 (3439) 1785 (3935) 1440 (3175) 1400 (3087) 1115 (2458) +2.4 (8)
2045 (4508) 1475 (3252) 1925 (4244) 1355 (2987) 1460 (3219) 1065 (2348) +1.8 (6)
2480 (5468) 1425 (3142) 2345 (5170) 1300 (2866) 1585 (3494) 1035 (2282) +1.2 (4)
3645 (8036) 1405 (3098) 3475 (7661) 1280 (2822) 1835 (4046) 1020 (2249) +0.6 (2)
1415 (3120) 1285 (2833) 2615 (5765) 1020 (2249) 0 (ground)
1450 (3197) 1320 (2910) 3625 (7992) 1035 (2282) -0.6 (2)
1525 (3362) 1395 (3075) 1070 (2359) -1.2 (4)
1550 (3417) 1395 (3075) 1130 (2491) -1.8 (6)
1570 (3461) 1410 (3109) 1150 (2535) -2.4 (8)
1645 (3627) 1470 (3241) 1180 (2602) -3.0 (10)
1965 (4332) 1755 (3869) 1240 (2734) -3.6 (12)
1395 (3075) -4.2 (14)
2055 (4531) -4.8 (16)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 57

LIFTING CAPACITY - MODELS B110B, B110BTC (SIDESHIFT)


Lifting capacity in normal operating mode - SAE
rated
The following table reports the lifting capacities of
the dipper (A) and the boom (B).
NOTE: the capacities indicated may slightly vary
from one machine to another, according to the
accessories mounted, the pressure settings and the
market requirements.
Lifting capacities are given in kg (lb) for a standard
dipper and a telescopic dipper.

Dipper Telescopic dipper (retracted) Telescopic dipper (extended) Height/Depth


Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B m (ft)
600 (1323) +5.4 (18)
1165 (2568) 1090 (2403) 900 (1984) +4.9 (16)
1560 (3439) 1460 (3219) 1455 (3208) 1030 (2271) +4.3 (14)
1925 (4244) 1680 (3704) 1815 (4001) 1570 (3461) 1400 (3087) 1095 (2414) +3.6 (12)
1865 (4112) 1700 (3748) 1755 (3869) 1585 (3494) 1380 (3042) 1125 (2480) +3.0 (10)
1900 (4189) 1560 (3439) 1785 (3935) 1440 (3175) 1400 (3087) 1115 (2458) +2.4 (8)
2045 (4508) 1475 (3252) 1925 (4244) 1355 (2987) 1460 (3219) 1065 (2348) +1.8 (6)
2480 (5468) 1425 (3142) 2345 (5170) 1300 (2866) 1585 (3494) 1035 (2282) +1.2 (4)
3645 (8036) 1405 (3098) 3475 (7661) 1280 (2822) 1835 (4046) 1020 (2249) +0.6 (2)
1415 (3120) 1285 (2833) 2615 (5765) 1020 (2249) 0 (ground)
1450 (3197) 1320 (2910) 3625 (7992) 1035 (2282) -0.6 (2)
1525 (3362) 1395 (3075) 1070 (2359) -1.2 (4)
1550 (3417) 1395 (3075) 1130 (2491) -1.8 (6)
1570 (3461) 1410 (3109) 1150 (2535) -2.4 (8)
1645 (3627) 1470 (3241) 1180 (2602) -3.0 (10)
1965 (4332) 1755 (3869) 1240 (2734) -3.6 (12)
1395 (3075) -4.2 (14)
2055 (4531) -4.8 (16)
58 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

LIFTING CAPACITY - MODELS B110B (CENTER PIVOT)


Lifting capacity in normal operating mode - SAE
rated
The following table reports the lifting capacities of
the dipper (A) and the boom (B).
NOTE: the capacities indicated may slightly vary
from one machine to another, according to the
accessories mounted, the pressure settings and the
market requirements.
Lifting capacities are given in kg (lb) for a standard
dipper and a telescopic dipper.

Dipper Telescopic dipper (retracted) Telescopic dipper (extended) Height/Depth


Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B m (ft)
590 (1301) +5.4 (18)
1160 (2557) 1085 (2392) 880 (1940) +4.9 (16)
1545 (3406) 1445 (3186) 1510 (3329) 1015 (2238) +4.3 (14)
2640 (5820) 1665 (3671) 2585 (5699) 1555 (3428) 1605 (3538) 1080 (2381) +3.6 (12)
2615 (5765) 1695 (3737) 2505 (5523) 1575 (3472) 1655 (3649) 1110 (2447) +3.0 (10)
2665 (5875) 1680 (3704) 2550 (5622) 1560 (3439) 1680 (3704) 1125 (2480) +2.4 (8)
2915 (6427) 1660 (3660) 2790 (6151) 1530 (3373) 1755 (3869) 1125 (2480) +1.8 (6)
3700 (8157) 1630 (3594) 3555 (7837) 1495 (3296) 1850 (4079) 1125 (2480) +1.2 (4)
6080 (13404) 1600 (3527) 5910 (13029) 1460 (3219) 2075 (4575) 1120 (2469) +0.6 (2)
1570 (3461) 1430 (3153) 3235 (7132) 1115 (2458) 0 (ground)
1545 (3406) 1400 (3087) 5787 (12758) 1110 (2447) -0.6 (2)
1530 (3373) 1380 (3042) 1110 (2447) -1.2 (4)
1525 (3362) 1370 (3020) 1115 (2458) -1.8 (6)
1540 (3395) 1380 (3042) 1125 (2480) -2.4 (8)
1610 (3549) 1435 (3164) 1150 (2535) -3.0 (10)
1920 (4233) 1710 (3770) 1210 (2668) -3.6 (12)
1350 (2976) -4.2 (14)
1990 (4387) -4.8 (16)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 59

LIFTING CAPACITY - MODELS B115B (SIDESHIFT)


Lifting capacity in normal operating mode - SAE
rated
The following table reports the lifting capacities of
the dipper (A) and the boom (B).
NOTE: the capacities indicated may slightly vary
from one machine to another, according to the
accessories mounted, the pressure settings and the
market requirements.
Lifting capacities are given in kg (lb) for a standard
dipper and a telescopic dipper.

Dipper Telescopic dipper (retracted) Telescopic dipper (extended) Height/Depth


Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B m (ft)
565 (1243) +5.4 (18)
1110 (2442) 1025 (2255) 850 (1870) +4.9 (16)
1500 (3300) 1395 (3069) 1525 (3355) 995 (2189) +4.3 (14)
2425 (5335) 1645 (3619) 2315 (5093) 1530 (3366) 1625 (3575) 1070 (2354) +3.6 (12)
2350 (5170) 1685 (3707) 2245 (4939) 1565 (3443) 1625 (3575) 1110 (2442) +3.0 (10)
2395 (5269) 1685 (3707) 2280 (5016) 1560 (3432) 1650 (3630) 1130 (2486) +2.4 (8)
2575 (5665) 1670 (3674) 2455 (5401) 1540 (3388) 1735 (3817) 1135 (2497) +1.8 (6)
3115 (6853) 1645 (3619) 2980 (6556) 1515 (3333) 1885 (4147) 1140 (2508) +1.2 (4)
4555 (10021) 1620 (3564) 4385 (9667) 1485 (3267) 2125 (4675) 1140 (2508) +0.6 (2)
1600 (3520) 1460 (3212) 3315 (7293) 1135 (2497) 0 (ground)
1580 (3476) 1435 (3157) 4565 (10043) 1135 (2497) -0.6 (2)
1570 (3454) 1420 (3124) 1140 (2508) -1.2 (4)
1575 (3472) 1420 (3124) 1145 (2519) -1.8 (6)
1600 (3527) 1440 (3168) 1165 (2563) -2.4 (8)
1690 (3726) 1515 (3333) 1200 (2640) -3.0 (10)
2095 (4619) 1875 (4125) 1270 (2794) -3.6 (12)
1440 (3168) -4.2 (14)
2255 (4961) -4.8 (16)
60 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

LIFTING CAPACITY - MODELS B115B (CENTER PIVOT)


Lifting capacity in normal operating mode - SAE
rated
The following table reports the lifting capacities of
the dipper (A) and the boom (B).
NOTE: the capacities indicated may slightly vary
from one machine to another, according to the
accessories mounted, the pressure settings and the
market requirements.
Lifting capacities are given in kg (lb) for a standard
dipper and a telescopic dipper.

Dipper Telescopic dipper (retracted) Telescopic dipper (extended) Height/Depth


Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B Dipper A Boom B m (ft)
545 (1202) +5.4 (18)
1085 (2392) 1005 (2216) 835 (1841) +4.9 (16)
1485 (3274) 1385 (3053) 1500 (3307) 975 (2150) +4.3 (14)
2620 (5776) 1625 (3583) 2425 (5346) 1510 (3329) 1600 (3527) 1050 (2315) +3.6 (12)
2560 (5644) 1660 (3660) 2450 (5401) 1540 (3395) 1615 (3561) 1090 (2403) +3.0 (10)
2620 (5776) 1660 (3660) 2505 (5523) 1535 (3384) 1640 (3616) 1105 (2436) +2.4 (8)
2875 (6338) 1645 (3627) 2750 (6063) 1515 (3340) 1730 (3814) 1115 (2458) +1.8 (6)
3700 (8157) 1620 (3572) 3550 (7826) 1490 (3185) 1870 (4123) 1120 (2469) +1.2 (4)
6280 (13845) 1600 (3527) 6075 (13393) 1460 (3219) 2120 (4674) 1120 (2469) +0.6 (2)
1575 (3472) 1435 (3164) 3660 (8069) 1115 (2458) 0 (ground)
1555 (3428) 1410 (3109) 5745 (12666) 1115 (2458) -0.6 (2)
1545 (3406) 1400 (3087) 1120 (2469) -1.2 (4)
1550 (3417) 1395 (3075) 1125 (2480) -1.8 (6)
1580 (3483) 1415 (3120) 1145 (2524) -2.4 (8)
1670 (3682) 1500 (3307) 1180 (2602) -3.0 (10)
2070 (4564) 1855 (4090) 1250 (2756) -3.6 (12)
1430 (3153) -4.2 (14)
2230 (4916) -4.8 (16)
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 61

MAXIMUM LIFTING LOADS

LOADER ATTACHMENT MAXIMUM LIFTING LOAD TABLE


2WS

4WS
62 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MAXIMUM LIFTING LOAD TABLE


2WS

4WS
SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 63

SUPPLY SUMMARY TABLE

RECOMMENDED FLUIDS AND NEW INTERNATIONAL MODELS Q.TY


APPLICATION HOLLAND Specifications
Specifications Litres Gal

ENGINE - OIL
Ambra Master Gold HSP 15W - 40 NH 330 H API CH-4, 2WS - with filter 11.7 3.09
ACEA E5, 15W - 40 4WS - with filter 11.5 3.04
COOLING SYSTEM
Ambra Agriflu NH 900 A ASTM D 6210 ALL 24 6.30
antifreeze 50% water 50%
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Ambra Multi G NH 410 B API GL4, ALL 118 31.10
ISO VG 32/46,
10W - 30

Hydrosystem biodegradable 46 BIO-S NH 646 BS ISO VG 46, ALL 118 31.10


DIN 51524 - part II
POWERSHUTTLE TRANSMISSION 2WD 18.5 4.07
(complete with torque converter and
4WD 20.8 4.57
pipework)
Ambra Mastertran
MAT3505
POWERSHIFT TRANSMISSION
(complete with torque converter and ALL 20.8 4.57
pipework)
Ambra Mastertran
FRONT AXLE (2WS)
Ambra TRX 80W - 140 2WD 0.8 0.21
4WD Differential 8.6 2.27
Wheel reduction gear 1 0.26
(each)
FRONT AXLE (4WS) Differential 10.5 2.80
Ambra TRX 80W - 140
Wheel reduction gear 1.3 0.34
NH 600/TR API GL4, 80W - 140
(each)
REAR AXLE (2WS) Differential B90B-B95B-
15.5 3.41
Ambra TRX 80W - 140 B100B
B110B 17 3.74
REAR AXLE (4WS) Differential 11 2.90
Ambra TRX 80W - 140
Wheel reduction gear 1.3 0.34
(each)
FUEL
Decanted and filtered diesel fuel ALL 135 35.50
VARIOUS JOINTS
Ambra MG2 grease NH 585/GR NLGI 2 ALL As required
TELESCOPIC DIPPER
Ambra Grease GR EXP NH 587/GR NLGI 2 ALL As required
AIR CONDITIONING
COMPRESSOR ALL 240 14.6 in3
PAG SP 20 oil cm 3
64 SECTION 02 - TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

NOTES:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

POWERSHUTTLE TRANSMISSION................................................................................................................ 3
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 4
CONTROLS ................................................................................................................................................. 9
LUBRICATION........................................................................................................................................... 13
GREASING ................................................................................................................................................ 16
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 18
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 19
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................. 144
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 148
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 149

POWERSHIFT TRANSMISSION.................................................................................................................. 150


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 150
CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................. 161
LUBRICATION......................................................................................................................................... 163
GREASING .............................................................................................................................................. 165
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................. 166
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY........................................................................................................... 167
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................. 331
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 335
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 336
2 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 3

POWERSHUTTLE TRANSMISSION
This transmission is used on powershuttle loader
backhoe models B90B-B90BLR-B100B-B100BLR-
B100BTC-B110B-B110BTC.
4 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
2WD/2WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHUTTLE (B90B)
Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB1 MPB 2WD
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 5.603:1 reverse travel 4.643:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 3.481:1 reverse travel 2.884:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.585:1 reverse travel 1.313:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.793:1 reverse travel 0.657:1

4WD/2WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHUTTLE (B90B - B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC)


Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB1 MPB 4WD
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 5.603:1 reverse travel 4.643:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 3.481:1 reverse travel 2.884:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.585:1 reverse travel 1.313:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.793:1 reverse travel 0.657:1
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 5

DIMENSIONS
2WD
6 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

4WD
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 7

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM
2WD

* located in the pump


8 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

REF. DESCRIPTION NOTES


1 Suction filter 250 micron
2 Pump 36 cm3/rev (2.19 in3/rev)
3 Filter 15 micron
4 Pressure regulator
5 Oil filter relief valve 23 bar (334 psi)
6 Differential lock engagement/release
7 Hydraulic differential lock valve
8 Torque converter relief valve 3.5 ÷ 5.5 bar (51 ÷ 80 psi)
9 Torque converter
10 Oil cooler
11 Temperature thermostat port
12 Flow divider
13 Forward/reverse travel modulation valve
14 Modulation relief valve
15 Forward/reverse travel selector valve
16 Forward gear clutch
17 Reverse gear clutch
18 Forward/reverse travel shaft lubrication
19 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th gear shaft lubrication
20 Check port for torque converter pressure
21 Pressure check port of lubrication return from cooler
22 Forward/reverse/HDL gear main pressure check port
23 Forward gear pressure check port
24 Reverse gear pressure check port
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 9

4WD

* located in the pump


10 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

REF. DESCRIPTION NOTES


1 Suction filter 250 micron
2 Pump 36 cm3/rev (2.19 in3/rev)
3 Filter 15 micron
4 Pressure regulator
5 Oil filter relief valve 23 bar (334 psi)
6 Valve for 4WD engagement/release
7 “Easy” 4WD engagement/release
8 Torque converter relief valve 3.5 ÷ 5.5 bar (51 ÷ 80 psi)
9 Torque converter
10 Oil cooler
11 Temperature thermostat port
12 Flow divider
13 Forward/reverse travel modulation valve
14 Modulation relief valve
15 Forward/reverse travel selector valve
16 Forward gear clutch
17 Reverse gear clutch
18 Forward/reverse travel shaft lubrication
19 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th gear shaft lubrication
20 4WD pressure check port
21 Check port for torque converter pressure
22 Pressure check port of lubrication return from cooler
23 Forward/reverse/HDL gear main pressure check port
24 Forward gear pressure check port
25 Reverse gear pressure check port
26 Hydraulic differential lock engagement/release
27 Hydraulic differential lock valve
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 11

PORTS
2WD

Ref. Dimension Use Notes - Miscellaneous


1 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil inlet from cooler
2 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil outlet to cooler
3 1/2” - 14 NPTF Transmission temperature switch
4 1/2” Oil drain plug
0.5 + 3.5 bar (7.3 + 50 psi) ON = forward /
1/8” - 28 BSP ISO Oil cooler return pressure check reverse travel
5
228 port 0.5 + 5 bar (7.3 + 72.5 psi) ON = neutral
position
11 + 13 bar (159 + 188 psi)
1/8” - 28 BSP ISO Forward gear pressure check
6 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure in
228 port
neutral position
11 + 13 bar (159 + 188 psi)
1/8” - 28 BSP ISO Reverse gear pressure check
7 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure in
228 port
neutral position
11 + 13 bar (159 + 188 psi)
1/8” - 28 BSP ISO Forward / reverse gear pressure
8 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure in
228 check port
neutral position
1/8” - 28 BSP ISO
9 Converter pressure check port 0.5 + 9 bar (7.3 + 130.5 psi)
228
Oil inlet / outlet for hydraulic
10 9/16” - 18 UNF
differential lock
13 bar (188 psi) at 900 rpm
11 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil outlet to brake
14.5 bar (210 psi) at 2200 rpm
12 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil inlet from the brake
13 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil inlet from “transport lock”
12 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

4WD

Ref. Dimension Use Notes - Miscellaneous


1 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil inlet from cooler
2 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil outlet to cooler
3 1/2” - 14 NPTF Transmission temperature switch
4 1/2” Oil drain plug
0.5 + 3.5 bar (7.3 + 50 psi) ON =
forward / reverse travel
5 1/8” - 28 BSP ISO 228 Oil cooler return pressure check port
0.5 + 5 bar (7.3 + 72.5 psi) ON =
neutral position
11 + 13 bar (159 + 188 psi)
6 1/8” - 28 BSP ISO 228 Forward gear pressure check port 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure
in neutral position
11 + 13 bar (159 + 188 psi)
7 1/8” - 28 BSP ISO 228 Reverse gear pressure check port 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure
in neutral position
11 + 13 bar (159 + 188 psi)
Forward / reverse gear pressure
8 1/8” - 28 BSP ISO 228 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure
check port
in neutral position
9 1/8” - 28 BSP ISO 228 Converter pressure check port 0.5 + 9 bar (7.3 + 130.5 psi)
Oil inlet / outlet for hydraulic
10 9/16” - 18 UNF
differential lock
13 bar (188 psi) at 900 rpm
11 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil outlet to brake
14.5 bar (210 psi) at 2200 rpm
12 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil inlet from the brake
13 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil inlet from “transport lock”
13 bar (188 psi) at 900 rpm
14 4WD pressure check port
16 bar (232 psi) at 2200 rpm
13 bar (188 psi) at 900 rpm
15 1/8” - 28 BSP ISO 228 Main line pressure check port
16 bar (232 psi) at 2200 rpm
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 13

CONTROLS

1. GEARSHIFT LEVER: it is possible to select 3. POWERSHUTTLE TRANSMISSION DIREC-


four forward and four rearward travel gears. TION LEVER: the movement of this lever from
2. TRANSMISSION DISCONNECT BUTTON (on the neutral position will engage the forward or
gearshift level): prior to gearshifting, press and reverse travel.
hold the disconnect switch; select the desired NOTE: the warning horn activates in reverse travel.
gear with the gearshift lever and release the
switch to re-engage transmission. 4. HORN BUTTON
5. TRANSMISSION DISCONNECT BUTTON (on
loader attachment control lever)
14 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

The transmission is fully synchronised providing 4


forward and 4 reverse speeds allowing gear ratio
changes on the move.
A torque converter is used to connect the engine to
the transmission and the column mounted power-
shuttle lever (3) enables shifts between forward and
reverse travel without disengaging gear ratios.
A device for “transmission disconnection” is acti-
vated by pushing button (2), placed on the gearshift
lever (1) or by pushing button (5), placed on the
loader attachment control lever.

S WARNING S
Always apply the parking brake whenever the
machine is parked as the machine is free to roll
even though the transmission gearshift lever and
power reversing lever may be “In Gear” and the
engine is turned OFF.

GEARSHIFT LEVER
The single gearshift lever (1) is used to select any of
the four gear ratios.
The transmission disconnect button (2) is
depressed and held as the lever is shifted from one
gear to another and then released to re-connect
transmission drive.

FORWARD/REVERSE POWERSHUTTLE LEVER


(TRAVEL DIRECTION CHANGE)
To select the forward travel, engage the required
gear ratio with the gearshift lever; then, with the
engine idling, lift the powershuttle lever from the
neutral lock position (1) and move it to the forward
position (2).
Use the accelerator pedal to control the engine rpm
and the ground speed.
To reverse the direction of travel, reduce engine
speed and move the power reversing from neutral
lock position (1) and rearwards (3) for reverse travel
an audible alarm device sounds.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 15

IMPORTANT: the powershuttle lever is equipped


with a neutral lock to prevent an accidental engage-
ment of the transmission. With this design, the pow-
ershuttle lever moves through a “T” slot to the
forward or reverse positions.
IMPORTANT: when operating at low environmental
temperatures with cold transmission oil, allow the oil
to warm up before attempting to shift the powershut-
tle lever. The transmission can be shifted normally
after the oil warms up.
IMPORTANT: the horn will sound if the powershuttle
lever is operated with the parking brake engaged.
IMPORTANT: the powershuttle lever can be shifted
at any engine speed; however, as a safety and pre-
cautionary measure, the engine must run at approx-
imately 1200 rpm.
This action is easily controlled by means of the foot
accelerator to control engine and ground speed.

TRANSMISSION DISCONNECTION
The 4x4 transmission provides for easy upward and
downward gear ratio changes on the move.
However, as a clutch is not used between the
engine and transmission, the power flow from the
engine to the transmission must be interrupted to
shift from one gear ratio to another. This is accom-
plished by means of a transmission disconnect
(dump) button.
The finger operated button (2) on the main gearshift
lever knob (1) is easy to operate.

S WARNING S
To avoid personal injury do not use the disconnect
switch control to coast down hill. Excessive speed
may cause loss of control, personal injury to a
bystander or failure of the transmission.

To make upward gear ratio changes simply depress


and hold the button (2) on the gearshift lever (1),
while moving the lever from one gear ratio to
another.
When the desired gear ratio has been selected
release the button and allow the unit to gain engine
speed and ground speed.
If another higher ratio is required repeat the proce-
dure.
16 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

IMPORTANT: to prevent possible damage to the


transmission hydraulic clutches, never use the dis-
connect switch for inching the machine forward.
Inching the machine forward with the button will
cause the clutches to slip excessively and overheat.
To make downward gear ratio changes or reduce
ground speed, simply lower the engine speed,
depress and hold the gearshift lever button and
downshift the transmission.
When the desired gear ratio has been selected
release the button and adjust the engine speed to
suit ground speed required.
Operating the machine in a too high gear or under a
too heavy load will cause the torque converter to slip
excessively and overheat. If the machine is over-
loaded, the engine speed will not exceed a range of
1800-2200 rpm at maximum accelerator and the
torque converter will “stall” bringing the machine to a
complete stop.
If “stall” does occur, there is still sufficient engine
power to operate the loader attachment; however, to
prevent the transmission from overheating, either
reduce the load on the machine or select a lower
gear ratio.
IMPORTANT: operating at a “stall” for more than 20
seconds can cause the transmission to overheat
and can possibly damage the transmission. If the
transmission overheats, the needle (3) reaches the
red field. Shift both the powershuttle lever and the
gearshift lever to neutral. Let the engine run idle
(1000 rpm) until transmission oil cools down enough
to have the needle (3) return to correct position.
Once the needle is returned to its position, all opera-
tions can be resumed.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 17

LUBRICATION
2WD

4WD

1. Oil filler tube interface


2. Oil drain plug
3. Breather
18 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

LEVEL CHECK
The oil level check should be carried out with the
engine running at low speed and at normal operat-
ing temperature.
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Raise the loader attachment and assemble the
safety support strut.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift
lever in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Open and raise the engine guard and lock it in
opened position by means of the safety lock on the
left-hand gas spring.
Extract the dipstick (1), clean it with a clean cloth
and completely insert it into the tube, then take it out
again.
If the oil level is below the mini mark, top up.
Stop the engine.
Unlock the safety lock and close the engine guard.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 19

OIL CHANGE
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Raise the loader attachment and assemble the
safety support strut.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Open and raise the engine guard and lock it in
opened position by means of the safety lock on the
left-hand gas spring.
Remove the dipstick (1).
NOTE: change the oil while the transmission is still
warm; the oil will flow more easily.
Place a container with suitable capacity under the
drain plug (2).
Unscrew and remove the drain plug.
Let the transmission oil drain.

Re-install the drain plug (2).


Fill with new oil of specified type through the dipstick
hole.
NOTE: transmission oil capacity 18.5 litres (4.07 gal)
(2WD) and 20.8 litres (4.57 gal) (4WD).
Reassemble the dipstick (1).
Check the oil level by means of the dipstick and, if
necessary, add more oil.
Drive the machine for a few minutes in first and sec-
ond gear, then stop the engine.
Check the oil level again by means of the dipstick
and, if necessary, add more oil.
20 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

GREASING
Tecnolube POLYMER 400 grease
Transmission oil

2WD - 4WD

*: no grease, no oil
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 21

ONLY 4WD
22 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE

1. Transmission 12. Dipstick tube


2. Anti-vibration 13. Dipstick
3. Left transmission support 14. M10 x 30 hex screw
4. Right transmission support [tightening torque 52 ÷ 57 Nm (38 ÷ 42 lbf·ft)]
5. Washer 15. Washer
6. M12 x 35 hex screw 16. Torque converter
[tightening torque 90 ÷ 110 Nm (66 ÷ 81 lbf·ft)] 17. Plate
7. Washer 18. Plate
8. M12 x 90 hex screw 19. Snap ring
[tightening torque 90 ÷ 110 Nm (66 ÷ 81 lbf·ft)] 20. Washer
9. Washer 21. M10 x 20 hex screw
10. M12 nut [tightening torque 52 ÷ 57 Nm (38 ÷ 42 lbf·ft)]
11. Fitting (apply Loctite 577) 22. M10 x 30 hex screw
[tightening torque 52 ÷ 57 Nm (38 ÷ 42 lbf·ft)]
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 23

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Some of the following pictures could not exactly
show your transmission, but the procedure is cor-
rect.

TIGHTENING TORQUES AND APPLICATION OF SEALANTS / ADHESIVES


A. Loctite 510 C. Loctite 638
B. Loctite 518 D. Loctite 542
24 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 25

Only 4WD
26 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

PLUGS AND FILTERS

Disassembly
Remove the oil drain plug (5) and drain the oil from
the transmission.

Loosen and remove the 2 screws (1).


Remove the cap (2).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 27

Remove the oil filter (4) and the O-ring (3).

Unscrew and remove the oil filter (6).

Remove fitting (7).

Remove the spool (8).


28 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the spring (9).

Use a puller to remove the pressure relief valve


(10).
NOTE: the pressure relief valve is adjusted by the
Manufacturer. Never disassemble nor adjust it. If
any of its parts are damaged, replace the valve with
a new one.

Do not remove the plug unless there are leaks.


The plug is sealed with Loctite 542 and is difficult to
remove.
If the removal is necessary, clean it and apply Loc-
tite 542 prior to assembly.

If necessary, remove the plugs (13) or the breather


(11).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 29

Assembly
Assemble the plugs (13) and the breather (11).

Assemble valve (10).

Assemble the spring (9).

Assemble the spool (8).


30 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble fitting (7).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).

Assemble a new oil filter (6).


Lubricate the gasket.
Tighten clockwise until the gasket makes contact
with its seat, then tighten further 2/3 of a turn.

Assemble the oil filter (4) and the O-ring (3).

Assemble the cover (2).


Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening
torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 31

Assemble the plug (5).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).
32 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

OIL PUMP

Disassembly
Loosen and remove the screws (1).
Mark the oil pump position with respect to the bell
housing before loosening the screws.

Use two levers (A) to pull out the oil pump (2).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 33

Remove the oil pump (2).


The pump seal ring can be damaged during this
operation.

If necessary, remove the O-ring (3).

S WARNING S
Do not disassemble the pump or its operation may
be compromised.

If necessary, remove the seal ring (4).


34 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Assemble the seal ring (4) onto the oil pump (2).
Use tool 380200218.
Lubricate the seal ring.

Assemble the O-ring (3).

Before pump assembly (if new), check that the oil


passage holes (between pump and half box) or the
visual marks coincide.

Lubricate the seal ring (4) to keep it centred, in


order to facilitate its introduction onto the oil pump.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 35

Lubricate the matching seat with the front half box.


Assemble the oil pump (2).

Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening


torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).
Check that the mark on the oil pump and on the bell
housing coincide.
36 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

TUBES

Disassembly
Drain transmission oil.
Loosen and remove the screws (1) and (2).
Remove the tube (3).
Collect the gaskets (4).

Assembly
Assemble the tube (3) with the gaskets (4).
Screw in and tighten the screws (1) and (2) to the
prescribed torque of 40 Nm (30 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 37

HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE

Disassembly
Disconnect all electric connections.
Drain the transmission oil.
Loosen and remove the screws (13).
Remove the hydraulic control valve (53).
38 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the gasket (49).

Remove the screws (48), and the plate (50).

Remove the gasket (51).

Lock the hydraulic control valve with a clamp.


Remove the plug (1) and the O-ring (2).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 39

Push piston (4) downwards and remove the snap


ring (3).

Remove the piston (4) and the spring (5).

Verify the wear condition of the piston (4) and of the


spring (5).

Do not disassemble the piston (8) from the control


valve body.
If the piston is to be disassembled (8), the control
valve body must be replaced (47).
If the piston (8) is to be replaced, also order the
control valve body (47).
40 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the plug (6) and the O-ring (7).

Remove the spring (9).

Remove the washer (10).

Loosen and remove the screws (33).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 41

Remove the valve cover (34).

Remove the gasket (35).

Remove the plate (36).

Remove the outer piston (38), the springs (39), (40)


and (41), the pin (42) and the inner piston (43).
42 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Verify the wear condition of the springs (39), (40)


and (41) and of the pin (42).

Remove the gasket (37).

Remove the ball (26).

Remove the spring (25).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 43

Remove the plug (32) and the O-ring (31).

Remove the solenoid valve coil (30) and the O-ring


(29).

Remove the solenoid valve coil (28) and the O-ring


(27).

Unscrew the solenoid tube (24).


44 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the solenoid tube (24) with the piston (21).

Disassemble the piston (21) and the solenoid tube


(24).

Remove the spring (23) and the washer (22).


Verify the wear condition of the piston (21) and of
the solenoid tube (24).

Unscrew and remove the nut (20).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 45

Remove the O-ring (19).


Remove the solenoid valve coil (18) and the O-ring
(17).

Unscrew the solenoid tube (18).

Remove the O-rings (17).

Verify the wear condition of the solenoid tube (18),


of the O-ring (19) and of the nut (20).
46 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly

Assemble the O-rings (17).

Assemble the solenoid tube (18).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 25 ÷ 30 Nm
(18 ÷ 22 lbf·ft).

Assemble the O-ring (17).


Assemble the solenoid coil (18).
Assemble the O-ring (19).

Screw in and tighten the nut (20) to the tightening


torque of 5 ÷ 7 Nm (3.6 ÷ 5 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 47

Assemble the solenoid tube (24), the spring (23),


the piston (21) and the washer (22).

Assemble the solenoid tube (24) and the piston


(21).

Screw in and tighten the solenoid tube (24) to a


tightening torque of 21.5 ÷ 24.5 Nm (15.9 ÷ 18 lbf·ft).

Assemble the O-ring (27).


Assemble the solenoid coil (28).
48 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the O-ring (29).


Assemble the solenoid coil (30).

Assemble the O-ring (31) on the plug (32).


Assemble the plug (32).
Tighten to the prescribed torque of 7 ÷ 10 Nm
(5 ÷ 7.4 lbf·ft).

Insert the spring (25).

Insert the ball (26).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 49

Position the gasket (37).

Pre-assemble the springs (39), (40) and (41) and


the pin (42) with the pistons (38) and (43).

Assemble the outer piston (38), the springs (39),


(40) and (41), the pin (42) and the inner piston (43).

Position the plate (36).


50 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Position and lubricate the gasket (35).

Assemble the valve cover (34).

Screw in and tighten the screws (33) to a tightening


torque of 9.8 ÷ 11.8 Nm (7 ÷ 8.7 lbf·ft).

Turn the hydraulic control valve (47).


Assemble the washer (10).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 51

Assemble the spring (9).

Assemble the O-ring (7) on the plug (6).


Screw in and tighten the plug (6) to the tightening
torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).

Assemble the piston (4) and the spring (5).

Push piston (4) downwards and assemble the snap


ring (3).
52 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the O-ring (2) on the plug (1).


Screw in and tighten the plug (1) to the tightening
torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).

Position and lubricate the gasket (51).

Assemble the plate (50).


Screw in and tighten the screws (40) to a tightening
torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Position and lubricate the gasket (49).


Lubricate the gasket (49).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 53

Assemble the hydraulic control valve (53).


Screw in and tighten the screws (13) to a tightening
torque of 15 ÷ 24.2 Nm (11 ÷ 17.9 lbf·ft).
54 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

4WD SOLENOID VALVE

Disassembly
Prior to disassembling the 4WD solenoid valve, dis-
connect all electric connections.
Drain the transmission oil.
Loosen and remove the screws (1).
Remove the solenoid body (2).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 55

Remove the nut (8).


Remove the solenoid valve coil (7).

Remove the shaft (6).


Remove the O-rings (5).

Remove the gasket (4).

If necessary, remove the valve (3).


Do not disassemble the valve (3).
There are no serviceable parts.
If there is a problem, use a new valve.
56 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Assemble valve (3).

Assemble the O-rings (5) on the shaft (6).

Assemble the 4WD solenoid coil (7).


Screw in and tighten the nut (8) to the tightening
torque of 5 ÷ 8 Nm (3.6 ÷ 5.9 lbf·ft).

Position the gasket (4).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 57

Remove the solenoid body (2).


Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening
torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).
58 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

PARKING HANDBRAKE

Disassembly
Drain the transmission oil.

Unscrew the screw (1).


Use a screwdriver and 2 screws to lock the flange.
Remove the screw (1) and the washer (2).
Remove the flange (4) and the O-ring (3).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 59

Loosen and remove the screws (5), (6) and (7).


Remove the brake (8) assembly.
Remove the O-ring (9) from the brake (8).

Remove the seal ring (15).


Remove the plug (16).

S WARNING S
The seal ring can be damaged.

Remove the rings (10), the 5 brake discs (11) and


the 5 counterdiscs (12).

Remove the hub (13).


60 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Assemble the hub (13).

Use a gauge to check that each counterdisc (12)


and each brake disc (11) is flat.
If necessary, replace them.
If the brake discs (11) are nearly smooth, replace
them.
If the friction material is damaged or appears
burned, replace it.
Check the grooves for wear.
Check counterdiscs (12) for pitting, scoring, or other
damage.
If necessary, replace them.
If you will be using new brake discs, soak them in oil
for at least an hour before assembly.
If you are using the old friction discs, make sure that
the contact surfaces are coated with oil before
assembly, check the wear condition.
If this is 50% compared to the nominal value, we
suggest its replacement.

Brake disc kit

Brake disc number 5


Counterdisc number 5
Nominal brake disc 3.6 ± 0.05 mm
thickness (0.14 ± 0.002 in)
Brake disc kit nominal
37.40 ÷ 37.60 mm
thickness [with 163 kg
(1.47 ± 1.48 in)
(359.34 lbs) of load]
Brake disc maximum wear 0.65 mm
(each side) (0.02 in)
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 61

Assemble the counterdisc (12), the brake disc (11)


and the ring (10).
Repeat this operation until the brake disc kit is com-
plete.

Assemble the plug (16).


Assemble the seal ring (15) onto the brake (8), use
tool 380200226.

Insert the O-ring (9) on the brake (8).


Assemble the brake assy (8) on transmission.
Screw in and tighten the screws (5), (6) and (7) to a
tightening torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the flange (4) and the O-ring (3).


Lubricate the O-ring (3).
Assemble the washer (2) and the screw (1).
Use a screwdriver and 2 screws to lock the flange (A).
Tighten the screw (1) to a tightening torque of 139 Nm
(102.5 lbf·ft).
62 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

2WD - TRANSMISSION BOX

Disassembly
Remove the snap ring (1).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 63

Loosen and remove the screws (2).


Remove the gearshift control assy (3) and the O-ring
(4).

Loosen and remove the screws (5).


Remove flange (6).

Loosen and remove the screws (7).


By means of a lever loosen the cover.
Remove the rear cover (8).

Remove the O-ring (9).


64 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the pins (10) by means of a punch.

Remove the retainers (12).

Loosen and remove the 2 screws (13).

Remove the plate (14).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 65

Remove the 2 balls (15).

Loosen and remove the screws (16) and the wash-


ers (17).

Remove the springs (18).

Remove the balls (19).


66 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Pull the secondary shaft to the rear so that there is


backlash between the snap ring and the rear hous-
ing.
Remove the snap ring (20).

Remove transmission shaft PTO (21) by pushing


lightly on the opposite side.

If necessary, replace the seal ring (22) by cutting it.

Remove the snap ring (23).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 67

Take out the bearing (24) with tool 380200190.

Loosen and remove the screws (25).

Use lever (A) to remove the front half box (26).

The outer rings of the bearings (27) and (28) can


either stay on the shafts or on the front box seat.
Remove the 2 bearings (27) and (28).
68 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

If necessary, remove the O-rings (29).

Assembly
Push the secondary shaft toward the back of the
rear box, so that there is backlash between the
snap ring seat and the rear box.
Assemble the snap ring (20).

Assemble the O-rings (29).


Do not apply any grease/oil on O-rings.

Apply a thin film of sealant on the edge of the rear


half box.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 69

Lubricate and assemble the bearings (27) and (28).

Assemble the front half box (26).


Make sure that the bearings of the shafts go straight
into the bores in the front box.

Screw in and tighten the screws (25) to a tightening


torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the snap ring (1).


70 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the ball (19).


NOTE: previously, the parts of the 1st and 2nd gear
lower control have been installed. It is necessary to
install both the upper control parts for 3rd and 4th
speed and the lower ones for 1st and 2nd speed,
according to the instructions given by the proce-
dure. Make sure that you start with both shift rods in
the neutral position.

Insert the spring (18).

Assemble the washer (17) and the screw (16).


Tighten the screw (16) to a tightening torque of 80 Nm
(59 lbf·ft).

Insert the ball (19) and the spring (18).


Assemble the screw (16) and the washer (17).
Tighten the screw (16) to a tightening torque of 80 Nm
(59 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 71

Assemble the bearing (24) on the transmission


shaft PTO (21).

Assemble the snap ring (23).

To assemble the seal ring (22) perform following


operations by means of the listed tools in sequence:
380200257;
380200225;
380200214.

Insert transmission shaft PTO (21) to stroke end.


72 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Grease the balls.


Insert the 2 balls (15).

Assemble the plate (14).

Apply sealant on the threads of the 2 screws.


Screw in the 2 screws (13) to fasten the plate cor-
rectly and tighten them to the prescribed torque of
50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the retainers (12) on the gearbox pins.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 73

Assemble the pins (10) to fasten retainers on the


gearbox pins and the dowel pins (11).

Apply a thin film of sealant on the edge of the rear


cover (8).
Assemble the O-ring (9).
Do not grease the O-ring.

Place the rear cover (8).


Make sure that the pin (11) is correctly installed both
in the rear box and in the hole of the rear cover.
Tighten the screws (7) to fasten the cover on the rear
half box at the tightening torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).
If necessary, tap the rear cover with a soft faced
hammer to close the gap between the rear half
housing and the rear cover to tighten the cap
screws.

Apply a thin film of sealant on the edge of the flange


(6).
Place the flange (6).
Screw in and tighten the screws (5) to a tightening
torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).
74 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble a new O-ring (4) on the gearshift control


assy (3).
Use clean oil to lubricate the ring and assembly it
on the rear box.
Screw in the 3 screws (2) fastening the gearshift
control assy to the rear cover and tighten to the pre-
scribed torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 75

4WD - TRANSMISSION BOX

Disassembly
Remove the snap ring (1).
76 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Loosen and remove flange retaining screw (2).


Use a screwdriver and 2 screws to prevent the
flange rotation.

Remove the washer (3).

Remove the flange (5) and the O-ring (4).

Loosen and remove the 3 screws (6).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 77

Remove cover (7).

Remove the O-ring (8) from the cover (7).

Remove the seal ring (9) from rear cover (7).

Loosen and remove the 3 screws (10).


Remove the gearshift control assy (11) and the O-ring
(12).
78 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Loosen and remove the 7 screws (13) and the


flange (14).

Loosen and remove the screws (15) fastening the


cover (16).
Use a prybar to loosen the rear cover from the
housing.
Remove the rear cover (16).

Remove the O-ring (17).

Remove the pins (18) by means of a punch.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 79

Remove the retainers (20).

Loosen and remove the 2 screws (21).

Remove the plate (22).

Remove the 2 balls (23).


80 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Loosen and remove the screws (24) and the wash-


ers (25).

Remove the springs (26).

Remove the balls (27).

Pull the secondary shaft to the rear so that there is


backlash between the snap ring and the rear hous-
ing.
Remove the snap ring (28).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 81

Remove transmission shaft PTO (29) by pushing


lightly on the opposite side.

If necessary, replace the seal ring (30) by cutting it.

Remove the snap ring (31).

Take out the bearing (32) with tool 380200190.


82 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Loosen and remove the screws (33).

Loosen and remove the screws (34).

Use a lever to remove the front half box (35).


Raise the front half box.

The outer rings of the bearings on the primary shaft


(36) and on the secondary shaft (37) can either stay
on the shafts or on the front box seat.
Remove the 2 bearings (36) and (37).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 83

Remove the bearing (38).

If necessary, replace the O-rings (39).

Assembly
Push the secondary shaft toward the back of the
rear box, so that there is backlash between the
snap ring seat and the rear box.
Assemble the snap ring (28).

Assemble the O-rings (39).


84 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Apply a thin film of sealant on the edge of the rear


half box.

Lubricate the primary shaft bearing (36) and the


secondary shaft bearing (37).
Assemble the 2 bearings (36) and (37).

Assemble the front half box (35) on the rear one.


Make sure that the bearings of the shafts go straight
into the bores in the front box.
Push the front half box onto the rear one.

Screw in and tighten the screws (34) to a tightening


torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 85

Screw in and tighten the screws (33) to a tightening


torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Lubricate the bearing of the 4WD shaft.


Assemble the bearing (38) on 4WD shaft by means
of tool 380200230.

By means of tool 380200213 assemble the seal ring


(9) on the cover (7).
Push just until the seal ring stops moving.
Do not use excessive force.
Fill the cavity under the lip with grease.

Assemble the O-ring (8).


86 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the cover (7).

Screw in the 3 screws (6) fastening the cover to the


front box and tighten them to a tightening torque of
23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).

Assemble and lubricate the O-ring (4) in the 4WD


flange.

Assemble the 4WD flange (5).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 87

Assemble the washer (3).

Screw in the screw (2).


Use a screwdriver to prevent the flange rotation.
Tighten the screw (2) to a tightening torque of 139 Nm
(102.5 lbf·ft).

Assemble the snap ring (1).

Insert the ball (27).


NOTE: later on the parts of the 1st and 2nd gear-
shift lower control will be installed. It is necessary to
install both the upper control parts for 3rd and 4th
speed and the lower ones for 1st and 2nd speed,
according to the instructions given by the proce-
dure. Make sure that you start with both shift rods in
the neutral position.
88 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the spring (26).

Assemble the washer (25) and the screw (24).


Tighten the screw (24) to a tightening torque of 80 Nm
(59 lbf·ft).

Insert the ball (27) and the spring (26).


Assemble the screw (24) and the washer (25).
Tighten the screw (24) to a tightening torque of 80 Nm
(59 lbf·ft).

Assemble the bearing (32) on the transmission


shaft PTO (29).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 89

Assemble the snap ring (31).

To assemble the teflon seal ring (30) perform follow-


ing operations by means of the listed tools in
sequence:
380200257 (without shim);
380200225;
380200214.

Insert transmission shaft PTO (29) to stroke end.

Grease the balls.


Insert the 2 balls (23).
90 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the plate (22).

Apply sealant on the threads of the 2 screws.


Screw in the 2 screws (21) to fasten the plate cor-
rectly and tighten them to the prescribed torque of
50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the retainers (20) on the gearbox pins.

Assemble the pins (18) to fasten the retainers on


the gearshift pins.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 91

Apply a thin film of sealant on the edge of the rear


cover (16).
Assemble the O-ring (17).
Do not grease the O-ring.

Place the rear cover (16).


Make sure that the pin (19) is correctly installed
both in the rear box and in the hole of the rear
cover.
Tighten the screws (15), to fasten the cover on
the rear half box at the tightening torque of 80 Nm
(59 lbf·ft).
If necessary, tap the rear cover with a soft faced
hammer to close the gap between the rear half
housing and the rear cover to tighten the cap
screws.

Apply a thin film of sealant on the edge of the flange


(14).
Place the flange (14).
Screw in and tighten the screws (13) to a tightening
torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble a new O-ring (12) on the gearshift control


assy (11).
Use clean oil to lubricate the ring and assembly it
on the rear box.
Screw in the 3 screws (10) fastening the gearshift
control assy to the rear cover and tighten to the pre-
scribed torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).
92 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

A, D SHAFTS

Disassembly
Grab the shaft with the (A) pliers and pull out the
shaft assy (D).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 93

Shaft (A)
If necessary, remove the seal ring (1).

Remove the snap ring (2).

Assemble a bearing separator under the gear (do


not assemble the bearing separator between the
gear and the bearing).
Use a puller on the bearing separator and insert a
shaft protector between the puller and the end of
the input shaft.
By means of puller which operates between separa-
tor and shaft protection, pull only until the bearing is
free, otherwise the parts can be damaged.

Remove the bearing (3).


94 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the spacer (4).

Remove the gear (6).

Remove the roller retainer (7).

Remove the thrust washer (8).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 95

Remove the pin (9).

Remove the snap ring (10).

Lift and remove the snap ring (11).

Remove the discs (18) and the counterdiscs (17).


96 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Place a mark below the groove on the clutch bell.

Mark the snap ring (11), the discs (18) and the
counterdiscs (17).
These marks will be used as a reference during
assembly.

Lower the cover (13) by means of tool 380200215.

Remove the snap ring (14).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 97

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Remove the cover (13) and the spring (15).

Remove the sleeve (5).

Remove the clutch piston (19) by blowing in com-


pressed air through the delivery hole.
98 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

If necessary, remove the seal ring (20) with the


inner O-ring from the outside seat of the piston and
the seal ring (21) with the relevant O-ring from the
inner seat of the piston.
To remove the rings it is necessary to cut them.

Turn the shaft.


If necessary, remove the seal rings (22).

Remove the snap ring (23).

Use a puller to remove the bearing (24).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 99

Remove the bearing (24) and the thrust washer


(25).

Remove the gear (26) and the roller retainer (12).

For the disassembly of other parts, repeat the oper-


ations described previously.

Check the seal ring grooves (large and small) for


wear or damage.
Check if the output shaft is worn or damaged.
Check oil passages in the output shaft to be sure
that they are open and free of foreign material.
Check the ball bearings and the needle bearings for
flat areas, pitting or other damage.
100 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

If you are to re-use the clutch discs, observe the


assembly order.

Use a gauge to check that each counterdisc (17)


and each clutch disc (18) is flat.
If they are not flat, replace them with new ones.
If the clutch discs (18) are nearly smooth, or if their
friction faces are damaged or burnt, they must be
replaced.
Check the grooves for wear.
Check counterdiscs (17) for pitting, scoring, or other
damage.
If you will be using new clutch discs, soak them in
oil for at least an hour before assembly.
If you are using the old clutch discs, make sure that
the contact surfaces are coated with transmission
oil before assembly, check their wear condition (see
chart below).
If the wear exceeds the 50% of the rated value,
replace them.

Verify the bore and the housing of the input shaft for
damage that will cause leakage during the assembly
of the clutch.
Check if the slots in the housing of the input shaft
are damaged by the tangs of the counterdiscs.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 101

Forward - reverse gear clutch

Disc number (each side) 6


Counterdisc number (each side) 7
Counterdisc rated thickness 2.5 ± 0.05 mm (0.10 ± 0.002 in)
Rated thickness of disc 1.75 ± 0.05 mm (0.07 ± 0.002 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.2 mm (0.009 in)

Disc number (each side) 6


Counterdisc number (each side) 6
Rated thickness of disc 2.4 ± 0.05 mm (0.09 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 29.00 ÷ 29.20 mm (1.14 ± 1.15 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.35 mm (0.01 in)

Shaft (D)
Remove the bearing (16) from the shaft (D) by
means of a puller.

Remove the bearing (37) from the shaft (D) by


means of a puller.
102 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Shaft (A)
Assemble the seal ring (20) with the relevant O-ring
and the seal ring (21) with the relevant inner O-ring,
respectively in the outer and inner seat of the pis-
ton.

Apply a thin film of oil on the seal rings.

Insert the piston (19) with tool (T) 380001926.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 103

Assemble the sleeve (5).

Assemble the spring (15) and the cover (13).

Lower the cover (13) and insert the snap ring (14)
by means of tool 380200215.

Remove the 380200215 tool and fit the pin (9).


104 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the thrust washer (8).

Insert the roller retainer (7).

To assemble the clutch discs start with the gear (6)


on the bench.
Assemble the thrust washer (11) so that the refer-
ence mark on top of the plate, made during disas-
sembly, is facing towards the gear.

Assemble the discs (18) and the counterdiscs (17)


on the gear (6).
The assembled clutch disc kit must contain 6 steel
discs and 6 friction discs.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 105

Use 2 screwdrivers to position the disc kit.

Assemble the snap ring (10).

Assemble the spacer (4).

Heat the bearing (3) to 80 ÷ 100 °C (176 ÷ 212 °F).


Assemble the bearing (3) with tool 380200190.
106 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the snap ring (2).

NOTE: for clarity of the seal ring installation proce-


dure, the following photos do not show the disc kit,
gear, spacer, bearing, and snap ring installed on the
input shaft.
Insert the seal ring (1).

Assemble the 380200224 tool onto the input shaft


with the chamfered end facing inwards.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 107

Let the tool 380200224 slide on the input shaft and


above the spacer.
The tool will stop in the correct position to install the
seal ring in the groove.

Heat the seal ring to 60 ÷ 80 °C (140 ÷ 176 °F) for 5


minutes.
Assemble the seal ring on the tool 380200224.

Assemble the 380200225 tool over the 380200224


tool and slide the seal ring until it reaches the
groove in the shaft.
Remove the tools 380200224 and 380200225, the
expander/protector and the spacer from the shaft.

Assemble the end of the 380200214 seal compres-


sor with the deep chamfer onto the shaft and over
the seal ring.
Use a back and forth twisting motion to allow the
seal compressor to slip over the top of the seal ring
and seat this latter into the groove.
Be careful not to damage the seal ring.
After the seal ring is seated in the groove, remove
the seal compressor from the shaft.
108 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Turn the seal compressor around and slide the end


with the narrow chamfer over the shaft and over the
seal ring.
Leave the seal compressor in place for 15 minutes
until the seal ring has cooled and is properly seated
in the groove.
After the seal ring has cooled, remove the seal
compressor from the shaft.

Turn the shaft upside down to carry out the opera-


tions described previously.
Lubricate the thrust washer (25).
Assemble the thrust washer so that the notch in the
inner edge fits over the pin.
Make sure that the side with the oil grooves is
down.

Heat the bearing (24) to 80 ÷ 100 °C (176 ÷ 212 °F).


By means of tool 380200197 place the bearing (24)
onto the input shaft until it makes contact with the
thrust washer.

Assemble the snap ring (23).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 109

Assemble the snap rings and place the spacer in


the protection (tool 380001933).

Place the tool 380001933 and the spacer on the


shaft.
The tool will stop in the correct position to install the
seal ring in the groove.

Heat the seal ring to 60 ÷ 80 °C (140 ÷ 176 °F) for 5


minutes.
Assemble the seal ring on the tool 380001933.

Assemble the 380001928 tool over the 380001933


tool and slide the seal ring until it reaches the
groove in the shaft.
Remove the tools 380001928 and 380001933.
110 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the end of the 380001927 seal compres-


sor with the deep chamfer onto the shaft and over
the seal ring.
Use a back and forth twisting motion to allow the
seal compressor to slip over the top of the seal ring
and seat this latter into the groove.
Be careful not to damage the seal ring.
After the seal ring is seated in the groove, remove
the seal compressor from the shaft.

Turn the seal compressor around and slide the end


with the narrow chamfer over the shaft and over the
seal ring.
Leave the seal compressor in place for 15 minutes
until the seal ring has cooled and is properly seated
in the groove.
After the seal ring has cooled, remove the seal
compressor from the shaft.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 111

In order to insert the other 3 rings, repeat the opera-


tions described previously, by means of following
spacer rings:
380001933/3 for the 2nd ring;
380001933/2 for the 3rd ring;
380001933/1 for the 4th ring.

1. Lubrication oil passage


2. Forward gear clutch passage
3. Reverse gear clutch passage
4. Forward gear engagement
5. Forward gear clutch disc kit
6. Reverse gear clutch disc kit
7. Reverse gear engagement
8. Input shaft

Apply compressed air of approximately 6 bar (87 psi)


to the forward clutch passage.
Listen for the forward gear piston to move and to
lock the relevant clutch disc kit.
Try to shift the forward travel gear.
It must not turn on the input shaft.
Try to shift the reverse travel gear.
It must turn freely on the input shaft.
If the clutches do not work correctly, disassemble
them to find the problem.
112 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Carry out the check procedure of the clutch disc kit


play on both sides of the clutch.
Position the shaft on a suitable support (S) and
apply load F on the counterdisc (11) surface by
means of a proper buffer (T), as shown.
This operation clears any possible play.

To check the backlash, supply the piston chamber


with compressed air at 6 bar (87 psi) and verify the
actual stroke “X” with a dial indicator.
Determine clearance “X”.

The piston stroke (19) and (38) must be such to


ensure a play corresponding to (according to the
clutch disc kit)
X = 2.15 ÷ 4.10 mm (0.08 ÷ 0.16 in)
X = 1.60 ÷ 2.45 mm (0.06 ÷ 0.10 in)
If the distance is not within specification, the clutch
is probably wrongly installed.
Turn the clutch shaft upside down and repeat the
operation for the other clutch disc kit.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 113

Shaft (D)
Assemble the bearing (16) on shaft (D) by means of
tool 380200230.

Assemble the bearing (37) on shaft (D) by means of


tool 380200230.

Lubricate with oil the shaft seat (A).

Insert shaft (D) and shaft (A).


The operation is correct only if the 2 shafts are fitted
at the same time.
114 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

B, C SHAFTS

Disassembly
Remove the shafts (B) and (C).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 115

Remove the gearshift control yokes.


To remove the shaft (C) use tool 380200246.

Shaft (C)
By means of a puller remove the bearing (1).

Remove the thrust washer (2) and 3rd speed gear


(3).

Remove the 3rd/4th speed synchronizer assy (4).


116 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the ring (5) from each side of the synchro-


nizer assy.
The components of the synchronizer assy are serv-
iced as a complete unit.
The synchronizer assy may be disassembled for
inspection and cleaning.
If some parts are damaged, replace the synchro-
nizer assy.

Use a suitable gauge to measure the backlash


between the bottom of the teeth on the synchro-
nizer ring and the edge of the sleeve on the outside
of the synchronizer assy.
The backlash (S) should be approximately 1.0 mm
(0.04 in) with used parts in good condition.
If the backlash (S) is 0.5 mm (0.02 in) or less, use a
new synchronizer assy.
Before disassembly, repeat the measurement on
the opposite side of the synchronizer.

Remove the ring (6) from each side of the synchro-


nizer.

Remove the sleeve (7) from the synchronizer hub.


When the sleeve is removed from the hub, the
spring plates, the hub pins and the hub springs will
be released from the hub.
Be careful not to lose any of these parts.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 117

Remove the blocks (8), the balls (9), the springs


(10) and the synchronizer hub (11).
The synchronizer hub contains 3 blocks (8), 3 balls
(9) and 3 springs (10).

Remove the 4th speed gear (12).

Turn the shaft.


Remove outer ring of bearing (15).

Use a puller to remove inner ring of bearing (15).


NOTE: do not try to remove the bearing by pulling
the gear since it is locked by snap ring (16).
118 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the snap ring (16).

Remove the shims (20) and the thrust washer (17).

Remove the pin (19).

Remove the 2nd speed gear (18).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 119

Remove the spacer (21).

Remove the 1st/2nd speed synchronizer assy (23).


Remove the synchronizer ring (22).

Remove the steel ring (24) and the sintered ring


(25) together.
Install the synchronizer with the synchronizer assy.
Use a suitable gauge to measure the backlash
between the bottom of the teeth on the synchro-
nizer ring and the edge of the sleeve on the outside
of the synchronizer assy.

The backlash (S1) should be approximately 1.0 mm


(0.04 in) with used parts in good condition.
If the backlash (S1) is 0.5 mm (0.02 in) or less, use
a new synchronizer assy.
Repeat the measurement on the opposite side.
120 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the ring (26).

Overturn the synchronizer and remove the ring (27)


from the other side.

Remove the steel ring (28) and the sintered ring


(29) together.

Remove the ring (30).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 121

Support the sleeve on blocks.


Push it down and, at the same time, extract the
detent devices of sleeve and hub.
Remove the sleeve (31).

Remove the balls (32), the blocks (33), the springs


(34) and the hub (35).

Remove the spacer (36).

Remove the 1st speed gear (37).


122 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Only with 4WD models


Remove the snap ring (38).

Only with 4WD models


Remove the 4WD gear (14).

Only with 4WD models


Remove the snap ring (13).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 123

Shaft (B)
Use a puller to remove the inner ring of bearing
(39).

Turn the shaft (41).


Remove the bearing (40).
124 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Shaft (C)
Only with 4WD models
Put the secondary shaft on the bench so that the
first-second gear end is up.
You can use a vice with soft jaws to hold the shaft in
position.
Install the snap ring (13).

Only with 4WD models


Assemble the 4WD gear (14).

Only with 4WD models


Assemble the snap ring (38).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 125

Assemble the 1st speed gear (37).

Assemble the spacer (36).

Assemble the 1st/2nd speed synchronizer (23).


Before final assembly, check the correct location of
the hub (35), sleeve (31), springs (34), blocks (33)
and balls (32).
The springs are installed on the hub.
The blocks are not yet pushed down into the sleeve
and are holding the hub outside the sleeve.
The balls are loose in the recesses of the blocks.

Use a punch or a screwdriver to push the balls (32)


into the blocks and push these latter downwards, so
that the balls are on the flat faces of the teeth, but
not into the detent grooves.
When all the balls are in position, push the hub and
the blocks downwards until the balls move into the
detent groove.
126 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the ring (30).

Lubricate the sintered ring (29) and the steel ring


(28).
Assemble the sintered ring (29) and the steel ring
(28).

Assemble the ring (27).


The flat sides of the teeth must be directed
upwards.

Overturn the synchronizer and assemble the ring


(26) from the other side.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 127

Lubricate the sintered ring (25) and the steel ring


(24) with oil.
Assemble the sintered ring (25) and the steel ring
(24).
Install the top synchronizer ring on the synchronizer
assy.
Make sure that the teeth on the top synchronizer
ring are aligned with the teeth inside the sleeve.
Push the sleeve upwards until it engages with the
teeth on top of synchronizer ring.
To do this, you must use enough force to overcome
the strength of the detent springs and balls.
When the synchronizer ring and the sleeve are
engaged, the detent must hold the sleeve in this
position.
Push the sleeve back to neutral position, turn over
the synchronizer assy and repeat the procedure
with the lower synchronizer ring.
If the sleeve does not engage with the teeth or does
not hold the position to which it was shifted, the syn-
chronizer assy is damaged or was not correctly
assembled.
Disassemble the synchronizer assy to find the prob-
lem.
Install the ring (22) so that the flat sides of the teeth
are directed upwards.
Assemble the 1st/2nd speed synchronizer (23).

Install the spacer (21) on the 2nd speed gear (18).


128 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the 2nd speed gear (18).

Assemble the pin (19).

Assemble the thrust washer (17) and the shims


(20).

Assemble the snap ring (16).


Measure the backlash “X” between gear (18) and
thrust washer (17):
the value must be between 0.2 ÷ 0.42 mm (0.01 ÷ 0.02 in).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 129

Use a thickness gauge.

If backlash “X” is more than the prescribed value,


remove the snap ring and the thrust washer from
their seats and, using the shims shown in the chart,
reach the prescribed value.
Correctly assemble the shims (20) between the
thrust washer (17) and the snap ring (16).

SHIM RANGE
Shims mm (in) 0.05 0.1 0.3 0.5
(0.002) (0.004) (0.012) (0.02)

Heat the inner ring of the bearing (15) to 80 ÷ 100 °C


(176 ÷ 212 °F).
Assemble the inner ring of the bearing (15) by
means of tool 380200203.

Assemble the outer ring of bearing (15).


130 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Turn the shaft.


Assemble the 4th speed gear (12).

Assemble the 3rd/4th speed synchronizer (4).


Before final assembly, check the correct location of
the hub (11), sleeve (7), springs (10), blocks (8) and
balls (9).
The springs are installed on the hub.
The blocks are now on the spring and not yet on the
sleeve and are holding the hub outside the sleeve.
The balls are loose in the recesses of the blocks.

Install the 3 sets of blocks (8), balls (9) and springs


(10) onto the hub (11).
Use a punch or a screwdriver to push the spring
plates as the synchronizer hub is installed into the
sleeve (7).
Be sure that the spring plates are aligned with the
grooves of the sleeve.

Assemble the ring (6) on each side of the synchro-


nizer assy.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 131

Use oil to lubricate the ring (5) and install it on each


side of the synchronizer assy. Install the top syn-
chronizer ring on the synchronizer assy.
Make sure that the teeth on the top synchronizer
ring are aligned with the teeth inside the sleeve.
Push the sleeve upwards until it engages with the
teeth on top of synchronizer ring.
To do this, you must use enough force to overcome
the strength of the detent springs and balls.
When the synchronizer ring and the sleeve are
engaged, the detent must hold the sleeve in this
position.
Push the sleeve back to neutral position, turn over
the synchronizer assy and repeat the procedure
with the lower synchronizer ring.
If the sleeve does not engage with the teeth or does
not hold the position to which it was shifted, the syn-
chronizer assy is damaged or was not correctly
assembled.
Disassemble the synchronizer assy to find the prob-
lem.
Assemble the 3rd/4th speed synchronizer assy (4)
on the shaft.

Lubricate the thrust washer (2).


Assemble the 3rd speed gear (3) and the thrust
washer (2) on the shaft.
132 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Heat the bearing (1) to 80 ÷ 100 °C (176 ÷ 212 °F).


Assemble the bearing (1) with tool 380200190.

Heat the inner ring of the bearing (39) to 80 ÷ 100 °C


(176 ÷ 212 °F).
Assemble the inner ring of the bearing (39) by
means of tool 380200203.

Turn the shaft (41).


Heat the bearing to 80 ÷ 100 °C (176 ÷ 212 °F).
Assemble the bearing (40) with tool 380200190.

Re-position the shaft assemblies (B) and (C) into


the half box.
Use tool 380200246.

S WARNING S
The shaft assemblies must be inserted with pins
and yokes.

Insert the pre-fitted yokes for 3rd and 4th speed and
for 1st and 2nd speed as shown.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 133

Position the assy with care, paying attention that the


ends of the yoke pins are correctly seated.
134 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

4WD - E SHAFT

Disassembly
Remove the shaft (E).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 135

Remove the 4WD clutch gear (10).

Remove the bearing (11).

Use tool 380200258 to compress the spring retainer


downwards in order to reach the snap ring. Remove
the snap ring (1).
Release the tension and remove the tool.
Remove the washer (2).

Remove the spacer (3).


136 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the springs (4).

Remove the sleeve (5).

Remove the 2 O-rings (6) and (9).

Remove the seal rings (8).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 137

Remove the 4WD clutch tube (7) from the front box.
If necessary, or if the tube is leaking or damaged,
replace the front box.

Assembly
Assemble and lubricate the O-rings (6) and (9).

Assemble the sleeve (5).

Assemble the springs (4).


138 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the spacer (3).

Position the washer (2) and the snap ring (1).

Use tool 380200258 to press the spring retainer


down until you have access to the snap ring.
Assemble the snap ring (1).
Release the tension and remove the tool.
Make sure that the snap ring (1) is seated correctly
in the recess of the spring retainer.

Place tool 380200207 on the shaft.


The tool will stop in the correct position to install the
seal ring in the groove.
Heat the seal ring (8) to 60 ÷ 80 °C (140 ÷ 176 °F).
Assemble the seal ring on the tool.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 139

Assemble the 380200225 tool on the 380200207


tool and slide the seal ring until it reaches the
groove of the shaft.
Remove the tools 380200225 and 380200207 and
the spacer from the shaft.

Assemble the end of the 380200214 seal compres-


sor with the deep chamfer onto the shaft and over
the seal ring.
Use a back and forth twisting motion to allow the
seal compressor to slip over the top of the seal ring
and seat this latter into the groove.
Be careful not to damage the seal ring.
After the seal ring is seated in the groove, remove
the seal compressor from the shaft.

Turn the seal compressor around and slide the end


with the narrow chamfer over the shaft and over the
seal ring.
Leave the seal compressor in place for 15 minutes
until the seal ring has cooled and is properly seated
in the groove.
After the seal ring has cooled, remove the seal
compressor from the shaft.

Insert the tool 380200208.


Repeat the previously described operations to
insert the second ring.
Lubricate the seal rings.
140 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Apply compressed air at about 6 bar (87 psi) to 4WD


clutch oil passage (see arrow) by plugging the oppo-
site hole with a finger.
The sleeve (5) should move when compressing the
springs (4).
The 4WD gear (10) should turn freely on 4WD shaft.
If the operation is not correct, dismantle to find the
problem.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 141

Assemble the bearing (11).

Assemble the gear (10).

Assemble the shafts (B) and (C).


Assemble shaft (E).

Reassemble the 4WD clutch tube (7), if previously


removed from the front box.
Assemble the front half box on the rear half box.
142 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

SPEED CONTROLS

Disassembly
Loosen and remove the screws (1).
For the disassembly of the two half boxes it is nec-
essary to remove the gearshift control assy.
Remove the gearshift control assy (2) and the O-ring
(3).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 143

Use proper pliers to release the catch on the collar


fastening the boot.
Remove the collar (4).

Remove the protection boot (5).

Remove the 2 pins (7).

Remove the snap ring (8).


144 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the bushing (9).

Remove the spring (10).

Remove the gearshift lever (6).

If disassembly is required, remove the pins (11) and


separate the yokes from the shift rods.
Make sure that you remember how the parts are
assembled and which parts go together.
Inspect all parts for burrs or excessive wear.
Assembly is the reverse procedure of disassembly.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 145

Assembly
Apply grease to the ball of the gearshift lever.
Assemble the gearshift lever (6).

Check for the correct position of the control lever (6)


according to the gearbox cover (2):
- direct the recess (A) towards the straight side of
cover (B);
- the slots (C) aligned with the cover holes (D).

Insert the spring (10).

Assemble the bushing (9).


146 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the snap ring (8).

Insert the pins (7) through the holes of the cover


flange, so that they engage in the slots of the gear-
shift lever.

Assemble the protection boot (5) so that its end is


correctly positioned over the pin ends.
Be careful so that the pins do not fall out during this
step.

Assemble the collar (4) on the protection.


Use proper pliers to engage the collar block.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 147

Assemble and lubricate the O-ring (3) in the seat of


the cover flange.
Put the gearshift control assy behind the rear cover.
Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening
torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).

Insert the two pins (11) to lock the 3rd and 4th
speed control yoke (13) and the 1st and 2nd speed
control yoke (14).
148 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

The vehicle does not Control valve supply problem. Check and, if necessary, replace the
move. control valves.

Damaged connections of transmission Repair and, if necessary, replace the


and vehicle wiring harness. wiring harness.

Oxidation in the contacts of the Clean the contacts.


electric cables of the wiring harness.

Interruption of the electric cable. Replace the electric cable.

Damage to the solenoids/solenoid Replace the solenoids.


valves.

Damage to sensors. Replace sensors.

Short circuits or bad contact. Check and, if necessary, replace the


fuses.

Incorrect oil level. Restore the oil level.

Check for possible oil leaks. Eliminate the leaks and restore the oil
level.

Suction strainer restriction. Clean the suction strainer.

Damaged oil pump. Replace the oil pump.

Damaged oil pump pressure relief Replace the oil pump.


valve.

Damaged/restricted filter. Replace the filter.

Damaged / stuck control valve. Replace the control valve.

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Oil temperature below 0 °C (32 °F). Wait for the operating temperature to
be reached (stall test).

Damaged rotary seal rings. Replace the rotary seal rings.

Synchronizers damaged. Replace the synchronizers.

Stuck shuttle lever. Repair the shuttle lever.

Excessively worn-out clutch assembly. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


clutch disc kit.

Lack of motion transmission (broken Check, repair and, if necessary,


gears, shafts, bearings, etc.). replace.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 149

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

The brake does not release. Check the general pressure of


transmission.

Check voltage.

Check the operation of the solenoid


valve.

Check the mounting of the brake


solenoid valve block after operating on
the brake.

After the above-described


verifications, disassemble the brake
cover and check the condition of the
parts for unlocking/locking the brake
(seal rings, belleville washers, brake
disc deformation, etc.).

The vehicle has a reduced Incorrect oil temperature. Wait for the operating temperature to
power transmission. be reached (stall test).

Transmission oil overheating. Restore acceptable temperature


values.

Incorrect operating pressures. Check the hydraulic circuit and


replace (oil pump, filters, control
valve).

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Incorrect oil level. Restore the oil level.

Worn-out clutch assembly. Replace/repair.

4WD fails to engage. Repair/replace the 4WD shaft assy.

Overheated solenoids/solenoid Replace.


valves.

Damage to sensors. Replace sensors.

Overheating. Damaged cooling system. Repair the cooling system.

Dirty heat exchanger. Clean the heat exchanger.

Unintentionally activated parking Deactivate the parking brake.


brake.

Excessive soil deposit on axle wheel Clean the axle wheel hubs.
hubs.

Seizure (broken gears, shafts, Check, repair and, if necessary,


bearings, etc.). replace.
150 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Braking force external to transmission: Check and repair the axle.


axle operating problem.

Dragging of clutch discs. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


clutch discs.

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Damaged oil thermostat. Replace the oil thermostat.

Incorrect oil level. Restore the oil level.

Worn-out oil pump. Replace the oil pump.

Wheel rotation with lifted Dragging of clutch discs. Repair and, if necessary, replace the
vehicle. clutch discs.

Low oil temperature (high oil Wait for the operating temperature to
viscosity). be reached (stall test).

Incorrect oil gradient. Change oil and filters.

Damaged control valve. Replace the control valve.

Stuck shuttle lever. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


shuttle lever.

Noise. Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Damaged oil pump. Replace the oil pump.

Ventilation/Cavitation. Check the oil level.


Check the oil gradient.

Seizure (broken gears, shafts, Check, repair and, if necessary,


bearings, etc.). replace.

Worn-out clutch discs. Replace the clutch discs.

Synchronizer coupling wear. Replace the synchronizer coupling.

Damaged 4WD coupling assy. Replace the 4WD coupling assy.

Irregular coupling. Damaged hydraulic control valve. Replace the control valves.

Electric system fault. Repair the electric system.

Worn-out clutch discs. Replace the clutch discs.

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Low oil temperature (high oil Wait for the operating temperature to
viscosity). be reached (stall test).

Overheating. See “overheating”.

Damaged hydraulic system. Repair the hydraulic system.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 151

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

The gear remains Damaged/stuck shuttle lever. Repair and, if necessary, replace the
engaged. shuttle lever.

Electric system fault. Repair the electric system.

Damaged control valve. Replace the control valve.

Damaged hydraulic system. Repair the hydraulic system.

Damaged clutch assembly. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


clutch assembly.

Gearshift lever damaged. Replace gearshift lever.

Synchronizers damaged. Replace the synchronizers.

Lack of 4WD power Damaged 4WD connection assy. Replace the 4WD coupling assy.
transmission.
Hydraulic system fault. Repair the hydraulic system.

Damaged control valve. Replace the control valve.

Braking sensor fault. Check and, if necessary, replace the


braking sensors.

Electric system fault. Repair the electric system.

Gear fails to engage. Gearshift lever damaged. Replace the gearshift lever.

Synchronizers damaged. Replace the synchronizers.


152 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

REPAIR TIMES
The times are referred to average values of mainte-
nance performed by skilled personnel in workshops
equipped with all necessary fixtures for a proper
execution of the required works.
The repair and/or replacement times are indicated in
minutes.
We assume that the transmission assy has already
been removed from the machine.

ASSY OPERATION TIME (minutes)


Plugs and filters Oil filter replacement 5
Oil pump Oil pump replacement 20
Replacement of lubrication tube 5
Lines Replacement of supply tube for solenoid valve of
5
parking brake
Control valve replacement 15
Control valve
Control valve overhauling 60
4WD solenoid valve
Solenoid valve replacement 10
(only with 4WD models)
PTO shaft replacement 60
Replacement of seal rings on input shaft 20
Transmission box
Half box replacement 80
Open, clean, close the half boxes 50
Replacement of shaft A / bearings 60
Overhauling of shaft A 150
A and D shafts
Replacement of seal rings on shaft A 120
Replacement of shaft D / bearings 60
B shaft replacement 60
Overhauling/replacement of C shaft 150
B and C shafts
Replacement of B shaft bearings 60
Replacement of C shaft bearings 60
Overhauling/replacement of shaft E 100

E shaft Replacement of E shaft bearings 70


(only with 4WD models) Replacement of seal rings 70
Gear/sleeve replacement 90
Gearshift control Gearshift lever replacement 20
Disc kit replacement 40
Parking brake
Brake overhauling/replacement 40
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 153

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH DESCRIPTION USE 2WD 4WD

380002211 Handle To be used with the various pushers and buffers • •

380200190 Buffer Assembly / disassembly of several bearings • •

380200197 Buffer Assembly of shaft A bearings • •

380200203 Buffer Assembly of B and C shaft bearings • •

380200207 Protection Assembly of 4WD shaft seal ring / •

380200208 Protection Assembly of 4WD shaft seal ring / •

380200213 Protection Assembly of 4WD shaft cover seal ring / •

380200214 Calibrator Assembly of seal ring on PTO shaft and 4WD shaft • •

380200215 Attachment Disassembly / assembly of clutch • •

380200218 Buffer Assembly of oil pump seal ring • •

380200224 Cover and shims Assembly of seal ring on shaft A • •

380200225 Plunger Assembly of seal ring on PTO shaft and 4WD shaft • •

380001926 Protection Clutch piston assembly • •

380200226 Buffer Assembly of SAHR seal ring for parking brake • •

380200230 Buffer Assembly of D shaft bearings • •

380001933 Cover and shims Assembly of seal ring on shaft A • •

380001927 Calibrator Assembly of seal ring on shaft A • •

380001928 Plunger Assembly of seal ring on shaft A • •

380200246 Hook Lifting of shafts B and C and of gear control yokes • •

380200257 Protection Assembly of seal ring on PTO shaft • •

380200258 Tool Disassembly / Assembly of snap ring on 4WD shaft / •


154 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

POWERSHIFT TRANSMISSION
This transmission is used only on powershift loader
backhoe models B110B-B110BTC-B115B.

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
4WD/2WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHIFT (B110B - B110BTC)
Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB2 MPB 4WD
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 5.533:1 reverse travel 4.549:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 3.359:1 reverse travel 2.762:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.553:1 reverse travel 1.260:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.811:1

4WD/4WS TRANSMISSION - POWERSHIFT (B115B)


Model ..................................................................................................................... CARRARO TLB2 MPB 4WS
Type (4x4) ................................................................................................. 4 forward and 4 reverse travel gears
Torque converter ratio.................................................................................................................................. 2.38
Transmission ratios:
1st gear .........................................................................forward travel 4.448:1 reverse travel 3.657:1
2nd gear ........................................................................forward travel 2.700:1 reverse travel 2.220:1
3rd gear.........................................................................forward travel 1.232:1 reverse travel 1.013:1
4th gear .........................................................................forward travel 0.652:1
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 155

HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE


2/3 proportional solenoid valve specifications
Absorption:.................................................................................................................................................. 10 W
Protection degree:......................................................................................................................................IP69K
Solenoid resistance:......................................................................................................... 7.25 Ω [20 °C (68 °F)]
Power supply voltage:............................................................................................................................ 12 V DC

2/3 solenoid valve specifications


Power supply voltage:............................................................................................................................ 12 V DC
Absorption:........................................................................................................................ 1.68 A [20 °C (68 °F)]
Protection degree:......................................................................................................................................IP69K
Solenoid resistance:......................................................................................................... 7.14 Ω [20 °C (68 °F)]

2/4 solenoid valve specifications


Power supply voltage:............................................................................................................................ 12 V DC
Absorption:........................................................................................................................ 1.68 A [20 °C (68 °F)]
Protection degree:......................................................................................................................................IP69K
Solenoid resistance:......................................................................................................... 7.14 Ω [20 °C (68 °F)]

Diagram
A. 2/3 proportional solenoid 2nd - 4th speed actuation
B. 2/3 proportional solenoid reverse speed
C. 2/3 proportional solenoid forward speed
D. 2/3 proportional solenoid 1st - 3rd speed actuation
E. 2/3 solenoid valve 4WD engagement
F. 2/4 solenoid valve 2nd or 4th speed selection
G. 2/3 solenoid valve differential lock engagement
H. 2/4 solenoid valve 1st or 3rd speed selection
PS. Supply pressure check port
HDL2. Differential lock engagement control port
156 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 157

DIMENSIONS
2WS
158 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

4WS
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 159

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM
2WS
160 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

REF. DESCRIPTION NOTES


1 Suction filter 250 Nm (184.39 lbf·ft)
2 Pump 36 cm3/rev (2.20 in3/rev)
3 Oil filter relief valve 23 bar (333 psi)
4 Filter 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)
5 Torque converter
6 Oil cooler
7 Torque converter relief valve 3.5 ÷ 5.5 bar (50 ÷ 80 psi)
8 Pressure regulator for sequential valve
9 Air breather
10 Forward gear pressure check port
11 Reverse gear pressure check port
12 Forward gear clutch
13 Reverse gear clutch
14 4WD clutch
15 HDL
16 Shaft lubrication inlet
17 Brake oil return port
18 Transfer oil return port
19 Main pressure check port
20 Pressure check port of 1st gear clutch
21 Pressure check port of 2nd gear clutch
22 1st gear clutch
23 2nd gear clutch
24 3rd gear clutch
25 4th gear clutch
26 Main shaft lubrication
27 Output shaft lubrication
28 Temperature thermostat
29 Parking brake lubrication
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 161

4WS
162 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

REF. DESCRIPTION NOTES


1 Suction filter 250 Nm (184.39 lbf·ft)
2 Pump 36 cm3/rev (2.20 in3/rev)
3 Oil filter relief valve 23 bar (333 psi)
4 Spin-on filter 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)
5 Torque converter
6 Oil cooler
7 Torque converter relief valve 3.5 ÷ 5.5 bar (50 ÷ 80 psi)
8 Pressure regulator for sequential valve
9 Air breather
10 Forward gear pressure check port
11 Reverse gear pressure check port
12 Forward gear clutch
13 Reverse gear clutch
14 4WD clutch
15 HDL
16 Shaft lubrication inlet
17 Brake oil return port
18 Transfer oil return port
19 Main pressure check port
20 Pressure check port of 1st gear clutch
21 Pressure check port of 2nd gear clutch
22 1st gear clutch
23 2nd gear clutch
24 3rd gear clutch
25 4th gear clutch
26 Main shaft lubrication
27 Output shaft lubrication
28 Temperature thermostat
29 Parking handbrake lubrication
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 163

PORTS
2WS

REF. DIMENSION USE NOTES - MISCELLANEOUS


1 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil inlet from cooler
2 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil outlet to cooler
Check port for torque converter input
3 9/16” - 18 UNF 3 ÷ 9 bar (43.5 ÷ 130 psi)
pressure
13.5 ÷ 16.5 bar (196 ÷ 239 psi)
4 9/16” - 18 UNF Forward gear pressure check port 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure in
neutral position
13.5 ÷ 16.5 bar (196 ÷ 239 psi)
5 9/16” - 18 UNF Reverse gear pressure check port 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure in
neutral position
6 Oil drain plug
7 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil pressure delivery to differential lock 14 ÷ 17 bar (203 ÷ 246 psi)
Lubrication pressure check port (from cooler) 1 ÷ 5 bar (14.5 ÷ 72.5 psi) forward/reverse gear
8 9/16” - 18 UNF
Oil outlet to brake tank 1 ÷ 5 bar (14.5 ÷ 72.5 psi) neutral position
9 9/16” - 18 UNF Brake oil pressure delivery 14 ÷ 17 bar (203 ÷ 246 psi)
10 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil return
11 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil level check port
12 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil main pressure check port 14 ÷ 17 bar (203 ÷ 246 psi)
13 1/8” - BSP Lubrication check port
14 1/8” - BSP Check port of 1st gear
15 1/8” - BSP Check port of 2nd gear
16 1/8” - BSP Check port of 4th gear
164 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

4WS

REF. DIMENSION USE NOTES - MISCELLANEOUS


1 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil inlet from cooler
2 7/8” - 14 UNF Oil outlet to cooler
Check port for torque converter input
3 9/16” - 18 UNF 3 ÷ 9 bar (43.5 ÷ 130 psi)
pressure
13.5 ÷ 16.5 bar (196 ÷ 239 psi)
4 9/16” - 18 UNF Forward gear pressure check port 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure in
neutral position
13.5 ÷ 16.5 bar (196 ÷ 239 psi)
5 9/16” - 18 UNF Reverse gear pressure check port 0.3 bar (4.3 psi) = maximum pressure in
neutral position
6 Oil drain plug
7 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil pressure delivery to differential lock 14 ÷ 17 bar (203 ÷ 246 psi)
Lubrication pressure check port (from cooler) 1 ÷ 5 bar (14.5 ÷ 72.5 psi) forward/reverse gear
8 9/16” - 18 UNF
Oil outlet to brake tank 1 ÷ 5 bar (14.5 ÷ 72.5 psi) neutral position
9 9/16” - 18 UNF Brake oil pressure delivery 14 ÷ 17 bar (203 ÷ 246 psi)
10 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil return
11 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil level check port
12 9/16” - 18 UNF Oil main pressure check port 14 ÷ 17 bar (203 ÷ 246 psi)
13 1/8” - BSP Lubrication check port
14 1/8” - BSP Check port of 1st gear
15 1/8” - BSP Check port of 2nd gear
16 1/8” - BSP Check port of 4th gear
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 165

CONTROLS

1. POWERSHIFT TRANSMISSION GEARSHIFT 3. HORN BUTTON


AND DIRECTION LEVER: it is possible to 4. TRANSMISSION DISCONNECT BUTTON (on
select four forward and four rearward travel loader attachment control lever)
gears.
The lever has 3 positions, according to which
the travel direction is defined:
F = forward travel
N = idle/neutral
R = reverse
By turning the knob, instead, the following
gears are selected:
1 = 1st gear
2 = 2nd gear
3 = 3rd gear
4 = 4th gear
2. KICKDOWN SWITCH: if the machine is in sec-
ond gear and it is necessary to shift to the first
gear to work with the loader attachment, acti-
vating the kickdown switch to a lower ration
allows the machine to instantly shift from sec-
ond to first gear.
When the reverse travel is activated, transmis-
sion reverts to second gear.
166 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

KICKDOWN (QUICK SHIFTING TO LOWER


GEAR RATIO)
The kickdown function (2nd to 1st gear only)
instantly increases the torque on the driving wheels
and, hence, the digging power. For example when
the loader is pushing into a pile and more torque is
required at the wheels.
This is achieved by an instant gearshift from 2nd to
1st by means of button (2) without activating the
gearshift lever.

TRANSMISSION DISCONNECTION
The disconnect feature is useful when loading, for
example when pushing the loader attachment onto
a pile of material, with the bucket sufficiently filled.
For this purpose, press the disconnect switch (4)
which disengages the transmission, thus allowing
the full power of the engine to be directed to the
hydraulic oil pump.
Disconnection is available in 1st and 2nd gear.
NOTE: transmission disconnection is selectable when
the machine speed is lower than 5 km/h (3 mph), by
depressing the button on the loader lever, and remains
active until the switch is released.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 167

LUBRICATION

1. Hole for filling and fastening of oil dipstick


2. Oil level plug
3. Oil drain plug
4. Breather

LEVEL CHECK
The oil level check should be carried out with the
engine running at low speed and at normal operat-
ing temperature.
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Raise the loader attachment and assemble the
safety support strut.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift
lever in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Open and raise the engine guard and lock it in
opened position by means of the safety lock on the
left-hand gas spring.
Extract the dipstick (1), clean it with a clean cloth
and completely insert it into the hose, then take it
out again.
If the oil level is below the mini mark, top up.
Stop the engine.
Unlock the safety lock and close the engine guard.
168 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

OIL CHANGE
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Raise the loader attachment and assemble the
safety support strut.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Open and raise the engine guard and lock it in
opened position by means of the safety lock on the
left-hand gas spring.
Remove the dipstick (1).
NOTE: change the oil while the transmission is still
warm; the oil will flow more easily.
Place a container with suitable capacity under the
drain plug (2).
Loosen and remove the drain plug (2).
Let the transmission oil drain.

Re-install the drain plug (2).


Fill with new oil of specified type through the dipstick
hole.
NOTE: transmission oil capacity 20.8 litres (4.57 gal).
Reassemble the dipstick (1).
Check the oil level by means of the dipstick and, if
necessary, add more oil.
Drive the machine for a few minutes in first and sec-
ond gear, then stop the engine.
Check the oil level again by means of the dipstick
and, if necessary, add more oil.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 169

GREASING
Tecnolube POLYMER 400 grease
Transmission oil

4WS

F45638
170 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE

1. Transmission 12. Dipstick tube


2. Anti-vibration 13. Dipstick
3. Left transmission support 14. M10 x 30 hex screw
4. Right transmission support [tightening torque 52 ÷ 57 Nm (38 ÷ 42 lbf·ft)]
5. Washer 15. Washer
6. M12 x 35 hex screw 16. Torque converter
[tightening torque 90 ÷ 110 Nm (66 ÷ 81 lbf·ft)] 17. Plate
7. Washer 18. Plate
8. M12 x 90 hex screw 19. Snap ring
[tightening torque 90 ÷ 110 Nm (66 ÷ 81 lbf·ft)] 20. Washer
9. Washer 21. M10 x 20 hex screw
10. M12 nut [tightening torque 52 ÷ 57 Nm (38 ÷ 42 lbf·ft)]
11. M8 x 25 screw 22. M10 x 30 hex screw
[tightening torque 26 ÷ 31 Nm (19 ÷ 23 lbf·ft)] [tightening torque 52 ÷ 57 Nm (38 ÷ 42 lbf·ft)]
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 171

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Some of the following pictures could not exactly
show your transmission, but the procedure is cor-
rect.

TIGHTENING TORQUES AND APPLICATION OF SEALANTS / ADHESIVES


A. Loctite 510
B. Loctite 542
C. Loctite 518
D. Loctite 638
172 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 173
174 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Only 4WS
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 175

PLUGS AND FILTERS

Disassembly
Remove the oil drain plug (1) and drain the oil from
the transmission.
176 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Loosen and remove the 2 screws (1).

Remove cover (3).


Remove the oil filter (4) and the O-ring (5).

Unscrew and remove the oil filter (6).


If necessary, remove the fitting (7).

Loosen and remove the valve (8).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 177

Check the valve (8).


Clean the valve.
If necessary, replace the O-rings (9) and (10).

If necessary, remove the breather (11).

NOTE: this port enables you to check the supply


pressure for forward gear engagement.
Remove the plug (12).

NOTE: this port enables you to check the supply


pressure for reverse gear engagement.
Remove the plug (13).
178 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

NOTE: this port enables you to check the lubrica-


tion pressure.
Remove the plug (14).

Remove the revolution sensor (15).

Remove the oil thermostat (16).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 179

Assembly
Assemble the revolution sensor (15).
Tighten to the prescribed torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the oil thermostat (16).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).

Assemble the plugs (12) and (13).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).

Assemble and tighten the breather (11) by hand.


180 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Clean the valve (8).


Assemble the O-rings (9) and (10) onto the valve
(8).

Assemble valve (8).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 28 Nm (21 lbf·ft).

Assemble fitting (7).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the oil filter (6).


Lubricate the gasket.
Tighten clockwise until the gasket makes contact
with its seat, then tighten further 2/3 of a turn.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 181

Assemble the O-ring (5) on the filter (4).


Insert the filter (4).

Assemble the cover (3).


Screw in the 2 screws (2) and tighten to the pre-
scribed torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).

Assemble the oil drain plug (1).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).
182 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

OIL PUMP

Disassembly
Loosen and remove the screws (1).
Mark the oil pump position with respect to the bell
housing before loosening the screws.

Pull out the oil pump (2) by means of two levers (A).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 183

Remove the oil pump (2).

S WARNING S
The O-ring can be damaged.

Remove the O-ring (3).

S WARNING S
Do not disassemble the pump or its operation may
be compromised.

If necessary, remove the seal ring (4).

S WARNING S
The seal ring can be damaged.
184 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Assemble the seal ring (4) onto the oil pump (2).
Use tool 380200218.
Lubricate the seal ring (4).

Assemble the O-ring (3).

Before pump assembly (if new), check that the oil


passage holes (between pump and half box) or the
visual marks coincide.

Lubricate the seal ring (4) to keep it centred, in


order to facilitate its introduction onto the oil pump.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 185

Lubricate the matching seat with the front half box.


Assemble the oil pump (2).

Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening


torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).
Check that the mark on the oil pump and on the bell
housing coincide.
186 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE

Disassembly
Disconnect cable (12).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 187

Drain the transmission oil.


Disconnect the electric connections.
Loosen all the fittings of the delivery pipes con-
nected with the control valve (2).
Loosen and remove the screws (1).

Remove the control valve (2).

Remove the gasket (3).

Remove the pressure switch (4).


188 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Place the control valve on a workbench.


Loosen and remove the screws (5) of the valves.

Pull out the valves (6), (7) and (8) with a screw-
driver.

Check the valves (6), (7) and (8).

Loosen and remove the valve (9).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 189

Check the valve (9).


Clean the valve and, if necessary, replace the O-rings
(10) and (11).

Assembly

Clean the valve (9).


Assemble the O-rings (10) and (11).

Assemble valve (9).


Tighten to the prescribed torque of 25 ÷ 30 Nm
(18 ÷ 22 lbf·ft).
190 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the valves ON/OFF (6) and (7) and the


proportional valves (8) by observing the shown
positions.

Assemble the pressure switch (4).

Screw in and tighten the screws (5) to a tightening


torque of 3 ÷ 4 Nm (2 ÷ 3 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 191

Assemble the gasket (3).

Assemble the control valve (2).

Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening


torque of 20 Nm (15 lbf·ft).
192 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

HYDRAULIC SYSTEM LINES

Disassembly
Drain the transmission oil.
Remove the tube (1) (2nd gear).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 193

Remove the tube (2) (4th gear).

Remove the tube (3) (3rd gear).

Remove the tube (4) (1st gear).

Remove the tube (5) (4WD).


194 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the tube (6) (lubrication).

Remove the tube (7) (lubrication).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 195

Assembly

Assemble the tube (7) (lubrication) by tightening the


fittings to the tightening torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).

Assemble the tube (6) (lubrication) by tightening the


fittings to the tightening torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).

Assemble the tube (5) (4WD) by tightening the fit-


tings to the tightening torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).

Assemble the tube (4) (1st gear) by tightening the


fittings to the tightening torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).
196 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the tube (3) (3rd gear) by tightening the


fittings to the tightening torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).

Assemble the tube (2) (4th gear) by tightening the


fittings to the tightening torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).

Assemble the tube (1) (2nd gear) by tightening the


fittings to the tightening torque of 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 197

PARKING BRAKE

Disassembly
Remove the oil drain plug (T) and drain the oil from
the transmission.
198 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Unscrew the screw (1).


Use a screwdriver and 2 screws to lock the flange.
Remove the screw (1) and the washer (2).
Remove the flange (4) and the O-ring (3).

Loosen and remove the screws (6) and (7).


Remove the brake (8) assembly.
Remove the O-ring (9) from the brake (8).

Remove the seal ring (15).

S WARNING S
The seal ring can be damaged.

Remove the plug (5).

Remove the rings (10), the 5 brake discs (11) and


the 5 counterdiscs (12).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 199

Remove the hub (13).

Only 4WS
Remove the brake and the disc kit.
Do not remove the plug (16).

Only 4WS
Remove the screw (17), the washer (18) and the
hub (19).
200 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Assemble the hub (13).

Use a gauge to check that each counterdisc (12)


and each brake disc (11) is flat.
If necessary, replace them.
If the brake discs (11) are nearly smooth, replace
them.
If the friction material is damaged or appears
burned, replace it.
Check the grooves for wear.
Check counterdiscs (12) for pitting, scoring, or other
damage.
If necessary, replace them.
If you will be using new brake discs, soak them in oil
for at least an hour before assembly.
If you are using the old friction discs, make sure that
the contact surfaces are coated with oil before
assembly, check the wear condition.
If this is 50% compared to the nominal value, we
suggest its replacement.

Brake disc kit

Brake disc number 5


Counterdisc number 5
3.6 ± 0.05 mm
Nominal brake disc thickness
(0.14 ± 0.002 in)
Brake disc kit nominal
37.40 ÷ 37.60 mm
thickness [with 163 kg
(1.47 ± 1.48 in)
(359.34 lbs) of load]
Brake disc maximum wear 0.65 mm
(each side) (0.02 in)
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 201

Assemble the counterdisc (12), the brake disc (11)


and the ring (10).
Repeat this operation until the brake disc kit is com-
plete.

Assemble the plug (5).


Assemble the seal ring (15) onto the brake (8), use
tool 380200226.
Lubricate the seal ring (15).

Insert the O-ring (9) on the brake (8).


Assemble the brake assy (8) on transmission.
Screw in and tighten the screws (6) and (7) to the
prescribed torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the flange (4) and the O-ring (3).


Lubricate the O-ring (3).
Assemble the washer (2) and the screw (1).
Use a screwdriver and 2 screws to lock the flange.
Tighten the screw (1) to a tightening torque of 139 Nm
(102.5 lbf·ft).
202 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Only 4WS
Assemble the hub (19), the washer (18) and the
screw (17).
Tighten the screw (1) to a tightening torque of 139 Nm
(102.5 lbf·ft).

Only 4WS
Assemble the brake disc kit and the brake (8).
Tighten the screws (6) and (7) to a tightening
torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 203

TRANSMISSION BOX

Disassembly
Remove the snap ring (16).
204 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Drain the transmission oil.


Unscrew and remove the screw (1) for flange fas-
tening (2).

If necessary, use a screwdriver and 2 screws to lock


the flange.

Collect the washer (3).

Remove the flange (2) and the O-ring (4).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 205

Remove the seal ring (5).

S WARNING S
The seal ring can be damaged.

Only 4WS
Loosen and remove the screw (A) and the washer
(B).
If necessary, replace the O-ring (E).
Remove the flange (D).
If necessary, replace the seal ring (G).
Loosen and remove the screws (C).
Remove the hub (F).

Unscrew and remove the screws (6) for flange fas-


tening (7).

Remove the flange (7).


206 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Pull out the transmission shaft PTO (8).

If necessary, replace the seal ring (9) by cutting it.

Remove the snap ring (10).

Take out the bearing (11) with tool 380200190.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 207

Loosen and remove the screws (12) from the rear


(13) and the front half box (14).

Insert a lever (L) in the special slot and remove the


cover.
NOTE: the surfaces are attached with some seal-
ant.

If necessary, use a plastic hammer to facilitate the


separation of the half box.

S WARNING S
Do not lift the transmission shafts; the removal of
the shafts from their housings can damage the seal
rings.

Lift the front half box (14).


208 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the 4 O-rings (15).

Seal all oil recirculation holes with rubber plugs (T).

Assembly
Clean the edge of the rear half box.
Carefully verify the box and its inner components for
the possible presence of debris (dirt, filings or
burrs).
Thoroughly clean all possible dirt.

S WARNING S
Only after a careful inspection of the whole trans-
mission, proceed with the re-assembly.
Remove the old sealant from the mating surface of
the rear half box by means of a proper scraper.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 209

We suggest the use of a sealant solvent.

Carefully clean the O-ring seats.

Degrease and dry accurately the mating surface of


the rear half box.
NOTE: we suggest the use of a proper solvent.

Apply sealant on the mating surface of the rear half


box.
210 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Spread the sealant uniformly.

Prevent the penetration of the sealant in the O-ring


seats.

Carefully clean the O-ring seats.

Assemble the O-rings (15).


Do not lubricate the O-rings.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 211

Place the 4 O-rings (15) into their seats with a


buffer.

Assemble the front half box (14) on the rear one.


Make sure that the bearings of the shafts go straight
into the bores in the front box.
Push the front half box onto the rear one.

Assemble the snap ring (16).

Tighten the screws (12) to the rear half box (13) and
to the front half box (14).
Tighten the screws (12) to a tightening torque of
50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).
212 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the seal ring (5) on the output of the front


shaft by means of tool 380200226.

Assemble the flange (2) and a new O-ring (4).

Assemble the washer (3) and tighten the screw (1).

Tighten the screw (1) to a tightening torque of 139 Nm


(102.5 lbf·ft).
Use a screwdriver and 2 screws to lock the flange.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 213

Assemble the bearing (11) on the transmission shaft


PTO (8).

Assemble the snap ring (10).

To assemble the seal ring (9) perform following


operations by means of the listed tools in sequence:
380200257;
380200225;
380200214.

Insert transmission shaft PTO (8) to stroke end.


214 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Smear a thin layer of sealant on the flange (7).

S WARNING S
During flange assembly, the 2 holes for the oil pas-
sage (P) should coincide.

Screw in and tighten the screws (6) to a tightening


torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Only 4WS
Assemble the hub (F).
Screw in and tighten the screws (C) to the tighten-
ing torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).
Assemble the seal ring (G) by means of tool
380200226.
Assemble O-ring (E).
Assemble the flange (D).
Place the washer (B), screw in and tighten the screw
(A) to the tightening torque of 139 Nm (102.5 lbf·ft).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 215

A, D SHAFTS

Disassembly
Grab the shaft with the (A) pliers and pull out the
shaft assy (D).
216 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Shaft (A)
If necessary, remove the seal ring (1).

Remove the snap ring (2).

Assemble a bearing separator under the gear (do


not assemble the bearing separator between the
gear and the bearing).
Use a puller on the bearing separator and insert a
shaft protector between the puller and the end of
the input shaft.
By means of puller which operates between separa-
tor and shaft protection, pull only until the bearing is
free, otherwise the parts can be damaged.

Remove the bearing (3).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 217

Remove the spacer (4).

Remove the gear (6).

Remove the roller retainer (7).

Remove the thrust washer (8).


218 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the pin (9).

Remove the snap ring (10).

Lift and remove the snap ring (11).

Remove the discs (18) and the counterdiscs (17).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 219

Place a mark below the groove on the clutch bell.

Mark the snap ring (11), the discs (18) and the
counterdiscs (17).
These marks will be used as a reference during
assembly.

Lower the cover (13) by means of tool 380200215.

Remove the snap ring (14).


220 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Remove the cover (13) and the spring (15).

Remove the sleeve (5).

Remove the piston (19) by blowing in compressed


air through the delivery hole.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 221

If necessary, remove the seal ring (20) with the


inner O-ring from the outside seat of the piston and
the seal ring (21) with the relevant O-ring from the
inner seat of the piston.
To remove the rings it is necessary to cut them.

Turn the shaft.


If necessary, remove the seal rings (22).

Remove the snap ring (23).

Remove the bearing (24) by means of a puller.


222 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the bearing (24) and the thrust washer


(25).

Remove the gear (26) and the roller retainer (12).

For the disassembly of other parts, repeat the oper-


ations described previously.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 223

Check the seal ring grooves (large and small) for


wear or damage.
Check if the output shaft is worn or damaged.
Check oil passages in the output shaft to be sure
that they are open and free of foreign material.
Check the ball bearings and the needle bearings for
flat areas, pitting or other damage.
If you are to re-use the clutch discs, observe the
assembly order.

At each disassembly check with a gauge that the


total thickness of the clutch discs remains in the
wear limits; otherwise replace the clutch disc kit (18)
with a new one.
Verify that all clutch discs are free from burns, that
the friction surfaces are not damaged and that the
grooves of the friction surfaces are well outlined.
Moreover, verify that the counterdiscs (17) are per-
fectly flat, without scrapes or pittings.
In case any of the discs shows even just one of the
above-mentioned faults, replace the clutch disc kit
with a new one.
If you are to use a new kit of clutch discs, let it soak
into a bath of oil for at least one hour before its use.
In any case, prior to assembling the clutch disc kit,
lubricate the contact surfaces of the counterdiscs
with oil.

Check that the hole of the input shaft on the rear half
box does not show damages that could cause leaks
when the clutch is assembled.
Check that the grooves of the input shaft are not
damaged by the steel discs.
224 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

2WS forward - reverse gear clutch

Disc number (each side) 6


Counterdisc number (each side) 6
Rated thickness of disc 2.4 ± 0.05 mm (0.09 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 29.00 ÷ 29.20 mm (1.14 ± 1.15 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.35 mm (0.01 in)

A. Reverse
B. Forward
1. Clutch disc (no. 6)
2. Clutch counterdisc (no. 3)
3. Clutch counterdisc (no. 3)
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 225

4WS forward gear clutch

Disc number (each side) 7


Counterdisc number (each side) 7
Rated thickness of disc 2.4 ± 0.05 mm (0.09 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 33.90 ÷ 34.10 mm (1.33 ± 1.34 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.35 mm (0.01 in)

A. Reverse
B. Forward
1. Reverse clutch disc (no. 6)
2. Reverse clutch counterdisc (no. 2)
3. Reverse clutch counterdisc (no. 2)
4. Forward clutch disc (no. 7)
5. Forward clutch counterdisc (no. 3)
6. Forward clutch counterdisc (no. 4)
226 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Shaft (D)
Remove the bearing (16) from the shaft (D) by
means of a puller.

Remove the bearing (37) from the shaft (D) by


means of a puller.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 227

Assembly
Shaft (A)
Assemble the seal ring (20) with the relevant O-ring
and the seal ring (21) with the relevant inner O-ring,
respectively in the outer and inner seat of the pis-
ton.

Apply a thin film of oil on the seal rings.

Insert the piston (19) by means of tool (T)


380001926 to protect the seal rings (21).
228 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the sleeve (5).

Assemble the spring (15) and the cover (13).

Lower the cover (13) by means of tool 380200215.

Insert the snap ring (14).


NOTE: make sure that the snap ring (14) is cor-
rectly fitted into its seat.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 229

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Remove the 380200215 tool and fit the pin (9).

Insert the thrust washer (8).

Insert the roller retainer (7).


230 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

To assemble the clutch discs start with the gear (6)


on the bench.
Assemble the thrust washer (11) so that the refer-
ence mark on top of the plate, made during disas-
sembly, is facing towards the gear.

Assemble the discs (18) and the counterdiscs (17)


on the gear (6).
The assembled clutch disc kit must contain 6 steel
discs and 6 friction discs.

Use 2 screwdrivers to position the disc kit.

Assemble the snap ring (10).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 231

Assemble the spacer (4).

Heat the bearing (3) to 80 ÷ 100 °C (176 ÷ 212 °F).


Assemble the bearing (3) with tool 380200190.

Assemble the snap ring (2).

NOTE: for clarity of the seal ring installation proce-


dure, the following photos do not show the disc kit,
gear, spacer, bearing, and snap ring installed on the
input shaft.
232 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the seal ring (1).

Assemble the 380200224 tool onto the input shaft


with the chamfered end facing inwards.

Let the tool 380200224 slide on the input shaft and


above the spacer.
The tool will stop in the correct position to install the
seal ring in the groove.

Heat the seal ring to 60 ÷ 80 °C (140 ÷ 176 °F) for 5


minutes.
Assemble the seal ring on the tool 380200224.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 233

Assemble the 380200225 tool over the 380200224


tool and slide the seal ring until it reaches the
groove in the shaft.
Remove the tools 380200224 and 380200225, the
expander/protector and the spacer from the shaft.

Assemble the end of the 380200214 seal compres-


sor with the deep chamfer onto the shaft and over
the seal ring.
Use a back and forth twisting motion to allow the
seal compressor to slip over the top of the seal ring
and seat this latter into the groove.
Be careful not to damage the seal ring.
After the seal ring is seated in the groove, remove
the seal compressor from the shaft.

Turn the seal compressor around and slide the end


with the narrow chamfer over the shaft and over the
seal ring.
Leave the seal compressor in place for 15 minutes
until the seal ring has cooled and is properly seated
in the groove.
After the seal ring has cooled, remove the seal
compressor from the shaft.

Turn the shaft upside down to carry out the opera-


tions described previously.
Lubricate the thrust washer (25).
Assemble the thrust washer so that the notch in the
inner edge fits over the pin.
Make sure that the side with the oil grooves is
down.
234 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Heat the bearing (24) to 80 ÷ 100 °C (176 ÷ 212 °F).


By means of tool 380200197 place the bearing (24)
onto the input shaft until it makes contact with the
thrust washer.

Assemble the snap ring (23).

Assemble the snap rings and place the spacer in


the protection (tool 380001933).

Place tool 380001933 on the shaft.


The tool will stop in the correct position to install the
seal ring in the groove.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 235

Heat the seal ring to 60 ÷ 80 °C (140 ÷ 176 °F) for 5


minutes.
Assemble the seal ring on the tool 380001933.

Assemble the 380001928 tool over the 380001933


tool and slide the seal ring until it reaches the
groove in the shaft.
Remove the tools 380001928 and 380001933.

Assemble the end of tool 380001927 with the deep


chamfer onto the shaft and over the seal ring.
Use a back and forth twisting motion to allow the
seal compressor to slip over the top of the seal ring
and seat this latter into the groove.
Be careful not to damage the seal ring.
After the seal ring is seated in the groove, remove
the seal compressor from the shaft.

Turn the seal compressor around and slide the end


with the narrow chamfer over the shaft and over the
seal ring.
Leave the seal compressor in place for 15 minutes
until the seal ring has cooled and is properly seated
in the groove.
After the seal ring has cooled, remove the seal
compressor from the shaft.
236 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

In order to insert the other 3 rings, repeat the opera-


tions described previously, by means of following
spacer rings:
380001933 for the 2nd ring;
380001933 for the 3rd ring;
380001933 for the 4th ring.

1. Lubrication oil passage


2. Forward gear clutch passage
3. Reverse gear clutch passage
4. Forward gear engagement
5. Forward gear disc kit
6. Reverse gear disc kit
7. Reverse gear engagement
8. Input shaft

Apply compressed air of approximately 6 bar (87 psi)


to the forward clutch passage.
Listen for the forward gear piston to move and to
lock the relevant disc kit.
Try to shift the forward travel gear.
It must not turn on the input shaft.
Try to shift the reverse travel gear.
It must turn freely on the input shaft.
If the clutches do not work correctly, disassemble
them to find the problem.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 237

Carry out the check procedure of the clutch disc kit


play on both sides of the clutch.
Position the shaft on a suitable support (S) and
apply load F on the counterdisc (11) surface by
means of a proper buffer (T), as shown.
This operation clears any possible play.

To check the backlash, supply the piston chamber


with compressed air at 6 bar (87 psi) and verify the
actual stroke “X” with a dial indicator.
Determine clearance “X”.

Only for 2WS input shaft


The piston stroke (19) and (38) must be such to
ensure a play corresponding to
X = 1.60 ÷ 2.45 mm (0.06 ÷ 0.10 in)
If the distance is not within specification, the clutch
is probably wrongly installed.
Turn the clutch shaft upside down and repeat the
operation for the other clutch disc kit.

Only for 4WS input shaft


The piston stroke (19) and (38) must be such to
ensure a play corresponding to
X = 1.60 ÷ 2.45 mm (0.06 ÷ 0.10 in)
Y = 1.90 ÷ 2.75 mm (0.07 ÷ 0.11 in)
If the distance is not within specification, the clutch
is probably wrongly installed.
Turn the clutch shaft upside down and repeat the
operation for the other clutch disc kit.
238 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Shaft (D)
Assemble the bearing (16) on shaft (D) by means of
tool 380200230.

Assemble the bearing (37) on shaft (D) by means of


tool 380200230.

Lubricate the shaft seat (A).

Assemble shaft (D) and shaft (A).


The operation is correct only if the 2 shafts are fitted
at the same time.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 239

B SHAFT

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the screws (28) and remove
the 4WD oil bulkhead (29).
240 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble on the rear end of the shaft (C) the hub


(27) and tool 380200256.

Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) simultaneously by


means of tool 380200239.

Do not remove the oil bulkhead (P) and the screw


(V).

Remove the seal rings (1) and (2).

S WARNING S
The seal rings can be damaged.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 241

Remove the bearing (3) and the gear (4) by means


of a puller.

Remove the bearing (3) and the gear (4).

Remove the snap ring (5).

Remove the thrust washer (6).


242 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the pin (23).

Remove the gear (8).

Remove the roller retainer (7) and the thrust washer


(13).

Remove the pin (24) and the spacer (14).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 243

Push the thrust washer (10) slightly.

Remove the snap ring (9).

Remove the thrust washer (10) by means of 2


screwdrivers.

Remove the discs (11) and the counterdiscs (12).


244 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Lower the cover (16) by means of tool 380200215.

Remove the snap ring (15).

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Remove the cover (16) and the spring (17).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 245

Remove the sleeve (18).

Remove the piston (19) by blowing in compressed


air through the delivery hole.

If necessary, remove the seal ring (20) with the


inner O-ring from the outside seat of the piston and
the seal ring (21) with the relevant O-ring from the
inner seat of the piston.
To remove the rings it is necessary to cut them.

Remove the seal ring (26).


246 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the bearing (25) by means of a puller.

Check the seal ring grooves (large and small) for


wear or damage.
Check if the output shaft is worn or damaged.
Check oil passages in the output shaft to be sure
that they are open and free of foreign material.
Check the ball bearings and the needle bearings for
flat areas, pitting or other damage.
If you are to re-use the clutch discs, observe the
assembly order.

At each disassembly check with a gauge that the


total thickness of the clutch disc kit remains within
the wear limits; otherwise replace the clutch disc kit
(11) with a new one.
Verify that all clutch discs are free from burns, that
the friction surfaces are not damaged and that the
grooves of the friction surfaces are well outlined.
Moreover, verify that the counterdiscs (12) are per-
fectly flat, without scrapes or pittings.
In case any of the discs shows even just one of the
above-mentioned faults, replace the clutch disc kit
with a new one.
If you are to use a new kit of clutch discs, let it soak
into a bath of oil for at least one hour before its use.
In any case, prior to assembling the clutch disc kit,
lubricate the contact surfaces of the counterdiscs
with oil.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 247

Check that the hole of the input shaft on the rear half
box does not show damages that could cause leaks
when the clutch is assembled.
Check that the grooves of the input shaft are not
damaged by the steel discs.

2nd gear clutch

Disc number (each side) 8


Counterdisc number (each side) 8
Rated thickness of disc 2.0 ± 0.05 mm (0.08 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 30.50 ÷ 30.70 mm (1.20 ÷ 1.21 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.20 mm (0.008 in)
Pack maximum wear (each side) 3.2 mm (0.126 in)

Assembly
Assemble the bearing (25) with tool 380200190.

Assemble the seal ring (26).


In order to fit the ring (26), repeat the following
operations by means of spacer ring 380200224.
248 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the seal ring (20) with the relevant inner


O-ring and the snap ring (21) with the relevant inner
O-ring, respectively in the outer and inner seat of
the piston.

Apply a thin film of oil on the seal rings recently fit-


ted.

Insert the piston (19) by means of tool 380001926


to protect the seal rings (21).

Assemble the sleeve (18).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 249

Assemble the spring (17) and the cover (16).

Lower the cover (16) by means of tool 380200215.

Assemble the snap ring (15).

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.
250 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the disc kit.

Assemble the spacer (14) and the pin (24).

Insert the thrust washer (13) and the roller retainer


(7).

Assemble the thrust washer (10) and push it to end


stroke on disc kit.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 251

Assemble the snap ring (9).

Supply compressed air at low pressure to the deliv-


ery hole to push the thrust washer (10) against the
snap ring (9) and align the disc teeth.

Assemble the gear (8) by paying attention not to let


it slide to stroke end.

Assemble the pin (23).


252 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the thrust washer (6) and the snap ring


(5).

Assemble the gear (4) paying attention to direct the


protruding end of the groove towards the clutch and
the bearing (3).
Use tool 380200203.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 253

1. Lubrication oil passage


2. Oil passage for 2nd gear clutch
3. 2nd gear engagement
4. 2nd gear clutch disc kit
5. Input shaft

Try to turn the 2nd travel gear. It must turn on the


input shaft.
Apply compressed air at approximately 6 bar (87 psi)
to the 2nd gear clutch passage.
Listen for the 2nd gear piston to move and to lock
the related clutch disc kit.
Try to shift the 2nd travel gear. It must not turn on
the input shaft.
If the clutch does not work correctly, disassemble it
to find the problem.
Carry out the check procedure of the clutch disc kit
backlash on both sides of the FWD-REV-clutch.
Position the shaft on a suitable support and apply
load F on the counterdisc (10) surface by means of
a proper buffer.
This operation clears any possible play.
254 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

To check the backlash, supply the piston chamber


(19) with compressed air at 6 bar (87 psi) and verify
the actual stroke “X” with a dial indicator.
Determine clearance “X”.

Only for 2WS input shaft


The piston stroke (19) must be such to ensure a
play corresponding to:
X = 2.20 ÷ 3.05 mm (0.09 ÷ 0.12 in)
If the distance is not within specification, the clutch
is probably wrongly installed.

Insert the seal rings (1) and (2).


In order to insert the seal rings, repeat the following
operations by means of:
- spacer 380200240 for 1st and 2nd ring;
- pusher 380200242 and compressor 380200241.

Assemble the bulkhead (29) and tighten the screws


(28).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 255

C SHAFT

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the screws (V1) to detach the
4WD oil bulkhead (P1).
256 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble on the rear end of the shaft (C) the hub


(61) and tool 380200256.

Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) simultaneously by


means of tool 380200239.

Do not remove the oil bulkhead (P2) and the screw


(V2).

Remove tool 380200256 and sleeve (62).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 257

Remove the bearing (58) by means of a puller.

Remove the spacer (57).

Remove the gear (54).

Overturn the assembly.


Push the thrust washer (39) downwards.
258 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the snap ring (38).

Remove the thrust washer (39) by means of 2


screwdrivers.

Remove the disc kit (40).

Lower the cover (42) so as to allow the extraction of


the snap ring (41) by means of tool 380200215.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 259

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Remove the snap ring (41), the cover (42) and the
spring (43).

Remove the piston (44) by blowing in compressed


air through the delivery hole.

If necessary, remove the seal ring (45) with the rele-


vant O-ring from the outer seat of piston (44).
260 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

If necessary, remove the seal ring (53) with the rele-


vant O-ring from the gear seat (54).

Remove the gear (37) by means of a puller.

Remove the 2 bushings (47) and (56), the 2 roller


retainers (46) and (55) and the spacer (50).
Verify the condition of the removed components
(46), (47), (50), (55) and (56).

Remove the O-rings (48) and (52) from the bushing


(50).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 261

Verify the wear condition of the seal rings (49) and


(51).
If necessary, cut the seal rings (49) and (51) to
remove them from bushing (50).

Remove the gear (35).

Remove the roller retainer (36).

Remove the thrust washer (31).


Remove the feather (32).
262 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Lower the counterdisc (33) slightly to release the


snap ring (34).

Remove the snap ring (34).

Remove the thrust washer (33) by means of 2


screwdrivers.

Remove the disc kit (32).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 263

Remove the pin (22).

Lower the cover (29) by means of tool 380200215.

Remove the snap ring (30).

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.
264 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the snap ring (30), the cover (29) and the
spring (28).

Pull out the piston (26) from its seat by blowing in


compressed air through the delivery hole.

Remove the bushing (27) and the piston (26).

If necessary, remove the seal ring (25) with the


inner O-ring from the outside seat of the piston and
the seal ring (24) with the relevant O-ring from the
inner seat of the piston.
To remove the rings it is necessary to cut them.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 265

Overturn the shaft (23).


Remove the seal rings (16), (17), (18) and (19) by
cutting them.

Remove the bearing (1) by means of a puller.

Remove the thrust washer (2).

Remove the gear (3).


266 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the roller retainer (7) and the thrust washer


(8).

Remove the pin (21).

Remove the roller retainer (7) and the thrust washer


(8).
Remove the feather (22).

Slightly lower the thrust washer (5) to release the


snap ring (4).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 267

Remove the snap ring (4).

Remove the thrust washer (5) by means of 2 screw-


drivers.

Remove the disc kit (6).

Lower the cover (10) by means of tool 380200215.


268 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the snap ring (9).

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Remove the snap ring (9), the cover (10) and the
spring (11).

Pull out the piston (13) from its seat by blowing in


compressed air through the delivery hole.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 269

Remove the bushing (12) and the piston (13).

If necessary, remove the seal ring (15) with the


inner O-ring from the outside seat of the piston and
the seal ring (14) with the relevant O-ring from the
inner seat of the piston.
To remove the rings it is necessary to cut them.

Check the seal ring grooves (large and small) for


wear or damage.
Check if the output shaft is worn or damaged.
Check oil passages in the output shaft to be sure
that they are open and free of foreign material.
Check the ball bearings and the needle bearings for
flat areas, pitting or other damage.
270 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

If you are to re-use the clutch discs, observe the


assembly order.

At each disassembly check with a gauge that the


total thickness of the clutch discs remains in the
wear limits; otherwise replace the clutch disc kit (B)
with a new one.
Verify that all clutch discs are free from burns, that
the friction surfaces are not damaged and that the
grooves of the friction surfaces are well outlined.
Moreover, verify that the counterdiscs (A) are per-
fectly flat, without scrapes or pittings.
In case any of the discs shows even just one of the
above-mentioned faults, replace the clutch disc kit
with a new one.
If you are to use a new kit of clutch discs, let it soak
into a bath of oil for at least one hour before its use.
In any case, prior to assembling the clutch disc kit,
lubricate the contact surfaces of the counterdiscs
with oil.
Check that the hole of the input shaft on the rear half
box does not show damages that could cause leaks
when the clutch is assembled.
Check that the grooves of the input shaft are not
damaged by the steel discs.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 271

1st gear clutch

Disc number (each side) 6


Counterdisc number (each side) 6
Rated thickness of disc 2.20 ± 0.05 mm (0.09 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 27.50 ÷ 27.70 mm (1.08 ÷ 1.09 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.15 mm (0.006 in)
Pack maximum wear (each side) 1.8 mm (0.071 in)

3rd gear clutch

Disc number (each side) 8


Counterdisc number (each side) 8
Rated thickness of disc 2.00 ± 0.05 mm (0.08 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 30.50 ÷ 30.70 mm (1.20 ÷ 1.21 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.20 mm (0.008 in)
Pack maximum wear (each side) 3.2 mm (0.126 in)

4th gear clutch

Disc number (each side) 4


Counterdisc number (each side) 4
Rated thickness of disc 2.00 ± 0.05 mm (0.08 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 15.90 ÷ 16.10 mm (0.62 ÷ 0.63 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.20 mm (0.008 in)
Pack maximum wear (each side) 1.6 mm (0.063 in)
272 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Assemble the seal ring (53) and the relevant O-ring
on gear (54) by means of tool 380200248.
Assemble the O-ring (52).

Adjust the seal ring (53) by means of tool


380200250.

Assemble the seal ring (45) and the relevant O-ring


on piston (44).

Apply a thin film of grease on the outer edge and in


the inner part of the piston (44) and fit it to the gear
(54).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 273

Insert the spring (43), the cover (42) and the snap
ring (41).

Lower the cover (42) by means of tool 380200215.

Insert the snap ring (41).


Make sure that the snap ring (41) is correctly fitted
into its seat.

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.
274 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the kit (40) and the thrust washer (39) into the
gear (54).

Assemble the snap ring (38) making sure it is cor-


rectly seated.

Assemble the seal ring (25) with the relevant O-ring


and the snap ring (24) with the relevant O-ring,
respectively in the outer and inner seat of the piston
(26).

Apply a thin film of oil on the seal rings recently fit-


ted.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 275

Insert the piston (26) by means of tool 380001926


to protect the seal rings.

Assemble the sleeve (27).

Assemble the spring (28) and the cover (29).

Lower the cover (29) by means of tool 380200215.


276 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the snap ring (30).


Make sure that the snap ring (30) is correctly fitted
into its seat.

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Remove the 380200215 tool and fit the pin (21).

Insert the thrust washer (31) on the shaft (23).


Apply a thin film of grease under the thrust washer
(31) to prevent its falling when overturning the shaft.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 277

Assemble the thrust washer (31) by inserting it on


pin (22).

Assemble the feather (22) and the thrust washer


(31).
Apply a thin film of grease under the thrust washer
(31) to prevent its falling when overturning the shaft.

Insert the disc and counterdisc kit (32) onto the


main shaft (23).

Assemble the roller retainer (36) and the thrust


washer (33).
278 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the snap ring (34).

Supply compressed air at low pressure into hole (a)


to push the thrust washer (33) against the snap ring
(34).

Assemble the gear (35) by paying attention not to


let it slide to stroke end.

Insert the gear (37) on the shaft (23).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 279

Insert the gear (54) on the shaft (23).

Assemble the bushing (47) and the bearing (46)


with tool 380200190.

Assemble the O-rings (48) and (52) on the bushing


(50).
280 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble new seal rings (49) and (51) on bushing


(50) by means of tools 380200251, 380200252 and
380200253.

Assemble the bushing (50) and the shaft (23) with


tool 380200190.
The reference marks must be directed upwards.

Assemble the bushing (56) and the bearing (55)


with tool 380200190.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 281

Assemble the spacer (57).

Assemble the bearing (58) with tool 380200190.

Assemble the hub (61) and tool 380200256.

Turn the shaft.


Assemble the O-ring with relevant ring (14) in the
outer seat of piston (13).
Assemble the O-ring with relevant ring (15) in the
inner seat of piston (13).
282 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Apply a thin film of oil on the seal rings recently fit-


ted.

Insert the piston (13) by means of tool 380001926


to protect the seal rings.

Assemble the sleeve (12).

Assemble the spring (11) and the cover (10).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 283

Lower the cover (10) by means of tool 380200215.

Insert the snap ring (9).


Make sure that the snap ring (9) is correctly fitted
into its seat.

Loosen the knobs of the threaded bars to clear the


spring tension.
Remove the upper part of tool 380200215.

Assemble the pin (21).


284 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the disc kit (6) on the shaft (23).

Assemble the thrust washer (5).

Assemble the snap ring (4).

Supply compressed air at low pressure into the sup-


ply hole to push the thrust washer (5) against the
snap ring (4).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 285

Assemble the thrust washer (8) and the roller


retainer (7).

Assemble the feather (22), the thrust washer (8)


and the roller retainer (7).

Assemble the gear (3).

Assemble the thrust washer (2).


286 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the bearing (1) with tool 380200190.

Assemble the seal rings (16), (17), (18) and (19) by


means of tool 380200224.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 287

1. 1st gear clutch oil passage


2. 3rd gear clutch oil passage
3. 4th gear clutch oil passage
4. 3rd gear engagement
5. 3rd gear disc kit
6. 4th gear disc kit
7. 4th gear engagement
8. 1st gear engagement
9. 1st gear disc kit
10. Main shaft
11. Lubrication oil passage

Check that all gears turn freely on main shaft. Listen for the 3rd gear piston to move and to lock
the related clutch disc kit.
Apply compressed air at approximately 6 bar (87 psi)
to the 1st gear clutch passage. Try to shift the 3rd travel gear.
Listen for the 1st gear piston to move and to lock It must not turn on the main shaft.
the related clutch disc kit. If the clutch does not work correctly, disassemble it
Try to shift the 1st travel gear. to find the problem.
It must not turn on the main shaft. Apply compressed air at approximately 6 bar (87 psi)
to the 4th gear clutch passage.
If the clutch does not work correctly, disassemble it
to find the problem. Listen for the 4th gear piston to move and to lock
the related clutch disc kit. Try to shift the 4th travel
Apply compressed air at approximately 6 bar (87 psi)
gear.
to the 3rd gear clutch passage.
It must not turn on the main shaft.
If the clutch does not work correctly, disassemble it
to find the problem.
288 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Carry out the check procedure of the clutch disc kit


play.
Position the shaft on a suitable support and apply
load F on the surface of the clutch counterdisc by
means of a proper buffer (T).
This operation clears any possible play.

To check the backlash, supply the piston chamber


(26) with compressed air at 6 bar (87 psi) and verify
the actual stroke “X” with a dial indicator.
Determine clearance “X”.

The piston stroke (26) must be such to ensure a


play corresponding to:
X = 0.5 ÷ 1.95 mm (0.020 ÷ 0.077 in)
If the distance is not within specification, the clutch
is probably wrongly installed.

The piston stroke (13) must be such to ensure a


play corresponding to:
X = 2.20 ÷ 3.05 mm (0.09 ÷ 0.12 in)
If the distance is not within specification, the clutch
is probably wrongly installed.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 289

The piston stroke (44) must be such to ensure a


play corresponding to:
X = 1.725 ÷ 2.375 mm (0.068 ÷ 0.093 in)
If the distance is not within specification, the clutch
is probably wrongly installed.

Hook the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) by means of tool


380200239.
Lift the shafts (B), (C) and (E) at the same time and
insert the assy into the half box.

Assemble the bulkhead (P1) and tighten the screws


(V1).
290 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

E SHAFT
(Only for 2WS)

* = 4WD shaft set

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the screws to detach the 4WD
oil bulkhead.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 291

Assemble on the rear end of the shaft (C) the hub


and tool 380200256.

Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) simultaneously by


means of tool 380200239.

Do not remove the oil bulkhead (P) and the screw


(V).

Remove the seal rings (22) and (23).


292 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the bearings (21) and (1) by means of a


puller.
Remove the spacer (20).

Remove the gear (18).

Remove the roller retainer (19).

Overturn the shaft.


Press the belleville washers and remove the snap
ring (2) by means of tool 380200258.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 293

Remove the shims (3) and the thrust washer (4).

Remove the belleville washers (5) and the spacer


(6).

Remove the snap ring (17).

Remove the thrust washer (16) and the disc and


counterdisc kit (15).
294 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the counterdisc (14).

Take out the piston (8).

Remove the inner (7) and outer O-ring (9) from the
piston (8).

Remove the pins (10) and the O-rings (11).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 295

If you are to re-use the clutch discs, observe the


assembly order.

At each disassembly check with a gauge that the


total thickness of the clutch discs remains in the
wear limits; otherwise replace the clutch disc kit (11)
with a new one.
Verify that all clutch discs are free from burns, that
the friction surfaces are not damaged and that the
grooves of the friction surfaces are well outlined.
Moreover, verify that the counterdiscs (12) are per-
fectly flat, without scrapes or pittings.
In case any of the discs shows even just one of the
above-mentioned faults, replace the clutch disc kit
with a new one.
If you are to use a new kit of clutch discs, let it soak
into a bath of oil for at least one hour before its use.
In any case, prior to assembling the clutch disc kit,
lubricate the contact surfaces of the counterdiscs
with oil.

Check that the hole of the input shaft on the rear half
box does not show damages that could cause leaks
when the clutch is assembled.
Check that the grooves of the input shaft are not
damaged by the steel discs.
4WD clutch

Disc number (each side) 9


Counterdisc number (each side) 9
Rated thickness of disc 2.00 ± 0.05 mm (0.08 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 33.80 ÷ 34.00 mm (1.33 ÷ 1.34 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.15 mm (0.006 in)
Pack maximum wear (each side) 2.7 mm (0.106 in)
296 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Insert the inner O-ring (7) and the outer O-ring (9)
on the piston (8).

Insert the O-rings (11) on the related pins (10).

Insert the pins (10) on the piston (8).

Apply a thin film of grease on the O-rings and posi-


tion the pins on piston (8) in order to match the
holes of the output shaft.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 297

Overturn the shaft (12) and insert the piston (8).

Insert the counterdisc (14) with the chamfer down-


wards into the shaft (12).

Assemble the disc and counterdisc kit starting with


a counterdisc (A) followed by a disc (B).

Assemble the thrust washer (16) on the shaft (12).


298 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the snap ring (17).

Assemble the gear (18).

Assemble the roller retainer (19) and the spacer


(20).

Assemble the bearing (21) with tool 380200190.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 299

Turn the shaft (12).


Make sure that the disc, counterdisc kit and the pis-
ton are correctly seated.

Pre-assemble the spacer (6), the thrust washer (4)


and the snap ring (2).

With a thickness gauge determine the value of “X”


between the thrust washer (4) and the snap ring (2).

To value “X” subtract the fixed measure “S1” of


1.80 mm (0.071 in) corresponding to the piston
stroke.
The resulting measure “S” corresponds to the height
of the shim that must be inserted between the thrust
washer (4) and the snap ring (2).
S = X - S1 = X - 1.80 mm (0.071 in)
300 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Choose the shim with value “S” from the shim range
available.
NOTE: in any case, choose the shim ensuring a
piston stroke of 1.70 ÷ 1.90 mm (0.067 ÷ 0.075 in).

SHIM RANGE
Shims mm (in) 0.1 0.3 0.5
(0.004) (0.012) (0.02)

Remove the thrust washer (4) and the snap ring (2).

Insert the belleville washers (5).


Check the proper orientation of the belleville wash-
ers (5).

Assemble the thrust washer (4) and the shims (3)


with size “S” previously calculated.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 301

Press the belleville washers and fit the snap ring (2)
by means of tool 380200275.
The springs can cause damages to persons if the
snap ring is not assembled correctly.

Assemble the bearing (1) with tool 380200203.

Assemble the seal rings (22) and (23).


Use tool 380200224.

Use tool 380200223 to check piston operation and


verify correct adjustment.
302 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

In order to check the sealing of rings (7) and (9), put


the piston chamber under pressure with oil at 10 bar
(145 psi) and verify with a dial gauge that the actual
stroke is 1.70 ÷ 1.90 mm (0.067 ÷ 0.075 in).

1. 4WD oil passage


2. 4WD gear
3. 4WD lubricant oil passage
4. Shaft
5. Belleville washers

Apply compressed oil pressure of approximately


10 bar (145 psi) to the 4WD clutch passage.
Listen for the piston to move and to unlock the
related clutch disc kit.
The belleville washers compress themselves. Try to
shift the 4WD gear.
It must turn freely on the 4WD shaft.
If the clutches do not work correctly, disassemble
them to find the problem.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 303

Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) at the same time
and insert the assy into the half box by means of
tool 380200239.

Assemble the bulkhead and tighten the screws.


304 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

E SHAFT
(Only for 2WS)

* = 4WD shaft set

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the screws to detach the 4WD
oil bulkhead.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 305

Assemble on the rear end of the shaft (C) the hub


and tool 380200256.

Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) simultaneously by


means of tool 380200239.

Do not remove the oil bulkhead (P) and the screw


(V).

Remove the seal rings (25) and (26).


306 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the bearings (1) and (24) by means of a


puller.
Remove the spacer (23).

Remove the gear (21).

Remove the roller retainer (22).

Remove the thrust washer (20).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 307

Overturn the shaft (13).


Press the belleville washers (5) and remove the
snap ring (2) by means of tool 380200258.

Remove the shims (3) and the thrust washer (4).

Remove the belleville washers (5) and the spacer


(6).

Overturn the shaft (13).


Remove the bell housing assy from the shaft.
308 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the O-ring (15).

Remove the snap ring (19).

Remove the thrust washer (18) and the disc and


counterdisc kit (15).

Remove the 4WD disc and counterdisc kit (17).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 309

Remove the counterdisc (16).

Take out the piston (8) by means of pins (10).

Remove the inner (7) and outer O-ring (9) from the
piston (8).

Remove the pins (10) and the O-rings (11).


310 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

If you are to re-use the clutch discs, observe the


assembly order.

At each disassembly check with a gauge that the


total thickness of the clutch discs remains in the
wear limits; otherwise replace the clutch disc kit (11)
with a new one.
Verify that all clutch discs are free from burns, that
the friction surfaces are not damaged and that the
grooves of the friction surfaces are well outlined.
Moreover, verify that the counterdiscs (12) are per-
fectly flat, without scrapes or pittings.
In case any of the discs shows even just one of the
above-mentioned faults, replace the clutch disc kit
with a new one.
If you are to use a new kit of clutch discs, let it soak
into a bath of oil for at least one hour before its use.
In any case, prior to assembling the clutch disc kit,
lubricate the contact surfaces of the counterdiscs
with oil.

Check that the hole of the input shaft on the rear half
box does not show damages that could cause leaks
when the clutch is assembled.
Check that the grooves of the input shaft are not
damaged by the steel discs.

4WD clutch

Disc number (each side) 9


Counterdisc number (each side) 9
Rated thickness of disc 2.00 ± 0.05 mm (0.08 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 33.80 ÷ 34.00 mm (1.33 ÷ 1.34 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.15 mm (0.006 in)
Pack maximum wear (each side) 2.7 mm (0.106 in)
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 311

Assembly
Insert the inner O-ring (7) and the outer O-ring (9)
on the piston (8).

Insert the O-rings (11) on the related pins (10).

Insert the pins (10) on the clutch piston (8).

Apply a thin film of grease on the O-rings and posi-


tion the pins on piston (8) in order to match the
holes of the output shaft (12).
312 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Overturn the bell housing (12) and insert the piston


(8).

Insert the brake counterdisc (16) with the chamfer


downwards into the bell housing (12).

Assemble the disc and counterdisc kit (17) starting


with a counterdisc (A) followed by a disc (B).

Assemble the thrust washer (18).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 313

Assemble the snap ring (17).

Assemble the O-ring (15).

Assemble the shaft (13).

Turn the shaft (13) and the bell housing (12).


Make sure that the disc and counterdisc kit and the
piston are correctly seated.
314 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Pre-assemble the spacer (6), the thrust washer (4)


and the snap ring (2).

With a thickness gauge determine the value of “X”


between the thrust washer (4) and the snap ring (2).

To value “X” subtract the fixed measure “S1” of


1.80 mm (0.071 in) corresponding to the piston
stroke.
The resulting measure “S” corresponds to the
height of the shim that must be inserted between
the thrust washer (4) and the snap ring (2).
S = X - S1 = X - 1.80 mm (0.071 in)

Choose the shim with value “S” from the shim range
available.
NOTE: in any case, choose the shim ensuring a
piston stroke of 1.70 ÷ 1.90 mm (0.067 ÷ 0.075 in).

SHIM RANGE
Shims mm (in) 0.1 0.3 0.5
(0.004) (0.012) (0.02)
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 315

Remove the thrust washer (4) and the snap ring (2).

Insert the belleville washers (5).

Check the proper orientation of the belleville wash-


ers (5).

Assemble the thrust washer (4) and the shims (3)


with size “S” previously calculated.
316 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Press the belleville washers and fit the snap ring (2)
by means of tool 380200275.
The springs can cause damages to persons if the
snap ring is not assembled correctly.

Assemble the bearing (1) with tool 380200203.

Assemble the thrust washer (20).

Assemble the gear (21).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 317

Assemble the roller retainer (22) and the spacer


(23).

Assemble the bearing (24) with tool 380200190.

Assemble the seal rings (25) and (26) by means of


tool 380200224.

Use tool 380200223 to check piston operation and


verify correct adjustment.
318 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

In order to check the sealing of the rings, put the


piston chamber under pressure with oil at 10 bar
(145 psi) and verify with a dial gauge that the actual
stroke is 1.70 ÷ 1.90 mm (0.067 ÷ 0.075 in).

1. 4WD oil passage


2. 4WD gear
3. 4WD lubricant oil passage
4. Shaft
5. Belleville washers

Apply compressed oil pressure of approximately


10 bar (145 psi) to the 4WD clutch passage.
Listen for the piston to move and to unlock the
related clutch disc kit.
The belleville washers compress themselves. Try to
shift the 4WD gear.
It must turn freely on the 4WD shaft.
If the clutches do not work correctly, disassemble
them to find the problem.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 319

Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) at the same time
and insert the assy into the half box by means of
tool 380200239.

Assemble the bulkhead and tighten the screws.


320 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

E SHAFT
(Only 4WS)

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the screws to detach the 4WD
oil bulkhead.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 321

Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) simultaneously by


means of tool 380200239.

Do not remove the oil bulkhead (P) and the screw


(V).

Remove the seal rings (24), (25) and (26).

Remove the gear (22).


322 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Remove the O-ring (21).

Remove the snap ring (19).


Remove the bearing (19) by means of a puller.

Remove the snap ring (16).


Remove the thrust washer (18) and the disc and
counterdisc kit (14).

Remove the counterdisc (13).


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 323

Overturn the shaft (17).


Press the belleville washers (5) and remove the
snap ring (2) by means of tool 380200258.

Remove the shims (3) and the thrust washer (4).

Remove the belleville washers (5) and the spacer


(6).

Remove the bell housing (12) from the shaft (17).


Remove the O-ring (18).
324 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Take out the piston (8) by means of pins (10).

Remove the inner (7) and outer O-ring (9) from the
piston (8).

Remove the pins (10) and the O-rings (11).

If you are to re-use the clutch discs, observe the


assembly order.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 325

At each disassembly check with a gauge that the


total thickness of the clutch discs remains in the
wear limits; otherwise replace the clutch disc kit with
a new one.
Verify that all clutch discs (b) are free from burns,
that the friction surfaces are not damaged and that
the grooves of the friction surfaces are well out-
lined.
Moreover, verify that the counterdiscs (a) are per-
fectly flat, without scrapes or pittings.
In case any of the discs shows even just one of the
above-mentioned faults, replace the clutch disc kit
with a new one.
If you are to use a new kit of clutch discs, let it soak
into a bath of oil for at least one hour before its use.
In any case, prior to assembling the clutch disc kit,
lubricate the contact surfaces of the counterdiscs
with oil.

Check that the hole of the input shaft on the rear half
box does not show damages that could cause leaks
when the clutch is assembled.
Check that the grooves of the input shaft are not
damaged by the steel discs.
4WD clutch

Disc number (each side) 9


Counterdisc number (each side) 9
Rated thickness of disc 2.00 ± 0.05 mm (0.08 ± 0.002 in)
Disc kit nominal thickness [with 163 kg (359.34 lbs) of load] 33.80 ÷ 34.00 mm (1.33 ÷ 1.34 in)
Disc maximum wear (each side) 0.15 mm (0.006 in)
Pack maximum wear (each side) 2.7 mm (0.106 in)
326 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assembly
Insert the inner O-ring (7) and the outer O-ring (9)
on the piston (8).

Insert the O-rings (11) on the related pins (10).

Insert the pins (10) on the piston (8).

Apply a thin film of grease on the O-rings and posi-


tion the pins on piston (8) in order to match the
holes of the output shaft (12).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 327

Overturn the bell housing (12) and insert the piston


(8).

Insert the brake counterdisc (13) with the chamfer


downwards into the clutch bell housing (12).

Assemble the disc and counterdisc kit (14) starting


with a counterdisc (A) followed by a disc (B).

Assemble the thrust washer (15).


328 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Assemble the O-ring (18) on the shaft (17).


Turn the shaft (17) on the bell housing (12).

Turn the shaft (13) and the bell housing (12).


Make sure that the disc, counterdisc kit and the pis-
ton are correctly seated.

Pre-assemble the spacer (6), the thrust washer (4)


and the snap ring (2).

With a thickness gauge determine the value of “X”


between the thrust washer (4) and the snap ring (2).
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 329

To value “X” subtract the fixed measure “S1” of


1.80 mm (0.071 in) corresponding to the piston
stroke.
The resulting measure “S” corresponds to the height
of the shim that must be inserted between the thrust
washer (4) and the snap ring (2).
S = X - S1 = X - 1.80 mm (0.071 in)

Choose the shim with value “S” from the shim range
available.
NOTE: in any case, choose the shim ensuring a
piston stroke of 1.70 ÷ 1.90 mm (0.067 ÷ 0.075 in).

SHIM RANGE
Shims mm (in) 0.1 0.3 0.5
(0.004) (0.012) (0.02)

Remove the thrust washer (4) and the snap ring (2).
330 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Insert the belleville washers (5).

Check the proper orientation of the belleville wash-


ers (5).

Assemble the thrust washer (4) and the shims (3)


with size “S” previously calculated.

Press the belleville washers and fit the snap ring (2)
by means of tool 380200275.
The springs can cause damages to persons if the
snap ring is not assembled correctly.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 331

Turn the shaft (17) and the bell housing (12).


Assemble the bearing (19) with tool 380200229.
Assemble the snap ring (20).

Assemble the O-ring (21).

Assemble the gear (22).

Assemble the bearing (24) with tool 380200220.


332 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Fitting diagram of bearing (23).

Assemble the seal rings (24), (25) and (26).

Use tools 380200264, 380001927 and 380001928.

Fitting diagram of tool (T) 380200264.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 333

Use tool 380200265 to check piston operation and


verify correct adjustment.

In order to check the sealing of rings (7) and (9), put


the piston chamber under pressure with oil at 10 bar
(145 psi) and verify with a dial gauge that the actual
stroke is 1.70 ÷ 1.90 mm (0.067 ÷ 0.075 in).

1. 4WD oil passage


2. 4WD gear
3. Bearing lubrication
4. Shaft
5. Belleville washers
6. Bearing
334 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

Apply compressed oil pressure of approximately


10 bar (145 psi) to the 4WD clutch passage.
Listen for the piston to move and to unlock the
related clutch disc kit.
The belleville washers compress themselves. Try to
shift the 4WD gear.
It must turn freely on the 4WD shaft.
If the clutches do not work correctly, disassemble
them to find the problem.
Lift the 3 shafts (B), (C) and (E) at the same time
and insert the assy into the half box by means of
tool 380200239.

Assemble the bulkhead and tighten the screws.


SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 335

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

The vehicle does not Control valve supply problem. Check and, if necessary, replace the
move. control valves.

Damaged connections of transmission Repair and, if necessary, replace the


and vehicle wiring harness. wiring harness.

Oxidation in the contacts of the Clean the contacts.


electric cables of the wiring harness.

Interruption of the electric cable. Replace the electric cable.

Damage to the solenoids/solenoid Replace the solenoids.


valves.

Damage to sensors. Replace sensors.

Short circuits or bad contact. Check and, if necessary, replace the


fuses.

EGM/ECU gearshift electronic control Replace the electronic control of the


operation fault. EGM/ECU gearshift.

Incorrect oil level. Restore the oil level.

Check for possible oil leaks. Eliminate the leaks and restore the oil
level.

Suction strainer restriction. Clean the suction strainer.

Damaged oil pump. Replace the oil pump.

Damaged oil pump pressure relief Replace the oil pump.


valve.

Damaged/restricted filter. Replace the filter.

Damaged / stuck control valve. Replace the control valve.

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Oil temperature below 0 °C (32 °F). Wait for the operating temperature to
be reached (stall test).

Damaged rotary seal rings. Replace the rotary seal rings.

Stuck shuttle lever. Repair the shuttle lever.

Excessively worn-out clutch assembly. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


clutch discs.

Lack of motion transmission (broken Check, repair and, if necessary,


gears, shafts, bearings, etc.). replace.
336 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

The brake does not release. Check the general pressure of


transmission.
Check voltage.
Check the operation of the solenoid
valve.
Check the mounting of the brake
solenoid valve block after operating on
the brake.
After the above-described
verifications, disassemble the brake
cover and check the condition of the
parts for unlocking/locking the brake
(seal rings, belleville washers, brake
disc deformation, etc.).

The vehicle has a reduced Incorrect oil temperature. Wait for the operating temperature to
power transmission. be reached (stall test).

Transmission oil overheating. Restore acceptable temperature


values.

Incorrect operating pressures. Check the hydraulic circuit and


replace (oil pump, filters, control
valve).

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Incorrect oil level. Restore the oil level.

Worn-out clutch assembly. Replace/repair.

4WD fails to engage. Repair/replace the 4WD shaft assy.

Overheated solenoids/solenoid Replace.


valves.

Damaged connections of transmission Repair and, if necessary, replace the


and vehicle wiring harness. wiring harness.

Software of EGM/ECU gearshift Replace EGM/ECU.


electronic control faulty.

Damage to sensors. Replace sensors.

Overheating. Damaged cooling system. Repair the cooling system.

Dirty heat exchanger. Clean the heat exchanger.

Unintentionally activated parking Deactivate the parking brake.


brake.

Excessive soil deposit on axle wheel Clean the axle wheel hubs.
hubs.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 337

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Seizure (broken gears, shafts, Check, repair and, if necessary,


bearings, etc.). replace.

Braking force external to transmission: Check and repair the axle.


axle operating problem.

Dragging of clutch discs. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


clutch discs.

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Damaged oil thermostat. Replace the oil thermostat.

Incorrect oil level. Restore the oil level.

Worn-out oil pump. Replace the oil pump.

Wheel rotation with lifted Dragging of clutch discs. Repair and, if necessary, replace the
vehicle. clutch discs.

Low oil temperature (high oil Wait for the operating temperature to
viscosity). be reached (stall test).

Incorrect oil gradient. Change oil and filters.

Damaged control valve. Replace the control valve.

Stuck shuttle lever. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


shuttle lever.

Noise. Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Damaged oil pump. Replace the oil pump.

Ventilation/Cavitation. Check the oil level.


Check the oil gradient.

Seizure (broken gears, shafts, Check, repair and, if necessary,


bearings, etc.). replace.

Worn-out clutch discs. Replace the clutch discs.

Irregular coupling. Damaged hydraulic control valve. Replace the control valves.

Electric system fault. Repair the electric system.

Worn-out clutch discs. Replace the clutch discs.

Damaged converter. Replace the converter.

Low oil temperature (high oil Wait for the operating temperature to
viscosity). be reached (stall test).

Overheating. See “overheating”.

EGM/ECU gearshift electronic control Replace EGM/ECU.


operation fault.

Damaged hydraulic system. Repair the hydraulic system.


338 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

The gear remains Damaged/stuck shuttle lever. Repair and, if necessary, replace the
engaged. shuttle lever.

Electric system fault. Repair the electric system.

Damaged control valve. Replace the control valve.

Damaged hydraulic system. Repair the hydraulic system.

Damaged clutch assembly. Repair and, if necessary, replace the


clutch assembly.

EGM/ECU gearshift electronic control Replace EGM/ECU.


operation fault.

Lack of 4WD power Damaged 4WD connection assy. Replace the 4WD coupling assy.
transmission.
Hydraulic system fault. Repair the hydraulic system.

Damaged control valve. Replace the control valve.

Braking sensor fault. Check and, if necessary, replace the


braking sensors.

Electric system fault. Repair the electric system.

EGM/ECU gearshift electronic control Replace EGM/ECU.


operation fault.

Gear fails to engage. Damaged clutch engagement assy. Replace the clutch engagement assy.

Damaged hydraulic system. Repair the hydraulic system.

Damaged control valve. Replace the control valve.

Damaged pressure sensors. Check and, if necessary, replace the


sensors.

Electric system fault. Repair the electric system.

EGM/ECU gearshift electronic control Replace EGM/ECU.


operation fault.
SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION 339

REPAIR TIMES
The times are referred to average values of mainte-
nance performed by skilled personnel in workshops
equipped with all necessary fixtures for a proper
execution of the required works.
The repair and/or replacement times are indicated in
minutes.
We assume that the transmission assy has already
been removed from the machine.

ASSY OPERATION TIME (minutes)


Oil filter replacement 5
Plugs and filters Oil temperature sensor replacement 5
Revolutions sensor replacement 5
Converter replacement 10
Oil pump
Oil pump replacement 20
Lines Replacement of lubrication and gearshift lines (each) 5
Control valve replacement 20
Control valve Control valve overhauling 40
Solenoid valve replacement (each) 5
PTO shaft replacement 30
Replacement of seal rings on input shaft 20
Transmission box
Half box replacement 80
Open, clean, close the half boxes 50
Replacement of shaft A / bearings 60
Overhauling of shaft A 150
A and D shafts
Replacement of seal rings on shaft A 120
Replacement of shaft D / bearings 60
Overhauling/replacement of B shaft 150
B shafts
Replacement of B shaft bearings 60
Overhauling/replacement of B shaft 180
C shafts
Replacement of C shaft bearings 60
Overhauling/replacement of shaft E 100
E shaft Replacement of E shaft bearings 60
Replacement of seal rings on shaft E 70
Solenoid valve replacement 10
Parking brake Disc kit replacement 40
Replacement of seal rings on piston 20
340 SECTION 21 - TRANSMISSION

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH DESCRIPTION USE 2WS 4WS

380002211 Handle To be used with the various pushers and buffers • •

380200190 Buffer Assembly / disassembly of several bearings • •

380200197 Buffer Assembly of shaft A bearings • •

380200203 Buffer Assembly of several bearings and of 2nd travel gear • •

380200214 Calibrator Assembly of seal ring on PTO shaft and 4WD shaft • •

380200215 Attachment Disassembly / assembly of clutch • •

380200218 Buffer Assembly of oil pump seal ring • •

380200223 Check Piston check • •

380200224 Cover and shims Several seal ring assembly • •

380200225 Plunger Several seal ring assembly • •

380001926 Protection Clutch piston assembly • •

380200226 Buffer Assembly of SAHR seal ring for parking brake • •

380200230 Buffer Assembly of D shaft bearings • •

380200240 Cover and shims Seal ring assembly • •

380001933 Cover and shims Assembly of seal ring on shaft A • •

380001927 Calibrator Assembly of seal ring on shaft A • •

380001928 Plunger Assembly of seal ring on shaft A • •

380200241 Calibrator Assembly of seal ring on shaft • •

380200239 Hook Lifting of shafts B, C, E and of gear control yokes • •

380200257 Protection Assembly of seal ring on PTO shaft • •

380200242 Plunger Seal ring assembly • •

380200248 Protection Assembly of seal ring on C shaft • •

380200250 Calibrator Assembly of seal ring on C shaft • •

380200251 Cover and shims Assembly of seal ring on C shaft • •

380200252 Plunger Assembly of seal ring on C shaft • •

380200253 Calibrator Assembly of seal ring on C shaft • •

380200256 Sleeve Shaft disassembly • •

380200275 Tool Assembly of snap ring on E shaft • •

380200258 Puller Disassembly of snap ring on E shaft • •

380200220 Drift Assembly of E shaft bearings / •

380200229 Drift Assembly of E shaft bearings / •


B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

2WD - 2WS FRONT AXLE ............................................................................................................................... 3


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 3
LUBRICATION AND GREASING ................................................................................................................ 4
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE ...................................................................................................................... 6
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................... 7
TROUBLESHOOTING................................................................................................................................. 7

4WD - 2WS FRONT AXLE ............................................................................................................................. 10


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 10
LUBRICATION AND GREASING .............................................................................................................. 11
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 13
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 14
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................... 57
SPECIAL TOOLS....................................................................................................................................... 61

4WS FRONT AXLE......................................................................................................................................... 62


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 62
LUBRICATION AND GREASING .............................................................................................................. 63
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 65
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 66
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................. 131
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 137
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 138
2 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 3

2WD - 2WS FRONT AXLE

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Manufacturer CNH
Model Steering
4 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

LUBRICATION AND GREASING

Oil capacity 0.8 litres (2.27 gal)


Oil type Ambra TRX 80W -140 NH600 / TR

1. Level and fill plug for differential oil


2. Air breather
3. Level, fill and drain plug for reduction gear oil
4. Oil drain plug
5. Greasing points
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 5

Before draining the oil from the axle body, use the
breather (2) to release any possible internal pres-
sure.

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

To drain the oil from the central body remove the


level plug (1) and the drain plug (4).

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

Drain all oil.


Clean, screw in and tighten the drain plug (4).
Fill through the hole of the plug (1).
Check the level and, if necessary, top up.
Clean, screw and tighten the plug (1).

Before draining the oil from the reduction gear,


rotate it so that the plug (3) is in the highest position
(position A) and partially unscrew the plug to
release any possible internal pressure.
Turn and bring the plug to the lowest position (posi-
tion B).
Remove the plug and drain the oil.
Now turn again and bring the hole of the plug (3) to
check and oil filling position (position C).
Carry out the filling.
Clean, screw and tighten the plug (3).
6 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Rest the loader attachment on the ground in order to
unload the weight of the machine from the 2 front
wheels, then lift the front part, thus ensuring the
safety of the subsequent operations.
Use the locking pin (if provided) to lock the loader
attachment controls.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Completely raise the stabilizers and lock them
mechanically.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key to
ON and release the pressure by moving the hydrau-
lic control levers in all directions.
Place some wedges under the wheels so as to pre-
vent the machine from moving.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Fasten the front axle (3) to a lifting hoist or to a sup-
port.
Now it is possible to carry out the disassembly of
the 2 front tyres by loosening and removing the rel-
evant fixing nuts (7) [tightening torque = 330 Nm
(243 lbf·ft)].
Disconnect the hoses of the steering cylinder, pay-
ing attention to possible oil leaks, preventing spill-
age over the ground using a container.
Remove the snap ring (6) from the machine side,
and keep the shims (4).
Using a soft hammer, tap the pin (5) in order to
extract it from the relevant hole, on the front side of
the machine.
Once the pin (5) has been disassembled, it is possi-
ble to remove the front axle (3).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 7

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


(See 4WD front axle)

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Bent axle beam body. Overloaded vehicle. Replace the axle beam body.

Damaged vehicle. Replace the axle beam body.

Worn out or pitted bearings. Insufficient lubrication. Replace the bearings and top up oil.

Contaminated oil. Change the oil, fill up to right level


and replace at recommended
intervals.

Excessive use. Replace the bearings.

Normal wear. Replace the bearings.

Oil leakage form the seals. Prolonged operation with oil at a Replace the gasket or seal and
high temperature. matching surface if damaged.

Incorrectly installed seal. Correctly lubricate and change oil


and seals at recommended
intervals.

Damaged seal lip. Replace the seal.

Contaminated oil. Change the oil, fill up to right level


and replace at recommended
intervals.

Bent or broken axle beam. Intensive use of the vehicle or Replace the axle beam.
overloaded vehicle.

Axle shaft broken on wheel Loose wheel support. Replace the axle beam and check if
side. the wheel support is worn out or
wrongly adjusted.

Bent axle beam body. Replace the axle beam and check if
the wheel support is worn out or
wrongly adjusted.

Wheel vibration and tyre Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


resistance.
Faulty differential. Inspect and repair the axle.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


8 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Difficult steering; the machine Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


travels in a straight line while
steering. Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Excessive noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Replace the parts and check that the
bearings are in good conditions.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Uneven wear of tyre. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel adjustment. Carry out the adjustment and check


that the bearings are in good
conditions.

Friction noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Damaged or worn axle parts. Replace the parts and check that the
bearings are in good conditions.

Presence of foreign objects. Discard.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 9

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Vibrations during travel. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Intermittent noise. Damaged ring gear. Replace bevel gear.

Differential box screws loose. Tighten the screws to torque.

Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


10 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

4WD - 2WS FRONT AXLE

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Manufacturer CNH
Model Steering
Steering angle According to the type
Total reduction ratio According to the type
Lubrication angle 35° maximum (front and rear) - 35° maximum (from side to side)
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 11

LUBRICATION AND GREASING

Differential 8.6 litres (2.27 gal)


Oil capacity
Final drive (each) 1 litres (0.26 gal)
Oil type Ambra TRX 80W -140 NH600 / TR

1. Level and fill plug for differential oil


2. Air breather
3. Level, fill and drain plug for reduction gear oil
4. Oil drain plug
5. Greasing points
12 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Before draining the oil from the axle body, use the
breather (2) to release any possible internal pres-
sure.

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

To drain the oil from the central body remove the


level plug (1) and the drain plug (4).

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

Drain all oil.


Clean, screw in and tighten the drain plug (4).
Fill through the hole of the plug (1).
Check the level and, if necessary, top up.
Clean, screw and tighten the plug (1).

Before draining the oil from the reduction gear,


rotate it so that the plug (3) is in the highest position
(position A) and partially unscrew the plug to
release any possible internal pressure.
Turn and bring the plug to the lowest position (posi-
tion B).
Remove the plug and drain the oil.
Now turn again and bring the hole of the plug (3) to
check and oil filling position (position C).
Carry out the filling.
Clean, screw and tighten the plug (3).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 13

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Rest the loader attachment on the ground in order to
unload the weight of the machine from the 2 front
wheels, then lift the front part, thus ensuring the
safety of the subsequent operations.
Use the locking pin (if provided) to lock the loader
attachment controls.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Completely raise the stabilizers and lock them
mechanically.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key to
ON and release the pressure by moving the hydrau-
lic control levers in all directions.
Place some wedges under the wheels so as to pre-
vent the machine from moving.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Fasten the front axle (4) to a lifting hoist or to a sup-
port.
Now it is possible to carry out the disassembly of
the 2 front tyres by loosening and removing the rel-
evant fixing nuts (5) [tightening torque = 330 Nm
(243 lbf·ft)].
Disconnect the hoses of the steering cylinder, pay-
ing attention to possible oil leaks, preventing spill-
age over the ground using a container.
Disconnect the cardan joint (1).
Loosen and remove the screws (2) with the rele-
vant washers (3) [tightening torque = 460 ÷ 540 Nm
(339 ÷ 398 lbf·ft)].
Remove the front axle (4).
14 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


NOTE: The 2WD and 4WD axles are identical, with
the following exceptions: the 2WD axle has pressed
steel plugs in the bores, while the 4WD has internal
gears and shafts.
The 2WD axle reduction gear has no planetary car-
rier.

MOUNTING SCREW TORQUE

Tie rod nut, standard 111 ÷ 137 Nm (82 ÷ 101 lbf·ft)


Tie rod nut, HD 213 ÷ 263 Nm (157 ÷ 194 lbf·ft)
Tie rod ball joint nut, standard 129 ÷ 160 Nm (95 ÷ 118 lbf·ft)
Ball joint nut, HD 162 ÷ 200 Nm (119 ÷ 147 lbf·ft)
Tie rod ball joint nut, standard 255 ÷ 315 Nm (188 ÷ 232 lbf·ft)
Breather 11 ÷ 14 Nm (8 ÷ 10 lbf·ft)
Oil drain plug 54 ÷ 66 Nm (40 ÷ 49 lbf·ft)
Lubrication fitting, king pin 20 ÷ 30 Nm (15 ÷ 22 lbf·ft)
Planet carrier retention screw 21 ÷ 26 Nm (15.5 ÷ 19 lbf·ft)
King pin screw 154 ÷ 188 Nm (114 ÷ 139 lbf·ft)
Differential cover screw 96 ÷ 118 Nm (71 ÷ 87 lbf·ft)
Steering cylinder screw 358 ÷ 442 Nm (264 ÷ 326 lbf·ft)
Steering stop nut 200 ÷ 244 Nm (148 ÷ 178 lbf·ft)
Shaft retaining nut 358 ÷ 442 Nm (264 ÷ 326 lbf·ft)
Ring gear support screw, standard 88 ÷ 108 Nm (65 ÷ 80 lbf·ft)
Ring gear support screw, HD 96 ÷ 118 Nm (71 ÷ 87 lbf·ft)
Gear pin screw 95 ÷ 105 Nm (70 ÷ 77 lbf·ft)
Oil drain plug 72 ÷ 88 Nm (53 ÷ 65 lbf·ft)
Bearing cup screw 96 ÷ 118 Nm (71 ÷ 87 lbf·ft)
Ring nut retainer screw 21 ÷ 26 Nm (15.5 ÷ 19 lbf·ft)
Ring gear screw 96 ÷ 118 Nm (71 ÷ 87 lbf·ft)
Pinion 1.7 ÷ 2.2 Nm (1.2 ÷ 1.6 lbf·ft)
Differential 1.5 ÷ 2.5 Nm (1.1 ÷ 1.8 lbf·ft)
Wheel bearing with seal, standard 8 ÷ 25 Nm (6 ÷ 18 lbf·ft)
Wheel bearing with seal, HD 12 ÷ 25 Nm (9 ÷ 18 lbf·ft)
Standard differential 0 ÷ 1 Nm (0 ÷ 0.7 lbf·ft)
Limited slip differential 1 ÷ 5 Nm (0.7 ÷ 4 lbf·ft)
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 15

WHEEL HUB

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the plug (1) and drain the oil.
16 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Loosen and remove the 2 screws (2).

Separate the planetary carrier (3) from the axle


using the two slots for prying.

Remove the planetary gear carrier assy (3).

Remove the O-ring (4).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 17

Mark the washers and grease the pins.

Remove the washers (18).

Inspect the washers (18) for dents or damage in


roller contact area.

If necessary, remove the gears.


18 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Wipe off any contamination on the drain plug.

Loosen the caulking on the nut (5).

Unscrew the ring nut (5) by means of the tool


380000468.

Remove the ring nut (5).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 19

Loosen and remove the screws (10).

Tighten the 2 screws (10) in the 2 threaded holes in


the hub.
Tighten the 2 screws evenly until the ring gear car-
rier (11) is free of the swivel housing.

Remove the ring gear (6).

Remove the wheel hub (13) complete with swivel


housing using a puller.
20 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the outer bearing (15).

Separate the wheel hub (13) from the swivel hous-


ing.

Remove the seal ring (17).

Remove the inner bearing (16).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 21

Remove the snap ring (12) which fastens the ring


gear (6) in the ring gear carrier (11).

Separate the ring gear carrier (11) and the ring gear
(6).

If necessary, remove the bushings (14).

Remove the bearing cups (15) and (16), if neces-


sary.
22 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Checks
Clean all parts in cleaning solvent.
Inspect the bearing cup and the rollers in the bear-
ings for flat areas, pitting, scoring, and other dam-
age. Also check the inner race for damage. If any of
these defects are found, new bearings and new
bearing cups must be installed.
Inspect the pins for wear and damage.
Inspect the teeth of the gears and of the ring gear
for wear, pitting, scoring or other damage.
Use new parts as required.

Assembly
If bearing cups were removed, use an acceptable
driver to press new bearing cups into the wheel
hub.

The word “OUTSIDE” on the seal ring (17) must be


facing up.
Use tool DMT100004 to insert the new seal ring into
the wheel hub.
Do not damage the seal ring.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 23

Insert the new rollers using tool DMT100002.

Apply grease to help retain the rollers.

Make sure that all required rollers have been


installed.

Install the gears (8) onto the pins, respecting the


reference marks traced during disassembly.
24 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove tool DMT100002.

Check the correct assembly of all rollers.

Install the washers (18).


Where possible, match the washers with the rele-
vant pins, respecting the reference marks traced
during disassembly.

Screw in and tighten the screws (9).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 25

Press the bushings (14) into the ring gear carrier


(11).

Assemble the ring gear carrier (11) and the ring


gear (6).

Assemble the snap ring (12).

Assemble the cup of the inner bearing into the


swivel housing.
Installation will be easier if you heat the bearing
slightly.
Do not heat the bearing more than 149 °C (300 °F).
Assemble the wheel hub (13).
26 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Install the outer bearing (15).


Installation will be easier if you heat the bearing
slightly.
Do not heat the wheel bearing more than 149 °C
(300 °F).

Align the holes in the ring gear carrier (11) with the
holes in the swivel housing and install the ring gear
carrier.

Install and tighten the screws (10) evenly to pull the


hub against the swivel housing.
Tighten the screws (10) to a tightening torque
of 358 ÷ 442 Nm (264 ÷ 326 lbf·ft).

Tighten the ring nut (5) using tool 380000468, to a tight-


ening torque of 358 ÷ 442 Nm (264 ÷ 326 lbf·ft).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 27

Assemble a new O-ring (4).

Assemble the planetary carrier (3).

Screw in and tighten the 2 screws (2) to a tightening


torque of 21 ÷ 26 Nm (15.5 ÷ 19 lbf·ft).
Screw on the plug (1) after oil filling.
28 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

SWIVEL HOUSING

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the tie rod nut (1).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 29

Use a two-jaw puller to loosen the ball joint.

Remove the ball joint (2).

Loosen and remove the screws (4).

Remove the steering cylinder (3).


30 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Fasten the swivel housing (10) to an appropriate lift-


ing tool.
Loosen the screws (6).

Remove the screws (6) and the top king pin (7).

Repeat the same operations to remove the bottom


king pin.

Remove the swivel housing (10) together with the


cardan joint (14).

Remove the belleville washer (9) from the top and


bottom of the axle body.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 31

Remove the bearing (8) from the top and bottom of


the axle body by means of a puller.

Remove the seal (15) by means of a puller.

Remove the bushing (16) by means of a puller.

Remove the bearing cup (8) from the king pin (7)
using a hammer and a chisel.
32 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assembly
Install the bushing (16) by means of tool
DMT100005.
Install the seal (15) by means of tool DMT100006.

Assemble the bearing (8).

Assemble the swivel housing (10) together with the


cardan joint (14).

Assemble the belleville washers (9).


Fasten the swivel housing (10).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 33

Assemble the top king pin (7).


Tighten the screws (6) to a tightening torque of
154 ÷ 188 Nm (114 ÷ 139 lbf·ft).

Assemble the bottom king pin (7).


Tighten the screws (6) to a tightening torque of
154 ÷ 188 Nm (114 ÷ 139 lbf·ft).

Assemble the ball joint (2) and the nut (1).

Tighten the nut (1) for 2WD to 129 ÷ 160 Nm


(95 ÷ 118 lbf·ft).
Tighten the nut (1) for 4WD to 162 ÷ 200 Nm
(119 ÷ 147 lbf·ft).
34 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

CARDAN JOINT

Disassembly
Remove the 4 snap rings (3).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 35

Use the CAS1980 V-block to support the coupling (5).


Adjust the screws in the V-block to hold the coupling
level.
Use a driver and press the bottom bearing cup
against the V-block.

Fasten the bearing cup in a vice and drive the cou-


pling off the bearing cup.

Use the V-block to support the coupling and press


the other bearing cup against the V-block.

Remove the long axle shaft (2) from the coupling (5).
36 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the coupling (5) from the bearing cup.

Press the bottom bearing cup out of the yoke.

Remove the yoke from the bearing cup. DO NOT hit


the axle shaft in the seal area.

Press the other bearing cup out of the yoke.


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 37

Remove the cross (4).

Press the bearing cup out of the yoke.

Press the bearing cup into the yoke until the top of
the bearing cup is 6 mm (0.24 in) above the top of
the yoke.

Carefully install the cross (4) in the bearing cup.


38 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Press the other bearing cup into the yoke until the
top of the bearing cup is 9 mm (0.35 in) above the
top of the yoke.

Carefully remove the cross (4) from the bearing cup


so that the cross is in both bearing cups.

Hold the cross and press the bearing cups into the
yoke.

Press a bearing cup into the yoke so that a snap


ring can be installed.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 39

Assemble the snap ring (3).

Repeat the same operations for the other bearing


cup.
Use the V-block to support the coupling and press
the bearing cup into the coupling evenly with the
outer diameter of the coupling.

Carefully install the cross (4) into the bearing cup.

Press the other bearing cup into the coupling until


the bearing cup is 6 mm (0.24 in) above the top of
the yoke.
40 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Carefully raise the cross into the top bearing cup so


that the cross is in both bearing cups.

Hold the cross and press the bearing cup into the
coupling so that a snap ring can be installed.

Assemble the snap ring (3).

Repeat the same operations for the other bearing


cup.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 41

DIFFERENTIAL

Disassembly
Loosen and remove the differential carrier screws
(1).
42 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the differential carrier (2) by means of a


suitable lifting device.

Place the differential on an approved working area.

Prevent the pinion from turning.


Measure the backlash of the ring gear.
Record the reading.

Make an identification mark on the supports and


ring nut on one side of the differential carrier.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 43

Loosen and remove the screws (29) and the wash-


ers (28).

Loosen both adjusting ring nuts (15) by means of


tool DMT100002.

Remove the screws (26) and the supports (27).

Remove the differential assy.


44 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the seal (4) and the cover (3).

Loosen and remove the nut (5) of the pinion using


tool 380000468 and tool 380100102.

Remove the washer (6).

Extract the pinion (13) using a press.


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 45

Remove the washers (8) and (10) and the spacer


(9).

Separate the pinion (13) from the inner bearing (11).

Remove the shim (12).

Use a soft punch to remove the bearing cups only if


the inspection indicates the need for new parts.
46 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the seal (30) from the cover (3).

Remove the O-ring (4) from the cover (3).

Loosen and remove the screws (14).

Remove the ring gear (17).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 47

Remove the gear (18).

Remove the retaining pin (19).

Remove the pin (20) and the gears (22).


48 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the thrust washer (24) and the gear (23).

Checks
Clean all parts in cleaning solvent.
Inspect the bearing cups and the bearings for flat
areas, pitting, scoring and other damage.
Also check the inner race for damage. If any of
these defects are found, new bearings and bearing
cups must be installed.
Inspect the teeth on the pinion and of the ring gear
for pitting, scoring and broken teeth. The ring gear
and pinion gear must be replaced as a set.
Inspect the gears, the pins and the teeth of the pin-
ion gears for pitting, scoring and other damage.
Also inspect the thrust surfaces and the bores of
each gear. Check the splines in the gears for wear.
Inspect the thrust washers for pitting, scoring and
other damage.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 49

Assembly
Assemble the thrust washer (24) and the gear (23).

Install the pin (20) and the gears (22).

Install the retaining pin (19).

NOTE: before assembly, grease all gear contact


surfaces.
50 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assemble the gear (18).

Make sure that the mounting surfaces of the ring


gear (17) are clean and install the ring gear.
Screw in and tighten the screws (14) to a tightening
torque of 96 ÷ 118 Nm (71 ÷ 87 lbf·ft).

Assemble the bearing cup(s) into the differential


carrier.
Use a feeler to ensure cups are fully seated.

Install the shim (12).


The chamfer of the shim must be towards the pin-
ion.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 51

Press the bearing (11) against the shim.


Use a feeler gauge to ensure bearing is fully
seated.

Lubricate the bearing (11).

Install a new spacer (9) and the washers (8) and


(10).

Insert the pinion (13).


Install the bearing (7).
52 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assemble the washer (6).

Install a new nut (5).


Use a yoke and the wrench 380000468 to tighten
the nut.

The pinion and bearings will still be loose.


Progressively tighten the nut until the bearings
become seated.
NOTE: If the nut is tightened too much (rotating
torque higher than specified), the pinion must be
removed and a new spacer must be installed on the
pinion.
Use tool 380100102 and a torque wrench to check
the rotating torque of the pinion.
It must be rotated while tightening the nut. Final
reading to be verified after 3 complete revolu-
tions. The rotating torque must be 1.7 ÷ 2.2 Nm
(1.2 ÷ 1.6 lbf·ft).
If the rotating torque is lower than specified, further
tighten the nut and check the rotating torque again.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 53

When the rotating torque is as specified, use a


hammer and punch and partially drive the nut (5)
into the slot in the pinion.

Assemble a new O-ring (4) on the cover (3).

Assemble a new seal (30) in the cover (3) using tool


DMT100001.
The seal will be approximately 1/16 from the inner
face of the cover.

Lubricate the O-ring and the seal.


Assemble the cover (3).
54 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Install the differential carrier assy and lubricate the


bearings.

Assemble the supports (27) with the alignment


marks.
Tighten the screws (26) to 20 Nm (15 lbf·ft) to pull
the supports against the differential carrier (do not
overtighten).
The bearings must be able to rotate.

Assemble the adjusting ring nuts (15).


Tighten both adjusting ring nuts (15), making sure
there is some backlash between the ring gear and
the pinion.

Rotate the pinion by approx. 3 or 4 turns and ensure


proper seating.
Check in 3 places, approximately 120° apart.
The value of the rolling torque must be
0.0009 ÷ 0.0015 Nm (0.0006 ÷ 0.0011 lbf·ft).
If values vary more than 0.001 Nm (0.0007 lbf·ft),
then replace bevel set.
If backlash value is too large, loosen the ring nut by
one slot on gear side and tighten the ring nut slot on
the back face of the ring gear.
If backlash value is too small, do the opposite of the
above-described operations.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 55

Make the final adjustments of the ring nuts to align


locking devices and confirm the rolling torque.
Apply the yellow compound on the bevel set in 3
places, 120° apart, on 3 teeth each.
Rotate bevel set enough to see pattern in yellow
compound.
Pattern should be per chart above.
Normal wear will flatten (elongate) the contact pat-
tern.
NOTE: this is a non-adjustable bevel set. If pattern
is significantly different from specifications, then
replace bevel set.
If the original ring gear and pinion gear are being
used, the backlash must be equal to the measure-
ment made during disassembly.
Tighten the screws (26) to the prescribed torque
of 266 Nm (196 lbf·ft).
Screw in the lock screw (29) which blocks the
ring gear and tighten to a tightening torque of
162 ÷ 200 Nm (119 ÷ 147 lbf·ft).

Apply some sealant.


56 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assemble the differential carrier (2).

Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening


torque of 162 ÷ 200 Nm (119 ÷ 147 lbf·ft).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 57

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Ring gear tooth broken on the Excessive gear load compared to Replace bevel gear set.
outer side. the one expected.

Incorrect ring gear adjustment Follow carefully the recommended


(excessive backlash). operations for the adjustment of the
bevel gear set backlash.

Loose pinion nut. Tighten the pinion nut.

Ring gear tooth side broken. Load bump. Replace bevel gear set.

Incorrect ring gear adjustment Follow carefully the recommended


(insufficient backlash). operations for the adjustment of the
bevel gear set backlash.

Loose pinion nut. Tighten the pinion nut.

Worn pinion or ring gear teeth. Insufficient lubrication. Replace bevel gear set.

Contaminated oil. Follow carefully the recommended


operations for the adjustment of the
Incorrect lubrication or depleted bevel gear set backlash.
additives.

Worn out pinion bearings that cause Use proper lubricants, fill up to the
an incorrect pinion axle backlash right levels and replace at
and wrong contact between pinion recommended intervals.
and ring gear.

Overheated ring gear and Prolonged operation at high Replace bevel gear set.
pinion teeth. temperatures.
Check if ring gear teeth are
damaged. Inappropriate lubricant. Use proper lubricants, fill up to the
right level and replace at
Low oil level. recommended intervals.
Contaminated oil.

Pinion teeth pitting. Excessive use. Replace bevel gear set.

Insufficient lubrication. Use correct lubrication, fill up to the


right level and substitute at
recommended intervals.

Bent axle beam body. Overloaded vehicle. Replace the axle beam body.

Damaged vehicle. Replace the axle beam body.

Worn out or pitted bearings. Insufficient lubrication. Replace the bearings and top up oil.

Contaminated oil. Change the oil, fill up to right level


and replace at recommended
intervals.

Excessive use. Replace the bearings.

Normal wear. Replace the bearings.


58 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Oil leakage form the seals. Prolonged operation with oil at a Replace the gasket or seal and
high temperature. matching surface if damaged.

Incorrectly installed seal. Correctly lubricate and change oil


and seals at recommended
intervals.

Damaged seal lip. Replace the seal.

Contaminated oil. Change the oil, fill up to right level


and replace at recommended
intervals.

Excessive wear of input Use until worn. Replace the flange.


flange spline.
Loose pinion nut. Check that the pinion spline is not
excessively worn out.

Pinion axle backlash. Replace bevel gear set if required.

Fatigue failure of pinion teeth. Use until worn. Replace bevel gear set.
See if the fracture line is well
defined (wave lines, straight Continuous overload.
lines).

Pinion and ring gear teeth Crash load of differential Check and/or replace other
breakage. components. differential components.

Worn out side gear spline. Excessive use. Replace differential gear group.
Replace all scratched
washers (excessive Replace the axle shaft if required.
backlash).

Worn out or scored thrust Excessive use. Use correct lubrication and fill up to
washer surface. right level.

Inappropriate lubricant. Replace at intervals recommended.

Contaminated oil. Replace all scratched washers and


those with a thickness by 0.1 mm
(0.004 in) lower than the new ones.

Worn out inner diameter of Excessive use. Replace bearing.


tapered roller bearing.
Excessive pinion axial backlash. Check pinion axial backlash.

Insufficient lubrication Use proper lubrication, fill up to right


Contaminated oil. level and replace at recommended
intervals.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 59

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Bent or broken axle beam. Intensive use of the vehicle or Replace the axle beam.
overloaded vehicle.

Axle shaft broken on wheel Loose wheel support. Replace the axle beam and check if
side. the wheel support is worn out or
wrongly adjusted.

Bent axle beam body. Replace the axle beam and check if
the wheel support is worn out or
wrongly adjusted.

Wheel vibration and tyre Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


resistance.
Faulty differential. Inspect and repair the axle.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Difficult steering; the machine Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


travels in a straight line while
steering. Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Excessive noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Replace the parts and check that the
bearings are in good conditions.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.


60 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Uneven wear of tyre. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel adjustment. Carry out the adjustment and check


that the bearings are in good
conditions.

Friction noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Damaged or worn axle parts. Replace the parts and check that the
bearings are in good conditions.

Presence of foreign objects. Discard.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Vibrations during travel. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Intermittent noise. Damaged ring gear. Replace bevel gear.

Differential box screws loose. Tighten the screws to torque.

Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Faulty differential. Replace the differential.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 61

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH DESCRIPTION USE

CAS-1980 V-block Support for cardan joint disassembly

380100103 Protection Assembly of differential carrier seal ring

DMT100001 Protection Pinion seal ring assembly

DMT100002 Tool Assembly of bearings

DMT100004 Buffer Wheel hub seal ring assembly

DMT100005 Buffer Assembly of bushing into the axle body

DMT100006 Buffer Assembly of seal ring in axle body

DMT100007 Tool Assembly of pinion bearing

380000468 Wrench Pinion nut tightening

380100102 Wrench Pinion nut tightening


62 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

4WS FRONT AXLE

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Manufacturer CARRARO
Model 26.32
Differential ratio 2.75
Planetary hub ratio 6.92
Total reduction ratio 19.04
Lubrication angle 35° maximum (front and rear) - 35° maximum (from side to side)
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 63

LUBRICATION AND GREASING

Differential 10.5 litres (2.31 gal)


Oil capacity
Final drive (each) 1.3 litres (0.29 gal)
Oil type Ambra TRX 80W -140 NH600 / TR

1. Oil level plug


2. Air breather
3. Level, fill and drain plug for reduction gear oil
4. Oil drain plug
5. Greasing points
64 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Before draining the oil from the axle body, use the
breather (2) to release any possible internal pres-
sure.

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

To drain the oil from the central body remove the


level plug (1) and the drain plug (4).

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

Drain all oil.


Clean, screw in and tighten the drain plug (4).
Fill through the hole of the plug (1).
Check the level and, if necessary, top up.
Clean, screw and tighten the plug (1).

Before draining the oil from the reduction gear,


rotate it so that the plug (3) is in the highest position
(position A) and partially unscrew the plug to
release any possible internal pressure.
Turn and bring the plug to the lowest position (posi-
tion B).
Remove the plug and drain the oil.
Now turn again and bring the hole of the plug (3) to
check and oil filling position (position C).
Carry out the filling.
Clean, screw and tighten the plug (3).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 65

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Rest the loader attachment on the ground in order to
unload the weight of the machine from the 2 front
wheels, then lift the front part, thus ensuring the
safety of the subsequent operations.
Use the locking pin (if provided) to lock the loader
attachment controls.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Completely raise the stabilizers and lock them
mechanically.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key to
ON and release the pressure by moving the hydrau-
lic control levers in all directions.
Place some wedges under the wheels so as to pre-
vent the machine from moving.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Fasten the front axle (6) to a lifting hoist or to a sup-
port.
Now it is possible to carry out the disassembly of the 2
front tyres by loosening and removing the relevant fix-
ing nuts (7) [tightening torque = 700 Nm (516 lbf·ft)].
Disconnect the hoses of the steering cylinder, pay-
ing attention to possible oil leaks, preventing spill-
age over the ground using a container.
Disconnect the cardan joint (1) by unlocking and
removing the screws (2) and the bracket (3).
Loosen and remove the screws (5) with the relevant
washers (4).
Remove the front axle (6).
66 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Some of the following pictures could not exactly show your axle, but the procedure is correct.

TIGHTENING TORQUES AND APPLICATION OF SEALANTS / ADHESIVES


A. Loctite 510
B. Loctite 270
C. Loctite 638
D. Loctite 542
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 67
68 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

GREASING POINTS
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 69

STEERING CYLINDER

Loosen and remove the clamps (7) and (8).


Remove the sensor (9) and the bracket (10).
70 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Loosen the nut (1) until it is protruding over the


threaded pin end of the tie rod (3).
Hit the nut (1) with an appropriate hammer in order
to separate the tie rod (3) from the swivel housing
(2).

S WARNING S
Do not hit the end of the threaded pin of the tie rod
(3).

NOTE: this is a destructive operation for the nut (1).


Repeat the whole sequence at the other side.

Remove the tie rods (3) and (14) by loosening the


lock nuts (4) and (13), then check their conditions.
Loosen the fastening nuts (6) and remove the
cylinder (11) using a rubber hammer, if necessary.
Remove the ball joints (5) and (12).
Remove only parts that need to be overhauled or
replaced.

Remove the heads (19) and (23) and extract the rod
(21) from the cylinder body (23).
Recover all seals (17, 18, 20, 22, 24 and 25) both
from the rod (21) and from the heads (19) and (23).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 71

Assembly
Assemble new seals (17, 18, 20, 22, 24 and 25)
onto the rod (21) and onto the cylinder heads (19)
and (23).
Insert the rod (21) into the cylinder body (23) and
assemble the heads (19) and (23).

Assemble the ball joints (5) and (12) to the ends of


the rod (21) of the cylinder (11) and tighten them to
a torque of 300 Nm (221.2 lbf·ft).

Before matching worked surfaces, make sure they


are perfectly clean, if not, clean with proper
detergents.
Apply a film of sealant onto the contact surface
between the beam and the steering cylinder
supports (11).
Assemble and tighten the fastening screws (6) to a
tightening torque of 460 Nm (339.27 lbf·ft).

Align the swivel housing (15) with the axle.


Screw the tie rod (14) so that its ball joint can be
inserted into the swivel housing (15).
NOTE: it is important to unscrew the locknut (13) to
carry out this operation.
Repeat the whole sequence of the mentioned
operations to the other side.
72 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Insert the ball joint of the tie rod (14) into its housing
in the swivel housing (15).
Assemble and tighten the lock nut (16) to a
tightening torque of 280 Nm (206.51 lbf·ft).
Repeat the whole sequence of the mentioned
operations to the other side.

Screw the lock nuts (4) and (13) of the tie rods (3)
and (14) only when the toe-in adjustment has been
carried out.

Assemble the sensor (9) and fasten it in the middle


of the cylinder by means of clamps (7) and (8).
Tighten the clamps (7) and (8) only after the toe-in
adjustment and the sensor adjustment have been
carried out.

Insert the bracket (10) under the clamp (8).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 73

Sensor adjustment
Connect, by means of the relevant connector (C),
the sensor (9) to a control device that can detect the
presence of voltage generated by the sensor. The
tool is usually provided with a led that turns on only
when voltage is present.

Respect the steering sensor electric specifications


and the connection diagram.
It is also possible to use a common tester or to
connect the steering sensor to the vehicle control
panel.
The picture shows the connector (C) diagram.

Align the wheels to rectilinear driving direction.


Move the sensor (9) and the relevant clamps to a
side of the cylinder, as shown in the figure.
Fasten the clamps (7) and (8) so that the sensor
can slide on the cylinder surface.

Horizontally slide the sensor until the led turns on


(position “A”) and measure the XA dimension,
between the differential support and the rear part of
the sensor.
74 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Horizontally slowly slide the sensor on the cylinder


until the led turns off (position “B”) and measure the
XB dimension, between the differential support and
the rear part of the sensor.

Move the sensor backwards by a distance of (XB-


XA)/2 (maximum tolerance ± 1.0 mm (0.039 in)).

Before tightening the clamps, check the right


position of the sensor (9) in the appropriate seat
fastened to the steering cylinder.

Place the fastening screws (S) of the two clamps (7)


and (8) in the shown position.
Tighten the fastening screws (S) to lock the sensor
(9).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 75

REDUCTION GEAR

Disassembly
Unscrew and remove the plug (2) and completely
drain the oil from the reduction gear.
76 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Loosen and remove the two fastening screws (1) of


the planetary carrier cover (3).

Remove the planetary carrier cover (3) from the


wheel hub. Remove the O-ring (11).
Position the planetary carrier cover (3) onto a
workbench and check its wear conditions.

If necessary, replace the gears as follows:


Z unscrew the screws (10) on every pin (P);
Z remove the washers (8) and (9);
Z extract the gears (6);
Z collect the bearings (5) and check their conditions;
Z collect the washer (4).
NOTE: with the new gears it is advisable to
assemble new needles.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 77

Assembly
Position the planetary carrier cover (3) onto a
workbench.
Insert the washers (4) and the gears (6) complete
with needles (5) in the pins of the planetary gear
carrier.
Assemble the washers (8) and fasten them with the
pins (7).
Assemble the washers (9) and screw on the screws
(10) and tighten them to a torque of 73 Nm
(53.84 lbf·ft).
NOTE: with the new gears it is advisable to
assemble new needles.
Insert a new O-ring (11).

Assemble the epicyclic reduction gear assy onto the


wheel hub.
Screw in the fastening screws (1) and tighten them
to the prescribed torque of 25 Nm (18.43 lbf·ft).

Fill in oil into the reduction gear.


Screw in the plug (2) and tighten it to the prescribed
torque of 60 Nm (44.25 lbf·ft).
78 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

WHEEL HUB

Disassembly
Insert a lever between the swivel housing (14) and
the axle beam.
With the lever, push the cardan shaft in the direction
of the wheel hub to allow the removal of the snap
ring.

S WARNING S
Do not damage the cardan shaft.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 79

Remove the snap ring (1) from the cardan shaft.


Collect the washer (2) and the thrust washer (3) from
the cardan shaft.

Unscrew and remove the fastening screws (5) from


the ring gear carrier (7).

In order to extract the ring gear carrier from its


housing, screw in two of the just removed screws (5)
in the threaded extraction holes.
Extract and remove the ring gear carrier (7)
together with the ring gear (4).

Remove the retaining ring (8) and separate the ring


gear carrier (7) from the ring gear (4).
Only if necessary, remove the bushes (6) from the
wheel carrier using a hammer and the special tool
380002667.
80 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the wheel hub (11) using levers and a


hammer to facilitate the operation.
NOTE: collect the bearing cone (9).

Position the wheel hub (11) on a flat surface and


remove the seal ring (13) with a lever.
NOTE: destructive operation for the seal ring (13).
Remove the bearings (9) and (12) using a hammer
and a suitable drift.
Remove the bearing cone (12) from the swivel
housing end using a suitable extractor.

Unscrew and remove the fastening screws (19) and


(17) from the upper (18) and lower (16) king pin.

S WARNING S
Before removing the king pins (16) and (18), secure
the swivel housing (14) to a rope or a hoist or to any
other supporting device; observe all current safety
regulations to guarantee the operator’s safety.

Remove the king pins (16) and (18).

Extract the swivel housing (14) from the axle shaft


and the cardan shaft.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 81

Collect the belleville washers (25) and (27).

Position the swivel housing (14) on a flat surface and


extract the seal ring (23) with a lever.
NOTE: this is a destructive operation for the seal
ring.
Turn the swivel housing and extract the bush (22)
using a suitable drift and a hammer.

Extract the cardan shafts (24) from the axle body


(26).

If previously removed, reassemble the ball joint (18)


onto the lower king pin (19).
Carefully grease the king pin housings with specific
grease.
Position the belleville washers (25) and (27) onto
the king pin housings.
82 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assembly
Insert the cardan shafts (24) into the axle body (26).

If it has been previously removed, reassemble the


mechanical steering lock consisting in the screw
(28), the nut (29) and the bushing (30).
NOTE: do not tighten the nut (29) until the steering
angle adjustment has been done.

Insert the bush (22) into the swivel housing (14) with
the special tool 380002668 and a hammer or a
press.
Insert the seal ring (23) into the swivel housing (14)
with the special tool 380002669 and a hammer.
Grease carefully the seal ring (23).

Secure the swivel housing (14) with a belt or a rope


to a hoist or to any other supporting device.
Protect the splined end of the axle shaft by winding
it with an adhesive tape to avoid damage to the seal
ring.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 83

Assemble the lower (19) and the upper (15) king


pins. Tighten the fastening screws (16) and (10) to a
tightening torque of 300 Nm (221.26 lbf·ft).

The special configuration of the bearings (9) and


(12) does not require specific preloading or
backlash adjustment. Anyway, before assembling
new components, check the indicated dimensions.
A = 17.950 ÷ 18.000 mm (0.706 ÷ 0.708 lbf·ft)
B = 64.275 ÷ 64.325 mm (2.530 ÷ 2.532 lbf·ft)
C = 23.072 ÷ 23.173 mm (0.908 ÷ 0.912 lbf·ft)

Insert both bearing cups (9) and (12) into their


wheel hub (11) housings using the special tool
380002222 under a press or with a hammer.
Insert the seal ring (13) into the wheel hub (11) with
the special tool 380002213 and a hammer.
NOTE: do not lubricate the seal ring (13).

Assemble the bearing (12) onto the swivel housing


end (14).
Assemble the wheel hub (11) on the swivel housing
(14) and fit the bearing (9).
84 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Position the ring gear carrier (7) onto a workbench


and force the bushes (6) to the carrier surface level
with the special tool 380002667.
At least two bushings (diametrically-opposed)
should be set slightly higher than the carrier surface
level to be used as dowel pins.

Preassemble the ring gear carrier (7) and the ring


gear (4) with the retaining ring (8).

Assemble the ring gear carrier assy on the wheel


hub using the two projecting bushes as dowel pins
and screw in the relevant screws in order to put the
ring gear in contact with the wheel hub.

Completely insert all bushes (6) using the special


tool 380002667 and a hammer.
Apply sealant on the fixing screw (5) thread.
Assemble the ring gear carrier (7) and fasten it with
the fastening screws (5).
Tighten the screws (5) to a tightening torque of
220 Nm (162.26 lbf·ft).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 85

Insert a lever between the swivel housing (14) and


the axle shaft and fit into the cardan shaft.
With the lever, push the double joint in the direction
of the wheel hub to allow an easier fitting of the
snap ring.

Assemble the washer (2) and the thrust washer (3)


onto the end of the cardan shaft.
Insert the snap ring (1) on the end of the splined
hub and push it into its seat.
NOTE: check that the snap ring (1) is correctly fitted
in its seat.
86 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

FLANGE

Disassembly
Remove the snap ring (1) and extract the flange (2).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 87

Remove the seal ring (3).


NOTE: destructive operation for the seal ring (3).

Remove the O-ring (4) and the washer (5).


88 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assembly
Insert the washer (5).
Lubricate and assemble a new O-ring (4).

Insert the seal ring (3).

Install the flange (2) and the snap ring (1).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 89

FRONT AND REAR SUPPORT

Disassembly
Loosen and remove the greaser (1).
Extract the rear support (2) from the differential
support (8).
90 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the O-ring (4) from the rear support (2).


NOTE: this is a destructive operation for the O-ring
(4).

Remove the bushing (5) from the rear support (2).

Remove the bushes (3) from the rear support (2).

Only if necessary, remove the bushing (6) and the


thrust washer (7) from the differential support (8).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 91

Loosen and remove the greaser (15).


Extract the front support (13) from the axle body (9).

Remove the bushing (12) from the front support


(13).

Only if necessary, remove the bushing (11) and the


thrust washer (10) from the axle body (9).

Remove the bushes (14) from the rear support (13).


92 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assembly
If previously removed, assemble the thrust washer
(7) and a new bushing (6) to the differential support
(8).

Apply sealant onto the contact surface of the


bushings (3).
Assemble the bushings (3) onto the rear support (2)
with a pad and a hammer.

Assemble the bushing (5) in the rear support (2).


Position the bushing (5) with the hole aligned with
the hole in the support (2).
Screw on the greaser (1).

Lubricate and insert a new O-ring (4) into the rear


support (2).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 93

Insert the rear support (2) on the differential support


(8).

S WARNING S
Do not damage the O-ring when inserting the rear
support on the axle housing.

If previously removed, assemble the thrust washer


(10) and a new bushing (11) onto the axle body (9).

Apply sealant onto the contact surface of the


bushings (14).
Assemble the bushes (14) to the front support (13)
with a pad and a hammer.

Assemble the bushing (12) into the front support


(13) using a suitable pad and a hammer.
Position the bushing (12) with the hole aligned with
the hole in the support (13).
Screw on the greaser (15).
94 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Insert the front support (13) into the axle body (9).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 95

DIFFERENTIAL SUPPORT

Disassembly
Drain the oil completely from the differential.
Loosen and remove the screws (2) of the differential
support (1).
Remove the differential support (1) from the axle
housing (15).

S WARNING S
Support the differential support with a rope or other
appropriate means.
96 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Measure the total starting preload FT0 of the


bearings (pinion-ring gear system) using a
dynamometer whose cord is wound on the splined
end of the pinion shaft.
Note the value FT0 that is necessary for
reassembling the bearings.

Loosen and remove the screws (3) to take out the


two ring nut retainers (4).

Before removing the screws, mark both half-


supports and the differential support with
permanent reference marks, to avoid exchanging
them during re-assembly. Mark the area between
the ring nuts (5) and (9) and the differential support
(1) as well.

Loosen and remove the adjustment ring nuts (5)


and (9) using tool 380000406 (A) and a wrench.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 97

Loosen and remove the 4 screws (12).


Remove the half-supports (11).
NOTE: check that the bushings (10) remain in their
housings.

Remove the differential assy (7).


Remove the bearings (6) and (8) together with the
differential assy.

S WARNING S
Do not exchange the bearings in case they are
replaced.
98 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assembly
Assemble the bearings (6) and (8) on the differential
assy (7).

S WARNING S
Do not exchange the bearings in case they are
replaced.

Assemble the differential assy (7) with bearings


onto the differential support (1).

S WARNING S
Check the correct assembly side of the ring gear.

Move the differential assy so that the ring gear is


placed against the pinion.
Check that all bushings (10) are in their housings
and position both half-supports (11) in their seats,
using the previously traced reference marks.
Lock both half-supports (11) with the fastening
screws (12).

Assemble the adjustment ring nuts (5) and (9) to the


differential support.
Tighten both ring nuts (5) and (9) with special tool
380000406, till the backlash is eliminated and the
differential bearings are slightly preloaded.
Check that the differential bearings are correctly
seated.
If necessary, slightly knock with a rubber hammer.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 99

Position a magnetic-base dial gauge on the


differential support, so that the feeler stylus touches
the surface of one tooth of the ring gear with a 90°
angle.

F27293

Lock the pinion and move the ring gear alternatively


and note the ring gear backlash, measured with the
dial gauge.
Repeat the operation on two or more points (teeth),
rotating the ring gear, so that to obtain an average
value.
Check if the measured backlash value is within the
requested range:
0.18 ÷ 0.25 mm (0.0070 ÷ 0.0098 in)
Carry out the adjustment by operating on the ring
nuts with the appropriate tool 380000406. F27430

Loosen/tighten both adjustment ring nuts by approx.


30 degrees at a time, as indicated in the following
step, then check the backlash.

Adjust the ring nuts (5) and (9), remembering that:


(A) - if the measured backlash is greater than the
given tolerance range, unscrew the adjustment
ring nut (5) and screw in the adjustment ring nut
(9) by the same measure.
(B) - if the measured backlash is lower than the
given tolerance range, unscrew the adjustment
ring nut (9) and screw in the adjustment ring nut
(5) by the same measure.
100 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Once the adjustment of the pinion-ring gear


backlash has been carried out, also check that
there is a minimum preloading on the differential
box bearings.
Repeat the whole sequence of the above
mentioned operations until the indicated conditions
are reached.

F27431

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have not been replaced,
measure the total preload FTm of the bearings
(pinion-ring gear system), using a dynamometer
whose cord is wound on the end of the splined
pinion shaft.
The measured value FTm should be within the
following range:
FTm = FT0 ÷ (FT0 + 10 (2.24 lbf)) N

S WARNING S
Use this method only if the bearings are already run
in. Otherwise, see the procedure described below.

If the bearings have been replaced, measure the


total preload FTm of the bearings (pinion-ring gear
system), using a dynamometer whose cord is
wound on the tool inserted on the pinion splined
end.

The total preload FTm is measured on the tool.


The measured value should be within the following
range:
FTm = (FPm + 10.7 (2.40 lbf)) ÷ (FPm + 15.6 (3.50 lbf)) N
- where FPm is the actual preload measured on the
tool
- where Dm (gauge diameter) = 104.4 mm (4.11 in)
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 101

In case you do not use the prescribed tool to


measure the total preload FTm, the reference
diameter is the diameter of pinion shaft splined end.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FTm= (FPm + 33.4 (7.50 lbf)) ÷ (FPm + 50.1 (11.26 lbf)) N
where FPm is the preload of the pinion bearings.

S WARNING S
This method is not precise with new bearings and
therefore not recommended.

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, as an alternative, it is possible to measure
the total rolling torque (MTm) of the bearings (pinion-
ring gear system) with a torque meter.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal ring.

The total torque MTm should be within the following


range:
MTm = (MPm + 0.58 (0.42 lbf·ft)) ÷ (MPm + 0.87
(0.64 lbf·ft)) Nm
where MPm is the preload of the pinion bearings.

If the measurement is not within the requested


range, check well the assembly of each component
and operate on the adjuster ring nuts (5) and (9) of
the differential support:
(A)- if the total preload is lower than the given range,
screw in both ring nuts (5) and (9) by the same
measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear backlash
value unchanged.
(B)- if the total preload is higher than the given
range, screw in both ring nuts (5) and (9) by the
same measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear
backlash value unchanged.
102 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Once all the adjustment operations have been


completed, fit the ring nut retainers (4) and their
screws (3).

Tighten the screws (12) of both half-supports (11) to


a tightening torque of 413 Nm (304.61 lbf·ft).

Before matching surfaces, make sure that they are


perfectly clean, degrease and clean them with
appropriate detergents.
Apply a film of adhesive onto the contact surface
between the axle body (15) and the differential
support.
NOTE: check that the two pins (14) are in their
housing.

Place the differential support (1) on the axle body


(15).
Tighten the fastening screws (2) to a tightening
torque of 169 Nm (124.64 lbf·ft).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 103

Bevel gear marking test


To test the marks of the bevel gear teeth, paint the
ring gear with red lead paint.
The marking test should always be carried out on
the ring gear teeth and on both sides.

OK -> Correct contact:


If the bevel gear is well adjusted, the mark on the
teeth surfaces will be regular.
Z -> Excessive contact on the tooth tip:
Bring the pinion closer to the ring gear and then
move the ring gear away from the pinion in order to
adjust the backlash.
X -> Excessive contact at the tooth base:
Move the pinion away from the ring gear and then
approach the ring gear to the pinion in order to
adjust the backlash.

Movements to correct:
1 -> move the pinion for type X contact adjustment.
2 -> move the pinion for type Z contact adjustment.
104 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

STANDARD DIFFERENTIAL GROUP

Disassembly
Use an extractor to remove bearing (3).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 105

Use an extractor to remove bearing (13).

Loosen all fastening screws (1) of the ring gear (2).

S WARNING S
This operation makes both differential half boxes
free, so take care not to lower the inner
components.

Remove the ring gear (2) by means of a hammer.

Mark the contact points in the two half-boxes (4)


and (12) that will be useful during assembly.
106 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the gear (6) and the shim (5).

Remove the shaft (7), the gears (8) and the


spherical washers (9).

Remove the gear (10) and the shim (11).

Assembly
Apply a thin layer of Molicote G-n plus paste on the
half housings of differential (4) and (12).

S WARNING S
Remove rests of dope.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 107

Apply a thin layer of Molicote G-n plus on the gears


(6) and (10) and on the gears (8).

Assemble the gear (10) and the shim (11).

Position the shaft (7), the gears (8) and the


spherical washers (9).

Assemble the gear (6) and the shim (5).


108 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assemble the two half-housings of the differential


unit (4) and (12).

S WARNING S
Carefully check that the marks of both differential
half housings coincide.

Assemble the ring gear (2) by means of a hammer.

Apply Loctite 242 on the thread of screws (1).

Tighten the screws (1) to the prescribed torque of


155 Nm (114.32 lbf·ft).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 109

Press the bearing (13).

Press the bearing (3).


110 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

SELF-LOCKING DIFFERENTIAL GROUP

Disassembly
Use an extractor to remove bearing (13).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 111

Use an extractor to remove bearing (3).

Loosen all fastening screws (1) of the ring gear (2).

S WARNING S
This operation makes both differential half boxes
free, so take care not to lower the inner
components.

Remove the ring gear (2) by means of a hammer.

Mark the contact points in the two half-boxes (4)


and (12) that will be useful during assembly.
112 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Remove the discs (5) and (6).

Assembly
Apply a thin layer of Molicote G-n plus paste on the
half-housings of differential unit (4) and (12).

S WARNING S
Remove rests of dope.

Apply a thin layer of Molicote G-n plus on the gears


(8) and (14) and on the gears (10).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 113

Assemble the discs (5) and (6).

Assemble the gear (14).

Position the shaft (9), the gears (10) and the


spherical washers (11).

Assemble the gear (8).


114 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assemble the discs (5) and (6).

Assemble the two half-housings of the differential


unit (4) and (12).

S WARNING S
Carefully check that the marks of both differential
half housings coincide.

Assemble the ring gear (2) by means of a hammer.

Apply Loctite 242 on the thread of screws (1).


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 115

Tighten the screws (1) to the prescribed torque of


155 Nm (114.32 lbf·ft).

Press the bearing (13).

Press the bearing (3).


116 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

PINION GROUP

Disassembly
Position the differential carrier in a vice.
Unscrew the ring nut (10) using the special tool
380002218.
NOTE: this operation will irretrievably damage the
ring nut (10).
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 117

Collect the washer (9).


Tap with a soft hammer to extract the pinion (1).

S WARNING S
Take care not to lower the pinion (1).

Collect the washers (4) and (6), the spacer (5) and
the bearing (8).

Place the differential carrier (7) on a flat surface and


remove the bearing cups (3) and (8) using a drift
and a hammer.

To remove the bearing (3) of the pinion (1), use an


extractor.
Collect the bearing (3) and the shim (2).

Check the conditions of all pinion parts.


The ring nut (10) and the elastic spacer (5) must be
replaced during reassembly.
118 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assembly
Place the differential support (7) onto a workbench.
Assemble the bearing cups (3) and (8).

Prepare the kit consisting of the special tools called


“false pinion” 380002219 (a1) and “false differential
box” 380000407 (a2) + 380000440 (a3) and a depth
gauge.

Insert the bearings (3) and (8) into their housings.


Assemble the “false pinion” 380002219 (a1) and the
ring nut (10).
Tighten without exceeding the ring nut, till the
backlash is eliminated.

Install the special tools “false differential box”


380000407 + 380000440 onto the supports of the
differential assy (7) and lock with the screws of the
half-collars.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 119

Assembly diagram of the “false differential box”


tools on the bearing differential support seats.
Use a depth gauge to measure distance “X”
(distance between the axis of the differential
bearings and the point at which the pinion head is
supported, or base of the bearing).

In order to determine the necessary thickness value


(S) between the pinion and the bearing, subtract the
value (V), stamped on the pinion head (V =
requested conical distance), from the measured
value (X).

S = X - V mm

Select the shim of thickness value (S) among the


range of available shims.

Remove the “false differential box” (a1) special tool


from the differential supports.
Remove the ring nut (10), the “false pinion” and the
bearing (3) and (8).
120 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Once you have chosen the suitable shim (2), insert


it on the pinion shaft with the chamfer against the
pinion head.

Force the bearing (3) into the pinion (1) using a vice
with the special tool 380002224, making sure it is
well set.
Insert the shims (4) and (6) and a new spacer (5).
NOTE: always use a new spacer (5).

Check the correct assembly sequence of shims (4)


and (6) and of the spacer (5).

Insert the pinion assy (1) into the differential support


housing (7) and the bearing (8).
In order to force the bearing (8) into position, use
the special tool 380002224 and a hammer.
It is advisable to offer resistance, for example a
sledge, to the beating force.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 121

Insert the washer (9) and screw in a new ring nut


(10) on the pinion.

Screw in the ring nut (10) using the wrench


380003218 for ring nut and for pinion retainer.

S WARNING S
The torque setting is given by the measure of the
preload on the bearings; gradually tighten the ring
nut (10).

NOTE: if the tightening is excessive, the removable


spacer must be replaced and the procedure
repeated. When you check the preloading, it is
advisable to beat slightly both pinion ends with a
soft hammer, so as to help setting the bearings.

If the bearings have not been replaced, to measure


the preload FPm of the bearings, use a
dynamometer whose cord is wound on the end of
the pinion shaft (1).

S WARNING S
Use this method only if the bearings are not to be
replaced, otherwise go to next step.

The measured value should be within the following


range:
FPm = FP0 ÷ (FP0 + 10 (2.24 lbf)) N

If the bearings are new, to measure the preload


FPm, use a dynamometer whose cord is wound on
the end of the pinion shaft.
122 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

The actual preload FPm is measured on the tool


(gauge diameter Dm = 104.4 mm (4.11 in)).
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 30.7 ÷ 46,0 N (6.90 ÷ 10.34 lbf)

S WARNING S
Values for new bearings.

In case you do not use the prescribed tool to


measure the preload, the reference diameter is the
diameter of pinion shaft splined end.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 92 ÷ 137 N

As an alternative, it is possible to measure the


pinion bearings’ rolling torque MPm with a torque
meter

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal ring.

The measured value MPm should be within the


following range:
MPm = 1.6 ÷ 2.4 Nm (1.18 ÷ 1.77 lbf·ft)
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 123

The adjustment is carried out by increasing the ring


nut (10) torque gradually, being careful not to
exceed.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.

Once the prescribed preload value is achieved,


caulk the ring nut (10) using a hammer and a
punch.
124 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

AXLE BEAM

Disassembly
Extract the seal ring (5).
NOTE: destructive operation for the seal ring (5),
which must be replaced.
Remove the bushing (4) only if the wear conditions
require it.

S WARNING S
Do not damage the bushing seat.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 125

Remove the bushing (2) and the ball joint (3) with a
suitable extractor only if the wear conditions require
it.
126 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Assembly
Cool down the upper bushing (2) and the ball joint
(3) to a temperature lower than -100 °C (-148 °F)
with liquid nitrogen.
Assemble the bushing (2) in the upper king pin seat
using the special tool 380200196 and a hammer.
Assemble the ball joint (3) in the lower king pin seat
using the special tool 380200196 and a hammer.

Assemble the bushing (4) using the special tool


380200227 and a hammer.
Assemble the seal ring (5) by using the special tool
380002226 and a hammer.

Direct the seal ring (5) as shown in the figure.


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 127

TOE-IN / STEERING ANGLE

Toe-in
Put two equal 1 m (39.37 in) long linear bars on the
wheel sides and lock them with two nuts on the
wheel hub stud screw.

S WARNING S
The two bars should be fixed on their middle so that
they are perpendicular to the supporting surface
and parallel to the pinion shaft axis; align the two
bars.
128 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Measure the distance in mm M between the bars


ends with a tapeline.
NOTE: keep the minimum value, swinging the
measurement point.

Check that the difference of the measurements


between the wheel hubs diameters ends is within
the requested tolerance range.
The nominal toe-in value (A) is referred to the
external diameter of the wheel hubs flange,
therefore the measured value (M) at the bars ends
must be related to the ratio between length of the
bar and flange diameter:
0 0
nominal toe-in = A - 2 measured toe-in = M - 5

If toe-in is incorrect, operate with two wrenches on


the rods (1) screwing in and out the two joint tie rods
(3) equally until the toe-in is within the requested
tolerance.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 129

After adjusting, screw in the locknuts (2) of the rods


(1) to a tightening torque of 250 Nm (184.38 lbf·ft).

Steering angle adjustment


Use the same bars assembled for the toe-in
adjustment and a long bar perfectly leaned over the
machined part of the central body (pinion side), so
that the two bars form an acute angle at the
maximum steering.

Adjust a protractor to the requested angle and


position it on the long bar.
Move a wheel side till it forms, with the two bars, the
angle fixed by the protractor.

Adjust the mechanical steering stop, screwing in or


out the stop screw (4), locking it with the locknut (5)
to a tightening torque of 150 Nm (110.63 lbf·ft).
130 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

Completely steer to the opposite side and repeat


the operations.

Check that the locks on the opposite sides are both


in contact with the axle body.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 131

TROUBLESHOOTING

TROUBLE POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Wheel vibrations. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair the axle.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Tyre resistance. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Broken axle shaft. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Difficult steering; the machine Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


travels in a straight line while
steering. Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

No differential action; jams Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


during steering.
Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.
132 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

TROUBLE POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Excessive noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Excessive wear of the tyre. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Differential locked. Check the installation.

Excessive steering angle. Reduce the steering angle.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Friction noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Damaged or worn axle parts. Replace the damaged axle parts.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Incorrect adjustment of the bevel Adjust the bevel gear set.


gear set.

Vibrations during travel. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 133

TROUBLE POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Outer tip of ring gear tooth is Excessive gear load compared to Replace bevel gear.
broken. the one expected. Follow carefully recommended
Gear adjustment wrong (excessive adjustment operations of ring gear
backlash). and pinion backlash and of tooth
marks detection.
Pinion nut loose.

Inner tip of ring gear tooth is Crash load. Replace bevel gear.
broken.
Gear adjustment wrong (insufficient Follow carefully recommended
backlash). adjustment operations of ring gear
and pinion backlash and of tooth
Pinion nut loose.
marks detection.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Insufficient lubrication. Replace bevel gear.
damaged or scored.
Contaminated lubricant. Replace worn out pinion bearings
that cause an incorrect pinion axle
Incorrect lubrication or poor
backlash and wrong contact
additives.
between pinion and ring gear.
Worn out pinion bearings that cause
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
an incorrect pinion axle backlash
level and replace at recommended
and wrong contact between pinion
intervals.
and ring gear.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Prolonged operation at high Replace bevel gear.
overheated. Check if gear temperature.
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
teeth have faded.
Unsuitable lubricant. level and replace at recommended
intervals.
Oil level low.
Contaminated lubricant.

Drive pinion teeth pitted. Extremely intense use. Replace bevel gear.
Insufficient lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Bent axle beam body. Machine overloaded. Replace the axle beam body.
Damaged vehicle.
Crash load.

Bearings worn or pitted. Insufficient lubrication. Replace the bearings.


Contaminated lubricant. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Extremely intense use.
intervals.
Normal wear.
Pinion nut loose.
134 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

TROUBLE POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Gaskets leak oil. Prolonged operation at excessive oil Replace the gasket and matching
temperature. surface if damaged.
Oil gasket wrongly installed. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Gasket edge cut or scored.
intervals.
Contaminated lubricant.

Excessive wear of input Intense use. Replace the flange.


flange spline.
Pinion nut loose. Check that the pinion spline is not
excessively worn out.
Pinion axial backlash.
Replace bevel gear, if necessary.

Pinion gear tooth fatigue Intense use. Replace bevel gear.


break. Continuous overload.
Check if the fracture line is
wavy or clearly delineated
(stop line).

Break of pinion and ring gear Crash load of differential Check and/or replace other
teeth. components. differential components.

Splines of planetary gear worn Intense use. Replace differential gear assy.
(excessive backlash).
Replace axle beam, if necessary.

Worn or scored surfaces of Insufficient lubrication. Replace all scratched washers and
the scraper thrust washer. those with a 0.1 mm (0.0039 in)
Lubrication wrong.
thickness lower than the new ones.
Contaminated lubricant.
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Inner diameter of pinion Intense use. Replace bearing.


tapered roller bearing worn Excessive pinion end play. Check pinion axial backlash.
out.
Unsuitable lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Contaminated lubricant.
intervals.

Broken or bent axle beam. Intense vehicle operation, overload. Replace the axle beam.
SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 135

TROUBLE POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Broken axle beam at wheel Loose wheel support. Replace the axle beam.
flange.
Bent axle beam body. Check bending of axle beam body.
Ensure that wheel support is not
worn out or wrongly adjusted.

Noise during travel. Excessive backlash between ring Adjust the backlash between the ring
gear and pinion. gear and the pinion.

Pinion and ring gear worn. Replace pinion and ring gear.

Worn-out pinion bearings Replace pinion bearings.

Loose pinion bearings. Adjust pinion bearings.

Excessive pinion end play. Adjust the axial play of the pinion.

Differential bearings worn out. Replace differential bearings.

Loose differential bearings. Adjust the bearings.

Ring gear excessively off-set. Replace the ring gear.

Low lubricant level. Restore the level.

Poor or wrong lubricant grade. Change lubricant.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Noise during idling. Noises emitted by the axle when the Adjust the backlash between the ring
vehicle is moving are usually heard gear and the pinion or replace pinion
during idling, even though they are and ring gear.
not too loud.

Wrong backlash between pinion and Adjust the play between the pinion
ring gear (the noise heard while and the ring gear.
decelerating disappears when speed
is increased).

Pinion spline or input flange worn. Replace the pinion.

Intermittent noise. Damaged ring gear. Replace bevel gear.

Differential box screws loose. Tighten the screws to torque.

Constant noise. Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Replace bevel gear.
damaged.

Worn bearings. Replace the bearings.

Pinion splines worn. Replace the pinion.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.


136 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

TROUBLE POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Noise while bending. Differential planetary gears Replace the planetary gears.
damaged.

Differential box and/or pins worn. Replace the differential box.

Worn differential thrust washers. Replace the thrust washers.

Worn-out axle beam splines Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES 137

REPAIR TIMES
The times are referred to average values of
maintenance performed by skilled personnel in
workshops equipped with all necessary fixtures for a
proper execution of the required works.
The repair and/or replacement times are indicated in
minutes.
We assume that the axle has already been removed
from the machine.

ASSY OPERATION TIME (minutes)


Flange Replacement of pinion seal ring 30
Rod replacement (x 1) 30
Ball joint replacement (x 1) 15
Tie rod replacement (x 1) 30
Ball joint boot replacement (x 1) 15
Steering cylinder Tie rod boot replacement (x 1) 15
Sensor replacement 15
Steering cylinder replacement 120
Steering cylinder overhauling 240
Sensor replacement and adjustment 60
Gear carrier replacement 20
Reduction gear assy Gear carrier overhaul (3 planetary gears) 35
Gear carrier overhaul (4 planetary gears) 45
Standard wheel hub replacement 30
Seal ring + wheel hub bearing replacement 75
Stud bolt replacement (x 1) 5
Swivel housing overhauling 90
Swivel housing replacement 70
Wheel hub
Cardan shaft replacement 30
Cardan shaft overhaul 60
King pin replacement (x 1) 30
King pin bearing replacement (x 1) 45
Ring gear replacement (x 1) 30
Ball joint replacement (x 1) 45
Replacement of the seal rings of the cardan shaft 45
Axle body Cardan shaft bushing replacement 60
Axle body replacement 180
King pins’ bushing replacement 30
Support overhaul 60
Supports
Support replacement 30
Replacement of differential assy 150
Differential support
Differential box bearings 180
Differential replacement 150
Differential Overhaul / replacement of bevel gear, planetary gears, pins 240
Overhauling / replacement of differential box bearings 120
Pinion Overhauling / replacement of pinion bearings 180
138 SECTION 25 - FRONT AXLES

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH USE

380000406 Disassembly/assembly of differential ring nuts

380000407 +
Calculation of pinion shims
380000440

380002213 Assembly of seal ring in the wheel hub

380002218 Disassembly/assembly of pinion rings

380002219 Calculation of pinion shims

380002222 Assembly of bearing cups in the wheel hub

380002224 Assembly of pinion bearing

380002226 Assembly of seal ring in the wheel hub

380002667 Disassembly/assembly of bushings in ring gear retaining hub

380002668 Assembly of bushing in the swivel housing

380002669 Assembly of seal ring in the swivel housing

380200196 Assembly of bushing in the half-beam

380200227 Assembly of bushing in the half-beam


B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

2WS REAR AXLE (B90B - B100B - B100BTC) ................................................................................................ 3


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 3
LUBRICATION AND GREASING ................................................................................................................ 5
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE ...................................................................................................................... 7
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................... 8
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................... 61
REPAIR TIMES.......................................................................................................................................... 67
SPECIAL TOOLS....................................................................................................................................... 68

2WS REAR AXLE (B110B - B110BTC) .......................................................................................................... 69


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 69
LUBRICATION AND GREASING .............................................................................................................. 71
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................... 73
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 74
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................. 127
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 133
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 134

4WS REAR AXLE (B115B)........................................................................................................................... 135


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 135
LUBRICATION AND GREASING ............................................................................................................ 138
REMOVAL FROM MACHINE .................................................................................................................. 140
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY........................................................................................................... 141
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................. 219
REPAIR TIMES........................................................................................................................................ 225
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 227
2 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 3

2WS REAR AXLE


(B90B - B100B - B100BTC)

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
4 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Manufacturer CARRARO
Model 28.44
Bevel gear reduction ratio 2.75/1
Epicyclic gear ratio 6.40/1
Total reduction ratio 17.6/1
Input rotation clockwise
420 kg
Dry weight
(926 lb)
Differential type Mechanical and driven
12 ÷ 35 bar
Pressure for differential lock
(174 ÷ 508 psi)
0.20 ÷ 0.28 mm
Bevel gear set backlash
(0.0079 ÷ 0.0110 in)
Pinion bearing preload (1) FP = 115 ÷ 138 N
(measured on Ø = 34.8 mm (1.37 in) without seal ring) (26 ÷ 31 lbf)
Ring gear-pinion bearing total preload (1) FT = (FP + 33) ÷ (FP + 50) N
(measured on Ø = 34.8 mm (1.37 in) without seal ring) [FT = (FP + 7.4) ÷ (FP + 11.2) lbf]
MP = 2.0 ÷ 2.4 Nm
Pinion bearing rolling torque (1) measured without seal ring
(1.47 ÷ 1.77 lbf·ft)
Total pinion-ring gear bearing rolling torque (1) measured without MT = (MP + 0.58) ÷ (MP + 0.87) Nm
seal ring [MT = (MP + 0.43) ÷ (MP + 0.64) lbf·ft]

(*) Only for new bearings

SERVICE BRAKE

Brake type Wet disc brake


Brake operating temperature -20 °C ÷ 150 °C (-4 ÷ 5.9 °F)
Maximum operating pressure 43 bar (624 psi)
Oil displacement for brake actuation (each side) 16 cm3 (0.98 in3)

A. New counterdisc thickness = 8.0 ± 0.05 mm


(0.31 ± 0.002 in)
B. New friction disc thickness = 6.73 ± 0.1 mm
(0.26 ± 0.004 in)
Worn disc minimum thickness = 5.8 mm (0.23 in)
C. New counterdisc thickness = 5.0 ± 0.05 mm
(0.20 ± 0.002 in)
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 5

LUBRICATION AND GREASING

Oil capacity (differential) 17 litres (3.74 gal)


Oil type Ambra TRX 80W -140 NH600 / TR

1. Level and fill plug for differential oil


2. Differential oil drain plug
3. Oil breather
4. Oil drain plug
5. Brake breather
6 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Before draining the oil from the axle body, use the
breather (3) to release any possible internal pres-
sure.

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

To drain the oil from the central body remove the


level plug (1) and the drain plug (2).

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

Drain all oil.


Clean the plug (2), screw it and tighten to the pre-
scribed torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).
Fill through the hole of the plug (1).
Check the level and, if necessary, top up.
Clean the plug (2), screw it and tighten to the pre-
scribed torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 7

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Lower the loader attachment to the ground.
Use the locking pin (if provided) to lock the loader
attachment controls.
Lower the backhoe attachment to the ground.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Lower the stabilizers until the rear wheels are
slightly lifted from the ground (they are free from
machine weight).
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key to
ON and release the pressure by moving the hydrau-
lic control levers in all directions.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Fasten the rear axle to a lifting hoist or to a support.
Now it is possible to carry out the disassembly of the
2 rear tyres by loosening and removing the relevant
fixing nuts (9) [tightening torque = 700 Nm (516 lbf·ft)].
Disconnect the cardan joint (6) by unlocking and
removing the screws (7) and the bracket (8).
Unscrew and remove the screws (4) with the nuts
(2) and the washers (3) and (5) [tightening torque
= 610 ÷ 678 Nm (445 ÷ 500 lbf·ft)].
Remove the rear axle (1).
8 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Some of the following pictures could not exactly
show your axle, but the procedure is correct.

TIGHTENING TORQUES AND APPLICATION OF SEALANTS / ADHESIVES


A. Loctite 510
B. Loctite 270
C. Loctite 638
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 9

GREASE POINTS
10 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FRONT FLANGE

Disassembly
Remove the stop ring (1) and the front flange (2).
Remove the O-ring (4) and the shim (5).

Remove the seal ring (3).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 11

Assembly
Assemble the seal ring (3) into the central body with
a drift 380200228 and a hammer.

Insert the shim (5) and a new O-ring (4) into the pin-
ion shaft.
Insert the front flange (2) on the shaft end.
Fasten the pieces as soon as assembled by fitting
the snap ring (1).
12 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

BRAKES

Disassembly
Drain the oil completely from the differential.

Loosen and remove all screws (1) except for 2 as a


safety measure.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 13

Connect the wheel hub (2) to a lifting device and


tension the rope.
Insert 2 opposed threaded rods to enable removal.

Remove the 2 last screws (1) and separate the


wheel hub assy (2) from the axle body (3).

Slowly remove the wheel hub assy and the half axle
(4), make sure that the braking discs (5) and the
counterdiscs (6) stay on the wheel hub assy.

Place the wheel hub assy vertically and mark the


counterdisc (5) assembled to the axle body side (3).
Remove the discs (6), the counterdiscs (5) and the
dowel pins (7).
14 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the half axle (4) from the wheel hub assy
(2).

In some cases the axle shaft can be delivered


already assembled in 2 parts.

Remove the screws (8) and the belleville washers


(9) from the brake cylinder (10).

Check screws (8) and belleville washers (9) for


damage.
NOTE: if brake discs are replaced, also replace
screws and springs.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 15

Remove the snap ring (11) and the self adjust kit
assy (12).

Place the self adjust kit (12) on tool 380200245 and


remove the snap rings (13).

Check bushing (14) for wear.


Repeat the procedure for the remaining 2 self
adjust kits.

Remove the brake cylinder assy (10).


16 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the brake piston (15) from the brake cylin-


der (10).

Remove the O-rings (16) and (17) from the brake


cylinder (10).

Remove the O-ring (18) from the brake piston (15).

Remove the O-ring (19).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 17

Assembly
Assemble the O-ring (19).

Assemble the O-ring (18) onto the brake piston


(15).

Assemble the O-rings (16) and (17) onto the brake


cylinder (10).

Lubricate the O-rings (16), (17) and (18).


Assemble the brake piston (15) into the brake cylin-
der (10).
18 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Lubricate the seat of the brake cylinder on the


wheel hub (2) and assemble the dowel pins (7).

Assemble the brake cylinder assy (10) and remove


the dowel pins (7).

Place the bushing (14) into the tool 380200245 pay-


ing attention to direct it with the chamfer edge
upwards.

Assemble the snap rings (13) by turning them by


90° with respect to the ring mounted before.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 19

Assemble the snap rings (13) until they are seated


against the calibrated disc and using a drift
380200245.
Repeat the procedure for the remaining 2 self
adjust kits.

Assemble the self adjust kits (12) into the brake cyl-
inder, paying attention to direct the chamfer edge of
the bushing (14) upwards.

Assemble the snap rings (11).


Make sure that the teeth of the snap ring are
directed towards the self adjust kit.

Snap ring (11) orientation.


20 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the belleville washers (9) on the screws


(8) paying attention to orientate them correctly.

Assemble the screws (8) and the belleville washers


(9).
Tighten the screws (8) to a tightening torque of
15.3 Nm (11 lbf·ft).
Make sure that the 4 belleville washers are correctly
aligned before tightening the screws.

Assemble half shaft (4) and the dowel pins (7).

Using the reference mark made during disassem-


bly, assemble the counterdisc (5) paying attention to
direct it with the mark towards the axle body (3).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 21

Assemble the first braking disc (6) and the counter-


disc (5).
If using new brake discs (6), they must be soaked in
oil for at least 24 hours prior to installation.

Assemble the last brake disc (6) and make sure that
its slots are aligned with those of the first disc.

Connect the wheel hub (2) to a lifting device and


assemble it on the beam (3).
Support and turn the axle beam (4), while pushing
the wheel hub onto it.

Screw in screws (1) applying the prescribed sealant


and tighten to tightening torque of 226 Nm (167 lbf·ft).
22 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

WHEEL HUB

Disassembly
Remove the brake assy.

If disassembly of the planetary gear carrier for over-


hauling is not necessary, use a bearing puller to lift
the planetary gear carrier assy.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 23

Enlarge the snap ring (2) and simultaneously


extract the gear carrier (1).

If necessary, remove the snap rings (3) and by


means of a puller the gears (4) with the bearings (5)
from the gear carrier (1).
NOTE: the bearing (5) cannot be removed from the
gear (4).
If one gear must be replaced, replace the whole
pair.

Unscrew and remove the ring nut (6) fastening the


ring gear retaining hub using tool 380200244.

Separate the wheel hub (7) from the wheel flange


(8) with a puller.
24 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Connect the wheel hub (7) to a hoisting tool to


remove it.
Collect the bearing (9).

Remove the bearing cup (9) from the wheel hub (7).

Remove the seal ring (10) from the wheel hub (7).

Remove the bearing cup (11) from the wheel hub


(7).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 25

Remove the spacer (12) from the wheel flange (8).

To remove the bearing (11), use a disc grinder to cut


the cage and to engrave the ring.
Then use a chisel to cut and to remove the ring.

Assembly
Assemble the bearing cup (11) onto wheel hub (7)
with the buffer 380200211.
Assemble the bearing cup (9) with the buffer
380002222.
Assemble the seal ring (10) on the wheel hub (7)
with the buffer 380200254.

Use tool 380200254 (T) for the assembly of the seal


ring (10) on the wheel hub (7).
26 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the bearing (11) onto wheel flange (8)


with a pusher and a press.

Place the spacer (12) on the wheel flange (8).

Connect the wheel hub (7) to a lifting device and


place it on the wheel flange (8).
Clean the sealing surface of the flange.
Pay attention not to damage the seal ring (10).

Assemble the bearing cup (9) with a pusher and a


hammer.
Assemble the ring nut (6).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 27

Screw in and tighten the ring nut (6) with tool


380200244 at tightening torque of 1000 Nm (738
lbf·ft).

Assemble the bearing (5) with tool 380200255 (T).

Assemble the gears (4) and the snap rings (3) on


the gear carrier (1).
Ensure that the chamfer of the bearings (5) is
directed towards the gear carrier (1).

Connect the gear carrier (1) to a hoisting tool to


remove it.
Lift it and then place it on the wheel hub (7).
28 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Orientate the gear carrier (1) so that the tooth


engages into the ring nut (6).

In order to simplify the installation, align the hole on


the gear carrier with the ring nut (6).
NOTE: it may take several attempts to find the right
combination of alignment between teeth and hole of
the gear carrier and the ring nut, to get the locking
tooth to engage.

Enlarge the snap ring (2) to complete the gear car-


rier (1) assembly.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 29

DIFFERENTIAL SUPPORT ASSY

Disassembly
Drain the oil completely from the differential.

Loosen and remove the screws (1).


30 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Separate the axle support (3) from the axle body (2)
using pry bars in slots.

Connect the differential support (3) to a lifting


device to remove it.

Measure the rolling torque MT0 of the bearings (pin-


ion-ring gear system), using wrench 380200269.
Note value MT0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.
NOTE: the total rolling torque must be determined
without the pinion seal ring.

It is possible to measure the total starting preload


FT0 of the bearings (pinion-ring gear system) using
a dynamometer whose cord is wound on the end of
the pinion shaft.
Note value FT0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 31

Unscrew and remove the screws (4) fastening the


ring nuts (5) and (6).

Unscrew the ring nuts (5) and (6) using tool


380200243.

Remove the differential box (7).


The bearings cups (8) and (9) have to be removed
together with the differential box.
32 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assembly
Assemble the bearing cups (8) and (9) on the differ-
ential box (7) with drift 380200218.

Assemble the differential box (7) with bearings onto


the differential support (3).

Tighten both ring nuts (5) and (6) with special tool
380200243, till the backlash is eliminated and the
bearings are slightly preloaded.
Check that the bearings are correctly seated.

Position a magnetic-base dial gauge on the differ-


ential support, so that the feeler touches the surface
of one tooth of the ring gear with a 90° angle.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 33

Lock the pinion and alternately move the ring gear,


and note the backlash between pinion and ring
gear, measured with the dial gauge.
Repeat the operation on two or more points (teeth),
rotating the ring gear, so that to obtain an average
value.
Check if the measured backlash value is within the
requested range:
0.20 ÷ 0.28 mm (0.0079 ÷ 0.0110 in)
Carry out the adjustment by operating on the ring
nuts (5) and (6) with tool 380200243.

Adjust the ring nuts (5) and (6), remembering that:


- if the measured backlash is less than the pre-
scribed tolerance range, unscrew the ring nut (6)
and screw in the ring nut (5) by the same meas-
ure;
- if the measured backlash is more than the pre-
scribed tolerance range, unscrew the ring nut (5)
and screw in the ring nut (6) by the same meas-
ure.

Repeat the whole sequence of the above men-


tioned operations until the requested conditions are
reached.

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have not been replaced,
measure the total preload FTm of the bearings (pin-
ion-ring gear system), using a dynamometer whose
cord is wound on the end of the pinion shaft.
Use this method only if the bearings are already run
in.
The measured value FTm should be within the fol-
lowing range:
FTm = FT0 ÷ (FT0 + 10) N
FTm = FT0 ÷ (FT0 + 2.25) lbf
34 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have not been replaced,
measure the total rolling torque MTm of the bearings
(pinion-ring gear system) with a torque meter and
the special wrench 380200269.
The measured value MTm should be the same of
the starting:
MTm = MT0

If the bearings have been replaced, measure the


total preload FTm of the bearings (pinion-ring gear
system), using a dynamometer whose cord is
wound on tool 380200272 inserted on the pinion
splined end.

The total preload FTm is measured by tool


380200237.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FTm = (FPm + 11) ÷ (FPm + 16.7) N
[FTm = (FPm + 2.47) ÷ (FPm + 3.75) lbf]
where FPm is the actual preload measured on tool
380200237 [gauge diameter Dm = 104.4 mm
(4.11 in)].

NOTE: if you do not use the prescribed tool to


measure the total preload FTm, the reference diam-
eter is the diameter of pinion shaft splined end.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FTm = (FPm + 33) ÷ (FPm + 50) N
[FTm = (FPm + 7.42) ÷ (FPm + 11.24) lbf]
where FPm is the preload of the pinion bearings.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 35

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have been replaced, meas-
ure the total rolling torque MTm of the bearings (pin-
ion-ring gear system) with a torque meter and the
wrench 380200269.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.

The total torque MTm should be within the following


range:
MTm = (MPm + 0.58) ÷ (MPm + 0.87) Nm
[MTm = (MPm + 0.43) ÷ (MPm + 0.64) lbf·ft]
where MPm is the preload of the pinion bearings.

If the measure is not within the requested range,


check the assembly of each component and oper-
ate on the ring nuts (5) and (6) of the differential
support:
- if the total preload is less than the given range,
screw on the ring nuts (5) and (6) by the same
measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear backlash
value unchanged;
- if the total preload is less than the given range,
screw on the ring nuts (5) and (6) with the same
measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear backlash
value unchanged.

Once all the adjustment operations have been com-


pleted, lock the ring nuts (5) and (6) with the screws
(4).
Tighten the screws (4) to a tightening torque of 10 Nm
(7.4 lbf·ft).
36 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Before matching worked surfaces, make sure they


are perfectly clean, if not, clean with proper deter-
gents.
Apply a film of sealant on the contact surface of the
axle body (2) and the differential support.

Place the differential support (3) on the axle body


(2).

Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening


torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 37

Check of the bevel gear


To test the marks of the bevel gear teeth, paint the
ring gear with red lead paint.
The contact mark test should always be carried out
on the ring gear teeth and on both sides.

OK -> Correct contact:


If the bevel gear is well adjusted, the mark on the
teeth surfaces will be regular.
Z -> Excessive contact on the tooth tip:
approach the pinion to the ring bevel gear and then
move the ring bevel gear away from the pinion in
order to adjust the backlash.
X -> Excessive contact at the tooth base:
move the pinion away from the ring bevel gear and
then approach the ring bevel gear to the pinion in
order to adjust the backlash.

Movements to correct:
1 -> move the pinion for type X contact adjustment;
2 -> move the pinion for type Z contact adjustment.
38 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

DIFFERENTIAL LOCKING ASSY

Disassembly
Loosen plug (1) without removing it.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 39

Push the yoke (2) downwards using the differential


support as a retainer, then remove the plug (1).

Insert the tool 380200259.

Remove the snap ring (5).


Remove the tool 380200259.

Remove the bushing (6).


40 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the spring (4).

Extract the rod assy (3) from the differential support.

Remove the yoke (2), the spring (7) and the spacer
(8) from the rod (3).

Remove the O-ring (9) from the plug (1).


Remove the O-rings (11) and (12) from the piston
(10).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 41

Assembly
Assemble the O-rings (11) and (12) onto the piston
(10).
Assemble the O-ring (9) on the plug (1).
Lubricate the O-rings.

Lubricate the rod (3).


Assemble the yoke (2) on the rod (3).
Assemble the spacer (8) and the spring (7).
Orientate the spacer (8) with the flat towards the
snap ring (13).

Assemble the rod assy (3) onto the differential sup-


port.

Assemble the spring (4).


42 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the bushing (6), make sure to orientate it


with the flat end outwards.

Insert the tool 380200259 (T1).

Assemble the snap ring (5) with tool 380200260


(T2).
Remove tools 380200259 (T1) and 380200260
(T2).

Push the yoke (2) downwards using the differential


support as a retainer.
Screw in the plug (1) by hand.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 43

Tighten the plug (1) to the requested torque of 80 Nm


(59 lbf·ft).
44 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

DIFFERENTIAL

Disassembly
If differential bearings must be replaced, remove
the bearing cups (1) and (2).
Remove the sleeve (3).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 45

Remove the snap ring (4).

Take out the cover (5) and collect the anti-rotation


pin (6) and the shoulder ring (7).

Remove the gear (8).

Remove the dowels (9).


46 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Take out the pins (10).

Unscrew and remove the screws (11) and the ring


gear (12).

Slip off pin (13) until the gear is free (14).


NOTE: the pin can be slipped off only in one direc-
tion.

Assemble the planetary gear (14) and the relevant


shoulder ring (15).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 47

Remove the pin (13), the planetary gear (16) and


the relevant shoulder ring (17).

Pull out partially the pins (18) and remove the


spacer (19).

Remove the pins (18), the gears (20) and the rele-
vant shoulder rings (21).

Remove the gear (22) and the relevant ring (23).


48 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the pins (25) locking the differential box


(24).

Assembly
Assemble the O-rings (26) on the pins (25).

Assemble the pins (25) into the differential box (24).

Assemble the gear (22) and the relevant ring (23).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 49

Assemble the gears (20) and the relevant shoulder


rings (21). Insert pins (18) far enough to hold them.
NOTE: orientate the flats on the pins facing up.

Assemble the spacer (19) and the pins (18), make


sure to align the pin holes with those of the differen-
tial box (24).

Lubricate and assemble the gear (16) and the rele-


vant shoulder ring (17).
Insert pin (13).
Orientate the pin (13) with the flat facing up.

Assemble the planetary gear (14) and the relevant


shoulder ring (15) and insert the pin (13) and make
sure to align the pin hole with that of the differential
box (24).
50 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the ring gear (12), apply some sealant


and tighten the screws (11) to a tightening torque of
165 Nm (122 lbf·ft).

Insert the pins (10) and tighten the plugs (9) to the
prescribed torque.

Assemble the gear (8).

Apply a thin film of grease on the cover (5) and


assemble the ring (7).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 51

Assemble the anti-rotation pin (6) on the cover (5).


Assemble the cover (5) onto the differential box.

Lock the cover (5) with the snap ring (4).

Assemble the sleeve (3) and make sure that it seats


correctly.
NOTE: to ease the fitting, turn the gear (22).

Assemble the bearing cups (1) and (2) with drift


380200218.
Take care not to mix the bearing cups.
52 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

PINION ASSY

Disassembly
Measure the starting preload FP0 of the pinion bear-
ings using a dynamometer whose cord is wound on
the end of the pinion shaft.

S WARNING S
Note value FP0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.

Measure the rolling torque MP0 of the bearings,


using a torque wrench and tool 380200269.

S WARNING S
Note value MP0 that is necessary for assembling
the bearings.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 53

Lock the differential assy in a vice.


Unscrew the ring nut (1) using special tools
380000021 and 380000020.
NOTE: this operation will irretrievably damage the
lock nut (1).

Remove the ring nut (1) and collect its washer (2).

Tap the shaft end with a soft hammer to remove the


pinion (3).
Collect the washers (4) and (5), the spacer (6) and
the bearing (7).

Remove the bearing cups (7) and (8) from the differ-
ential support (9) using a buffer and a hammer.
54 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the bearing (8) from the pinion (3) by


means of a puller.
Collect the shim (10).

Check the conditions of all pinion parts.


The ring nut (1) and the spacer (6) must be
replaced during assembly.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 55

Assembly
Place the differential support (9) on a workbench.
Insert the bearing cups (7) and (8) with the buffers
380200200 and 380002215 and a hammer.

Insert the bearings (7) and (8) into the relevant


seats.
Assemble the false pinion kit 380200273 (a1) and
the ring nut (1).
Tighten without exceeding the ring nut, until the
backlash is eliminated.

Assemble tool 380200187 (T) on the differential box


seats (9).

Use a depth gauge to measure dimension “X” (dis-


tance between bearing axis of differential box and
leaning point of pinion head or bearing base).
56 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

To adjust the bevel gear measure the distance “A”


with a depth gauge.
Determine the value “X” as follows:
X = (A + C) - B mm (in)
where “B” and “C” are known values.

In order to determine the value (S) of the shim to be


placed between pinion and bearing, subtract from
the measured value (X) the value (V) engraved on
pinion head (V = prescribed distance).
S = (X - V) mm (in)

Select the shim (10) with value (S) from the range
of available shims, and fit it onto the shaft end under
the pinion head.

SHIM RANGE
Shims
2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 3.0 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4
mm
(0.098) (0.102) (0.106) (0.110) (0.114) (0.118) (0.122) (0.126) (0.130) (0.134)
(in)
Q.ty - - - - - - - - - -

Remove tool 380200187 from the seats (9) of the


differential box.
Disassemble the ring nut (10), the false pinion
380200202 (a1) and the bearings (7) and (8).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 57

Once you have chosen the suitable shim (10), insert


it on the pinion shaft with the chamfer against the
pinion head.

Insert the bearing (8) into the pinion (3) using a


press and a buffer 380200204.

Insert the pinion (3) into the differential box (9).


Insert the shims (4) and (5) and the spacer (6).
NOTE: always use a new spacer (6).

Check the right assembly sequence.


58 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the bearing (7) on pinion shaft, using


buffer 380200204 and a hammer.

Insert the washer (2) and tighten the new ring nut
(1) on the pinion shaft.
Lubricate the ring nut thread (1) and the supporting
face with the washer (2) with oil.

Screw in the ring nut (1) using the wrench for ring
nut 380200268 and the pinion retainer 380200269.

S WARNING S
The tightening torque is given by the measure of
the preload on bearings (7) and (8); gradually
tighten the ring nut (1).

NOTE: if the tightening is excessive, the spacer (6)


must be replaced and the procedure repeated.
When you check the preload, strike the pinion end
(3) with a soft hammer to favour the bearings (7)
and (8) settlement.

If the bearings have not been replaced, to measure


the preload FPm of the bearings (7) and (8), use a
dynamometer whose cord is wound on the end of
pinion shaft (3).

S WARNING S
Use this method only if the bearings are not to be
replaced, otherwise go to next step.

The measured value should be within the following


range:
FPm = FP0 ÷ (FP0 + 10) N
[FPm = FP0 ÷ (FP0 + 2.25) lbf]
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 59

If the bearings have not been replaced, it is possible


to measure the rolling torque MPm of the bearings
(7) and (8), using a torque wrench and tool
380000020.
NOTE: use this method only if the bearings are not
replaced.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.

The measured value should be the same of the


starting:
MPm = MP0
If the bearings (7) and (8) are new, to measure the
preload FPm of the bearings, use a dynamometer
whose cord is wound on tool 380200237, inserted
on the end of pinion shaft.

The actual preload FPm is measured on tool


380200237 [gauge diameter Dm = 114.4 mm (4.50
in)].
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 38.3 ÷ 46 N
[FPm = 8.61 ÷ 10.34 lbf]

S WARNING S
Values for new bearings.

In case you do not use the prescribed tool to meas-


ure the preload, the reference diameter is the diam-
eter of pinion shaft splined end.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 115 ÷ 138 N
[FPm = 25.85 ÷ 31.02 lbf]
60 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

If the bearings are new, measure the rolling torque


MPm of the pinion shaft bearings with a torque
meter and the wrench 380000020.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.

The measured value MPm should be within the fol-


lowing range:
MPm = 2.0 ÷ 2.4 Nm
[MPm = 1.47 ÷ 1.77 lbf·ft]

Once the prescribed preload value is achieved,


caulk the ring nut (1) using a hammer and a punch.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 61

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Wheel vibrations. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair the axle.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Tyre resistance. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Broken axle shaft. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Difficult steering; the machine Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


travels in a straight line while
steering. Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

No differential action; jams Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


during steering.
Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.
62 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Excessive noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Excessive wear of the tyre. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Differential locked. Check the installation.

Excessive steering angle. Reduce the steering angle.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Friction noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Damaged or worn axle parts. Replace the damaged axle parts.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Incorrect adjustment of the bevel Adjust the bevel gear set.


gear set.

Vibrations during travel. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 63

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Outer tip of ring gear tooth is Excessive gear load compared to Replace bevel gear.
broken. the one expected. Follow carefully recommended
Gear adjustment wrong (excessive adjustment operations of ring gear
backlash). and pinion backlash and of tooth
marks detection.
Pinion nut loose.

Inner tip of ring gear tooth is Crash load. Replace bevel gear.
broken.
Gear adjustment wrong (insufficient Follow carefully recommended
backlash). adjustment operations of ring gear
and pinion backlash and of tooth
Pinion nut loose.
marks detection.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Insufficient lubrication. Replace bevel gear.
damaged or scored.
Contaminated lubricant. Replace worn out pinion bearings
that cause an incorrect pinion axle
Incorrect lubrication or poor
backlash and wrong contact
additives.
between pinion and ring gear.
Worn out pinion bearings that cause
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
an incorrect pinion axle backlash
level and replace at recommended
and wrong contact between pinion
intervals.
and ring gear.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Prolonged operation at high Replace bevel gear.
overheated. Check if gear temperature.
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
teeth have faded.
Unsuitable lubricant. level and replace at recommended
intervals.
Oil level low.
Contaminated lubricant.

Drive pinion teeth pitted. Extremely intense use. Replace bevel gear.
Insufficient lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Bent axle beam body. Machine overloaded. Replace the axle beam body.
Damaged vehicle.
Crash load.

Bearings worn or pitted. Insufficient lubrication. Replace the bearings.


Contaminated lubricant. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Extremely intense use.
intervals.
Normal wear.
Pinion nut loose.
64 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Gaskets leak oil. Prolonged operation at excessive oil Replace the gasket and matching
temperature. surface if damaged.
Oil gasket wrongly installed. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Gasket edge cut or scored.
intervals.
Contaminated lubricant.

Excessive wear of input Intense use. Replace the flange.


flange spline.
Pinion nut loose. Check that the pinion spline is not
excessively worn out.
Pinion axial backlash.
Replace bevel gear, if necessary.

Pinion gear tooth fatigue Intense use. Replace bevel gear.


break.
Continuous overload.
Check if the fracture line is
wavy or clearly delineated
(stop line).

Break of pinion teeth and ring Crash load of differential Check and/or replace other
gear teeth. components. differential components.

Splines of planetary gear worn Intense use. Replace differential gear assy.
(excessive backlash).
Replace axle beam, if necessary.

Worn or scored surfaces of Insufficient lubrication. Replace all scratched washers and
the scraper thrust washer. those with a 0.1 mm (0.004 in)
Lubrication wrong.
thickness lower than the new ones.
Contaminated lubricant.
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Inner diameter of pinion Intense use. Replace bearing.


tapered roller bearing worn
Excessive pinion end play. Check pinion axial backlash.
out.
Unsuitable lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Contaminated lubricant.
intervals.

Broken or bent axle beam. Intense vehicle operation, overload. Replace the axle beam.

Broken axle beam at wheel Loose wheel support. Replace the axle beam.
flange.
Bent axle beam body. Check bending of axle beam body.
Ensure that wheel support is not
worn out or wrongly adjusted.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 65

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Noise during travel. Excessive backlash between ring Adjust the backlash between the ring
gear and pinion. gear and the pinion.

Pinion and ring gear worn. Replace pinion and ring gear.

Worn-out pinion bearings Replace pinion bearings.

Loose pinion bearings. Adjust pinion bearings.

Excessive pinion end play. Adjust the axial play of the pinion.

Differential bearings worn out. Replace differential bearings.

Loose differential bearings. Adjust the bearings.

Ring gear excessively off-set. Replace the ring gear.

Low lubricant level. Restore the level.

Poor or wrong lubricant grade. Change lubricant.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Noise during idling. Noises emitted by the axle when the Adjust the backlash between the ring
vehicle is moving are usually heard gear and the pinion or replace pinion
during idling, even though they are and ring gear.
not too loud.

Wrong backlash between pinion and Adjust the play between the pinion
ring gear (the noise heard while and the ring gear.
decelerating disappears when speed
is increased).

Pinion spline or input flange worn. Replace the pinion.

Intermittent noise. Damaged ring gear. Replace bevel gear.

Differential box screws loose. Tighten the screws to torque.

Constant noise. Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Replace bevel gear.
damaged.

Worn bearings. Replace the bearings.

Pinion splines worn. Replace the pinion.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.


66 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Noise while bending. Differential planetary gears Replace the planetary gears.
damaged.

Differential box and/or pins worn. Replace the differential box.

Worn differential thrust washers. Replace the thrust washers.

Worn-out axle beam splines Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 67

REPAIR TIMES
The times are referred to average values of mainte-
nance performed by skilled personnel in workshops
equipped with all necessary fixtures for a proper
execution of the required works.
The repair and/or replacement times are indicated in
minutes.
We assume that the axle has already been removed
from the machine.

ASSY OPERATION TIME (minutes)


Connection flange Pinion sealing ring 30
Replacement / overhauling of wheel flange (x 1) 240
Replacement of wheel hub with ring gear (x 1) 240
Wheel hub Replacement of bearings and wheel hub seal ring (x 1) 210
O-ring replacement (x 1) 30
Gear carrier assy replacement (x 1) 50
Replacement of discs and counterdiscs and zero setting of
40
self-adjust (for each side)
Overhauling / replacement of brake piston seals (x 1) 90
Brake
Overhauling / replacement of brake cylinder (for each side) 105
Self-adjust replacement (for each side) 60
Axle shaft replacement (x 1) 30
Differential bearing replacement 180
Differential support
Bevel gear / differential replacement 150
Differential Differential gear replacement 240
Differential locking O-ring / piston replacement 30
Pinion Pinion bearings replacement 180
68 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH DESCRIPTION USE

380002211 Handle To be used with the various pushers and buffers

380000021 Wrench Screw / unscrew the pinion ring nut

380200187 False differential box Differential and pinion assembly

380002215 Buffer Pinion bearing cups assembly

380000020 Wrench Measure of pinion rolling torque

380002222 Buffer Wheel hub seal ring and bearing assembly

380200200 Buffer Pinion bearing cups assembly

380200202 False pinion Differential and pinion assembly

380200204 Buffer Assembly of pinion bearings

380200211 Buffer Wheel hub seal ring and bearing assembly

380200218 Buffer Assembly of bearing cups into the differential box

380200228 Drift Pinion seal ring assembly

380200237 Tool Measure of pinion preload

380200243 Wrench Screw / unscrew the pinion ring nuts

380200244 Wrench Screw / unscrew the wheel hub ring nuts

380200245 Buffer Assembly / disassembly of self-adjust kit

380200254 Buffer Wheel hub seal ring and bearing assembly

380200255 Buffer Assembly of bearings into gears

380200259 Plunger Assembly / disassembly of differential locking yoke

380200260 Guide Assembly / disassembly of differential locking yoke


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 69

2WS REAR AXLE


(B110B - B110BTC)

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
70 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Manufacturer CARRARO
Model 28.50
Bevel gear reduction ratio 2.75/1
Epicyclic gear ratio 6.40/1
Total reduction ratio 17.6/1
Input rotation clockwise
472 kg
Dry weight
(1040 lb)
Differential type Mechanical and driven
12 ÷ 35 bar
Pressure for differential lock
(174 ÷ 508 psi)
0.20 ÷ 0.35 mm
Bevel gear set backlash
(0.008 ÷ 0.014 in)
Pinion bearing preload (*) FPm = 10.0 ÷ 12.0 daN
(measured on Ø = 39.7 mm (1.56 in) without seal ring) (22.48 ÷ 26.98 lbf)
Ring gear-pinion bearing total preload (*) FTm = (FPm + 2.76) ÷ (FPm + 4.16) daN
(measured on Ø = 39.7 mm (1.56 in) without seal ring) [FTm = (FPm + 6.20) ÷ (FPm + 9.35) lbf]
MPm = 2.0 ÷ 2.4 Nm
Pinion bearing rolling torque (*) measured without seal ring
(MPm = 1.47 ÷ 1.77 lbf·ft)
Total pinion-ring gear bearing rolling torque (*) measured MTm = (MPm + 0.55) ÷ (MPm + 0.83) Nm
without seal ring [MTm = (MPm + 0.40) ÷ (MPm + 0.61) lbf·ft]

(*) Only for new bearings

SERVICE BRAKE

Brake type Wet disc brake


Brake operating temperature -20 °C ÷ 150 °C (-4 ÷ 5.9 °F)
Maximum operating pressure 55 bar (798 psi)
Oil displacement for brake actuation (each side) 16 cm3 (0.98 in3)

A. New counterdisc thickness = 8.0 ± 0.05 mm


(0.31 ± 0.002 in)
B. New friction disc thickness = 6.73 ± 0.1 mm
(0.26 ± 0.004 in)
Worn disc minimum thickness = 5.8 mm (0.23 in)
C. New counterdisc thickness = 5.0 ± 0.05 mm
(0.20 ± 0.002 in)
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 71

LUBRICATION AND GREASING

Oil capacity (differential) 15.5 litres (3.41 gal)


Oil type Ambra TRX 80W -140 NH600 / TR

1. Level and fill plug for differential oil


2. Differential oil drain plug
3. Oil breather
4. Oil drain plug
5. Brake breather
72 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Before draining the oil from the axle body, use the
breather (3) to release any possible internal pres-
sure.

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

To drain the oil from the central body remove the


level plug (1) and the drain plug (2).

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

Drain all oil.


Clean the plug (2), screw it and tighten to the pre-
scribed torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).
Fill through the hole of the plug (1).
Check the level and, if necessary, top up.
Clean the plug (2), screw it and tighten to the pre-
scribed torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 73

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Lower the loader attachment to the ground.
Use the locking pin (if provided) to lock the loader
attachment controls.
Lower the backhoe attachment to the ground.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Lower the stabilizers until the rear wheels are
slightly lifted from the ground (they are free from
machine weight).
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key to
ON and release the pressure by moving the hydrau-
lic control levers in all directions.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Fasten the rear axle to a lifting hoist or to a support.
Now it is possible to carry out the disassembly of
the 2 rear tyres by loosening and removing the
relevant fixing nuts (9) [tightening torque = 700 Nm
(516 lbf·ft)].
Disconnect the cardan joint (6) by unlocking and
removing the screws (7) and the bracket (8).
Unscrew and remove the screws (4) with the nuts
(2) and the washers (3) and (5) [tightening torque =
610 ÷ 678 Nm (445 ÷ 500 lbf·ft)].
Remove the rear axle (1).
74 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Some of the following pictures could not exactly
show your axle, but the procedure is correct.

TIGHTENING TORQUES AND APPLICATION OF SEALANTS / ADHESIVES


A. Loctite 510
B. Loctite 270
C. Loctite 638
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 75

GREASE POINTS
76 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FRONT FLANGE

Disassembly
Remove the stop ring (1) and the front flange (2).
Collect shim (4) and the O-ring (3).

Take out the seal ring (5) from the central body (6).

S WARNING S
The seal ring can be damaged.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 77

If necessary, remove protection (7) from the front


flange (2).

Assembly
On the front flange (2), assemble the protection (7)
using tool 380200277.

Use tool 380200277 to assemble the protection (7)


on the front flange (2).

Insert a new seal ring (5) into the central body (6)
using tool 380200276.
78 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Use tool 380200276 to fit the seal ring (5) into the
central body (6).

Grease the O-ring (3).


Insert the washer (4), the O-ring (3) and the front
flange (2) into the pinion.
Fasten the pieces as soon as assembled by fitting
the snap ring (1).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 79

BRAKES

Disassembly
Drain the oil completely from the differential.

Loosen and remove all screws (1) except for 2 as a


safety measure.
80 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Connect the wheel hub (2) to a lifting device and


tension the rope.
Insert 2 opposed threaded rods to enable removal.

Remove the 2 last screws (1) and separate the


wheel hub assy (2) from the axle body (3).

Slowly remove the wheel hub assy and the half axle
(4), make sure that the discs (5) and the counter-
discs (6) stay on the wheel hub assy.

Place the wheel hub assy vertically and mark the


counterdisc (5) assembled to the axle body side (3).
Remove the discs (6), the counterdiscs (5) and the
dowel pins (7).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 81

Remove the half axle (4) from the wheel hub assy
(2).

Remove the screws (8) and the belleville washers


(9) from the brake cylinder (10).

Check screws (8) and belleville washers (9) for


damage.
NOTE: if brake discs are replaced, also replace
screws and springs.

Remove the snap ring (11) and the self adjust kit
assy (12).
82 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Place the self adjust kit (12) on tool 380200245 and


remove the snap rings (13).

Check bushing (14) for wear.


Repeat the procedure for the remaining 2 self
adjust kits.

Remove the brake cylinder assy (10).

Remove the brake piston (15) from the brake cylin-


der (10).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 83

Remove the O-rings (16) and (17) from the brake


cylinder (10).

Remove the O-ring (18) from the brake piston (15).

Remove the O-ring (19).


84 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assembly
Assemble the new O-ring (19).

Assemble the O-ring (18) onto the brake piston


(15).

Assemble the O-rings (16) and (17) onto the brake


cylinder (10).

Lubricate the O-rings (16), (17) and (18).


Assemble the brake piston (15) into the brake cylin-
der (10).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 85

Lubricate the seat of the brake cylinder on the


wheel hub (2) and assemble the dowel pins (7).

Assemble the brake cylinder assy (10) and remove


the dowel pins (7).

Place the bushing (14) into the tool 380200245 pay-


ing attention to direct it with the chamfer edge
upwards.

Assemble the snap rings (13) by turning them by


90° with respect to the ring mounted before.
86 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the snap rings (13) until they are seated


against the calibrated disc and using a drift
380200245.
Repeat the procedure for the remaining 2 self
adjust kits.

Assemble the self adjust kits (12) into the brake cyl-
inder, paying attention to direct the chamfer edge of
the bushing (14) upwards.

Assemble the snap rings (11).


Make sure that the teeth of the snap ring are
directed towards the self adjust kit.

Snap ring (11) orientation.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 87

Assemble the belleville washers (9) on the screws


(8) paying attention to orientate them correctly.

Assemble the screws (8) and the belleville washers


(9).
Tighten the screws (8) to a tightening torque of
15.3 Nm (11 lbf·ft).
Make sure that the 4 belleville washers are correctly
aligned before tightening the screws.

Assemble half shaft (4) and the dowel pins (7).

Using the reference mark made during disassem-


bly, assemble the counterdisc (5) paying attention to
direct it with the mark towards the axle body (3).
88 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the first braking disc (6) and the counter-


disc (5).
If using new brake discs (6), they must be soaked in
oil for at least 24 hours prior to installation.

Assemble the last brake disc (6) and make sure that
its slots are aligned with those of the first disc.

Connect the wheel hub (2) to a lifting device and


assemble it on the beam (3).
Support and turn the axle beam (4), while pushing
the wheel hub onto it.

Screw in screws (1) applying the prescribed seal-


ant and tighten to tightening torque of 226 Nm
(167 lbf·ft).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 89

WHEEL HUB

Disassembly
Remove the brake assy.

If disassembly of the planetary gear carrier for over-


hauling is not necessary, use a bearing puller to lift
the planetary gear carrier assy.
90 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Enlarge the snap ring (2) and simultaneously


extract the gear carrier (1).

If necessary, remove the snap rings (3) and by


means of a puller the gears (4) with the bearings (5)
from the gear carrier (1).
NOTE: the bearing (5) cannot be removed from the
gear (4).
If one gear must be replaced, replace the whole
pair.

Unscrew and remove the ring nut (6) fastening the


ring gear retaining hub using tool 380200244.

Separate the hub (7) from the wheel flange (8) with
a puller.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 91

Connect the hub (7) to a hoisting tool to remove it.


Collect the bearing (9).

Remove the bearing cup (9) from the wheel hub (7).

Remove the seal ring (10) from the wheel hub (7).

Remove the bearing cup (11) from the wheel hub


(7).
92 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the spacer (12) from the wheel flange (8).

To remove the bearing (11), use a disc grinder to cut


the cage and to engrave the ring.
Then use a chisel to cut and to remove the ring.

Assembly
Assemble the bearing cup (11) onto wheel hub (7)
with the buffer 380200211.
Assemble the bearing cup (9) with the buffer
380002222.
Assemble the seal ring (10) on the wheel hub (7)
with the buffer 380200254.

Use tool 380200254 (T) for the assembly of the seal


ring (10) on the wheel hub (7).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 93

Assemble the bearing (11) onto wheel flange (8)


with a press.

Place the spacer (12) on the wheel flange (8).

Connect the wheel hub (7) to a lifting device and


place it on the wheel flange (8).
Clean the sealing surface of the flange.
Pay attention not to damage the seal ring (10).

Assemble the bearing (9) and the ring nut (6).


94 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Screw in and tighten the ring nut (6) with tool


380200244 at tightening torque of 1000 Nm
(738 lbf·ft).

Assemble the bearing (5) with tool 380200255 (T).

Assemble the gears (4) and the snap rings (3) on


the gear carrier (1).
Ensure that the chamfer of the bearings (5) is
directed towards the gear carrier (1).

Connect the gear carrier (1) to a hoisting tool to


remove it.
Lift it and then place it on the wheel hub (7).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 95

Orientate the gear carrier so that the tooth engages


into the ring nut (6).

In order to simplify the installation, align the hole on


the gear carrier with the ring nut (6).
NOTE: it may take several attempts to find the right
combination of alignment between teeth and hole of
the gear carrier and the ring nut, to get the locking
tooth to engage.

Enlarge the snap ring (2) to complete the gear car-


rier (1) assembly.
96 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

DIFFERENTIAL SUPPORT ASSY

Disassembly
Drain the oil completely from the differential.

Loosen and remove the screws (1).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 97

Separate the axle support (3) from the axle body (2)
using pry bars in slots.

Connect the differential support (3) to a lifting


device to remove it.

Measure the rolling torque MT0 of the bearings (pin-


ion-ring gear system), using wrench 380200269.
Note value MT0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.
NOTE: the total rolling torque must be determined
without the pinion seal ring.

It is possible to measure the total starting preload


FT0 of the bearings (pinion-ring gear system) using
a dynamometer whose cord is wound on the end of
the pinion shaft.
Note value FT0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.
98 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Unscrew and remove the screws (4) fastening the


ring nuts (5) and (6).

Unscrew the ring nuts (5) and (6) using tool


380200243.

Remove the differential box (7).


The bearings cups (8) and (9) have to be removed
together with the differential box.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 99

Assembly
Assemble the bearing cups (8) and (9) on the differ-
ential box (7) with drift 380200218.

Assemble the differential box (7) with bearings onto


the differential support (3).

Tighten both ring nuts (5) and (6) with special tool
380200243, till the backlash is eliminated and the
bearings are slightly preloaded.
Check that the bearings are correctly seated.

Position a magnetic-base dial gauge on the differ-


ential support, so that the feeler touches the surface
of one tooth of the ring gear with a 90° angle.
100 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Lock the pinion and alternately move the ring gear,


and note the backlash between pinion and ring
gear, measured with the dial gauge.
Repeat the operation on two or more points (teeth),
rotating the ring gear, so that to obtain an average
value.
Check if the measured backlash value is within the
requested range:
0.20 ÷ 0.35 mm (0.008 ÷ 0.014 in)
Carry out the adjustment by operating on the ring
nuts (5) and (6) with tool 380200243.

Adjust the ring nuts (5) and (6), remembering that:


- if the measured backlash is less than the pre-
scribed tolerance range, unscrew the ring nut (6)
and screw in the ring nut (5) by the same meas-
ure;
- if the measured backlash is more than the pre-
scribed tolerance range, unscrew the ring nut (5)
and screw in the ring nut (6) by the same meas-
ure.

Repeat the whole sequence of the above men-


tioned operations until the requested conditions are
reached.

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have not been replaced,
measure the total preload FTm of the bearings (pin-
ion-ring gear system), using a dynamometer whose
cord is wound on the end of the pinion shaft.
Use this method only if the bearings are already run
in.
The measured value FTm should be within the fol-
lowing range:
FTm = FT0 ÷ (FT0 + 10) N
[FTm = FT0 ÷ (FT0 + 2.25) lbf]
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 101

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have not been replaced,
measure the total rolling torque MTm of the bearings
(pinion-ring gear system) with a torque meter and
the special wrench 380200269.
The measured value MTm should be the same of
the starting:
MTm = MT0

If the bearings have been replaced, measure the


total preload FTm of the bearings (pinion-ring gear
system), using a dynamometer whose cord is
wound on tool 380200272 inserted on the pinion
splined end.

The total preload FTm is measured by tool


380200272.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FTm = (FPm + 9.2) ÷ (FPm + 13.8) N
[FTm = (FPm + 2.07) ÷ (FPm + 3.10) lbf]
where FPm is the actual preload measured on tool
380200272 [gauge diameter Dm = 119.1 mm
(4.69 in)].

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have been replaced, meas-
ure the total rolling torque MTm of the bearings (pin-
ion-ring gear system) with a torque meter and the
wrench 380200269.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.
102 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

If the measure is not within the requested range,


check the assembly of each component and oper-
ate on the ring nuts (5) and (6) of the differential
support:
- if the total preload is less than the given range,
screw on the ring nuts (5) and (6) by the same
measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear backlash
value unchanged;
- if the total preload is less than the given range,
screw on the ring nuts (5) and (6) with the same
measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear backlash
value unchanged.

NOTE: To test the marks of the bevel gear teeth,


paint the ring gear with red lead paint.
The contact mark test should always be carried out
on the ring gear teeth and on both sides.

OK -> Correct contact:


If the bevel gear is well adjusted, the mark on the
teeth surfaces will be regular.
Z -> Excessive contact on the tooth tip:
approach the pinion to the ring bevel gear and then
move the ring bevel gear away from the pinion in
order to adjust the backlash.
X -> Excessive contact at the tooth base:
move the pinion away from the ring bevel gear and
then approach the ring bevel gear to the pinion in
order to adjust the backlash.

Movements to correct:
1 -> move the pinion for type X contact adjustment;
2 -> move the pinion for type Z contact adjustment.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 103

Once all the adjustment operations have been com-


pleted, fit the ring nuts (5) and (6) by tightening the
screws (4).
Tighten the screws (4) to a tightening torque of 10 Nm
(7.4 lbf·ft).

Before matching worked surfaces, make sure they


are perfectly clean, if not, clean with proper deter-
gents.
Apply a film of sealant on the contact surface of the
axle body (2) and the differential support.

Place the differential support (3) on the axle body


(2).

Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening


torque of 169 Nm (125 lbf·ft).
104 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

DIFFERENTIAL LOCKING ASSY

Disassembly
Loosen plug (1) without removing it.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 105

Push the yoke (2) downwards using the differential


support as a retainer.
Remove the plug (1).

Insert the tool 380200259.

Remove the snap ring (5).


Remove the tool 380200259.

Remove the bushing (6).


106 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the plug (7).

Remove the springs (4) and (8) and the spacer (9).

Extract the rod assy (3) from the differential support.

Remove the O-ring (10) from the plug (1).


Remove the O-rings (12) and (13) from the piston
(11).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 107

Remove the O-ring (14) from the plug (7).

Assembly
Assemble the O-ring (14) on the plug (7).

Assemble the O-rings (12) and (13) onto the piston


(11).
Assemble the O-ring (10) on the plug (1).
Lubricate the O-rings.

Assemble the rod (3) and the yoke (2) in the differ-
ential support.
NOTE: orientate the rod (3) with the outer groove
(A) directed towards the yoke (2).
108 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Insert the springs (4) and (8) and the spacer (9).

Screw in and tighten the plug (1) to the prescribed


torque of 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft).

Assemble the bushing (6).

Insert the tool 380200259 (T1).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 109

Assemble the snap ring (5) with tool 380200260


(T2).
Remove tools 380200259 (T1) and 380200260
(T2).

Push the yoke (2) downwards using the differential


support as a retainer.
Screw in the plug (1) by hand.

Tighten the plug (1) to the prescribed torque of 30 Nm


(22 lbf·ft).
110 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

DIFFERENTIAL

Disassembly
Loosen and remove the screws (1).
Remove the ring gear (2).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 111

If necessary, replace the differential bearings.


Remove the bearing cups (3) and (4).
Remove the sleeve (5).

Remove the snap ring (6).

Take out the cover (7) and collect the anti-rotation


pin (8) and the ring (9).

Remove the gear (10).


112 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the dowels (11).

Take out the pins (12).

Slip off pin (13) until the gear is free (14).

Assemble the gear (14) and the relevant shoulder


ring (15).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 113

Remove the pin (13), the gear (16) and the relevant
shoulder ring (17).

Pull out partially the pins (18) and remove the


spacer (19).

Remove the pins (18), the gears (20) and the rele-
vant shoulder rings (21).

Remove the gear (22) and the relevant ring (23).


114 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the pins (25) locking the differential box


(24).

Assembly
Assemble the O-rings (26) on the pins (25).

Assemble the pins (25) into the differential box (24).

Assemble the gear (22) and the relevant ring (23).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 115

Assemble the gears (20) and the relevant shoulder


rings (21). Insert pins (18) far enough to hold them.
NOTE: orientate the flats on the pins facing up.

Assemble the spacer (19) and the pins (18), make


sure to align the pin holes with those of the differen-
tial box (24).

Assemble the gear (16) and the relevant shoulder


ring (17).
Insert pin (13).
Orientate the pin (13) with the flat facing up.

Assemble the gear (14) and the relevant shoulder


ring (15) and insert the pin (13) and make sure to
align the pin hole with that of the differential box
(24).
116 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Insert the pins (12).


Screw in and tighten the plugs (11) to the pre-
scribed torque of 25 Nm (18.4 lbf·ft).

Assemble the gear (10).

Apply a thin film of grease on the cover (7) and


assemble the ring (9).

Assemble the anti-rotation pin (8) on the cover (7).


Assemble the cover (7) onto the differential box.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 117

Lock the cover (7) with the snap ring (6).

Assemble the sleeve (5) and make sure that it seats


correctly.
NOTE: to ease the fitting, turn the gear (22).

Assemble the bearing cups (3) and (4) with drift


380200218.
Take care not to mix the bearing cups.

Assemble the ring gear (2).


Apply some sealant and tighten the screws (1) to
the prescribed torque of 190 Nm (140 lbf·ft).
118 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

PINION ASSY

Disassembly
Measure the starting preload FP0 of the pinion bear-
ings using a dynamometer whose cord is wound on
the end of the pinion shaft.

S WARNING S
Note value FP0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.

Measure the rolling torque MP0 of the bearings,


using a torque wrench and tool 380200269.

S WARNING S
Note value MP0 that is necessary for assembling
the bearings.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 119

Lock the differential assy in a vice.


Unscrew the ring nut (1) using special tools
380200268 and 380200269.
NOTE: this operation will irretrievably damage the
lock nut (1).

Remove the ring nut (1) and collect its washer (2).

Tap the shaft end with a soft hammer to remove the


pinion (3).
Collect the washers (4) and (5), the spacer (6) and
the bearing (7).

Remove the bearing cups (7) and (8) from the differ-
ential support (9) using a buffer and a hammer.
120 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the bearing (8) from the pinion (3) by


means of a puller.
Collect the shim (10).

Check the conditions of all pinion parts.


The ring nut (1) and the spacer (6) must be
replaced during assembly.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 121

Assembly
Place the differential support (9) on a workbench.
Insert the bearing cups (7) and (8) with the buffer
380200274 and a hammer.

Insert the bearings (7) and (8) into the relevant


seats.
Assemble the false pinion kit 380200273 (a1) and
the ring nut (1).
Tighten without exceeding the ring nut, until the
backlash is eliminated.

Assemble tool 380200187 (T) on the differential box


seats (9).

Use a depth gauge to measure dimension “X” (dis-


tance between bearing axis of differential box and
leaning point of pinion head or bearing base).
122 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

To adjust the bevel gear measure the distance “A”


with a depth gauge.
Determine the value “X” as follows:
X = (A + C) - B mm (in)
where “B” and “C” are known values.

In order to determine the value (S) of the shim to be


placed between pinion and bearing, subtract from
the measured value (X) the value (V) engraved on
pinion head (V = prescribed distance).
S = (X - V) mm (in)

Select the shim (10) with value (S) from the range
of available shims, and fit it onto the shaft end under
the pinion head.
NOTE: orientate the shim (10) with chamfered end
towards the pinion head (3).

SHIM RANGE
Shims
2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 3.0 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4
mm (0.098) (0.102) (0.106) (0.110) (0.114) (0.118) (0.122) (0.126) (0.130) (0.134)
(in)
Q.ty - - - - - - - - - -

Remove tool 380200187 from the seats (9) of the


differential box.
Disassemble the ring nut, the spacer, the false pin-
ion 380200273 and the bearings (7) and (8).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 123

Once you have chosen the suitable shim (10), insert


it on the pinion shaft with the chamfer against the
pinion head.

Insert the bearing (8) on the pinion (3) using a press


and a buffer 380200220.

Insert the pinion (3) into the differential box (9).


Insert the shims (4) and (5) and the spacer (6).

Check the right assembly sequence.


124 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble bearing (7) on pinion shaft, using buffer


380200220 and a hammer.

Insert the washer (2) and tighten the new ring nut
(1) on the pinion shaft.
Lubricate the ring nut thread (1) and the supporting
face with the washer (2) with oil.

Screw in the ring nut (1) using the wrench for ring
nut 380200268 and the pinion retainer 380200269.

S WARNING S
The tightening torque is given by the measure of
the preload on bearings (7) and (8); gradually
tighten the ring nut (1).

NOTE: if the tightening is excessive, the spacer (6)


must be replaced and the procedure repeated.
When you check the preload, strike the pinion end
(3) with a soft hammer to favour the bearings (7)
and (8) settlement.

If the bearings have not been replaced, to measure


the preload FPm of the bearings (7) and (8), use a
dynamometer whose cord is wound on the end of
pinion shaft (3).

S WARNING S
Use this method only if the bearings are not to be
replaced, otherwise go to next step.

The measured value should be within the following


range:
FPm = FP0 ÷ (FP0 + 10) N
[FPm = FP0 ÷ (FP0 + 2.25) lbf]
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 125

If the bearings have not been replaced, it is possible


to measure the rolling torque MPm of the bearings
(7) and (8), using a torque wrench and tool
380200269.
NOTE: use this method only if the bearings are not
replaced.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.

The measured value should be the same of the


starting:
MPm = MP0
If the bearings (7) and (8) are new, to measure the
preload FPm of the bearings, use a dynamometer
whose cord is wound on tool 380200272, inserted
on the end of pinion shaft.

The actual preload FPm is measured on tool


380200272 [gauge diameter Dm = 119.1 mm
(4.69 in)].
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 33.3 ÷ 40 N
(FPm = 7.49 ÷ 8.99 lbf)

S WARNING S
Values for new bearings.

In case you do not use the prescribed tool to meas-


ure the preload, the reference diameter is the diam-
eter of pinion shaft splined end.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 100 ÷ 120 N
(FPm = 22.48 ÷ 2.02 lbf)
126 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

If the bearings are new, measure the rolling torque


MPm of the pinion shaft bearings with a torque
meter and the wrench 380200269.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.

The measured value MPm should be within the fol-


lowing range:
MPm = 1.6 ÷ 2.4 Nm
(MPm = 1.18 ÷ 1.77 lbf·ft)

Once the prescribed preload value is achieved,


caulk the ring nut (1) using a hammer and a punch.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 127

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Wheel vibrations. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair the axle.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Tyre resistance. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Broken axle shaft. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Difficult steering; the machine Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


travels in a straight line while
steering. Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


128 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

No differential action; jams Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


during steering.
Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Excessive noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Excessive wear of the tyre. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Differential locked. Check the installation.

Excessive steering angle. Reduce the steering angle.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Friction noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Damaged or worn axle parts. Replace the damaged axle parts.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Incorrect adjustment of the bevel Adjust the bevel gear set.


gear set.

Vibrations during travel. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 129

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Outer tip of ring gear tooth is Excessive gear load compared to Replace bevel gear.
broken. the one expected. Follow carefully recommended
Gear adjustment wrong (excessive adjustment operations of ring gear
backlash). and pinion backlash and of tooth
marks detection.
Pinion nut loose.

Inner tip of ring gear tooth is Crash load. Replace bevel gear.
broken.
Gear adjustment wrong (insufficient Follow carefully recommended
backlash). adjustment operations of ring gear
and pinion backlash and of tooth
Pinion nut loose.
marks detection.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Insufficient lubrication. Replace bevel gear.
damaged or scored. Contaminated lubricant. Replace worn out pinion bearings
that cause an incorrect pinion axle
Incorrect lubrication or poor
backlash and wrong contact
additives.
between pinion and ring gear.
Worn out pinion bearings that cause
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
an incorrect pinion axle backlash
level and replace at recommended
and wrong contact between pinion
intervals.
and ring gear.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Prolonged operation at high Replace bevel gear.
overheated. Check if gear temperature. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
teeth have faded. Unsuitable lubricant. level and replace at recommended
intervals.
Oil level low.
Contaminated lubricant.

Drive pinion teeth pitted. Extremely intense use. Replace bevel gear.
Insufficient lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Bent axle beam body. Machine overloaded. Replace the axle beam body.
Damaged vehicle.
Crash load.

Bearings worn or pitted. Insufficient lubrication. Replace the bearings.


Contaminated lubricant. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Extremely intense use.
intervals.
Normal wear.
Pinion nut loose.
130 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Gaskets leak oil. Prolonged operation at excessive oil Replace the gasket and matching
temperature. surface if damaged.
Oil gasket wrongly installed. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Gasket edge cut or scored.
intervals.
Contaminated lubricant.

Excessive wear of input Intense use. Replace the flange.


flange spline.
Pinion nut loose. Check that the pinion spline is not
excessively worn out.
Pinion axial backlash.
Replace bevel gear, if necessary.

Pinion gear tooth fatigue Intense use. Replace bevel gear.


break.
Continuous overload.
Check if the fracture line is
wavy or clearly delineated
(stop line).

Break of pinion teeth and ring Crash load of differential Check and/or replace other
gear teeth. components. differential components.

Splines of planetary gear worn Intense use. Replace differential gear assy.
(excessive backlash).
Replace axle beam, if necessary.

Worn or scored surfaces of Insufficient lubrication. Replace all scratched washers and
the scraper thrust washer. those with a 0.1 mm (0.004 in)
Lubrication wrong.
thickness lower than the new ones.
Contaminated lubricant.
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Inner diameter of pinion Intense use. Replace bearing.


tapered roller bearing worn
Excessive pinion end play. Check pinion axial backlash.
out.
Unsuitable lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Contaminated lubricant.
intervals.

Broken or bent axle beam. Intense vehicle operation, overload. Replace the axle beam.

Broken axle beam at wheel Loose wheel support. Replace the axle beam.
flange.
Bent axle beam body. Check bending of axle beam body.
Ensure that wheel support is not
worn out or wrongly adjusted.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 131

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Noise during travel. Excessive backlash between ring Adjust the backlash between the ring
gear and pinion. gear and the pinion.

Pinion and ring gear worn. Replace pinion and ring gear.

Worn-out pinion bearings Replace pinion bearings.

Loose pinion bearings. Adjust pinion bearings.

Excessive pinion end play. Adjust the axial play of the pinion.

Differential bearings worn out. Replace differential bearings.

Loose differential bearings. Adjust the bearings.

Ring gear excessively off-set. Replace the ring gear.

Low lubricant level. Restore the level.

Poor or wrong lubricant grade. Change lubricant.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Noise during idling. Noises emitted by the axle when the Adjust the backlash between the ring
vehicle is moving are usually heard gear and the pinion or replace pinion
during idling, even though they are and ring gear.
not too loud.

Wrong backlash between pinion and Adjust the play between the pinion
ring gear (the noise heard while and the ring gear.
decelerating disappears when speed
is increased).

Pinion spline or input flange worn. Replace the pinion.

Intermittent noise. Damaged ring gear. Replace bevel gear.

Differential box screws loose. Tighten the screws to torque.

Constant noise. Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Replace bevel gear.
damaged.

Worn bearings. Replace the bearings.

Pinion splines worn. Replace the pinion.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.


132 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Noise while bending. Differential planetary gears Replace the planetary gears.
damaged.

Differential box and/or pins worn. Replace the differential box.

Worn differential thrust washers. Replace the thrust washers.

Worn-out axle beam splines Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 133

REPAIR TIMES
The times are referred to average values of mainte-
nance performed by skilled personnel in workshops
equipped with all necessary fixtures for a proper
execution of the required works.
The repair and/or replacement times are indicated in
minutes.
We assume that the axle has already been removed
from the machine.

ASSY OPERATION TIME (minutes)


Connection flange Pinion sealing ring 30
Replacement / overhauling of wheel flange (x 1) 240
Replacement of wheel hub with ring gear (x 1) 240
Wheel hub Replacement of bearings and wheel hub seal ring (x 1) 210
O-ring replacement (x 1) 30
Gear carrier assy replacement (x 1) 50
Replacement of discs and counterdiscs and zero setting of
40
self-adjust (for each side)
Overhauling / replacement of brake piston seals (x 1) 90
Brake
Overhauling / replacement of brake cylinder (for each side) 105
Self-adjust replacement (for each side) 60
Axle shaft replacement (x 1) 30
Differential bearing replacement 180
Differential support
Bevel gear / differential replacement 150
Differential Differential gear replacement 240
Differential locking O-ring / piston replacement 30
Pinion Pinion bearings replacement 180
134 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH DESCRIPTION USE

380002211 Handle To be used with the various pushers and buffers

380200268 Wrench Screw / unscrew the pinion ring nut

380200187 False differential box Differential and pinion assembly

380002222 Buffer Wheel hub seal ring and bearing assembly

380200269 Wrench Measure of pinion rolling torque

380200211 Buffer Wheel hub seal ring and bearing assembly

380200218 Buffer Assembly of bearing cups into the differential box

380200220 Buffer Assembly of pinion bearings

380200272 Tool Measure of pinion preload

380200273 False pinion Differential and pinion assembly

380200274 Buffer Assembly of bearings into the differential box

380200243 Wrench Screw / unscrew the pinion ring nuts

380200244 Wrench Screw / unscrew the wheel hub ring nuts

380200245 Buffer Assembly / disassembly of self-adjust kit

380200276 Buffer Assembly of seal ring into front flange

380200254 Buffer Disassembly of bearings and wheel hub seal ring

380200277 Buffer Assembly of protection onto front flange

380200255 Buffer Assembly of bearings into gears

380200259 Plunger Assembly / disassembly of differential locking yoke

380200260 Guide Assembly / disassembly of differential locking yoke


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 135

4WS REAR AXLE


(B115B)

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
136 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Manufacturer CARRARO
Model 26.32M
Maximum steering angle 21° 0-1
Toe-in A±1
Bevel gear reduction ratio 2.750/1
Epicyclic gear ratio 6.923/1
Total reduction ratio 19.038/1
Input rotation clockwise
538 kg
Dry weight
(1186 lb)
Differential type Limited slip or open
0.15 ÷ 0.30 mm
Bevel gear set backlash
(0.006 ÷ 0.012 in)
Pinion bearing preload (*) FP = 92 ÷ 138 N
(measured on Ø = 34.8 mm without seal ring) (FP = 21 ÷ 31 lbf)
Ring gear-pinion bearing total preload (*) FT = (FP + 33.4) ÷ (FP + 50.2) N
(measured on Ø = 34.8 mm without seal ring) [FT = (FP + 7.5) ÷ (FP + 11.29) lbf]
MP = 1.6 ÷ 2.4 Nm
Pinion bearing rolling torque (*) measured without seal ring
(MP = 1.18 ÷ 1.77 lbf·ft)
Total pinion-ring gear bearing rolling torque (*) measured without MT = (MP + 0.58) ÷ (MP + 0.87) Nm
seal ring [MT = (MP + 0.43) ÷ (MP + 0.64) lbf·ft]

(*) Only for new bearings


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 137

SERVICE BRAKE

Brake type Wet disc brake


Brake actuation Hydraulic
Brake operating temperature -25 °C ÷ 150 °C (-13 ÷ 5.9 °F)
Maximum operating pressure Mineral oil
Oil displacement for brake actuation (each side) 14 cm3 (0.85 in3)

Standard brake discs


A. New counterdisc thickness = 5.0 ± 0.05 mm
(0.20 ± 0.002 in)
B. New friction disc thickness = 4.8 ± 0.05 mm
(0.19 ± 0.002 in)
Worn disc minimum thickness = 4.0 mm (0.16 in)
C. New counterdisc thickness = 8.9 ÷ 9.0 mm
(0.350 ÷ 0.354 in)

“Limited slip” brake discs


A. New counterdisc thickness = 1.3 ± 0.03 mm
(0.051 ± 0.001 in)
B. New friction disc thickness = 1.6 ± 0.03 mm
(0.063 ± 0.001 in)
Worn disc minimum thickness = 1.4 mm (0.055 in)
C. New friction disc thickness = 2.7 ± 0.05 mm
(0.106 ± 0.002 in)
Worn disc minimum thickness = 2.6 ± 0.05 mm
(0.102 ± 0.002 in)
138 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

LUBRICATION AND GREASING

Differential 11 litres (2.42 gal)


Oil capacity
Final drive (each) 1.3 litres (0.28 gal)
Oil type Ambra TRX 80W -140 NH600 / TR

1. Level and fill plug for differential oil


2. Differential oil drain plug
3. Oil breather
4. Filler, level and drain plug for reduction gear oil
5. Greasing points
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 139

Before draining the oil from the axle body, use the
breather (3) to release any possible internal pres-
sure.

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

To drain the oil from the central body remove the


level plug (1) and the drain plug (2).

S WARNING S
Risk of violent oil ejection.

Drain all oil.


Clean, screw and tighten the plug (2).
Fill through the hole of the plug (1).
Check the level and, if necessary, top up.
Clean, screw and tighten the plug (1).

Before draining the oil from the reduction gear, turn


the gear so that the plug (4) is in the highest possi-
ble position [position A].
Partially unscrew the plug (4) to release any possi-
ble internal pressure.
Turn the plug (4) and bring it to its lowest position
[position B].
Remove the plug and drain the oil.
Rotate again to bring the hole of the plug (4) to
check and oil filling position (position C).
Carry out the filling.
Clean, screw in and tighten the plug (4).
140 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Lower the loader attachment to the ground.
Use the locking pin (if provided) to lock the loader
attachment controls.
Lower the backhoe attachment to the ground.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Lower the stabilizers until the rear wheels are
slightly lifted from the ground (they are free from
machine weight).
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key to
ON and release the pressure by moving the hydrau-
lic control levers in all directions.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Fasten the rear axle to a lifting hoist or to a support.
Now it is possible to carry out the disassembly of
the 2 rear tyres by loosening and removing the
relevant fixing nuts (9) [tightening torque = 700 Nm
(516 lbf·ft)].
Disconnect the cardan joint (6) by unlocking and
removing the screws (7) and the bracket (8).
Unscrew and remove the screws (2) with the nuts
(4) and the washers (3) and (5) [tightening torque
= 830 ÷ 970 Nm (612 ÷ 715 lbf·ft)].
Remove the rear axle (1).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 141

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Some of the following pictures could not exactly
show your axle, but the procedure is correct.

TIGHTENING TORQUES AND APPLICATION OF SEALANTS / ADHESIVES


B. Loctite 270
C. Loctite 638
142 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 143

GREASE POINTS

Tecnolube POLYMER 400 grease

grease AGIP GR MU EP2


144 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FRONT FLANGE

Disassembly
Drain oil from the central body.
Remove the snap ring (1) from the pinion shaft (6)
and slip off the front flange (2).

Remove the seal ring (5).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 145

Remove the O-ring (3).


Collect the washer (4).

Assembly
Insert the washer (4) into the pinion shaft.
Assemble and lubricate the new O-ring (3).

Assemble the new seal ring (5) with tool 380200267


and a hammer.

Assemble the seal ring (5) by means of tool


380200267 (T1).
146 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the front flange (2).


Assemble the snap ring (1).
Refill the central body with oil.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 147

STEERING CYLINDER

Disassembly
Loosen and remove the nuts (1) and (14) and slip
off the tie rods (3) and (12) from the swivel housings
(2) and (13).

S WARNING S
Do not damage the end of the threaded pins.

If necessary, replace the nuts (1) and (14).


148 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the clamps (15) and (18).


Disassemble the sensor (17), the connector bracket
(16) and the 2 clamps (15) and (18).

Remove the tie rods (3) and (12) from the cylinder
rods by loosening the nuts (4) and (11), then check
their conditions.
Remove the ball joints (5) and (9).

Loosen and remove the 2 screws (6) and the 2


screws (9).
Take out the bushings (7) by means of a puller.

Remove the steering cylinder (8).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 149

Remove the snap rings (19) and (27) from the


steering cylinder (8).

Push the two cylinder heads (21) and (25) inside


the cylinder.

Collect the 2 snap rings (20) and (26).

Pull out the rod (23) as necessary to collect the cyl-


inder head (25).
NOTE: do not extract the piston from the cylinder
(22).
150 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Push the rod (23) in the opposite direction and


remove it from the cylinder (22) with the head (21).
Extract the head (21) from the rod (23).

Remove and, if necessary, replace all different seal


rings from the rod (23) and from the 2 cylinder
heads (21) and (25).

Assembly
Assemble the seal rings (24) onto the 2 heads (21)
and (25).

Assemble the seal rings (24) onto rod (23).


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 151

Check the proper assembly of the seal rings.

Assemble the 2 heads (21) and (25) with rod (23).

The 2 heads (21) and (25) must be positioned cor-


rectly.

Insert into the cylinder body (22) the pre-assembled


group, consisting of the rod (23) and the 2 cylinder
heads (21) and (25).
152 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Push the cylinder heads (21) and (25) into the cylin-
der body (22).

Insert the 2 snap rings (20) and (26) into the rele-
vant seats in the cylinder body (22).

Pull outward the rod (23) on each side pulling the


cylinder heads (21) and (25) to the end of the
stroke.

Assemble the 2 snap rings (19) and (27) on the


heads (21) and (25).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 153

Check the correct assembly of the heads and snap


rings.

Assemble the steering cylinder (8).

Cool the bushes (7) at a temperature lower


than -100 °C (-148 °F) with liquid nitrogen.
Assemble the bushes (7) by means of a punch and
a hammer.

Screw in and tighten the screws (6) to a tightening


torque of 220 Nm (162 lbf·ft).
Screw in and tighten the screws (9) to a tightening
torque of 660 Nm (487 lbf·ft).
154 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Screw in the ball joints (5) and (10) to the ends of the
rod to the prescribed torque of 300 Nm (221 lbf·ft).
Screw in the nuts (4) and (11) and the tie rods (3)
and (12) to the ball joints (5) and (10).

Align the swivel housing (2) with the axle.


Screw the tie rod (3) so that its ball joint can be
inserted into the swivel housing (2) arm.
It is important to unscrew the nut (4) to carry out this
operation.
Repeat the mentioned operations on the other side.

Insert the ball joint of the tie rod (12) into its seat on
the swivel housing (13).
Screw in and tighten the nut (14) to a tightening
torque of 260 Nm (192 lbf·ft).
Repeat the mentioned operations on the other side.

Screw in the nuts (4) and (11) of the tie rods (3) and
(12) only after the toe-in adjustment has been car-
ried out.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 155

Assemble the sensor (17) and the connector


bracket (16) with the clamps (15) and (18) to the
steering cylinder (8).

Tighten the clamps (7) and (8) only after the toe-in
adjustment has been carried out.
156 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

STEERING SENSOR ADJUSTMENT

S WARNING S
The steering sensor adjustment operations can be
carried out only after toe-in adjustment has been
carried out.

Connect, by means of the relevant connector (C),


the steering sensor (17) to a control device that can
detect the presence of voltage generated by the
sensor. The tool is usually provided with a led that
turns on only when voltage is present.

Respect the steering sensor electric specifications


and the connection diagram.
It is also possible to use a common tester or to con-
nect the steering sensor to the vehicle control
panel.
The picture shows the connector (C) diagram.

Align the wheels to rectilinear driving direction.


Move the steering sensor (17) and relative clamps
to a side of the cylinder.
Fix the clamps (15) and (18) so that they can slide
on the cylinder surface.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 157

Slide horizontally the steering sensor till the led is


on (position “A”) and measure XA dimension,
between the differential support and the rear part of
the sensor shown in the figure.

The red led (L) of the sensor (17) is located as illus-


trated.

Slide horizontally the steering sensor till the led is


on (position “B”) and measure XB dimension,
between the differential support and the rear part of
the sensor.

Move backward the steering sensor for a distance


of (XB - XA)/2 as sown in the figure [maximum toler-
ance ± 1.0 mm (0.04 in)].
158 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Before tightening the hose clamps, check the right


position of the steering sensor (17) in the appropri-
ate seat fixed on the steering cylinder (the steering
sensor must be oriented as shown in the figure).

Position the fastening screws (S) of the 2 hose


clamps (15) and (18).
Tighten the fastening screws (S) to lock the sensor
(17).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 159

REDUCTION GEAR

Disassembly
Unscrew the plug (1) and drain oil from the reduc-
tion gear.

Loosen and remove the 2 fixing screws (2).


160 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the gear carrier (3) from the wheel hub


(10) and remove the relevant O-ring (9).
Position the gear carrier (3) on a workbench and
check its wear conditions.

To carry out any possible replacement of the gears


(6):
- loosen and remove the screw (8) of each gear (6);
- remove the washer (7);
- take out the gears (6) from the pins;
- collect the bearings (5) and check their condi-
tions;
- collect the thrust washer (4).

Assembly
Collect all reduction gear parts: the gear carrier, the
thrust washers (4), the gears (6) with the relevant
needle bearings (5), the washers (7) and the
screws (8).
With new gears (6), it is advisable to assemble new
bearings (5).

Position the planetary gears carrier (3) on a work-


bench.
Insert the needles (5) into the gears (6).
Grease the needles (5).
Insert the pin of the planetary gear carrier (3), the
thrust washer (4) and the gears (6) with needles.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 161

Assemble the washers (7) into the pins of the plane-


tary gear carrier (3).
Screw in and tighten the screws (8) to a tightening
torque of 79 Nm (58 lbf·ft).

Install the new O-ring (9) on the wheel hub (10).

Assemble the reduction gear assy on the wheel


hub.
Screw in and tighten the screws (2) to a tightening
torque of 25 Nm (18.4 lbf·ft).

Refill the epicyclic reduction gear with oil.


Screw in and tighten the plug (1) to the tightening
torque of 60 Nm (44 lbf·ft).
162 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

WHEEL HUB

Disassembly
Insert a lever between the swivel housing and the
axle body and fit it into the double joint.
With the lever push the double joint in the direction
of the wheel hub to allow the snap ring removal.
Do not damage the double joint.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 163

Remove the snap ring (1).


Collect the washer (2) and the thrust washer (3).

Loosen and remove the screws (5).

In order to remove the ring gear carrier hub from its


housing, screw two of the just removed screws (5)
in the threaded extraction holes.
Remove the ring gear carrier hub (7) together with
the ring gear (4).

Remove the snap ring (8) and separate the ring


gear carrier hub (7) from the ring gear (4).
Only if necessary, remove the centering bushes (6)
from the ring gear carrier by means of the tool
380200192 and a hammer.
164 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the wheel hub (11) from the swivel housing


(14) and collect the bearing (9).

Slide out the wheel hub (11), using levers and a


hammer to facilitate the operation.

Position the wheel hub (11) on a flat surface and


remove the seal ring (13).
Take out the bearing cups (9) and (12) with a drift
and a hammer.

Remove the bearing (12) from the swivel housing


(14) by means of a puller.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 165

Unscrew and remove the screws (15) and (19) from


the upper (16) and lower (18) king pins.

S DANGER S
Before removing the king pins (16) and (18), secure
the swivel housing (14) with a rope or a hoist or any
other supporting device to guarantee operator’s
safety.

Remove the king pins (16) and (18).

Loosen and remove the swivel housing (14).

Position the swivel housing (14) on a flat surface


and take the seal ring (25) out with a puller.
Rivet the swivel housing and take out the bronze
bushing (24), using a buffer and a hammer.
166 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assembly
If previously removed, assemble the steering stop
screw (23), the nut (22) and the bushings (20) and
(21).
Do not tighten the nut (22) until the steering angle
adjustment has been carried out.

Insert the bronze bushing (24) into the swivel hous-


ing (14) by means of tool 380000024 and a ham-
mer.
Assemble the new seal ring (25) into the swivel
housing (14) with tool 380200266 and a hammer.

If the ball bearing (17) has been previously


removed, reassemble it to the lower king pin (18) by
means of tool 380200195 under a press.
Grease the king pin seats (16) and (18).
Position the belleville washers (27) and (28) on the
king pin seats (16) and (18).

Secure the swivel housing (14) with a rope to a


hoist or any other supporting device.
Protect the splined end of the axle shaft by winding
it with protective tape, to avoid damaging the seal
ring.
Assemble the swivel housing (14) to the axle and,
after assembly, completely remove the protective
tape.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 167

Assemble the lower (18) and the upper (16) king


pins.
Screw in and tighten the screws (19) and (15) to the
prescribed torque of 300 Nm (221 lbf·ft).
Make sure that the belleville washers stay in the
correct position.

The special operation “Set Right” of the bearings


does not require preload or backlash adjustment.
Anyway, before assembling new components,
check the indicated dimensions.
A = 10.090 ÷ 10.140 mm (0.397 ÷ 0.399 in)
B = 64.275 ÷ 64.325 mm (2.530 ÷ 2.532 in)
C = 27.000 ÷ 27.100 mm (1.063 ÷ 1.066 in)

Insert the bearing cups (9) and (12) into the wheel
hub (11) by means of the tool 380200211 and a
press.
Insert the new seal ring (13) into the wheel hub (11)
using tool 380200210 and a hammer.
Lubricate the seal ring (13).

Assemble the bearing (12) in the swivel housing


(14).
Assemble the wheel hub (11) on the swivel housing
(14) and fit the bearing (9).
168 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Position the ring gear hub (7) on a workbench and


insert the bushings (6) at surface level with tool
380200192.
At least two bushings (diametrically-opposed)
should be set slightly higher than the carrier surface
level to be used as dowel pins.

Preassemble the ring gear carrier hub (7) and the


ring gear (4) with the snap ring (8).

Assemble the ring gear carrier hub assy on the


wheel hub using the two projecting bushings as
dowel pins.
Screw the relevant screws in order to put in contact
the assembly with the wheel hub.

Assemble all bushings (6) up to stroke end with tool


380200192 and a hammer.
Screw in and tighten the screws (5) to a tightening
torque of 230 Nm (170 lbf·ft).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 169

Insert a lever between the swivel housing (14) and


the axle body and fit it into the double joint.
With the lever push the double joint in the direction
of the wheel hub to allow the snap ring introduction.

Insert the thrust washer (3) and the washer (2).


Assemble the snap ring (1) at the end of the splined
hub.
170 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

BEAM ASSY

Disassembly
Drain axle oil completely.
Loosen and remove the two screws (13).
Unscrew the nuts (11) of the oil recirculation line
(12).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 171

Remove the oil recirculation line (12).

If necessary, remove the cover (1) from the double


joint (2).

Remove the double joint (2).

Put alignment marks on the beam trumpets, on the


brake cylinders and on the axle central body, in
order to identify the coupling parts during reassem-
bly.
172 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Position the axle on supports suitable to hold it or


secure the assemblies separately to a lifting device.
Loosen and remove the screws (7).

Remove the beam (8) and the O-ring (9).


If the beam is removed, the brake assy is released.

Extract the seal ring (3).


If necessary, remove the bushing (4), paying atten-
tion not to damage its seat.

If necessary, remove the bushing (5) and the race


(6) of the ball joint from the seats using a puller.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 173

Assembly
Cool down the bushing (5) and the cup (6) to a tem-
perature lower than -100 °C (-148 °F) with liquid
nitrogen.
Assemble the bushing (5) in the upper king pin seat
with buffer 380200196 and a hammer.
Assemble the cup (6) on the lower king pin seat
with buffer 380200196 and a hammer.

Assemble the bushing (4) by means of the tool


380200227 and a hammer.
Assemble a new seal ring (3) by means of tool
380002226.
Lubricate the seal ring.

Orientate correctly the seal ring (3).

Assemble the new O-ring (9) on the beam (8).


174 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Support the assemblies properly as already pointed


out for disassembly phase.
Assemble the beam (8) on the central axle body
(10) respecting the reference marks applied during
disassembly.

Screw in and tighten the screws (7) to a tightening


torque of 320 Nm (236 lbf·ft).

Tighten the screw (7) respecting the sequence


shown.

Insert the double joint (2).


Be careful not to damage the seal ring.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 175

Assemble the oil recirculation line (12).

Screw in and tighten the screws (13) to a tightening


torque of 23 Nm (17 lbf·ft).
Tighten the nuts (11) to the tightening torque of
60 Nm (44 lbf·ft).
176 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

BRAKES

Disassembly
Remove the beam and the axle shaft.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 177

Remove the brake components: the counterdiscs


(11), discs (12), the brake disc carrier hub (10), the
brake disc (9) and the brake counterdisc (8).
NOTE: mark the position of the hub for assembly.

Remove the brake piston return kit (7) and the self-
adjust kit (6).

Take out the brake piston (4) from the brake cylin-
der (1).
If necessary, remove the plug (14) and the relevant
O-ring (13).

Blow some air through the oil supply hole for the
brake to eject the piston (4), using the minimum
pressure required.
178 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Remove the O-rings (2) and (3) from the piston (4).

If necessary, remove the bushings (5) of the self-


adjust kit from the piston (4), using tool 380200194
and a hammer.

Assembly
Collect the piston (4).
Push the washers (5) into the self-adjust seats
using tool 380200194 and a hammer, till they are
aligned with the piston supporting inner surface.

The bushings (5) must be aligned with the inner


supporting surface of the piston (4).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 179

Assemble the new O-rings (2) and (3) into the pis-
ton (4).
Lubricate the O-rings.

Insert the piston (4) into the brake cylinder (1).

Place tool 380200238 onto the piston (4).


Place the piston (4) with one slot aligned with the oil
recirculation hole or with the brake inspection hole
in the brake cylinder (1).
Use a prybar to insert the piston into the brake
flange with a light pressure.

Insert the big spring, the small spring and the bush-
ing of the piston return kit (7) into the bigger hole of
the piston.
180 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assemble the cover and the screw of the piston


return kit (7).

Assemble the bushing, the washer and the screw of


the self-adjust kit (6).

Screw and tighten the screws of the 2 kits.

If you are to replace the brake discs, you have to


restore the initial piston position.
Remove the connections, the breathers and possi-
ble plugs from the brake oil inlets.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 181

Bring the piston (4) to stroke end, using tool


380200238 and a hammer.
Place the tool carefully so as not to damage the pis-
ton.

Check that the brake discs and the counterdiscs do


not show any sign of burning (otherwise replace
them).
If new brake discs are installed, soak them into pre-
scribed oil before assembly.

Reassemble all elements of the brake assy: the


brake counterdisc (8), the brake disc (9), the brake
disc carrier hub (10), the counterdiscs (11) and the
discs (12).

Orientate the teeth correctly i.e. outside the brake


disc carrier hub (10).
182 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Reassemble the beam with the axle central body.

BRAKE DISC REPLACEMENT


Remove the wheel hub assy from the axle.

Remove the beam.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 183

Remove the brake components: the counterdiscs


(11), discs (12), the brake disc carrier hub (10), the
brake disc (9) and the brake counterdisc (8).

Check that the brake discs and the counterdiscs do


not show any sign of burning (otherwise replace
them).
If new brake discs are installed, soak them into pre-
scribed oil before assembly.

If you are to replace the brake discs, you have to


restore the initial piston position.
Remove the connections, the breathers and possi-
ble plugs from the brake oil inlets.

Bring the brake piston (4) to stroke end, using tool


380200238 and a hammer.
place the special tool carefully so as not to damage
the piston.
184 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Reassemble all brake elements: the brake counter-


disc (8), the brake disc (9), the brake disc carrier
hub (10), the counterdiscs (11) and the discs (12).

Orientate the teeth correctly i.e. outside the brake


disc carrier hub (10).

Reassemble the beam with the axle central body.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 185

DIFFERENTIAL SUPPORT

Disassembly
Remove the brake.

Measure the starting preload FT0 of the bearings


(pinion-ring gear system) using a dynamometer
whose cord is wound on the end of the pinion shaft.
Note value FT0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.
186 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Ensure the brake cylinder (6) to a lifting device


using its holes.
Loosen and remove the screw (7).

Remove the brake cylinder (6).


This operation releases the differential assy.
Disassemble the brake cylinder (6) and remove the
relevant O-ring (4).
Remove the O-ring (2).

Remove the differential (3) from the central body


(1).

Unscrew and remove the screw (10) and the ring


nut retainer (9) from the brake cylinder (6).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 187

Unscrew and remove the ring nut (8) from the brake
cylinder (6) using tool 380200209.

Pull out the bearing cup (5) from the brake cylinder
(6) using a buffer and a hammer.
188 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assembly
Before assembling the differential, install the pinion
assy.

Lubricate and insert the new O-ring (2) on each side


of the central body (1).

Place the brake cylinder (6) on a flat surface and


force the bearing cup (5) using buffer 380200218.

Measure the outer diameter C of the ring gear


installed on the differential.
Calculate the value:
R = C / 2 mm (0.079 in)
NOTE: this datum is required for the backlash
adjustment between pinion and ring gear.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 189

Lubricate or assemble a new O-ring (4) into the seat


of the 2 brake cylinders (6).

Assemble the left brake cylinder into the central


body (1).
Check that the reference marks applied during dis-
assembly between the brake cylinders and the cen-
tral body coincide.
Insert the differential (3) into the central body (1).
The ring gear must be placed on the left side.

Assemble the right brake cylinder (6) into the cen-


tral body (1).
Check that the reference marks applied during dis-
assembly between the brake cylinders and the cen-
tral body coincide.

Tighten screw (7) in place (A).


Tighten the screw to the prescribed torque of 80 Nm
(59 lbf·ft).
Screw in the 2 screws M16 x 130 (S) in place (B)
and tighten them to the 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft) torque.
190 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Tighten both ring nuts (8) with tool 380200209, till


the backlash is eliminated and slightly preload the
differential bearings.

Assemble the tool 380200222 on the hole of the dif-


ferential box.
Place a dial gauge and a feeler in contact and to
90° with respect to the surface of the tool and in cor-
respondence of value R.

Shift manually and alternately the tool 380200222


bracket installed on the hole of the differential box.
Determine and note the backlash between pinion
and ring gear.
Turn the ring gear 1/4 of turn, determine and note
the backlash between pinion and ring gear.
Repeat this operation to get several values of the
backlash.
Check if the average backlash is within the
requested range:
0.15 ÷ 0.30 mm (0.006 ÷ 0.012 in)
If the backlash is not within the requested range,
carry out adjustment as follows.
Adjust the ring nuts (8) with tool 380200209.
Unscrew and tighten both ring nuts of about 30°
each, then check the backlash.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 191

Adjust the ring nuts (8) remembering that:


- if the measured backlash is higher than the pre-
scribed tolerance range, tighten the ring nut on
the opposite side of the ring gear and loosen the
opposite ring nut by the same measure (A);
- if the measured backlash is lower than the pre-
scribed tolerance range, tighten the ring nut on
the ring gear side and loosen the opposite ring nut
by the same measure (B).

After pinion-ring gear backlash adjustment, check


that there is a minimum preload on the differential
box bearings.
Repeat the whole sequence of the above men-
tioned operations until the indicated conditions are
reached.

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have not been replaced,
measure the total preload FTm of the bearings (pin-
ion-ring gear system), using a dynamometer whose
cord is wound on the end of the pinion shaft.
Use this method only if the bearings are already run
in.
The measured value FTm should be within the fol-
lowing range:
FTm = FT0 ÷ (FT0 + 10) N
[FTm = FT0 ÷ (FT0 + 2.25) lbf]

If the bearings have been replaced, measure the


total preload FTm of the bearings (pinion-ring gear
system), using a dynamometer whose cord is
wound on tool 380200237 inserted on the pinion
splined end.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal ring.
192 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

The total preload FTm is measured by tool


380200237.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FTm = (FPm + 11.1) ÷ (FPm + 16.7) N
[FTm = (FPm + 2.5) ÷ (FPm + 3.7) lbf]
where FPm is the actual preload measured on tool
380200237 [gauge diameter Dm = 104.4 mm (4.11 in)].

NOTE: if you do not use the prescribed tool to


measure the total preload FTm, the reference diam-
eter is the diameter of pinion shaft splined end.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FTm = (FPm + 33.4) ÷ (FPm + 50.2) N
[FTm = (FPm + 7.5) ÷ (FPm + 11) lbf]
where FPm is the preload of the pinion bearings.

Once the pinion-ring gear backlash has been


adjusted, if the bearings have been replaced, meas-
ure the total rolling torque MT of the bearings (pin-
ion-ring gear system) with a torque meter and the
wrench 380000020.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.

The total torque MT should be within the following


range:
MTm = (MP + 0.58) ÷ (MP + 0.87) Nm
[MTm = (MP + 0.43) ÷ (MP + 0.64) lbf·ft]
where MP is the preload of the pinion bearings.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 193

If the measure is not within the requested range,


check the assembly of each single component and
operate on the ring nuts of the differential support:
- if the total preload is less than the given range,
screw on the adjusting ring nuts by the same
measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear backlash
value (A) unchanged;
- if the total preload is more than the given range,
unscrew the adjusting ring nuts by the same
measure, keeping the pinion-ring gear backlash
value (B) unchanged.

Once all adjustment operations have been per-


formed, assemble the ring nut retainers (9), fasten-
ing them with the relevant screws (10).
Tighten the screws (10) to a tightening torque of
13 Nm (9 lbf·ft).
Turn the ring nuts (8) as little as possible to allow
their assembly.

Remove the 2 additional screws M16 x 130 (S) from


both sides.
194 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

NON-SELF-LOCKING DIFFERENTIAL

Disassembly
Lock the differential with a clamp.
Loosen the screws (1) and remove the ring gear (2).
This operation releases also the two half boxes of
the differential.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 195

Disassemble the 2 half boxes (4) and (12).


Apply reference marks on the 2 half boxes before
separating them.
Disassemble all parts and check their operating sta-
tus and wear condition.

Take out the bearings (3) and (13) from the half
boxes (4) and (12) using a puller.
196 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assembly
Assemble the bearings (3) and (13) on the half
boxes (4) and (12), using tool 380200188 and a
hammer.

Place the half boxes (4) and (12) on a workbench


and carefully assemble the inner elements: the dif-
ferential locking counterdiscs (5), the gear (6), the 2
pins (7), the planetary gears (8) and the thrust
washers (9).
Join the two half boxes (4) and (12), aligning the
reference marks made during disassembly.

Before matching worked surfaces, make sure they


are perfectly clean, if not, clean with proper deter-
gents.
Place the ring gear (2) on the differential box.
Apply sealant on the screw thread (1).
Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening
torque of 155 Nm (114 lbf·ft).
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 197

“LIMITED SLIP” DIFFERENTIAL

Disassembly
Lock the differential with a clamp.
Loosen the screws (1) and remove the ring gear (2).
This operation releases also the two half boxes of
the differential.

Disassemble the 2 half boxes (4) and (12).


Apply reference marks on the 2 half boxes before
separating them.
Disassemble all parts and check their operating sta-
tus and wear condition.
198 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Take out the bearings (3) and (13) from the half
boxes (4) and (12) using a puller.

If necessary, take out the bushings (14) from the


half boxes (4) and (12).
Do not damage the bushing seats.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 199

Assembly
If previously removed, insert bushings (14) into the
half boxes (4) and (12) using the tool 380200205
and a hammer.

Assemble the bearings (3) and (13) on the half


boxes (4) and (12), using tool 380200188 and a
hammer.

Place the half boxes (4) and (12) on a workbench


and carefully assemble the inner elements: differen-
tial locking counterdiscs (5), differential locking
discs (6) and (7), gears (8), 2 pins (9), planetary
gears (10) and thrust washers (11).
The first disc (7) must be oriented with friction face
towards the discs and with smooth face towards the
gear (8).
Join the 2 half boxes (4) and (12), aligning the refer-
ence marks made during disassembly.

Before matching worked surfaces, make sure they


are perfectly clean, if not, clean with proper deter-
gents.
Place the ring gear (2) on the differential box.
Apply sealant on the screw thread (1).
Screw in and tighten the screws (1) to a tightening
torque of 155 Nm (114 lbf·ft).
200 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

PINION

Disassembly
Remove the differential assy.
Measure the starting preload FP0 of the pinion bear-
ings using a dynamometer whose cord is wound on
the end of the pinion shaft.

S WARNING S
Note value FP0 that is necessary for assembling the
bearings.

Unscrew the ring nut (10) using wrench (T1) and


pinion retainer (T2) 380000020 with 3/4” standard
connection.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 201

Tap the shaft end with a soft hammer to remove the


pinion (1).

Once the pinion (1) has been removed, collect the


washers (4), (6) and (9), the spacer (5) and the
bearing (8).

Check the wear condition of the bearing cups.


Take out the bearing cups (3) and (8), if necessary.

Remove the bearing (3) from the pinion (1) by


means of a puller.
Collect the shim (2).
202 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Check the conditions of all parts.


The ring nut (10) and the spacer (5) must be
replaced during reassembly.

Assembly
Position the axle central body onto a workbench.
Insert the bearing cups (3) and (8) into their seats
using kit 380200216.

Use the false pinion 380200202 and false differen-


tial box 380200217.
Insert the bearing and the false pinion into the
seats.
Tighten the ring nut, until the backlash is eliminated.

Check the correct place of the differential box sup-


ports at the right and left side, using the reference
marks applied on the same and on the central body.
Assemble the 2 brake cylinders, fastening them
with the relevant screws.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 203

Insert the false differential box 380200217 into the


central axle body.
Check that the false differential box is inserted in
both seats of the differential supports.

To adjust the bevel gear measure the distance “A”


with a depth gauge.
Determine the value “X” as follows:
X = (A + C) - B mm (in)
where “B” and “C” are known values.

From the value “X” deduct the value “V” (stamped


on the pinion head) to get the value “S”.
S = X - V mm (in)

Choose the shim with value (S) from the shim range
available.

SHIM RANGE
Shims
2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 3.0 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4
mm
(0.098) (0.102) (0.106) (0.110) (0.114) (0.118) (0.122) (0.126) (0.130) (0.134)
(in)
Q.ty - - - - - - - - - -
204 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Loosen and remove the ring nut (10).


Remove the false pinion 380200202 and the bear-
ings (3) and (8) from the central body (7).
Disassemble the false differential box 380200217
from the brake cylinders and then unscrew the
screws to remove the brake cylinders.

Once you have chosen the suitable shim (2), insert


it on the pinion shaft with the chamfer against the
pinion head.

Insert the bearing (3) on the pinion shaft (1) using a


press and tool 380200190.
Insert the shim (4) and a new spacer (5) and the
shim (6).

Check the right assembly sequence.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 205

Insert the preassembled pinion (1) into the central


body and the bearing (8) into the pinion shaft.
Assemble the bearing (8) with tool 380200190 and
a hammer.

Insert the ring nut retaining washer and tighten the


new ring nut (10) on the pinion shaft.
Tighten the ring nut (10) using wrench (T1)
380000021 and the pinion retainer (T2) 380000020
with 3/4” standard connection.
The torque setting is given by the preload measure-
ment on bearings.
Tighten the ring nut (10) gradually.
Excessive tightening could damage the spacer (5),
that would need to be replaced and the procedure
to be repeated.
When you check the preload, strike the pinion ends
(1) with a soft hammer to favour the seating of the
bearings.
If the bearings have not been replaced, to measure
the preload FPm, use a dynamometer whose cord is
wound on the end of the pinion shaft.

S WARNING S
Use this method only if the bearings are not
replaced.

The measured value should be within the following


range:
FPm = FP0 ÷ (FP0 + 10) N
[FPm = FP0 ÷ (FP0 + 2.25) lbf]
206 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

If the bearings are new, to measure the preload


FPm, use a dynamometer whose cord is wound on
tool 380200237, inserted on the end of pinion shaft.

The actual preload FPm is measured on tool


380200237 [gauge diameter Dm = 114.4 mm
(4.50 in)].
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 31 ÷ 46 N
[FPm = 6.97 ÷ 10.34 lbf]

In case you do not use the prescribed tool to meas-


ure the preload, the reference diameter is the diam-
eter of pinion shaft splined end.
The measured value should be within the following
range:
FPm = 92 ÷ 138 N
[FPm = 20.68 ÷ 31.02 lbf]

It is possible to measure the rolling torque MP of the


pinion shaft bearings with a torque meter and the
wrench 380000020.

S WARNING S
All preloads must be measured without seal rings.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 207

The measured value MP should be within this


range:
MP = 1.6 ÷ 2.4 Nm
[MP = 1.18 ÷ 1.77 lbf·ft]

Once the prescribed preload value is achieved,


caulk the ring nut (10) using a hammer and a
punch.

Assemble the differential assy (3).


208 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

TOE-IN / STEERING ANGLE

Toe-in check
Assemble 2 identical, 1 m long linear bars on the
wheel sides and lock them with 2 nuts on the wheel
hub stud screws.

S WARNING S
The 2 bars should be fixed on their middle so that
they are perfectly perpendicular to the supporting
surface and parallel to the pinion axis; align the 2
bars.

Measure with a tape measure the distance (M)


between bar ends.
NOTE: keep the minimum value, swinging the
measurement point.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 209

Check that the difference between the measure-


ments at the ends of the wheel hub diameters is
within the required tolerance range.
The nominal toe-in (A) value is referred to the exter-
nal diameter of the wheel hubs flange, therefore the
measured toe-in value (M) at the bar ends must be
related to the ratio between length of the bar and
flange diameter:
nominal toe-in = A±1 J measured toe-in = M±3

If toe-in is not correct, operate with two wrenches


on the rods (1) screwing in and out the two tie rods
(3) equally, till the toe-in is within the requested tol-
erance.

Once this adjustment has been performed, screw


in the nuts (2) of the bars (1) and tighten them to
a 250 Nm (184 lbf·ft) torque.
210 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Steering angle adjustment


Use the same bars assembled for toe-in adjustment
and a long bar perfectly rested on the machined
part of the central body (pinion side), so that, at
maximum steering, the two bars form an acute
angle.

In order to set the steering angle, adjust a goniome-


ter according to the angle measure (C), calculated
as follows:
C = 90° - S
Where (S) is the prescribed steering angle set.
Place the goniometer on the long bar.
Orientate the left wheel assy until you get the calcu-
lated angle with the 2 bars (C).

Apply the prescribed sealant on the screw thread


(4).
Carry out the adjustment of the mechanical lock,
screwing in and out the relevant screws (4), locking
them afterwards with the nuts (5).
Tighten to the prescribed torque of 150 Nm (111 lbf·ft).

Check that the locks on the opposite sides are both


in contact with the axle beam.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 211

Completely steer to the opposite side and repeat


the same operations described previously.

Check that the locks on the opposite sides are both


in contact with the axle beam.
212 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

SPECIAL INTERVENTIONS

Disassembly of wheel assy and double joint


Drain the oil from the differential.
Loosen and remove the nut (1) and disconnect the
tie rod (3) from the swivel housing.

S WARNING S
Do not hit the end of the threaded pin of the tie rod
(3) during disassembly.

Do not unscrew the tie rod (3) and the relevant nut
(4) so as not to impair the wheel toe-in.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 213

Ensure the swivel housing to a lifting device with a


rope.
Unscrew and remove the screws (5) and (9) from
the upper (6) and lower (10) king pins.

Remove the king pins (6) and (10).

Remove the wheel hub assy.


214 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Assembly of wheel assy and double joint


Assemble the wheel hub assy.

Grease the king pin seats (6) and (10).


Position the belleville washers on the king pin seats.
Assemble the lower (10) and the upper (6) king
pins.

Assemble the upper (6) and lower (10) and king


pins by fastening the screws (9) and (5) to the pre-
scribed torque of 300 Nm (221 lbf·ft).

Insert the ball joint of the tie rod (3) into its seat on
the swivel housing (1) by turning the swivel housing
as much as necessary.
Do not unscrew the tie rod (3) and the relevant nut
(4) so as not to impair the wheel toe-in.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 215

Screw in and tighten the nut (2) to a tightening


torque of 260 Nm (192 lbf·ft).

Check the differential oil level from the hole of the


oil inlet plug (14) and top up if necessary.
Screw in and tighten the plug (14) to the tighten-
ing torque of 60 Nm (44 lbf·ft).
216 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Replacement of the seal ring of the double joint


Remove the wheel assy and the double joint.
Take out the seal ring (11), paying attention not to
damage its seat.

Assemble the new seal ring (11) with the buffer


380002226 and a hammer.
Lubricate the seal ring.

Check the correct place of the seal ring (11) accord-


ing to the axle type.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 217

Replacement of the bronze bushing of the dou-


ble joint
Remove the wheel assy and the double joint.
Extract the seal ring (11).
Remove the bronze bushing (13) with a puller, pay-
ing attention not to damage its seat.

Insert the new bronze bushing (13) with the buffer


380200227 and a hammer.

Assemble the seal ring (11).


218 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

Brake wear check


Actuate the service brake with machine stopped.
Unscrew the breather to release the inner pressure.
Unscrew and remove the plug (1).

Check the wear condition of the brake disc friction


face by trying to insert between the counterdiscs a
dowel with 4.08 mm (0.16 in) of diameter.
If the dowel cannot be inserted, the brake discs
must be replaced because worn out.
If the dowel can be inserted, the brake discs must
not be replaced.

Screw in the plug (1) with a dynamometric wrench.


Carry out the check of the other brake assy.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 219

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Wheel vibrations. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair the axle.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Tyre resistance. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Broken axle shaft. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Difficult steering; the machine Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


travels in a straight line while
steering. Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

No differential action; jams Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.


during steering.
Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.
220 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Excessive noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Excessive wear of the tyre. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Overload. Remove the excessive load.

Incorrect tyre rotation radius. Replace the tyre or adjust pressure


on both tyres.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Differential locked. Check the installation.

Excessive steering angle. Reduce the steering angle.

Incorrect wheel alignment. Check that the structure and the


bearings are in good conditions.

Friction noise. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.

Damaged or worn axle parts. Replace the damaged axle parts.

Incorrect axle part installation. Check the installation.

Incorrect adjustment of the bevel Adjust the bevel gear set.


gear set.

Vibrations during travel. Incorrect installation. Correct the installation.

Axle faulty. Inspect and repair.

Wrong weight distribution. Distribute the weight differently.

Bent or broken axle shaft. Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 221

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Outer tip of ring gear tooth is Excessive gear load compared to Replace bevel gear.
broken. the one expected.
Follow carefully recommended
Gear adjustment wrong (excessive adjustment operations of ring gear
backlash). and pinion backlash and of tooth
marks detection.
Pinion nut loose.

Inner tip of ring gear tooth is Crash load. Replace bevel gear.
broken.
Gear adjustment wrong (insufficient Follow carefully recommended
backlash). adjustment operations of ring gear
and pinion backlash and of tooth
Pinion nut loose.
marks detection.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Insufficient lubrication. Replace bevel gear.
damaged or scored.
Contaminated lubricant. Replace worn out pinion bearings
that cause an incorrect pinion axle
Incorrect lubrication or poor
backlash and wrong contact
additives.
between pinion and ring gear.
Worn out pinion bearings that cause
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
an incorrect pinion axle backlash
level and replace at recommended
and wrong contact between pinion
intervals.
and ring gear.

Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Prolonged operation at high Replace bevel gear.
overheated. Check if gear temperature. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
teeth have faded.
Unsuitable lubricant. level and replace at recommended
intervals.
Oil level low.
Contaminated lubricant.

Drive pinion teeth pitted. Extremely intense use. Replace bevel gear.
Insufficient lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Bent axle beam body. Machine overloaded. Replace the axle beam body.
Damaged vehicle.
Crash load.

Bearings worn or pitted. Insufficient lubrication. Replace the bearings.


Contaminated lubricant. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Extremely intense use.
intervals.
Normal wear.
Pinion nut loose.
222 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Gaskets leak oil. Prolonged operation at excessive oil Replace the gasket and matching
temperature. surface if damaged.
Oil gasket wrongly installed. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Gasket edge cut or scored.
intervals.
Contaminated lubricant.

Excessive wear of input Intense use. Replace the flange.


flange spline.
Pinion nut loose. Check that the pinion spline is not
excessively worn out.
Pinion axial backlash.
Replace bevel gear, if necessary.

Pinion gear tooth fatigue Intense use. Replace bevel gear.


break.
Continuous overload.
Check if the fracture line is
wavy or clearly delineated
(stop line).

Break of pinion teeth and ring Crash load of differential Check and/or replace other
gear teeth. components. differential components.

Splines of planetary gear worn Intense use. Replace differential gear assy.
(excessive backlash).
Replace axle beam, if necessary.

Worn or scored surfaces of Insufficient lubrication. Replace all scratched washers and
the scraper thrust washer. those with a 0.1 mm (0.004 in)
Lubrication wrong.
thickness lower than the new ones.
Contaminated lubricant.
Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
intervals.

Inner diameter of pinion Intense use. Replace bearing.


tapered roller bearing worn
Excessive pinion end play. Check pinion axial backlash.
out.
Unsuitable lubrication. Use proper lubricant, fill up to right
level and replace at recommended
Contaminated lubricant.
intervals.

Broken or bent axle beam. Intense vehicle operation, overload. Replace the axle beam.
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 223

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Broken axle beam at wheel Loose wheel support. Replace the axle beam.
flange.
Bent axle beam body. Check bending of axle beam body.
Ensure that wheel support is not
worn out or wrongly adjusted.

Noise during travel. Excessive backlash between ring Adjust the backlash between the ring
gear and pinion. gear and the pinion.

Pinion and ring gear worn. Replace pinion and ring gear.

Worn-out pinion bearings Replace pinion bearings.

Loose pinion bearings. Adjust pinion bearings.

Excessive pinion end play. Adjust the axial play of the pinion.

Differential bearings worn out. Replace differential bearings.

Loose differential bearings. Adjust the bearings.

Ring gear excessively off-set. Replace the ring gear.

Low lubricant level. Restore the level.

Poor or wrong lubricant grade. Change lubricant.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.

Noise during idling. Noises emitted by the axle when the Adjust the backlash between the ring
vehicle is moving are usually heard gear and the pinion or replace pinion
during idling, even though they are and ring gear.
not too loud.

Wrong backlash between pinion and Adjust the play between the pinion
ring gear (the noise heard while and the ring gear.
decelerating disappears when speed
is increased).

Pinion spline or input flange worn. Replace the pinion.

Intermittent noise. Damaged ring gear. Replace bevel gear.

Differential box screws loose. Tighten the screws to torque.

Constant noise. Ring gear teeth or pinion teeth Replace bevel gear.
damaged.

Worn bearings. Replace the bearings.

Pinion splines worn. Replace the pinion.

Axle beam bent. Replace the axle beam.


224 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Noise while bending. Differential planetary gears Replace the planetary gears.
damaged.

Differential box and/or pins worn. Replace the differential box.

Worn differential thrust washers. Replace the thrust washers.

Worn-out axle beam splines Replace the axle beam.


SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 225

REPAIR TIMES
The times are referred to average values of mainte-
nance performed by skilled personnel in workshops
equipped with all necessary fixtures for a proper
execution of the required works.
The repair and/or replacement times are indicated in
minutes.
We assume that the axle has already been removed
from the machine.

ASSY OPERATION TIME (minutes)


Flange Replacement of pinion seal ring 30
Rod replacement (x 1) 30
Ball joint replacement (x 1) 15
Tie rod replacement (x 1) 30
Ball joint boot replacement (x 1) 15
Steering cylinder Tie rod boot replacement (x 1) 15
Sensor replacement 15
Steering cylinder replacement 120
Steering cylinder overhauling 240
Sensor replacement and adjustment 60
Gear carrier replacement 20
Reduction gear assy Gear carrier overhaul (3 planetary gears) 35
Gear carrier overhaul (4 planetary gears) 45
Standard wheel hub replacement 30
Seal ring + wheel hub bearing replacement 75
Stud screw replacement (x 1) 5
Swivel housing overhauling 90
Swivel housing replacement 70
Wheel hub
Double joint replacement 30
Double joint overhauling 60
King pin replacement (x 1) 30
King pin bearing replacement (x 1) 45
Ring gear replacement (x 1) 30
Ball joint replacement (x 1) 45
Replacement of the seal rings of the double joint 45
Axle shaft Cardan joint bronze bushing replacement 60
Axle shaft replacement (x 1) 120
O-ring replacement (x 1) 30
Disc and counterdisc replacement (for each side) 60
Overhaul / replacement of piston seal rings (for each side) 90
Brake Self-adjust kit replacement (for each side) 60
Overhaul / replacement of piston (for each side) 90
Overhaul / replacement of O-ring (for each side) 30
Replacement of differential assy 150
Differential support
Differential box bearings 120
226 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

ASSY OPERATION TIME (minutes)


Differential replacement 150
Differential Overhaul / replacement of bevel gear, planetary gears, pins 240
Overhauling / replacement of differential box bearings 120
Overhauling / replacement of pinion bearings 180
Pinion
Overhaul / replacement of bevel gear, planetary gears, pins 240
SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE 227

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH DESCRIPTION USE

380002211 Handle To be used with the various pushers and buffers

380000021 Wrench Screw / unscrew the pinion ring nut

380200188 Buffer Assembly of bearing cups into the differential box

380200190 Buffer Assembly of pinion bearing cups

380000020 Wrench Measure of pinion rolling torque

380200192 Buffer Assembly / disassembly of bushings in the ring gear carrier hub

380200194 Buffer Assembly / disassembly of self-adjust kit

380200195 Buffer Ball bearing assembly of the lower king pin

380200196 Buffer Ball bearing assembly of the upper king pin

380000024 Buffer Bushing assembly into the swivel housing

380200202 False pinion Differential and pinion assembly

380200205 Buffer Assembly of bushings into the differential box

380200209 Wrench Tighten / loosen the brake cylinder ring nut

380200210 Buffer Wheel hub seal ring assembly

380200211 Buffer Assembly of bearing cups into the wheel hub

380200216 Kit Assembly of pinion bearing cups

380200217 False differential box Differential and pinion assembly

380200218 Buffer Assembly of bearing cup into the brake cylinder

380200222 Tool Backlash measure between pinion and ring gear

380200227 Buffer Assembly of bushing in the half-beam

380002226 Buffer Assembly of seal ring in the half-beam

380200237 Tool Preload measure

380200238 Buffer Brake piston assembly

380200266 Buffer Seal ring assembly into the swivel housing

380200267 Buffer Pinion seal ring assembly


228 SECTION 27 - REAR AXLE

NOTES:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM

PARKING BRAKE............................................................................................................................................. 3
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................................................. 3
OPERATION................................................................................................................................................ 3
ADJUSTMENT............................................................................................................................................. 4
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................... 5

SERVICE BRAKE ........................................................................................................................................... 14


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 14
OPERATION.............................................................................................................................................. 14
2 SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM
SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM 3

PARKING BRAKE
This device allows the immobilization of the
machine each time it must be parked or stopped to
carry out maintenance work.

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Type ....................................................................................................................................... manual, with lever
Maximum lever pull ....................................................................................................................1650 N (371 lbf)
Lever stroke ............................................................................................................................... 21 mm (0.87 in)
Maximum torque - Powershuttle .............................................................................................2000 Nm (450 lbf)
Maximum torque - Powershift .................................................................................................1500 Nm (337 lbf)

OPERATION
The parking brake essentially consists of:
- manual control lever;
- transmission brake.

The lever (1) is located on the right side of the cab


(seat placed to loader attachment).
The lever position (1) is controlled by the sensor (2),
when the lever is lifted to immobilize the machine,
the lamp (3) indicating the parking brake activation
and placed on the side instrument panel (4), lights
on.
IMPORTANT: if the gear is engaged when the park-
ing brake is activated, it will actuate the warning
buzzer and the symbol “parking brake alarm” will
appear on the display.
By lifting the lever (1), by means of cable (5) and of
the relevant yoke (7), the brake is actuated inside
transmission (6).
4 SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM

NEGATIVE PARKING BRAKE OPERATION


Negative parking brake applied (A)
When the system is not under pressure, the bel-
leville washers (1) push on the parking brake piston
(2) compressing the brake discs (3).
This happens when the machine motor is stopped
or because the operator has actuated the parking
brake.
In order to move the machine disable the parking
brake.

Negative brake released (B)


When the brake oil reaches the disengagement
pressure, the parking brake piston (2) is pushed
against the belleville washers (1) and the brake
discs (3) are free.
This happens under normal operating condition,
when the operator disengages the parking brake.

ADJUSTMENT
The parking brake can be adjusted by placing the
brake pad in contact with the disc, now you have to
block the brake cable.
The brake cable movement (1) can be adjusted by
handling on the locknut (2).
Adjust the parking brake so as to brake the machine
completely by lifting the brake lever up to the 4th
ratchet.
SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM 5

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


These procedures deal with the parking brake sec-
tion and leave off the control lever and the relevant
connection cable.

1. Screw 10. Piston


2. Washer 11. Snap ring
3. O-ring 12. O-ring
4. Flange 13. Stop plate
5. Screw 14. O-ring
6. Brake cover 15. Disc
7. O-ring 16. Brake discs
8. Belleville washer 17. Hub
9. O-ring
6 SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM

DISASSEMBLY
Loosen the screw (1).

Remove the screw (1) and the washer (2).

Remove the O-ring (3) and the flange (4).

Loosen the screws (5).


SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM 7

Remove all screws (5), the screws (A) and alter-


nately loosen the screws (B) to release the load
from the belleville washers.
NOTE: the housing is under spring pressure, failure
to follow the instructions will result in serious injury
or damage to the equipment.

Remove the brake cover (6).


Remove the O-ring (7).

Remove the brake discs (16).

Remove the hub (17).


8 SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM

Remove the retaining plate (13).

Remove the O-rings (12) and (14) from the retaining


plate.

Compress the belleville washers, to remove the


snap ring (11).

Remove the piston (10) from the brake cover (6).


SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM 9

Remove the O-ring (9) from the piston (10).

Remove the belleville washers (8) from the brake


cover (6).

INSPECTION
Clean all parts in cleaning solvent.
Inspect the brake discs and plates for pitting, scor-
ing, excessive surface wear and other damage.
Inspect the belleville washer for cracking and exces-
sive surface wear at contact points.
Inspect brake pistons and housing for scratches on
their sliding surfaces, and contact surfaces for pit-
ting or excessive wear.
Replace the O-rings.
10 SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM

ASSEMBLY
Assemble the new O-ring (7) on the brake cover (6).

Assemble the belleville washers (8).

Assemble the new O-ring (9) on the piston (10).

Lubricate and install the piston (10) into the brake


cover (6).
SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM 11

Compress the belleville washers, to assemble the


snap ring (11).

Assemble new O-rings (12) and (14) onto the


retaining plate.

Lubricate and install the retaining plate (13) into the


brake cover (6).

Assemble the hub (17).


12 SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM

Assemble the brake discs (16).

Assemble the brake cover assembly.

Screw in and tighten the screws (5) to a tightening


torque of 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).

Assemble the flange (4) and the new O-ring (3).


SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM 13

Screw in the screw (1) with the washer (2).

Tighten the screw (1) to a tightening torque of 139 Nm


(102 lbf·ft).
14 SECTION 33 - BRAKE SYSTEM

SERVICE BRAKE
During operation, the brake system of the machine
can stop the machine at any time.

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
2WS
Type ........................................................................................................wet multi-discs, 4 x axle (2 x half axle)
Braking surface ..................................................................................................................... 1236 cm2 (191 in2)
4WS
Type ........................................................................................................wet multi-discs, 6 x axle (3 x half axle)
Braking surface ..................................................................................................................... 1092 cm2 (169 in2)

OPERATION
This system essentially consists of:
- brake pedals (in the cab);
- wet disc brakes hydraulically operated in the rear
axle.

NOTE: this drawing represents the 2WS rear axle; By pushing the pedals (1) you activate the brake
the operation of the 4WS rear axle is the same. pump (3) delivering hydraulic oil to the 2 brake
discs (5) fitted in the rear axle (6).
The two pedals (1) located in the cab underneath
the steering wheel, can be matched with the locking In this way, pressure is generated against the brake
pin (2). pistons (7), which, on their turn, compress the discs
(9) and the counterdiscs (8), thus locking the axle
This enables:
and therefore the machine.
- the machine braking (pedals locked together);
- the machine turning (by pushing just one pedal).
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAMS ................................................................................................................................. 3


HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS SIDESHIFT MECHANICAL MODELS....................................................... 3
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS SIDESHIFT PILOT MODELS .................................................................... 5
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS CENTER PIVOT PILOT MODELS ............................................................ 7
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS SIDESHIFT MECHANICAL MODELS....................................................... 9
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS SIDESHIFT PILOT MODELS .................................................................. 11
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS CENTER PIVOT PILOT MODELS .......................................................... 13

HYDRAULIC PUMP........................................................................................................................................ 15
HYDRAULIC FIXED-FLOW-RATE GEAR PUMP...................................................................................... 15
HYDRAULIC VARIABLE-FLOW-RATE PISTON PUMP ........................................................................... 26

CONTROL VALVES ....................................................................................................................................... 40


LOADER CONTROL VALVE ..................................................................................................................... 49
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE......................................................................................... 53
RELIEF VALVES ....................................................................................................................................... 65

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE PILOT SOLENOID VALVE .................................................. 74

ACCUMULATOR “GLIDE RIDE” PARKER..................................................................................................... 77


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 77
MAINTENANCE......................................................................................................................................... 77
SAFETY ..................................................................................................................................................... 77
CHECKING AND ADJUSTING THE PRECHARGE PRESSURE ............................................................. 78

HYDRAULIC SWING SYSTEM ...................................................................................................................... 80


OPERATION.............................................................................................................................................. 80

HYDRAULIC CYLINDERS.............................................................................................................................. 83
LOADER ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER ........................................................................................... 84
LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER ................................................................................................................. 91
4X1 LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER .......................................................................................................... 97
BACKHOE BOOM CYLINDER ................................................................................................................ 100
2 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DIPPER CYLINDER .................................................................................... 104


BACKHOE BUCKET CYLINDER............................................................................................................. 108
TELESCOPIC CYLINDER ....................................................................................................................... 112
STABILIZER CYLINDER - CENTER PIVOT............................................................................................ 116
STABILIZER CYLINDER - SIDESHIFT ................................................................................................... 120
SWING CYLINDER.................................................................................................................................. 124
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LOCK CYLINDER - SIDESHIFT .................................................................. 128
SPECIAL TOOLS..................................................................................................................................... 129

HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVERS................................................................................................................ 130


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 130
CONTROLS AND OPERATION .............................................................................................................. 131
COMPONENTS ....................................................................................................................................... 132
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY........................................................................................................... 134
CONTROL LEVER VALVE ...................................................................................................................... 137

TROUBLESHOOTING .................................................................................................................................. 139


PRELIMINARY CHECKS......................................................................................................................... 139
TROUBLESHOOTING (WITH “REXROTH” CONTROL VALVES).......................................................... 140
SWING ..................................................................................................................................................... 142
HYDRAULIC PUMP ................................................................................................................................. 143
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 3

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAMS

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS SIDESHIFT MECHANICAL MODELS

* Alternative diagram for non-reactive steering


4 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

1. Front axle steering cylinder


2. Power steering
3. 4x1 bucket cylinders
3A. 4x1 bucket control valve
4. Dipper cylinders
4A. Lock valve
4B. Lock valve
5. Boom cylinders
5A. Lock valve
5B. Lock valve
6. Ride control valve (optional)
7. Ride control accumulator (optional)
8. Loader attachment control valve
9. Backhoe hammer control valve (optional)
10. Backhoe hammer (optional)
11. Hand hammer control valve (optional)
12. Hand hammer (optional)
13. Hydraulic pump
14. Priority valve
15. Oil cooler
16. Hydraulic tank
17. Air filter
18. Filter manifold
19. Return filter
20. Backpressure valve
21. Backhoe attachment travel lock cylinders
22. Auxiliary bidirectional (optional)
23. Stabilizer right cylinder
23A. Lock valve
24. Stabilizer left cylinder
24A. Lock valve
25. Dipper cylinder
25A. Lock valve
26. Bucket cylinder
27. Swing cylinders
28. Boom cylinder
28A. Lock valve
29. Telescopic dipper cylinder (optional)
30. Backhoe attachment control valve
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 5

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS SIDESHIFT PILOT MODELS

* Alternative diagram for non-reactive steering


6 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

1. Front axle steering cylinder


2. Power steering
3. 4x1 bucket cylinders
3A. 4x1 bucket control valve
4. Dipper cylinders
4A. Lock valve
4B. Lock valve
5. Boom cylinders
5A. Lock valve
5B. Lock valve
6. Ride control valve (optional)
7. Ride control accumulator (optional)
8. Loader attachment control valve
9. Backhoe hammer control valve (optional)
10. Backhoe hammer (optional)
11. Hand hammer control valve (optional)
12. Hand hammer (optional)
13. Hydraulic pump
14. Priority valve
15. Oil cooler
16. Hydraulic tank
17. Air filter
18. Filter manifold
19. Return filter
20. Backpressure valve
21. Backhoe attachment travel lock cylinders
22. Auxiliary bidirectional (optional)
23. Stabilizer right cylinder
23A. Lock valve
24. Stabilizer left cylinder
24A. Lock valve
25. Dipper cylinder
25A. Lock valve
26. Bucket cylinder
27. Swing cylinders
28. Boom cylinder
28A. Lock valve
29. Telescopic dipper cylinder (optional)
30. Backhoe attachment control valve
31. Backhoe attachment control valve solenoid valve
32. Left-hand hydraulic control lever
32A. Boom or dipper left hydraulic control lever
32B. Hydraulic control lever left-swing
33. Right-hand hydraulic control lever
33A. Boom or dipper right hydraulic control lever
33B. Hydraulic control lever right-bucket
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 7

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 2WS CENTER PIVOT PILOT MODELS

* Alternative diagram for non-reactive steering


8 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

1. Front axle steering cylinder


2. Power steering
3. 4x1 bucket cylinders
3A. 4x1 bucket control valve
1. Dipper cylinders
2. Boom cylinders
6. Ride control valve (optional)
7. Ride control accumulator (optional)
8. Loader attachment control valve
9. Backhoe hammer control valve (optional)
10. Backhoe hammer (optional)
11. Hand hammer control valve (optional)
12. Hand hammer (optional)
13. Hydraulic pump
14. Priority valve
15. Oil cooler
16. Hydraulic tank
17. Air filter
18. Filter manifold
19. Return filter
20. Backpressure valve
22. Auxiliary bidirectional (optional)
23. Stabilizer right cylinder
23A. Lock valve
24. Stabilizer left cylinder
24A. Lock valve
25. Dipper cylinder
25A. Lock valve
26. Bucket cylinder
27. Swing cylinders
27A. Rotation valve
28. Boom cylinder
28A. Lock valve
29. Telescopic dipper cylinder (optional)
30. Backhoe attachment control valve
31. Backhoe attachment control valve solenoid valve
32. Left-hand hydraulic control lever
32A. Boom or dipper left hydraulic control lever
32B. Hydraulic control lever left-swing
33. Right-hand hydraulic control lever
33A. Boom or dipper right hydraulic control lever
33B. Hydraulic control lever right-bucket
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 9

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS SIDESHIFT MECHANICAL MODELS


10 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

1. Front axle steering cylinder


2. Rear axle steering cylinder
3. 4WS steering control valve
4. Power steering
5. 4x1 bucket cylinders
5A. 4x1 bucket control valve
6. Dipper cylinders
6A. Lock valve
6B. Lock valve
7. Boom cylinders
7A. Lock valve
7B. Lock valve
8. Ride control valve (optional)
9. Ride control accumulator (optional)
10. Loader attachment control valve
11. Hand hammer (optional)
12. Hand hammer control valve (optional)
13. Backhoe hammer (optional)
14. Backhoe hammer control valve (optional)
15. Hydraulic pump
16. Priority valve
17. Oil cooler
18. Hydraulic tank
19. Air filter
20. Filter manifold
21. Return filter
22. Backpressure valve
23. Backhoe attachment control valve
24. Backhoe attachment travel lock cylinders
25. Auxiliary bidirectional (optional)
26. Stabilizer right cylinder
26A. Lock valve
27. Stabilizer left cylinder
27A. Lock valve
28. Dipper cylinder
28A. Lock valve
29. Bucket cylinder
30. Swing cylinders
31. Boom cylinder
31A. Lock valve
32. Telescopic dipper cylinder (optional)
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 11

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS SIDESHIFT PILOT MODELS


12 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

1. Front axle steering cylinder


2. Rear axle steering cylinder
3. 4WS steering control valve
4. Power steering
5. 4x1 bucket cylinders
5A. 4x1 bucket control valve
6. Dipper cylinders
6A. Lock valve
6B. Lock valve
7. Boom cylinders
7A. Lock valve
7B. Lock valve
8. Ride control valve (optional)
9. Ride control accumulator (optional)
10. Loader attachment control valve
11. Hand hammer (optional)
12. Hand hammer control valve (optional)
13. Backhoe hammer (optional)
14. Backhoe hammer control valve (optional)
15. Hydraulic pump
16. Priority valve
17. Oil cooler
18. Hydraulic tank
19. Air filter
20. Filter manifold
21. Return filter
22. Backpressure valve
23. Backhoe attachment control valve
24. Backhoe attachment travel lock cylinders
25. Auxiliary bidirectional (optional)
26. Stabilizer right cylinder
26A. Lock valve
27. Stabilizer left cylinder
27A. Lock valve
28. Dipper cylinder
28A. Lock valve
29. Bucket cylinder
30. Swing cylinders
31. Boom cylinder
31A. Lock valve
32. Telescopic dipper cylinder (optional)
33. Backhoe attachment control valve solenoid valve
34. Left-hand hydraulic control lever
34A. Boom or dipper left hydraulic control lever
34B. Hydraulic control lever left-swing
35. Right-hand hydraulic control lever
35A. Boom or dipper right hydraulic control lever
35B. Hydraulic control lever right-bucket
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 13

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM - 4WS CENTER PIVOT PILOT MODELS


14 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

1. Front axle steering cylinder


2. Rear axle steering cylinder
3. 4WS steering control valve
4. Power steering
5. 4x1 bucket cylinders
5A. 4x1 bucket control valve
6. Dipper cylinders
6A. Lock valve
6B. Lock valve
7. Boom cylinders
7A. Lock valve
7B. Lock valve
8. Ride control valve (optional)
9. Ride control accumulator (optional)
10. Loader attachment control valve
11. Hand hammer (optional)
12. Hand hammer control valve (optional)
13. Backhoe hammer (optional)
14. Backhoe hammer control valve (optional)
15. Hydraulic pump
16. Priority valve
17. Oil cooler
18. Hydraulic tank
19. Air filter
20. Filter manifold
21. Return filter
22. Backpressure valve
23. Backhoe attachment control valve
25. Auxiliary bidirectional (optional)
26. Stabilizer right cylinder
26A. Lock valve
27. Stabilizer left cylinder
27A. Lock valve
28. Dipper cylinder
28A. Lock valve
29. Bucket cylinder
30. Swing cylinders
31. Boom cylinder
31A. Lock valve
32. Telescopic dipper cylinder (optional)
33. Backhoe attachment control valve solenoid valve
34. Left-hand hydraulic control lever
34A. Boom or dipper left hydraulic control lever
34B. Hydraulic control lever left-swing
35. Right-hand hydraulic control lever
35A. Boom or dipper right hydraulic control lever
35B. Hydraulic control lever right-bucket
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 15

HYDRAULIC PUMP
The machine can be provided with 2 types of
hydraulic pump:
- fixed-flow-rate gear pump;
- variable-flow-rate piston pump.
Further to the type, pumps differentiate according to
the motor:
- 97 HP (78 kW) motor
- 110 HP (82 kW) motor

HYDRAULIC FIXED-FLOW-RATE GEAR


PUMP
The hydraulic pump is mounted on the rear part of
the transmission and is driven by a shaft directly
connected to the engine splined to the torque con-
verter.
The pump consists of two pumping elements, the
front pump (1) and the rear pump (2), and a load-
sensing flow divider valve (3) for the steering sys-
tem.
Oil is drawn through the common inlet port into both
pumping elements.
The front pump flow is directed to the loader and
backhoe attachment control valve and also to the
sideshift carriage lock cylinders.
The rear pump flow passes through the flow divider
valve, which maintains priority oil flow to the steer-
ing system, with the remaining flow directed for
operating the stabilizers.

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
72 kW - 97 HP Pump (B90B - B100B - B100BTC)
Model .......................................................................................................... CASAPPA KP 30.34 - 05 S6 - LMF
Type ...................................................................................................................................... double gear pump
Displacement ............................................................................. 35.427 + 35.427 cm3/rev (2.16 + 2.16 in3/rev)
82 kW - 110 HP Pump (B110B - B110BTC - B115B)
Model .......................................................................................................... CASAPPA KP 30.38 - 05 S6 - LMF
Type ...................................................................................................................................... double gear pump
Displacement ............................................................................. 40.258 + 35.427 cm3/rev (2.45 + 2.16 in3/rev)
16 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

PUMP (97 HP ENGINE) 1st PUMP 2nd PUMP


Direction of rotation (looking on drive
Clockwise (D)
shaft)
35.427 cm3/rev 35.427 cm3/rev
Displacement
(2.16 in3/rev) (2.16 in3/rev)
Inlet pressure range for pump 0.7 - 3 bar (10 - 43 psi)
Maximum continuous pressure P1 260 bar (3771 psi) 260 bar (3771 psi)
Maximum intermittent pressure P2 280 bar (4061 psi) 280 bar (4061 psi)
Maximum peak pressure P3 300 bar (4351 psi) 300 bar (4351 psi)
Operating temperature -25 to -80 °C (-13 to -112 °F)
min P1 350 rpm
Speed
max P1 3000 rpm
recommended 2
12 to 100 mm /s (0.47 to 3.93 in/s²) (cSt)
Viscosity range
permitted max 750 mm2/s (29.53 in/s²) (cSt)
Dp > 200 bar (2900 psi) 8 - Nas 1638
bx = 75 - 10 mm (3.0 - 0.39 in) 19 / 17 /14 - ISO 4406
Contamination class
Dp < 200 bar (2900 psi) 10 - Nas 1638
bx = 75 - 25 mm (3.0 - 0.98 in) 21 / 19 /16 - ISO 4406
Relief valve 177 ± 3 bar (2567 - 43 psi)
Stand by pressure load sensing valve 7 bar (102 psi)
Weight 30 kg (66 lb)

PUMP (110 HP ENGINE) 1st PUMP 2nd PUMP


Direction of rotation (looking on drive
Clockwise (D)
shaft)
40.258 cm3/rev 35.427 cm3/rev
Displacement
(2.45 in3/rev) (2.16 in3/rev)
Inlet pressure range for pump 0.7 - 3 bar (10 - 43 psi)
Maximum continuous pressure P1 260 bar (3771 psi) 260 bar (3771 psi)
Maximum intermittent pressure P2 280 bar (4061 psi) 280 bar (4061 psi)
Maximum peak pressure P3 300 bar (4351 psi) 300 bar (4351 psi)
Operating temperature -25 to -80 °C (-13 to -112 °F)
min P1 350 rpm
Speed
max P1 3000 rpm
recommended 12 to 100 mm2/s (0.47 to 3.93 in/s²) (cSt)
Viscosity range
permitted max 750 mm2/s (29.53 in/s²) (cSt)
Dp > 200 bar (2900 psi) 8 - Nas 1638
bx = 75 - 10 mm (3.0 - 0.39 in) 19 / 17 /14 - ISO 4406
Contamination class
Dp < 200 bar (2900 psi) 10 - Nas 1638
bx = 75 - 25 mm (3.0 - 0.98 in) 21 / 19 /16 - ISO 4406
Relief valve 177 ± 3 bar (2567 - 43 psi)
Stand by pressure load sensing valve 7 bar (102 psi)
Weight 30 kg (66 lb)
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 17

Tightening torques

Hydraulic diagram
18 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

LOAD-SENSING VALVE

1. Orifice 8. Steering relief valve


2. Rear systems (EF) 9. Relief valve adjuster
3. Filter 10. Poppet
4. Spool 11. Return to inlet pump port
5. To steering priority flow (CF) 12. Lock plug
6. Orifice 13. Load sensing signal (LS)
7. Inlet port from rear pump (IN) 14. Orifice

When the steering is in neutral the load sensing port


is connected to the unload (through the steering)
and the steering inlet port (CF) is open.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 19

Load sensing valve with pump running - Steering in neutral


Return to oil tank
Trapped oil
Pressure oil
1. Orifice 5. To steering priority flow (CF)
2. Rear systems (EF) 6. Orifice
3. Filter 7. Inlet port (from rear port)
4. Spool

The pressure on (CF) increases until the pressure value (stand-by pressure) is sufficient to move the spool
valve in a way to divert the flow toward (EF).

Load sensing valve with pump running - Steering working


Trapped oil
Return to oil tank
1. Orifice 5. To steering priority flow (CF)
2. Rear systems (EF) 6. Orifice
3. Filter 7. Inlet port (from rear port)
4. Spool

During steering two actions are performed:


1. The fluid moves to the steering through (CF).
2. The (LS) signal is in communication to the steering.
20 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

COMPONENTS

1. Screw 19. Bushing


2. Steering control valve 20. Gasket
3. Spool 21. Bushing
4. O-ring 22. Elastic retainer
5. Plug 23. Bearing
6. Valve 24. Gear
7. Filter 25. Gear
8. Fitting 26. Front pump body
9. Spring seat 27. Gasket
10. Spring 28. Gear
11. O-ring 29. Flange
12. Cover 30. Seal ring
13. Relief valve 31. Seal ring
14. O-ring 32. Snap ring
15. Poppet 33. Pressure seal
16. Spring 34. Gear
17. Seat 35. O-ring
18. Rear pump body 36. Screw
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 21

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Disassembly of the steering control valve
To aid reassembly draw an alignment line along the
total length of the pump assembly.
Remove the screws (1).

Remove the load-sensing steering control valve (2).


Check and replace the O-rings (35), if necessary.

Disassembly of the steering control valve


Do not disassemble the steering system relief valve
(A) if the valve’s pressure is to specification when
pressure-testing the pump prior to overhaul.
NOTE: if the steering system pressure relief valve is
disassembled, the valve must be reset as described
in Chapter “Troubleshooting, pressure and flow test-
ing”.
Wash all components in an approved degreasant
and check the following:
- the valve bore must be free from scoring or dam-
age to metering edges;
- the spool (3) should slide freely in the bore and
must be free from scoring or damage;
- ensure all orifices are clean;
- the valve seat must not show cavities or damage
(a small chamfer at the entrance of the bore is
allowed);
- examine the filter (7) mounted inside the outlet
and relief valves and replace the filter if dirty.
Pressure and flow test the pump.
22 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Rear pump disassembly


Remove the screws (36).

Remove the rear pump assembly (18).

IMPORTANT: prior to disassembly and to ensure


correct reassembly identify the position of each
bearing block in the pump body as described below.
Write an identifying letter “A” and “B”, “C” and “D” on
the pump housing and in the channel of each bear-
ing block.

NOTE: orientation of bearing block seals relative to


oil port.
If scribe is not available take care to keep bearing
blocks in pairs.

Disassemble the gears (24), the seals (33), the


elastic retainers (22) and the bearings (23).
Wash all components in approved degreasant.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 23

Inspect the wear track cut by the gears in pump


body. The body can be reused if the track is bright
and polished and does not exceed 0.08 ÷ 0.076 mm
(0.0031 ÷ 0.0029 in) in depth.
Examine bearing block faces for scoring and flat-
ness, paying particular attention to the face which
abuts the gears.
Examine bearing block bushes for scoring.
Examine pump gears for scored or worn side faces,
journals and damaged teeth.
If pump block, gears or bearing blocks are worn and
require replacement the pump assembly must be
replaced.
Re-assemble using the disassembly procedure in
reverse order and observe the following warnings:
- ensure that all parts are perfectly clean and lubri-
cate bushes and gears with clean hydraulic fluid;
- replace all seals and O-rings;
- install the bearing blocks into the same positions
from which they were removed, using the identifi-
cation letters written during disassembly;
- ensure plastic back-up seals are correctly posi-
tioned in the rubber seal.
24 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Front pump disassembly


To remove the pump assy (26) from the flange (29)
it is necessary to remove the snap ring (33).
Remove and replace the seal rings (30) and (31).

Identify and note the position of each bearing block


to ensure correct reassembly.
Disassemble the gears (28) and (34), the seals
(33), the elastic retainers and the bearings (23).
Wash all components in approved degreasant.

Inspect the wear track cut by the gears in the inlet


side of the pump body. The body can be reused if
the track is bright and polished and does not
exceed 0.15 mm (0.006 in) in depth.
Examine bearing block faces for scoring.
Inspect teflon coated bearings in body or flange for
wear. If bearings are worn the bronze backing will
be revealed.
Examine pump gears for scored or worn side faces,
journals and damaged teeth.
Examine flange seal contact area on driveshaft. If
pump block, gears, bearing blocks or drive shaft are
worn the pump assembly must be replaced.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 25

Re-assemble using the disassembly procedure in


reverse order and observe the following warnings:
- ensure that all parts are perfectly clean and lubri-
cate bushes and gears with clean hydraulic oil;
- replace all seals and O-rings;
- install bearing blocks into the same positions from
which they were removed;
- make sure the safety retainers are correctly posi-
tioned in the rubber seal rings.

Assemble the inner seal, (30), with the spring and


the lip facing the pump.
Install the outer seal ring (31), with the spring and
the lip facing outwards and refit the snap ring (30).
Coat the rings with high melting point grease.
NOTE: ensure seal rings are fitted back to back.
NOTE: if the seal ring recess has been scored dur-
ing seal removal, coat the outside diameter of the
seal ring with flexible gasket sealant to prevent
leakage.
26 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

HYDRAULIC VARIABLE-FLOW-RATE PISTON PUMP


As an alternative to the fixed-flow-rate gear pump,
the machine can be provided with another type of
variable-flow-rate pump.

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
72 kW - 97 HP Pump (B90B - B100B - B100BTC)
Model ....................................................................................................................... DANFOSS J71C Series 45
Type ......................................................................................................................................... with axial pistons
Displacement .............................................................................................................. 71 cm3/rev (4.33 in3/rev)
82 kW - 110 HP Pump (B110B - B110BTC - B115B)
Model ....................................................................................................................... DANFOSS J75C Series 45
Type ......................................................................................................................................... with axial pistons
Displacement ............................................................................................................... 75 cm3/rev (4.57 in3/rev)
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 27

COMPONENTS
28 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

1. Snap ring 32. Piston disc


2. Seal ring 33. Articulation
3. Pump body 34. Pin
4. O-ring 35. Cylinder
5. Plug 36. Washer
6. Plug 37. Spring
7. O-ring 38. Washer
8. Bearing 39. Ring
9. Shaft 40. Plug
10. Cradle bearing 41. O-ring
11. Pin 42. Spool
12. Snap ring 43. Plug
13. Pin 44. O-ring
14. Swash plate 45. Spool
15. Spring 46. Valve body
16. Piston 47. O-ring
17. Cylinder assy 48. Plug
18. O-ring 49. Spring guide
19. Bearing 50. Spring
20. Pin 51. Spring
21. Valve plate 52. O-ring
22. Check valve 53. Adjusting screw
23. Spring 54. Plug
24. O-ring 55. O-ring
25. Plug 56. Spring guide
26. Cover 57. Spring
27. Screw 58. Spring
28. O-ring 59. Back-up ring
29. Load-sensing control valve 60. O-ring
30. Screw 61. Adjusting screw
31. Piston 62. Dowel
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 29

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Disassembly
Remove the load-sensing control valve (29) by
removing the 4 screws (30).
Remove and discard the 4 O-rings (28).

Loosen and remove the 4 screws (27).


Carefully remove the end cap (26).
Prevent the valve plate (21) from falling off.
Place the end cap and valve plate in a clean area,
protecting them from contamination.
Remove the bearing (19) and the O-ring (18).

Tilt the pump body to allow oil to drain.


Remove the cylinder assy (17).
Set the cylinder assy on a clean and dry surface.
30 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Rotate the pump body (3) to a position so that the


shaft is pointing down.
Pull the shaft (9) out of the pump body (3).
Compress the spring (15) and rotate the piston (16)
towards the swash plate (14).
Lift the swashplate/piston assy until it is tilted and
remove it from the pump body (3).
Remove the piston (16) and the spring (15) from the
swashplate (17) by removing the pin (13) and the
snap ring (12).

Remove the bearing (8).


Examine the cradle bearings (10) to determine if
they need replacement.
Removing the pins (11) will likely damage the cradle
bearings, so make sure you have replacement
bearings before you remove them.
If cradle bearings (10) need replacing, remove the 2
pins (11).
Note the location and orientation of the bearings for
re-installation.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 31

Orientate the pump body (3) with the flange facing


up.
Remove the snap ring (1).
Carefully pry out the seal ring (2).
In case it is not possible to extract the seal ring (2),
try to push the seal out by going through the inside
of the pump body (3).

Disassembly of the load-sensing control valve


(29)
Remove the 4 plugs (40), (43), (48), (54) and their
O-rings (41), (44), (47), (55).
Remove the 2 screws (62).
Remove the spools (42), (45). Note which bore
each spool came out of.
Also note the orientation of each spool for reinser-
tion.
There may be differences in reinserting into the
same bore.
Remove the adjusting screw (53) and the O-ring
(52).
Remove the springs (51), (50) and the spring guide
(49).
Remove the adjusting screw (61), the O-ring (60)
and the back-up ring (59).
Remove the springs (57), (58) and the spring guide
(56).
32 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Disassembly of cylinder assy (17)


Pull to extract the piston disc (32) with the pistons
(31) from the cylinder (35).
Number the pistons and bores for reassembly if
they are to be reused.
Remove the articulation (33).
Remove the 3 pins (34).
NOTE: perform this procedure only if you suspect
problems with the spring.
Turn the cylinder (35) over. Using a press, apply
pressure on the washer (38) to compress the spring
(37). Compress the spring enough to safely remove
the ring (39).
Carefully release the pressure and remove the
washer (38), the spring (37) and the washer (36)
from the cylinder (35).

S WARNING S
Compressing the spring (37) requires about
350 ÷ 400 N (79 ÷ 90 lbf).
Use a press sufficient to maintain this force.
Ensure that the spring is secure before attempting
to remove the ring (39).
Release the pressure slowly after the ring (39) has
been removed.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 33

Inspection
After disassembly, wash all parts (including the end
cap and the pump body) thoroughly with clean sol-
vent and allow to air dry.
Clean the oil ducts in the pump body and the end
cover with compressed air.
Conduct inspection in a clean area and keep all
parts free from contamination.
Inspect the pistons (31) for damage and discolora-
tion. Discoloured pistons may indicate excessive
heat; do not reuse.
Inspect the running surface of the pistons (A).
Replace all pistons with scored or excessively
rounded edges. Measure the piston foot thickness
(B). Replace all excessively worn pistons.
Check the axial end-play (C).
Replace all pistons with excessive end-play.

Foot thickness (B) 3.23 mm (0.13 in)


Piston axial end-play (C) 0.05 mm (0.002 in)
The articulation (33) should be free of nicks and
scratches, and should not be excessively scored.
Examine for discoloration that may indicate exces-
sive heat or lack of lubrication.
The piston disc (32) must be flat. The pistons must
insert with a minimum side play.
Place the pins (34) on a flat surface and roll them to
make sure they are straight.
Discard and replace any damaged parts.

If the cylinder assy was fully dissembled, visual


inspection of the cylinder block, spring (37) and
washers (36), (38) should indicate minimal wear.
Replace if cracks or other damage is present.
34 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Examine the running face of the cylinder (35). The


surface should be smooth and free of nicks and
burrs.
Ensure that no scratches or grooves exist; these
may drastically reduce output flow.

Minimum height (D) 62.25 mm (2.45 in)


Maximum bore diameter (E) 19.8 mm (0.78 in)

Inspection of the load-sensing control valve (29).


Carefully examine the plugs (40), (43), (48), (54) for
signs of wear.
Inspect all springs to make sure they are intact.
Check the inside and outside surfaces of the
springs for wear.
Check the spool’s (42), (45) outside diameter for
scratches and/or burrs.
Clean and coat all spools, bores and seals with a
light coating of oil.

Make sure that the shaft (9) and its splines are
straight and free of damage or heavy wear.
Inspect the shaft surface where it meets the seal
ring.
Replace the shaft if a groove exists at the sealing
land surface that may let dirt into or hydraulic oil out
of the unit.
Clean the sealing area with non-abrasive material.
Lubricate the shaft with a light coat of oil.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 35

Carefully inspect each surface of the swashplate


(14) for wear. All swashplate surfaces should be
smooth.
Inspect the swashplate’s running surface for dam-
age and brass transfer.
Excessive transfer may indicate that the pistons
should be replaced.
Finally, check the swashplate pin for scratches.

Inspect the cradle bearings (10) for damage or


excessive wear.
The polymer wear layer must be smooth and intact.
Replace if scratched or excessively worn.
Inspect the valve plate (21) for scratches or
grooves.
Check the plate for evidence of any cavitation along
the running face.
If pitting from cavitation exists, replace the valve
plate.
Check for excess wear on the running face. If any
discoloration or burn marks are observed, replace.
Run a fingernail or a pencil tip across the diameter
of the sealing land surface. No deep or outstanding
grooves should be felt, as these may decrease
pump flow. Lap or replace if grooves or nicks are
present.
Inspect the mating surfaces of the end cap and
valve plate for any possible contamination.
Measure the thickness of the valve plate (21).
Ensure that valve plate parallelism is equal to or
less than 0.025 mm (0.0010 in).
Appearance should be flat and smooth on both the
running face and the bottom surface.
The valve plate should be flat to 0.005 mm (0.0002 in)
convex.
Carry out a magnetic particle inspection to detect
possible cracks.
The plate (21) must be replaced in case of cracks.
36 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Check the cover (26).


Remove the check valve (22) to expose the spring
(23).
Check and record orientation of the pin (20). The
split in the pin should be facing into or out of the slot
in the valve plate.
Inspect the check valve (22) for wear on its sealing
face.
Make sure the spring (23) is undamaged.
Replace any components if excess wear is present.

Check that the piston assy (16) for any obvious


wear or damage.
Check the corresponding end cap bore for galling or
excessive wear.

Inspect the pump body (3) to ensure that it is clean


and free of foreign material.
Inspect the surfaces of the cradle bearings and the
mating surfaces of the end cover.

The bearings (8) consist of a race (B) and a cone


(A).
Make sure the cup (B) and cone (A) are free of
excessive wear or contamination.
Rotate the bearing to check for smoothness.
If a contaminated bearing is suspected, clean with
solvent and lubricate with hydraulic oil.
Inspect for uneven wear.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 37

Assembly
Coat the cradle bearings (10) with oil and install
them into the pump body (3).
Insert the pins (11) a minimum of 0.5 mm (0.02 in)
below the bearing surface.
If the bearings (10) are reused, reinstall them in
their original position.
Install the bearing (8).
Before replacing the spring (15), coat the contact
surface of the swashplate (14) with oil.
Assemble the swashplate (14), and the piston (16)
and the spring (15) into the pump body (3).
Rotate the piston (16) perpendicularly to the swash-
plate (14) and, at the same time, compress the spring
(15) to fit it into the pump body (3).
Liberally lubricate all sides of the piston (16) and its
relevant bore and also the flat face of the swash-
plate to prevent premature wear during start-up.
Insert the shaft (9) through the bearing in the body.
Push on the piston to rotate the swashplate in order
to put the shaft in properly.

Lubricate components before assembly.


Install the inner washer (36), the spring (37) and the
outer washer (38) into the cylinder (35). Compress
the spring enough to insert the ring (39).

S WARNING S
Compressing the spring (37) requires about
350 ÷ 400 N (79 ÷ 90 lbf). Use a press suffi-
cient to maintain this force.
Ensure that the spring is secure before attempting
to assemble the ring (39).
Release the pressure slowly after the ring (39) has
been installed.

Turn the cylinder over and assemble the pins (34)


and the ball guide (33) into the cylinder (35).
Assemble the pistons (31) on the piston disc (32).
Install the piston/disc assy into the cylinder (35).
Ensure the concave surface of the disc seats cor-
rectly in the ball guide. If reusing the pistons, install
them to the original cylinder bores.
Lubricate the pistons (31), the piston disc (32) and
the ball guide (33) before assembly.
IMPORTANT: make sure to install the piston disc
(32) so that it mates correctly with the articulation
(33), the concave side of the disc against the con-
vex side of the ball guide.
38 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Secure the end of the shaft with one hand and keep
it horizontal. Insert the cylinder assy (17) onto the
shaft (9).
While holding the shaft still, slightly rotate the cylin-
der assy (17) to help position the shaft splines over
the ball guide and align them with the cylinder
splines.
When the cylinder slides completely over the shaft
splines, reposition the body with the flange facing
downward.

Clean the valve plate (21) and the end cap.


Assemble the pin (20) in the end cap (26) and verify
that it is properly oriented with the split facing into or
out of the slot in the valve plate (21).
The pin should be installed to 3.61 ± 0.25 mm
(0.1421 ± 0.0098 in) above the valve plate (21) sur-
face.
Apply a liberal amount of grease to the backside of
the valve plate (21) surface to hold it in position.
Assemble the valve plate (21) over the pin (20).
Assemble the spring (23) and the check valve (22).
To ensure proper pump operation, it is extremely
important to guarantee that there is no contamina-
tion between the end cap (26) and the valve plate
(21).
Assemble the bearing cup (19).
Assemble the bearing race (19) onto the shaft (9).
Apply some grease to keep the O-ring (18) in place.
Assemble the cover (26) to the body (3).
Screw in and tighten the screws (27) to a tightening
torque of 127 ÷ 155 Nm (94 ÷ 114 lbf·ft).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 39

Lubricate the seal ring (2) with oil.


Place a protective sleeve over the shaft end (9) to
prevent damage to the seal ring during installation.
Holding the seal ring (2) perpendicular to the shaft
(9), press it into the body just far enough to clear the
ring groove.
Assemble with the concave side towards the shaft
bearing.
Assemble the snap ring (1).
40 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

CONTROL VALVES
The hydraulic circuit is a load-sensing flow sharing LOADER CONTROL VALVE
system working together with a hydraulic pump.
The loader control valve is mounted on the right
This system has the advantage that at any time the side of the machine adjacent to the pump.
distribution of flow to the services being operated is The control valve assembly consists of a maximum
in proportion to the openings of the control valve of three sections and provides oil to the loader
spools. attachment, to the bucket and to the 4x1 bucket, if
The flow distribution to the backhoe and loader installed.
control valves is independent of the load and it is
therefore possible to operate two or more spools at BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE
the same time. The backhoe attachment control valve is located in
Important components of the system are the pres- the rear part of the machine.
sure compensator valves in each control valve sec- The control valve consists of a maximum of 7 or 8
tion, together with the load-sensing line which sections and provides the oil flow for operating the
connects all spools of the loader and backhoe lifting, the digging, the bucket, the stabilizers, the
attachment control valves. swing, the (optional) telescopic arm and the auxil-
With the fixed-flow-rate hydraulic pump, the load- iary services, if installed.
sensing line only connects the loader and backhoe
attachment control valves and does not have any
connection to the hydraulic pump.
The hydraulic pump draws oil from the tank and
flow from the front pump is directed to the centre
galleries of the loader and backhoe control valves
assemblies.
The flow coming from the rear section of the pump
passes through the flow divider valve and sends
the priority flow to the steering system, while the
remaining flow adds to the flow from the front
pump, directed to the loader and backhoe attach-
ment systems.
The centre gallery of both the loader and backhoe
control valves are blocked by the end plate.
Pressure in the supply system is controlled by the
pump flow balancer valve in accordance with the
pressure in the load-sensing line.
Consequently, the higher the load sensing pressure
is, the less flow is returned to the tank, with a corre-
sponding increase in flow/pressure to the hydraulic
systems.
Maximum system pressure is limited by the load
sense pressure relief valve which relieves pressure in
the load sense line when it reaches 210 bar (304 psi).
Since the flow balancer valve is influenced by the
load-sensing pressure, the valve diverts a sufficient
quantity of oil to the tank to maintain the maximum
system pressure of 210 bar (304 psi).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 41

SYSTEM DIAGRAM (BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MECHANICAL CONTROLS)

Hydraulic system oil Suction oil


Steering system oil Return to oil tank
Load-sensing line oil

1. Hydraulic tank 8. Backhoe hammer control valve


2. Hydraulic pump 9. Backhoe hammer
3. Power steering 10. Oil cooler
4. Hand hammer control valve 11. Return line distributor block
5. Hand hammer 12. Filter
6. Backhoe attachment control valve 13. Oil cooler by-pass valve
7. Loader attachment control valve
42 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

SYSTEM DIAGRAM (BACKHOE ATTACHMENT PILOT CONTROLS)

Hydraulic system oil Suction oil


Steering system oil Return to oil tank
Load-sensing line oil Control circuit oil

1. Hydraulic tank 9. Backhoe hammer


2. Pump 10. Oil cooler
3. Power steering 11. Return line distributor block
4. Hand hammer control valve 12. Filter
5. Hand hammer 13. Oil cooler by-pass valve
6. Backhoe attachment control valve 14. Solenoid valve for piloting backhoe control
7. Loader attachment control valve valve
8. Backhoe hammer control valve 15. Hydraulic control lever
16. Accumulator
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 43

OIL FLOW OPERATION


All loader/backhoe attachment systems are in
neutral position
Each control valve section within the backhoe or
loader control valve assemblies contains a spool,
two check valves and a load-sensing pressure com-
pensator.
A load-sensing gallery connects the compensators
in each control valve section.
When all control valves are in neutral position, the
spools stop the oil flow in each system and the pres-
sure of the load-sensing line can bleed to the tank
through the relevant return-to-tank port.
Because there is no load sense pressure being
applied to the rear face of the flow balancer valve,
the valve will move against the spring and off its
seat when pump pressure reaches 15 bar (217 psi).
The pump flow is now diverted back to the tank and
the balancer valve maintains a stand-by pressure of
15 bar (217 psi) while the systems are in neutral
position.

Flow balancer valve operation - All spools in neutral


Pump stand-by pressure 15 bar (217 psi) Return to oil tank

1. Load sense bleed orifice 1 l/min (0.22 gal/min) 4. Load sense line
2. Load-sensing limiter 5. Pump flow balancer (unload) valve
(system pressure relief valve) 6. Pump flow IN
3. Return to oil tank 7. To backhoe control valves
44 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Load sensing flow sharing - All spools in neutral


Pump pressure Return to oil tank
Trapped oil

1. Load non-return check valve 3. Pressure compensator


2. Load sense line 4. Spool
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 45

One hydraulic circuit operating


When a single hydraulic circuit is operated the When pump pressure overcomes the pressure
spool in the control valve section is moved allowing behind the load check valve, the valve opens allow-
oil to flow past the lands of the spool and apply ing oil to flow into the cylinder port.
pressure to the metering element of the pressure Exhaust oil from the cylinder returns to tank through
compensating valve. the other port in the control valve section.
The metering element moves upwards to allow oil
If pressure in a load-sensing system reaches 195 bar
to flow to the load check valve and at the same time
(2828 psi), the relief valve is activated.
uncovers the drilling in the spool portion of the
pressure compensator valve enabling operating Pump pressure is now limited to 210 bar (304 psi).
pressure to be sensed in the load sense gallery. This is the pressure required to overcome the pres-
sure of the flow balancing valve spring [15 bar
As pressure increases to open the check valve, the (217 psi)] plus the load sensing pressure controlled
load-sensing pressure is applied to the spring side at 195 bar (2828 psi).
of the flow balancer valve.
A higher pressure is now required to operate the
flow balancer valve and pump pressure increase
accordingly.

Flow balancer valve operation - Hydraulic systems operating


Pump pressure
Load-sensing pressure
Return to oil tank
1. Load sense bleed orifice 1 l/min (0.22 gal/min) 4. Load sense line
2. Load-sensing limiter 5. Pump flow balancer (unload) valve
(system pressure relief valve) 6. Pump flow IN
3. Return to oil tank 7. To backhoe control valves
46 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Load sensing flow sharing - One spool operating


Pump pressure
Trapped oil
Return to oil tank
1. Load non-return check valve 3. Pressure compensator
2. Load sense line 4. Spool
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 47

Two or more hydraulic systems operating


When two or more hydraulic systems operate, each Pump pressure will rise until it exceeds the pressure
system operates at a different pressure. of the check valve of the system operating at the
heaviest load and the pressure in the load sensing
If pump flow to a specific system is not controlled, the
line has a value similar to that of the high pressure.
system requiring a lower operating pressure will work
faster than the system requiring a higher pressure, The pressure required to operate the system with a
because the flow will have to overcome less resist- lower load is now too high and, if not limited, it will
ance. result in this system operating instead of and faster
than the system with a higher load.
To prevent this situation, the pressure compensating
valve regulates the oil flow directed to the system To compensate for this condition, the load sensing
operating at a lower load. pressure moves the metering element of the pressure
compensating valve in the system with a lower load
When two spools are operated simultaneously pump
downwards and restricts the flow to the system.
pressure is applied to the metering element of the
pressure compensating valve in both valve sections. This balancing of flow and pressure according to the
load ensures that both systems operate simultane-
Both metering elements therefore move upwards
ously and at a balanced flow rate.
allowing oil to flow to the load check valves. At the
same time, the port in the spool section of the pres-
sure compensating valve is uncovered to allow oper-
ating pressure to be sensed in the load-sensing
gallery.

Load sense relief valve operating


Pump pressure at 210 bar (304 psi) Return to oil tank
Load sense pressure at 195 bar (2828 psi)

1. Load sense bleed orifice 1 l/min (0.22 gal/min) 4. Load sense line
2. Load sense limiter (system relief valve) 5. Pump flow balancer (unload) valve
3. Return to oil tank 6. Pump flow IN
7. To backhoe control valves
48 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Load sensing flow sharing - Two spools operating


1st spool operating pressure Trapped oil
2nd spool operating pressure Return to oil tank

1. Load non-return check valve 3. Pressure compensator


2. Load sense line 4. Spool
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 49

LOADER CONTROL VALVE


The loader control valve is mounted on the right side
of the machine adjacent to the pump.
This control valve may be of 2 types, similar to each
other, according to the hydraulic pump assembled to
the machine:
- gear pump (with fixed flow rate);
- piston pump (with variable flow rate).
The control valve consists of 2 or 3 sections, an end
cover and an inlet section.
The 3 control valve sections are:
- loader attachment lifting;
- loader bucket;
- 4x1 loader bucket.
The loader attachment control valve has three sec-
tions when the 4x1 bucket is installed on the
machine.

LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE WITH GEAR PUMP (WITH FIXED FLOW RATE)

A. 4x1 loader bucket section


B. Bucket section
C. Loader attachment lifting section
1. End cover
2. Bucket relief valve (rod side) - 240 bar (3481 psi)
3. Bucket relief valve (piston side) - 165 bar
(2393 psi)
4. Hydraulic speed relief valve - 165 bar (2393 psi)
5. 4x1 bucket relief valve - 240 bar (3481 psi)
6. Hydraulic speed solenoid
7. Inlet spool
50 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE WITH PISTON PUMP (WITH VARIABLE FLOW RATE)

A. 4x1 loader bucket section


B. Bucket section
C. Loader attachment lifting section
1. End cover
2. Bucket relief valve (rod side) - 240 bar (3481 psi)
3. Bucket relief valve (piston side) - 165 bar (2393 psi)
4. 4x1 bucket relief valve - 240 bar (3481 psi)
5. Inlet spool
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 51

CONTROL VALVE REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Lower the loader attachment to the ground.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Lower the stabilizers to the ground.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key
to ON and release the pressure by moving the
hydraulic control levers in all directions.
Place some wedges under the wheels so as to pre-
vent the machine from moving.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Drain oil from the hydraulic system.
Disconnect the battery.
Clean the area around the control valve.
Identify and disconnect the articulations, cables and
hoses and plug the hose ends.
A drip tray will be required to catch oil draining from
inside the hoses.
Loosen and remove the fastening screws.
Remove the control valve assembly from the
machine.
For installation, follow the removal procedure in
reverse order.
52 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

DISASSEMBLY
Loosen and remove the 3 nuts (1).
[Tightening torque = 42 Nm (30.97 lbf·ft) ± 10%]
Extract the 3 tie rods (2).

Remove the end cover (7).


Disassemble the sections of the control valve (4),
(5) and (6) and the inlet section (3).
Check and, if necessary, replace the O-rings (8)
located between the different sections of the control
valve.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 53

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE


The backhoe attachment control valve is located in
the rear part of the machine.
The backhoe attachment control valve may be of 2
types, similar to each other, according to the
hydraulic pump installed on the machine:
- gear pump (with fixed flow rate);
- piston pump (with variable flow rate);
Furthermore, the backhoe attachment control valves
are divided into:
- control valves for backhoe attachment mechanical
controls;
- control valves for backhoe attachment pilot con-
trols.
The backhoe attachment control valve may consist
of 6 or 7 or 8 sections, an end cover and an inlet
section.
The possible 8 sections are:
- right-hand stabilizer;
- left-hand stabilizer;
- boom;
- digging;
- swing;
- bucket;
- telescopic dipper (optional);
- auxiliary attachment (only optional on control
valves for backhoe attachment pilot controls).
54 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE - BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MECHANICAL CONTROLS


The backhoe attachment control valves for
machines with backhoe attachment mechanical
controls may have 6 or 7 sections (and not 8 sec-
tions).
With gear pump

A. Right stabilizer section 1. End cover


B. Left stabilizer section 2. Inlet section
C. Dipper section 3. Dipper relief valve - 240 bar (3481 psi)
D. Bucket section 4. Bucket relief valve - 220 bar (3191 psi)
E. Swing section 5. Swing relief valve - 205 bar (2973 psi)
F. Boom section 6. Boom relief valve (rod side) - 240 bar (3481 psi)
G. Telescopic dipper section 7. Boom relief valve (piston side) - 310 bar (4496 psi)
8. Telescopic dipper relief valve - 124 bar (1798 psi)
9. Pump flow rate balancer valve - 10 bar (145 psi)
10. Load-sensing relief valve - 205 bar (2973 psi)
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 55

With piston pump

A. Right stabilizer section 1. End cover


B. Left stabilizer section 2. Inlet section
C. Dipper section 3. Dipper relief valve - 240 bar (3481 psi)
D. Bucket section 4. Bucket relief valve - 220 bar (3191 psi)
E. Swing section 5. Swing relief valve - 205 bar (2973 psi)
F. Boom section 6. Boom relief valve (rod side) - 240 bar (3481 psi)
G. Telescopic dipper section 7. Boom relief valve (piston side) - 310 bar (4496 psi)
8. Telescopic dipper relief valve - 124 bar (1798 psi)
9. Pump flow rate balancer valve - 10 bar (145 psi)
56 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

CONTROL VALVE REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Lower the loader attachment and the backhoe
attachment to the ground.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Lower the stabilizers to the ground.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key
to ON and release the pressure by moving the
hydraulic control levers in all directions.
Place some wedges under the wheels so as to pre-
vent the machine from moving.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Drain oil from the hydraulic system.
Disconnect the battery.
Clean the area around the control valve.
Identify the position of all hoses to be disconnected
and tag them.
Disconnect the hoses and plug their ends.
Disconnect the manual control levers.
Loosen and remove the fastening screws.
Remove the control valve assembly from the
machine.
For installation, follow the removal procedure in
reverse order.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 57

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Loosen and remove the 3 nuts (1).
[Tightening torque = 42 Nm (30.97 lbf·ft) ± 10%]
Extract the 3 tie rods (2).

Remove the end cover (3).


Disassemble the sections of the control valve (4),
(5), (6), (7), (8), (9) and (10) and the inlet section
(11).
Check and, if necessary, replace the O-rings (12)
located between the different sections of the control
valve.

Inlet section disassembly


Remove the flow balancer valve (13).
[Tightening torque = 100 Nm (73.76 lbf·ft)]
Remove the load-sensing valve (14).
[Tightening torque = 45 Nm (33.19 lbf·ft)]
Remove the pressure relief valve (15).
Unscrew and remove the plugs (16) and (17).
Unscrew and remove the plug (18).
[Tightening torque = 20 Nm (15 lbf·ft)]
58 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Disassembly of the end cover


Remove the relief valve (19).
Remove the valve (20).

Disassemble the control valve sections

NOTE: The figure shows the stabilizer section, the - extract the spring (27) with the relevant spring
valves may be different in the other sections. guides (26);
Remove the check valves (21). - keep the seal (29).
[Tightening torque = 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft)] - loosen and remove the yoke (30) with the protec-
Remove the flow balancer valve (22). tion (31);
[Tightening torque = 60 Nm (44 lbf·ft)] [Tightening torque = 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)]
- loosen and remove the screws (32);
[Tightening torque = 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)]
Remove the spool: - remove the flange (33) with the relevant seal
- loosen and remove the screws (23); (34);
[Tightening torque = 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)] - keep the seal (35);
- remove the cover (24) and the seal (28); - extract the spool (36).
- loosen and remove the pin (25);
[Tightening torque = 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)]
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 59

Assembly of spool seals


Position the metal part of the seal (29) on the out-
side of the spool (36).
The seal must be fitted on the end of the spool so
that its grooves (S) are not damaged and its tight-
ness is not jeopardized.
Let the seal slide perpendicularly onto the spool.
60 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE - BACKHOE ATTACHMENT PILOT CONTROLS


The backhoe attachment control valves for
machines with backhoe attachment pilot controls
may have 6 or 7 or 8 sections.
With gear pump

A. Right stabilizer section 3. Dipper relief valve - 220 bar (3191 psi)
B. Left stabilizer section 4. Backhoe bucket relief valve - 240 bar (3481 psi)
C. Dipper section 5. Swing relief valve - 205 bar (2973 psi)
D. Bucket section 6. Boom relief valve (rod side) - 124 bar (1798 psi)
E. Swing section 7. Boom relief valve (piston side) - 310 bar
F. Boom section (4496 psi)
G. Telescopic dipper section 8. Telescopic dipper relief valve - 124 bar (1798 psi)
H. Auxiliary section 9. Auxiliary section relief valves - 220 bar (3191 psi)
1. End cover 10. Pump flow rate balancer valve - 10 bar (145 psi)
2. Inlet section 11. Load-sensing relief valve - 205 bar (2973 psi)
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 61

With piston pump

A. Right stabilizer section 1. End cover


B. Left stabilizer section 2. Inlet section
C. Dipper section 3. Dipper relief valve - 220 bar (3191 psi)
D. Bucket section 4. Backhoe bucket relief valve - 240 bar (3481 psi)
E. Swing section 5. Swing relief valve - 205 bar (2973 psi)
F. Boom section 6. Boom relief valve (rod side) - 124 bar (1798 psi)
G. Telescopic dipper section 7. Boom relief valve (piston side) - 310 bar
H. Auxiliary section (4496 psi)
8. Telescopic dipper relief valve - 124 bar (1798 psi)
9. Auxiliary section relief valves - 220 bar (3191 psi)
10. Pump flow rate balancer valve - 10 bar (145 psi)
62 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

CONTROL VALVE REMOVAL FROM MACHINE


Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away
from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Lower the loader attachment and the backhoe
attachment to the ground.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Lower the stabilizers to the ground.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions.
On hydraulically controlled machines, turn the key
to ON and release the pressure by moving the
hydraulic control levers in all directions.
Place some wedges under the wheels so as to pre-
vent the machine from moving.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Drain oil from the hydraulic system.
Disconnect the battery.
Clean the area around the control valve.
Identify the position of all hoses to be disconnected
and tag them.
Disconnect the hoses and plug their ends.
Disconnect the manual control levers.
Loosen and remove the fastening screws.
Remove the valve assembly from the machine.
For installation, follow the removal procedure in
reverse order.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 63

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Loosen and remove the 3 nuts (1).
[Tightening torque = 42 Nm (30.97 lbf·ft) ± 10%]
Extract the 3 tie rods (2).

Remove the end cover (3).


Disassemble the sections of the control valve (4),
(5), (6), (7), (8), (9), (10) and (11) and the inlet sec-
tion (12).
Check and, if necessary, replace the O-rings (13)
located between the different sections of the control
valve.

Inlet section disassembly


Remove the flow balancer valve (19).
[Tightening torque = 100 Nm (73.76 lbf·ft)]
Remove the load-sensing valve (14).
[Tightening torque = 45 Nm (33.19 lbf·ft)]
Remove the pressure relief valve (15).
Unscrew and remove the plugs (16) and (17).
Unscrew and remove the plug (18).
[Tightening torque = 20 Nm (15 lbf·ft)]
64 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Disassembly of the cover


Remove the relief valve (21).
Remove the valve (20).

Disassemble the control valve sections

NOTE: the figure shows the swing section, the - if necessary, replace the O-ring (28);
valves may be different in the other sections. - remove the spring (29) and the relevant spring
Remove the check valves (22). guide (30);
[Tightening torque = 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft)] - loosen and remove the screws (31);
Remove the flow balancer valve (24). [Tightening torque = 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)]
[Tightening torque = 60 Nm (44 lbf·ft)] - remove the cover (32);
Remove the pressure relief valve (23). - if necessary, replace the O-ring (33);
[Tightening torque = 70 Nm (52 lbf·ft)] - remove the spring (34) and the relevant spring
guide (35);
- extract the spool (25).
Remove the spool:
- loosen and remove the screws (26);
[Tightening torque = 10 Nm (7.4 lbf·ft)]
- remove the cover (27);
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 65

RELIEF VALVES
There are different relief valves installed on the
loader and backhoe attachment control valves.
The relief valves may be operated with anti-cavita-
tion feature (1) or direct acting (2) and protect the
single systems from excessive pressure.

OPERATION
Relief valve inoperative
When the system is not subject to overload condi-
tions pressure in the system is insufficient to over-
come pilot valve spring pressure and move the
valve of its seat.
System pressure sensed on the larger rear face of
the poppet valve maintains the poppet and sleeve
firmly on their seats.
1. Sleeve
2. Poppet valve
3. Pilot valve
4. Pilot valve body
Exhaust oil
5. Piston High pressure oil
6. Control valve (cylinder) exhaust gallery
7. Cylinder supply gallery
66 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Pilot valve operation


When the cylinder is subjected to shock forces, the
pressure increase in the cylinder supply gallery
exceeds the pilot valve spring pressure: this valve
lifts off its seat.
System pressure on the rear face of the poppet
valve escapes to tank between the sleeve poppet
and valve body causing a pressure differential
between the front and rear face of the poppet valve.
The higher pressure in the cylinder supply gallery
unseats the poppet valve and moves the piston to
seat against the pilot valve.
1. Sleeve Exhaust oil
2. Poppet valve High pressure oil
Reduced pressure oil
3. Pilot valve
4. Pilot valve body
5. Piston
6. Control valve (cylinder) exhaust gallery
7. Cylinder supply gallery

Pilot and poppet valve operation


The excessive system pressure in the cylinder sup-
ply gallery now flows past the poppet valve to the
cylinder exhaust gallery and back to tank.
NOTE: during this operation the sleeve poppet is
held in the fully seated position by pressure oil.
1. Sleeve
2. Poppet valve
3. Pilot valve
4. Pilot valve body
5. Piston
6. Control valve (cylinder) exhaust gallery High pressure oil
7. Cylinder supply gallery Exhaust oil
Reduced pressure oil
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 67

Anti-cavitation operation
Relief valves with an anti-cavitation feature are fitted
in systems where a rapid extension of the cylinder
could create a void condition and permit the transfer
of oil from the high pressure side of a cylinder to the
low pressure (void) side.
When for example the boom is rapidly lowered and
the cylinder rod end circuit relief valve operates, oil
has been removed from the rod end of the cylinder
and a void created in the piston end. This oil is auto-
matically replenished by the anti-cavitation device in
the opposite circuit relief valve as follows:
The void creates a pressure lower in the cylinder
supply gallery and back pressure in the control
valve exhaust gallery acts on the outer face of the
sleeve poppet moving it to the right.
Exhaust oil is then directed into the cylinder supply
gallery to stop cavitation.

High pressure oil Relief valve exhaust oil


Anti-cavitation oil supply to cylinder

1. Anti-cavitation system pressure relief valve 4. Control valve exhaust gallery


2. Cylinder rod 5. Spool
3. System pressure relief valve
68 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Pilot-operated pressure relief valve with anti-cavita-


tion feature subjected to overload and fully relieving
high-pressure oil
1. Sleeve
2. Poppet valve
3. Pilot valve
4. Pilot valve body
5. Piston
6. Control valve (cylinder) exhaust gallery
7. Cylinder supply gallery

Anti-cavitation cylinder resupply oil


Exhaust oil

Direct-acting pressure relief valve operation


High-pressure oil in the system is sensed in the cyl-
inder supply gallery and acts on the surface of the
pressure relief valve poppet.
When pressure in the system exceeds the pressure
relief valve setting, the oil pressure lifts the poppet,
allowing excess pressure in the overloaded cylinder
to escape to the drain gallery.

A. Direct acting circuit relief valve


Valve not subjected to overload conditions
B. Direct acting circuit relief valve
Valve subjected to overload conditions
1. Relief valve seat
2. Relief valve poppet
3. Valve pressure adjusting screw
4. Spring
5. Control valve exhaust gallery
6. Cylinder supply oil

Exhaust oil
High-pressure system oil
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 69

OVERHAUL
Before removing the relief valves from the machine,
lower the loader and backhoe attachment to the
ground, stop the engine and relieve pressure in all
systems by moving the backhoe attachment, loader
attachment and telescopic dipper controls through
all operating positions. If the pressure relief valves
are suspected of contamination, they may be disas-
sembled and inspected for wear. During assembly,
restore the correct pressure.
During disassembly examine the poppet and seat in
the plunger assembly for a complete seating sur-
face.
Pilot operated relief valve

1. Body 9. O-ring
2. Shutter 10. Nut
3. Spring 11. O-ring
4. Spring 12. Adjusting screw
5. O-ring 13. Spring
6. O-ring 14. Pilot valve
7. Valve 15. Poppet
8. Cover 16. Piston
70 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Direct acting circuit relief valve

1. Body 6. Cover
2. Poppet 7. O-ring
3. Spring 8. Nut
4. Spring 9. O-ring
5. Shim 10. Adjusting screw

Loader bucket relief valve

1. Relief valve assembly


2. Spring 7. Piston
3. Nut 8. Poppet
4. Body 9. Valve
5. Adjusting screw 10. Inner body
6. Spring 11. Spring seat
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 71

ADJUSTMENTS
System pressure relief valve adjustment
After overhaul, the pressure relief valves of the sys-
tem must be tested and adjusted using a suitable
hand pump (1), a 275 bar (3988 psi) pressure
gauge and a V. L. Churchill test kit (2).

The hand pump must be attached to inlet port Ι and


the drain hose to the outlet port T of test block using
suitable 1/2” BSP (British Standard Pipe) adaptors.
The pressure gauge may be connected to either the
hand pump or to the 3/8 UNF threaded port G in the
test block.
Remove the plug and insert the valve to be tested
into the appropriate port in the test block:
A. Stabilizer and backhoe relief valves
B. Loader bucket relief valves
C. Unload valve

NOTE: a special removable insert, which is part of


the test block, is installed in the bottom part of the
port used for testing the loader attachment valve. If
difficulty is experienced in screwing the loader valve
into the test block, check that the insert is fully
seated and correctly installed. When correctly
installed the O-ring (3) on the face of the insert
should be visible.
72 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Operate hand pump and record maximum pressure


reading on gauge. Compare pressure values with
previous specifications.
IMPORTANT: before removing the valve from the
test block, release the pressure in the system using
the vent valve on the hand pump.

To adjust all relief valves with the exception of the


loader bucket relief valve remove the valve cap,
loosen locknut and turn adjuster to obtain correct
pressure.
IMPORTANT: relief valves must not be set outside
off the specified range.

Loader bucket relief valve adjustment


If the loader bucket circuit relief valve requires
adjustment, use the special adjusting tool supplied
with the test kit.
Hold relief valve in vice and using wrench supplied
with tool, unscrew the internal valve assembly from
the valve body.
Screw the internal valve assembly (2) into the body
of the adjusting tool (1).

Install valve into test block and operate hand pump


until valve is pressurized to 170 bar (2466 psi).
Using the special wrench supplied, loosen the lock-
nut on the end of the valve and adjust pressure set-
ting.
Operate hand pump and recheck pressure.
When pressure setting is correct tighten locknut and
release pressure in circuit using the vent valve on
the hand pump.
Remove the valve and, using a 3/8” 16 UNC screw,
remove the insert.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 73

Reassemble the valve and install it on the test block.


Operate hand pump and recheck pressure.
If pressure is now lower than that recorded with the
insert installed it is an indication that the anti-cavita-
tion feature of the valve is leaking and the valve
requires overhaul or replacement.
The insert isolates the anti-cavitation feature of the
valve. When reassembling the insert into the test
block ensure it is installed correctly. When correctly
installed the O-ring (3) on the face of the insert
should be visible.
74 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROL VALVE PILOT SOLENOID VALVE

Solenoid valve is located under the cab floor and is


installed directly in the lower part of the chassis that
supports the operating levers. The solenoid valve is
installed on loader backhoes with backhoe attach-
ment pilot controls and has the task to transform the
electric controls, received from the control levers,
into hydraulic controls, and to send them to the
backhoe attachment control valve. The module (A)
is installed only on the machines versions with tele-
scopic dipper. If the machine is not equipped with
telescopic dipper, the solenoid valve installed is of
type (B); while if the telescopic dipper is installed
the solenoid valve can be of type (A) + (B).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 75

If the loader backhoe is equipped with a telescopic


dipper and if the rear control valve contains an aux-
iliary section, the solenoid valve consists of valve
(B) and module (C).

DISASSEMBLY
Unscrew and remove the accumulator (1) from the
solenoid valve assy (2).

Loosen and remove the three screws (3) and disas-


semble valve (4).
Check and replace the O-rings (5), if necessary.
76 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

If necessary, it is possible to disassemble the vari-


ous solenoid valves:
- disassemble the solenoid valves (7) by loosening
the screws (6);
- loosen and remove the valve (8);
- loosen and remove the solenoid valves (9) and
(10);
- check and replace the O-rings, if necessary.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 77

ACCUMULATOR “GLIDE RIDE” PARKER

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Capacity (gas)...........................................................................................................................2 litres (0.44 gal)
Capacity (oil) ........................................................................................................................1.84 litres (0.40 gal)
Precharge .................................................................................................................. 30 ± 1 bar (4354 ± 14 psi)

MAINTENANCE SAFETY
Regularly check the gas pre-charge pressure dur- Charging must be carried out by qualified person-
ing the first few weeks of operation. nel.
Then check at suitable intervals based on this initial Before taking any readings or pressurizing with
experience. nitrogen, the accumulator must be isolated from the
hydraulic system and the fluid side discharged in
Carry out a visual examination of the accumulator
order to depressurize it.
periodically in order to detect any early signs of
deterioration such as corrosion, deformation etc. Use only nitrogen (N2) to pressurize the accumula-
tor.
Comply with the regulatory provisions concerning
the monitoring of operational equipment. Danger of Explosion - Never Charge with Oxygen
Before removal, make sure that there is no residual The types of nitrogen permitted are:
pressure in the accumulator. - type S (99.8% pure);
Before carrying out any maintenance operation,
- type R (99.99% pure);
discharge the gas of the accumulator using a
Parker UCA charging and measuring device. - type U (99.993% pure).
If the pressure of the gas contained in the nitrogen
bottle is greater than the maximum permissible
operating pressure of the accumulator, a pressure
regulator must be fitted to the nitrogen bottle.
The precharge should be checked during the first
week following commissioning of the system.
Thereafter, it should be checked every three
months, or at intervals determined by the Manufac-
turer.
Effect of temperature on precharge pressure
In order to compensate for the difference in pres-
sure at ambient and operating temperature, the
precharge pressure po should be adjusted accord-
ing to the operating temperature of the system.
Stabilization
The process of charging or discharging an accumu-
lator with nitrogen causes a temperature change
which is transmitted to the surrounding air as the
temperature of the accumulator stabilizes.
To allow for the effects of temperature transfer, the
accumulator should be allowed to stand for a mini-
mum of 15 minutes before a final reading of the
precharge pressure is taken.
78 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

CHECKING AND ADJUSTING THE PRECHARGE PRESSURE


To check the precharge pressure of the accumula-
tor, it is necessary to have the universal charging
and measuring kit UCA 380002714.
The kit must be screwed onto the accumulator’s
gas valve, allowing the precharge pressure to be
checked and reduced.
If the precharge pressure is to be increased, the
UCA can be connected to the nitrogen source with
the hose supplied.
The kit includes two pressure gauges for readings
of 0 ÷ 25 bar (0 ÷ 363 psi) and 0 ÷ 250 bar
(0 ÷ 3626 psi).
If a different pressure interval becomes necessary,
use a pressure gauge available in commerce.
Kit UCA 380002714
A. Inflation valve
B. Bleed valve
1. UCA
2. Adapter (long)
3. Adapter (short)
4. Adapter (insert)
5. Pressure gauge
6. Protective cap - gauge port
7. Collar - gas port
8. Protective cap - filling port
9. Hose (1/4) with O-ring
10. Valve

Remove the protective cover and cap (11) from the


accumulator, to gain access to the gas valve (12).
Select the appropriate pressure gauge (5) for the
pressure to be checked, remove the protective cap
(6) and connect the port to the UCA (1).
Make sure that the bleed valve (B) is fully closed
and that the inflation valve (A) is fully raised by turn-
ing the handwheel in a counterclockwise direction.
Assemble the short adapter and adapter insert (3)
and (4), screw onto the gas valve (12) and hand
tighten.
Screw the UCA onto the adapter.
Position the assembly to permit easy reading of the
gauge, then hand tighten the collar (7).
Open the inflation valve (A) by screwing the hand-
wheel clockwise until the inflation pressure registers
on the gauge.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 79

READINGS AND RESULTS


3 conditions may become true. Screw the handwheel (A) counterclockwise to close
the accumulator gas valve.
Nitrogen po pressure is correct
Screw the handwheel (A) counterclockwise to close Slacken the bleed valve (B) to release pressure in
the accumulator gas valve. the UCA.

Slacken the bleed valve (B) to release pressure in Remove the hose carefully, to release internal pres-
the UCA. sure.

Unscrew the UCA from the adapter. Refit the cap (8) on the valve (10).

Unscrew the adapters from the accumulator gas Unscrew the UCA from the adapter(s).
valve. Unscrew the adapters from the accumulator gas
Nitrogen po pressure is too high valve.
Slacken the bleed valve (B) to vent nitrogen from After removing the UCA and adapter(s), make sure
the accumulator until, after stabilization, the desired that the accumulator gas valve (12) is sealing effec-
pressure po is registered. Nitrogen vents into the tively.
air. Refit the gas valve dust cover (12) and replace the
protective cover (11).
Tighten the bleed valve (B) once the desired filling
pressure is reached.
Screw the handwheel (A) counterclockwise to close
the accumulator gas valve.
Slacken the bleed valve (B) to release pressure in
the UCA.
Unscrew the UCA from the adapter.
Unscrew the adapters from the accumulator gas
valve.
Nitrogen po pressure is too low
Close the inflation valve (A) by screwing the hand-
wheel counterclockwise.
Remove the cap (8).
Connect the end of the hose (9) to the valve (10).
Connect the other end of the hose to the nitrogen
source.
Progressively open the valve on the nitrogen
source.
Turn the handwheel (A) clockwise to let pressurized
gas in.
Use special care if the accumulator has small
capacity.
When pressure po is reached, close the valve on
the nitrogen source.
To allow for the effects of temperature transfer, the
accumulator should be allowed to stand for a mini-
mum of 15 minutes to allow the temperature to sta-
bilize before a final reading of the precharge
pressure is taken.
80 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

HYDRAULIC SWING SYSTEM

OPERATION
The hydraulic swing system has two versions:
- Sideshift:
it can shift laterally with the backhoe attachment
because it is installed directly on the sideshift car-
riage performing the shifting;
- Center pivot:
it is fixed because it is installed directly on the
chassis.
The backhoe attachment may slew by 180° around
the main frame.
This movement is obtained by means of two
hydraulic cylinders (1) installed between the main
chassis and the backhoe attachment support.
The cylinders act directly on the backhoe attach-
ment support, with no need for connections or bell
cranks.
Each cylinder is free to rotate, around two pivots
(3), while the stem comes out or retracts inside of
the cylinder body (2).
As each cylinder extends or retracts, the swing post
and the cylinders turn, pivoting on the headstocks
within the carriage.
Each cylinder is double-acting and, as hydraulic oil
is fed to a cylinder to turn the post, one cylinder
pushes and the other cylinder pulls.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 81

HYDRAULIC OIL FLOW


Hydraulic feed to the swing cylinders is controlled By allowing oil to flow unrestricted to the power side
by the swing section of the backhoe attachment of the cylinder and be restricted on the exhaust side
control valve, which contains pilot-operated pres- a smooth controlled swing of the backhoe at opti-
sure relief valves with anti-cavitation feature to pro- mum speed is achieved.
tect the system and the cylinders, should an When the swing system reaches the last 20 - 25° of
overload condition occur. travel the sliding restrictor in the end of the piston
The diagram illustrates the operation of the swing rod touches the outlet port in the cylinder barrel.
circuit when retracting the right-hand cylinder (4) This further restricts the flow of oil drained from the
and extending the left-hand cylinder (5) in order to cylinder. As the piston moves towards the end of its
swing the backhoe attachment to the right. stroke, the sliding restrictor is gently pushed down
towards the centre of the cylinder rod, allowing a
When swinging the backhoe to the left the oil flows
progressive and controlled stop of the swing cycle.
are reversed and exactly the same principle of
operation applies. If the swing control valve is suddenly returned to
neutral mid-way through a full power swing the sup-
The various operating stages for right swing are
ply and exhaust ports in the main control valve are
described below as an example.
totally blocked.
When the swing control is operated the control
The momentum of the swinging backhoe assembly
valve directs oil flow to the rod end of the right hand
if not controlled will make the machine extremely
cylinder.
unstable.
The flow of oil at pump pressure lifts the one way
To prevent this from occurring, the system pressure
restrictor (2) of its seat allowing the flow to continue
relief valves operate and drain the oil until an
unrestricted to the inlet port of the piston end of the
excess pressure is detected.
left hand cylinder.
When the relief valve operates the cylinder rod will
System pressure increases causing the right hand
move and a void will be created in the low pressure
cylinder to retract and the left hand cylinder to
side of the cylinder.
extend.
The anti-cavitation feature in the relief valves pre-
As the cylinders move, displaced oil on the piston
vents the void from creating by transferring the
side of the left hand cylinder flows towards the one
drain oil from the side of the system where an
way restrictor (7) in the inlet port on the rod end of
excess pressure occurred to the low pressure side.
the right hand cylinder.
The oil flow moves the restrictor to the restrict posi-
tion which limits the flow of oil and creates a back
pressure (1st stage restricted return oil) in the right
hand cylinder.
The restricted flow of oil passes through restrictor
(7) into the rod end of the left hand cylinder before
returning to the control valve and back to tank.
The spool in the swing control valve (1) is designed
so that, during operation, oil can flow freely through
the port directing oil flow to the swing cylinders, but
is restricted when going back to the tank.
This restriction is achieved using metering lands
machined into the lands of the spool and creates a
secondary back pressure (2nd stage restricted
return oil) in the rod end of the cylinder.
82 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Pump pressure oil


1st stage restricted return oil
2nd stage restricted return oil
Return to oil tank

1. Control valve swing section 5. Left hand cylinder


2. Limiter 6. Compressor rod
3. Cushioning rod 7. Limiter
4. Right hand cylinder
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 83

HYDRAULIC CYLINDERS

1. Loader attachment boom cylinder 7. Telescopic cylinder


2. Loader bucket cylinder 8. Swing backhoe cylinder
3. 4x1 loader bucket cylinder 9. Stabilizer cylinder (center pivot models)
4. Backhoe boom cylinder 10. Stabilizer cylinder (sideshift models)
5. Backhoe dipper cylinder 11. Backhoe sideshift locking cylinder (sideshift
6. Backhoe bucket cylinder models)
84 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

LOADER ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER


2WS

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted

2WS-TC

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 85

4WS

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted

LOADER ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER REMOVAL


(B90B-B90BLR-B100B-B100BLR-B110B)
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Sufficiently raise the loader attachment to allow the
boom cylinder pivot pin to be removed and securely
support the front and rear part of the bucket with
stands to prevent the loader attachment arms from
lowering when the cylinder is disconnected.

If the bucket cannot be safely supported it must be


removed and the loader arms supported using a
suitable stand or hoist.

S WARNING S
Always ensure that the loader is fully supported. Do
not work under or near an unsupported loader
attachment, to prevent the danger of personal
injury.

Relieve the residual pressure in the system by mov-


ing the loader control lever through all operating
positions.
86 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Support the cylinder using sling and suitable hoist.


Disconnect the hoses.
Cap or plug all exposed openings.

Remove the stop ring (1) and the shim (2).

Remove the ring (3) and the pin (4).


Use a hammer to extract the rod pin (5).

Remove the loader attachment boom cylinder.


SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 87

LOADER ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER REMOVAL


(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B)
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Sufficiently raise the loader attachment to allow the
boom cylinder pivot pin to be removed and securely
support the front and rear part of the bucket with
stands to prevent the loader attachment arms from
lowering when the cylinder is disconnected.
If the bucket cannot be safely supported, remove it
and support the loader attachment arms using a
suitable stand or hoist.

S WARNING S
Always ensure that the loader is fully supported. Do
not work under or near an unsupported loader
attachment, to prevent the danger of personal
injury.

Relieve the residual pressure in the system by mov-


ing the loader control lever through all operating
positions.

Support the cylinder using sling and suitable hoist.


Disconnect the hoses.
Cap or plug all exposed openings.

Remove the stop ring (1) and the shim (2).


88 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Remove the ring (3) and the pin (4).


Use a hammer to extract the rod pin (5).

Remove the loader attachment boom cylinder.


SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 89

LOADER ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Cylinder rod 9. Back-up ring


2. Bushing 10. O-ring
3. Wiper ring 11. Piston
4. Ring 12. Piston gasket
5. Seal ring 13. Piston guide rings
6. Guide bush 14. Screw
7. Cylinder head 15. Cylinder tube
8. Safety screw 16. Bushing

The disassembly procedure described below may


start on the premise that the hydraulic lines have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight: 36 kg (79.36 lb).

Lift and securely place the cylinder on a workbench.


Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
90 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Support the cylinder rod (1).


Unscrew and remove the safety screw (8).
Use the wrench 380000725 to loose the cylinder
head (7).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Remove the cylinder head (7) from the cylinder bar-


rel (15) using a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (1) and the cylinder head
(7).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (1)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (14).


Extract the piston (11) and the cylinder head (7)
from the cylinder rod (1).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (3), the seal ring (4), the
ring (5), the guide bush (6) and the back-up ring
(9) with the O-ring (10) from the cylinder head (7);
- remove the piston seal (12) and the piston guide
rings (13) from the piston (11).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 91

LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER


2WS

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted

2WS-TC

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted
92 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

4WS

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted

LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER REMOVAL


(B90B-B90BLR-B100B-B100BLR-B110B)
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.
Relieve the residual pressure in the system by mov-
ing the loader control lever through all operating
positions.
Position a suitable support below the bucket cylin-
der tie rod (1).
Support the cylinder using a sling or a suitable
hoist.

Disconnect the hoses.


Cap or plug all exposed openings.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 93

Remove the ring (2) and the pin (3).


Using a hammer, extract the rod pin (4) and release
the rod (5).

Remove the stop ring (7) and the shim (8).


Remove the snap ring (9) and the spacer (10).
Remove the lever (6), the rod (5) and extract the
cylinder rod (1).

Remove the ring (11) and the pin (12).


Hammer to slide out the pin (13).

Remove the loader bucket cylinder.


94 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER REMOVAL


(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B)
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.
Relieve the residual pressure in the system by mov-
ing the loader control lever through all operating
positions.
Support the cylinder using a sling and a suitable
support.
Disconnect the hoses.
Cap or plug all exposed openings.

Support the bucket linkage and rods.


Remove the snap ring (1) and the spacer (2).
Hammer to slide out the pin (3).

Remove the stop ring (4) and the shim (5).


Hammer to slide out the pin (6).

Remove the loader bucket cylinder.


SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 95

LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Bushing 9. O-ring
2. Cylinder rod 10. Piston
3. Wiper ring 11. Piston gasket
4. Seal ring 12. Piston guide rings
5. Rings 13. Screw
6. Cylinder head 14. Cylinder tube
7. Snap ring 15. Bushing
8. Back-up ring

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight (2WS): 24.6 kg (54.23 lb)
Cylinder weight (2WS-TC and 4WS): 32.5 kg
(71.65 lb)

Lift and securely place the cylinder on a workbench.


Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
96 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Support the cylinder rod (2) and use the wrench


380000722 to loosen the cylinder head (6).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Remove the stop ring (7)


Extract the cylinder head (6) from the cylinder barrel
(14) by tapping it with a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (2) and the cylinder head
(6).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (2)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (13).


Extract the piston (10) and the cylinder head (6)
from the cylinder rod (2).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (3), the seal rings (4), the
rings (5), the back-up ring (8) with the O-ring (9)
from the cylinder head (6);
- remove the piston seal (11) and the piston guide
rings (12) from the piston (10).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 97

4X1 LOADER BUCKET CYLINDER

1. Cylinder rod pin


2. Dowel
3. Bucket
4. Cylinder
5. Dowel
6. Nut
7. Cylinder bottom pin

LOADER 4x1 BUCKET CYLINDER REMOVAL


Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.
Relieve the residual pressure in the system by mov-
ing the loader control lever through all operating
positions.
98 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

Disconnect the hoses.


Cap or plug all exposed openings.

Unscrew and remove the clamping screws of the


cover (C).
Remove the cover (C).

Remove the pin (2).


Slide out the rod pin (1) with an hammer.

Unscrew and remove the nut (6) and the dowel (5).
Slide out the lower pin (7) with an hammer.

Remove the 4x1 bucket cylinder.


SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 99

LOADER 4x1 BUCKET CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Cylinder tube 7. Cylinder head


2. Piston 8. Gasket
3. Pin 9. Wiper ring
4. O-ring 10. Cylinder rod
5. Piston guide 11. Bushing
6. O-ring
100 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE BOOM CYLINDER

1. Stroke ) with long dipper


2. Completely retracted (B90BLR - B100BLR - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)
2 with short dipper
(B90B - B100B - B100BTC)

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER


REMOVAL
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.
Support the backhoe attachment elements for cylin-
der removal using a suitable support.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Stop the engine and move the backhoe attachment


control levers through all operating positions to
relieve any residual pressures in the system.
Position a sling or other suitable lifting equipment
around the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 101

Loosen and remove the screw (1) and the nut (2).
Slide out the rod pin (3) with an hammer.
NOTE: the tube end of the dig cylinder and the rod
end of the boom cylinder use a common pin (3).
If the boom cylinder has to be disassembled, slide
out the pin (3) only partially, then remove the cylin-
der rod and finally reinsert the pin.
If necessary, use hydraulic power to very slowly
retract the cylinder.
In this way, the rod moves away from the attaching
point.

Disconnect the hoses.


Cap or plug all exposed openings.
Remove the stop ring (4) and extract the pin (5).
NOTE: accurate positioning of the cylinder prior to
hose disconnection will aid pin removal.

Remove the backhoe attachment boom cylinder.


102 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT BOOM CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Wiper ring
2. Bushing 11. O-ring
3. Cylinder rod 12. Piston gasket
4. Wiper ring 13. Piston guide
5. Seal ring 14. Piston
6. Ring 15. Screw
7. Guide bush 16. Cylinder tube
8. Screw 17. Bushing
9. Cylinder head 18. Wiper ring
10. Back-up ring

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight (with short dipper): 80.5 kg (177.47 lb).
Cylinder weight (with long dipper): 93.1 kg (205.25 lb).

Lift and securely place the cylinder on a workbench.


Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 103

Support the cylinder rod (3).


Unscrew and remove the safety screw (8).
Use the wrench 380000724 to loose the cylinder
head (9).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Extract the cylinder head (9) from the cylinder barrel


(16) by tapping it with a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (3) and the cylinder head
(9).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (3)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (15).


Extract the piston (14) and the cylinder head (9)
from the cylinder rod (3).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (4), the seal ring (5), the
ring (6), the guide bush (7) and the back-up ring
(10) with the O-ring (11) from the cylinder head
(9);
- remove the piston guide ring (13) and the piston
seal (12) from the piston (14).
104 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DIPPER CYLINDER

1. Stroke ) with long dipper


2. Completely retracted (B90BLR - B100BLR - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)
2 with short dipper
(B90B - B100B - B100BTC)

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DIPPER CYLINDER


REMOVAL
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.
Support the backhoe attachment elements for cylin-
der removal using a suitable support.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Stop the engine and move the backhoe attachment


control levers through all operating positions to
relieve any residual pressures in the system.
Position a sling or other suitable lifting equipment
around the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 105

Loosen and remove the nut (1) and the screw (2).
Slide out the rod pin (3) with an hammer.
If necessary, use hydraulic power to very slowly
retract the cylinder.
In this way, the rod moves away from the attaching
point.

Disconnect the hoses.


Cap or plug all exposed openings.
Loosen and remove the screw (4) and the nut (5).
Slide out the rod pin (6) with an hammer.
The tube end of the dipper cylinder and rod end of
the boom cylinder use a common attaching pin (6).
Therefore before shifting the dig cylinder, support
the boom cylinder with a rope or an hoist.

Remove the backhoe dipper cylinder.


106 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DIPPER CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Wiper ring 10. Back-up ring


2. Bushing 11. O-ring
3. Cylinder rod 12. Piston gasket
4. Wiper ring 13. Piston guide
5. Seal ring 14. Piston
6. Ring 15. Screw
7. Guide bush 16. Cylinder tube
8. Safety screw 17. Bushing
9. Cylinder head 18. Wiper ring

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Short dipper cylinder weight: 71.8 kg (158.29 lb).
Long dipper cylinder weight: 72.2 kg (159.17 lb).

Lift and securely place the cylinder on a workbench.


Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 107

Support the cylinder rod (3).


Unscrew and remove the safety screw (8).
Use the wrench 380000724 to loose the cylinder
head (9).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Extract the cylinder head (9) from the cylinder barrel


(16) by tapping it with a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (3) and the cylinder head
(9).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (3)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (15).


Extract the piston (14) and the cylinder head (9)
from the cylinder rod (3).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (4), the seal ring (5), the
ring (6), the guide bush (7) and the back-up ring
(10) with the O-ring (11) from the cylinder head
(9);
- remove the piston guide ring (13) and the piston
seal (12) from the piston (14).
108 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE BUCKET CYLINDER

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted

BACKHOE BUCKET CYLINDER REMOVAL


Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Stop the engine and move the backhoe attachment


control levers through all operating positions to
relieve any residual pressures in the system.
Position a sling or other suitable lifting equipment
around the cylinder.

Remove the stop ring (1) and the shim (2). Slide out
the pin (3) with an hammer and pay attention to
levers.
If necessary use hydraulic power to very slowly
retract the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 109

Disconnect the hoses.


Cap or plug all exposed openings.
Unscrew and remove the nut (4).
Hammer to slide out the pin (6). Extract the screw
(5).

Remove the backhoe bucket cylinder.


110 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE BUCKET CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Wiper ring 10. Back-up ring


2. Bushing 11. O-ring
3. Cylinder rod 12. Piston gasket
4. Wiper ring 13. Piston guide
5. Seal ring 14. Piston
6. Ring 15. Screw
7. Guide bush 16. Cylinder tube
8. Safety screw 17. Bushing
9. Cylinder head 18. Wiper ring

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight: 50.1 kg (110.45 lb).

Lift and securely place the cylinder on a workbench.


Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 111

Support the cylinder rod (3).


Unscrew and remove the safety screw (8).
Use the wrench 380000725 to loose the cylinder
head (9).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Extract the cylinder head (9) from the cylinder barrel


(16) by tapping it with a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (3) and the cylinder head
(9).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (3)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (15). Extract the pis-


ton (14) and the cylinder head (9) from the cylinder
rod (3).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (4), the seal ring (5), the
ring (6), the guide bush (7) and the back-up ring
(10) with the O-ring from the cylinder head (9);
- remove the piston guide ring (13) and the piston
seal (12) from the piston (14).
112 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

TELESCOPIC CYLINDER

1. Stroke ) with short telescopic


2. Completely retracted (B90B - B100B - B100BTC)
2 with long telescopic
(B90BLR - B100BLR - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)

TELESCOPIC CYLINDER REMOVAL


Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.
Support the backhoe attachment elements for cylin-
der removal using a suitable support.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Stop the engine and move the backhoe attachment


control levers through all operating positions to
relieve any residual pressures in the system.

Remove the snap ring (1).


Hammer to slide out the pin (2) from the other side.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 113

Disconnect the hydraulic hoses (3) of the cylinder


and support the cylinder using a suitable support.
Remove the snap ring (5).
Hammer to slide out the pin (4) from the other side.

Remove the telescopic cylinder.


114 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

TELESCOPIC CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Cylinder rod 8. Back-up ring


2. Wiper ring 9. O-ring
3. Seal ring 10. Piston gasket
4. Ring 11. Piston guide
5. Guide bush 12. Piston
6. Safety screw 13. Screw
7. Cylinder head 14. Cylinder tube

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight (with short telescopic): 41.4 kg
(91.27 lb).
Cylinder weight (with long telescopic): 45.2 kg
(99.65 lb).

Lift and securely place the cylinder on a workbench.


Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 115

Support the cylinder rod (1).


Unscrew and remove the safety screw (6). Use the
wrench 380000721 to loose the cylinder head (7).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Extract the cylinder head (7) from the cylinder barrel


(14) by tapping it with a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (1) and the cylinder head
(7).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (1)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (13).


Extract the piston (12) and the cylinder head (7)
from the cylinder rod (1).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (2), the seal ring (3), the
ring (4), the guide bush (5) and the O-ring (9) with
the back-up ring (8) from the cylinder head (7);
- remove the piston guide ring (11) and the piston
seal (10) from the piston (12).
116 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

STABILIZER CYLINDER - CENTER PIVOT

(1) Stroke
(2) Completely retracted

STABILIZER CYLINDER REMOVAL - CENTER PIVOT


Make sure that the backhoe loader is locked in the
transfer position or parked in a safety work position.
Lower the stabilizers to the ground.

Support the cylinder safely with suitable belt and


hoist.
Remove the snap ring (1) and the shim (2).
Extract the pin (3) with a hammer. Using the
hydraulic power, retract the cylinder very slowly.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 117

Stop the engine.


Release possible residual pressure by moving the
control levers of the stabilizers.
Disconnect all hoses.
Cap or plug all exposed openings.
Remove the snap ring (4) and the shim (5).
Hammer to slide out the pin (6).

Remove the stabilizer cylinder.


118 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

STABILIZER CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY - CENTER PIVOT

1. Cylinder rod 8. Back-up ring


2. Wiper ring 9. O-ring
3. Ring 10. Piston gasket
4. Seal ring 11. Piston guide
5. Guide bush 12. Piston
6. Safety screw 13. Screw
7. Cylinder head 14. Cylinder tube

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight: 43 kg (94.80 lb).

Lift and securely place the cylinder on a workbench.


Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 119

Replace the cylinder rod (1).


Unscrew and remove the safety screw (6).
Use the wrench 380000726 to loose the cylinder
head (7).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Extract the cylinder head (7) from the cylinder barrel


(14) by tapping it with a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (1) and the cylinder head
(7).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (1)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (13).


Extract the piston (12) and the cylinder head (7)
from the cylinder rod (1).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (2), the seal ring (3), the
ring (4), the guide bush (5) and the O-ring (9) with
the back-up ring (8) from the cylinder head (7);
- remove the piston guide ring (11) and the piston
seal (10) from the piston (12).
120 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

STABILIZER CYLINDER - SIDESHIFT

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted

STABILIZER CYLINDER REMOVAL - SIDESHIFT


Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.

Lower the stabilizers to the ground.


Relieve possible residual pressures in the system
by moving the loader attachment control lever
through all operating positions.
Loosen and remove the screw (1) and the nut (2).
Extract the pin (3) to release the cylinder rod.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 121

Disconnect the hydraulic tubes at the top of the sta-


bilizer leg.
Remove the snap ring (4) and extract the pin (5).
Screw in an eye screw (6) on the cylinder and con-
nect a rope or a chain.

Lift and remove the stabilizer cylinder.


122 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

STABILIZER CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY - SIDESHIFT

1. Cylinder rod 8. Back-up ring


2. Wiper ring 9. O-ring
3. Seal ring 10. Piston
4. Ring 11. Piston guide
5. Guide bush 12. Piston gasket
6. Cylinder head 13. Screw
7. Safety screw 14. Cylinder tube

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight: 34.6 kg (76.28 lb).

Lift and place the cylinder on a workbench and


secure it to a vice.
Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 123

Support the cylinder rod (1).


Unscrew and remove the safety screw (6). Use the
wrench 380000721 to loose the cylinder head (7).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.

Extract the cylinder head (7) from the cylinder barrel


(14) by tapping it with a plastic hammer.
Remove the cylinder rod (1) and the cylinder head
(7).
IMPORTANT: be sure to pull the cylinder rod (1)
straight so as not to damage the sliding surfaces.

Loosen and remove the screw (13).


Extract the piston (12) and the cylinder head (7)
from the cylinder rod (1).

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (2), the seal rings (3), the
ring (4), the guide bush (5) and the O-ring (9) with
the back-up ring (8) from the cylinder head (7);
- remove the piston guide ring (11) and the piston
seal (10) from the piston (12).
124 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

SWING CYLINDER

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted

SWING CYLINDER REMOVAL


Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Place the bucket firmly on the ground.
Support the backhoe attachment elements for cylin-
der removal using a suitable stand and a hoist.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Stop the engine and move the backhoe attachment


control levers through all operating positions to
relieve any residual pressures in the system.

Loosen and remove the nut (1).


Slide out the screw (2) from the opposite side.
Now the pin (3) can come out and release the rod
cylinder.
If necessary hammer to help the pin (3) to come
out.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 125

Disconnect the feed and return hose to the cylin-


ders and cap all exposed openings.
Loosen and remove the nuts (4) and the screws (5)
(from both sides).
Now it is possible to remove the support (6).

Carefully lift and remove the swing cylinder.


126 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

SWING CYLINDER DISASSEMBLY

1. Bushing 10. Trunnion


2. Wiper ring 11. O-ring
3. Cylinder rod 12. Back-up ring
4. Wiper ring 13. Piston gasket
5. Seal ring 14. Piston guide
6. Ring 15. Piston
7. Guide bush 16. Lock retaining piston
8. Bushing 17. Cylinder tube
9. Seal ring

The disassembly procedure described below is


based on the premise that the hydraulic hoses have
already been disconnected.

S WARNING S
Cylinder weight: 31 kg (68.34 lb).

Lift and place the cylinder on a workbench and


secure it to a vice.
Be sure that the cylinder is placed horizontally.
Drain hydraulic oil from the cylinder.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 127

Use the wrench 380000725 to loose the trunnion


(10).
If necessary gently heat the gland carrier to soften
the thread sealant applied during manufacture.
Remove the rod assy with the trunnion and the pis-
ton assy.

Unscrew and remove the piston lock (16).


Disassembly the cylinder rod (3) and piston assy
(15) and the trunnion (10) complete with gaskets.
Check the bushings (8) status.

Only if necessary:
- remove the wiper ring (4), the seal ring (5), the
ring (6), the guide bush (7) and the back-up ring
(12) with the O-ring (11) from the king pin (10).
- remove the piston seal (13) and the piston guide
ring (14) from the piston (15).
128 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LOCK CYLINDER - SIDESHIFT


They are installed on the loader backhoe n. 4 side-
shift locking cylinders.
Their function is to lock the carriage once the back-
hoe attachment is ready in the digging position.
The cylinder consists of:
1. Body
2. Cylinder
3. Gasket

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LOCK CYLINDER


REMOVAL
Park machine on a flat surface and position the
bucket on the ground.
Position the backhoe support in the centre of the
machine and lower the backhoe on the ground.
Lower the stabilizers to the ground.
Relieve the residual pressure in the system by mov-
ing the control levers through all operating posi-
tions.

Disconnect the line (1).


Loosen and remove the two screws (2).
Now it is possible to remove the whole cylinder (3).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 129

SPECIAL TOOLS

PN CNH DESCRIPTION APPLICATION


Telescopic dipper cylinder head
380000721 Wrench
Stabilizer cylinder head (sideshift)
380000722 Wrench Loader bucket cylinder head
Backhoe boom cylinder head
380000724 Wrench
Backhoe dipper cylinder head
Backhoe bucket cylinder head
380000725 Wrench Swing cylinder head
Loader cylinder head
380000726 Wrench Stabilizer cylinder head (center pivot)
130 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVERS

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Weight 5.1 ÷ 5.3 kg (11.24 ÷ 11.68 lb)

Spool stroke 7.55 mm (0.29 in)

SPECIAL TORQUE SETTINGS

Maximum permissible on the hydraulic control lever 80 Nm (59 lbf·ft)

Control block retaining screw 30 Nm (22 lbf·ft)

Control block cardan joint 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft)

Control block nut 40 Nm (30 lbf·ft)

Lower body screw 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft)


SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 131

CONTROLS AND OPERATION

1. CONTROL ENABLE SWITCH: when set to ON 6. TELESCOPIC DIPPER CONTROLS: (propor-


(control lamp on), this switch allows enabling all tional controls): press the right-hand button to
hydraulic controls of the backhoe attachment. extend the telescopic dipper.
2. LEFT-HAND HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVER: Press the left-hand button to retract the tele-
the left-hand hydraulic control lever controls scopic dipper.
attachment swing and the boom or the dipper 7. WRIST RESTS: the wrist rests may be adjusted
(depending on the control pattern adopted). to the required height.
3. RIGHT-HAND HYDRAULIC CONTROL 8. HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVER SUPPORT
LEVER: the right-hand hydraulic control lever ANGLE ADJUSTMENT: these controls are
controls the bucket and the boom or the dipper used for the fore/aft and left/right adjustment of
(depending on the control pattern adopted). the arm.
NOTE: the operating speed depends on the angle 9. HORN BUTTON: (momentary action control).
of movement of the control levers. In intermediate 10. CONTROLS OF AUXILIARY BIDIRECTIONAL
position, two movements may be obtained simulta- ATTACHMENT (If fitted): proportional buttons
neously. for the activation of the additional attachment.
4. STABILIZER CONTROLS: the right-hand con- 11. DECELERATOR BUTTON: by pressing this
trol is for the right-hand stabilizer and the left- button, the engine rpm sets to low idle. During
hand control is for the left-hand stabilizer. this phase, the accelerator knob and pedal are
disabled.
5. CONTROL PATTERN CHANGE SWITCH: this
By pressing the button again, the engine rpm is
switch is used for changing the standard control
restored and the accelerator knob and pedal
pattern to the ISO pattern.
are functional again.
132 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

COMPONENTS
RIGHT HAND HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVER

1. Valve 10. Half handle


2. Plate 11. Cover
3. Screw 12. Switches
4. Nut 13. Washer
5. Boot 14. Spacer
6. Connector 15. Clip
7. Wedge 16. Clip
8. Half handle 17. Plugs [if the switches (12) are not fitted]
9. Screw
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 133

LEFT HAND CONTROL LEVER

1. Valve 11. Cover


2. Plate 12. Switch push button (horn)
3. Screw 13. Washer
4. Nut 14. Spacer
5. Boot 15. Clip
6. Connector 16. Clip
7. Wedge 17. Plugs [if the switches (18) are not fitted]
8. Half handle 18. Push-buttons (auxiliary bidirectional)
9. Screw 19. Connector
10. Half handle 20. Wedge
134 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


Disassembly
Release the pressure from the hydraulic systems by
carrying out the operations described below.
Turn the starter switch key to ON but do not start
the engine.
Turn pilot control cancellation switch to the ON posi-
tion.
Move the hydraulic control levers through all posi-
tions.
Turn the starter switch key to OFF. Disconnect the
negative battery cables.
Mark the position of the lever parts (see the
exploded view on previous pages).
Remove the knob (P) and the support (S).
Remove the bracket (O) with the relevant screws
(with left hydraulic control lever).

Remove the decal (D), the mounting plate (D1) and


the detach the connectors (Q) (with left hydraulic
control lever).

Pull out both switches (I) and the detach relevant


connectors (Q1) (with right control lever).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 135

Remove the knob (P1) in the rear section of control


lever.

Remove the screws (V) and the plate (N).

Lift the rubber boot (RL) for left control lever and the
rubber boot (RR) for right control lever.

Tag all hydraulic hoses before disconnecting them.


Disconnect all hoses (H).
Disconnect all connectors (Q2).
136 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

- Remove the screws (V1) and take out control


lever from the column.

Remove the screws (9).


Remove the half handles (8) and (10).
Remove the cap (11).
Remove the wedge (7) from the connector (6).
Remove the wedge (20) from the connector (19).
Remove the discs (6) and (19).
Remove the grommet (13), the clips (15) and the tie
hose (16).
Extract the switches (12) and (18).
Remove the spacers (14). Remove the boots (5).
Loosen the nut (4) and remove the screw (3).
Remove the plate (2).

Assembly
Proceed in reverse order.
Follow the marks made during disassembly and tighten
the nut (4) to a torque of 36 ÷ 44 Nm (26 ÷ 32 lbf·ft).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 137

CONTROL LEVER VALVE


P. Supply
T. Return to tank

Right valve (dipper/bucket)


1. Retracting the dipper
2. Opening the backhoe bucket
3. Extending the dipper
4. Closing the backhoe bucket

Left valve (backhoe attachment/swing)


1. Boom
2. Right swinging
3. Lowering
4. Left swinging

1. cardan joint cam


2. Plate
3. Shim
4. Upper body
5. Rod guide
6. Seal ring
7. Seal ring
8. Rod
9. Spring guide
10. Spring
11. Shim
12. Cover
13. Safety ring
14. Spring
15. Spool
16. Shims
17. Valve
18. O-ring
19. Lower body
20. O-ring
21. O-ring
138 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVER VALVE OVERHAUL

Disassembly
Mark the direction of installation of all disassembled
parts.
Remove the U/J cam (1) using a key.
Remove the plate (2).
Remove the shim (3) from the upper body (4).
Extract the rod guide (5) and replace the seal rings
(6) and (7).
Drift the rod (8) out.
Remove the spring guide (9), the spring (10) and
the shims (11).
Extract the spool assembly.
Hold the cover (12) and remove the safety ring
(13).
Remove the spring (14) and the spool (15).
Remove and note the thickness of the shims (16).
Proceed in the same manner for the other rods.
Secure the upper body (4) in a vice.
Loosen and remove the screw (17) using a key and
replace the O-ring (18).
Separate the upper (4) and lower (19) bodies and
replace the seal rings (20) and (21).

Assembly
To reassemble, proceed in the reverse order to that
of removal.
In the case of reassembly without changing the U/J
cam (1), put the same value of shims (3) as those
in place.
After changing the U/J cam (1) adjust the pressure
of the cam on the rods.
Install a 2 mm (0.079 in) shim (3), check that the
recessing of the push-rods is less than 0.2 mm
(0.009 in), modify the shimming to more or less if
required.
Assemble the new seal rings (6), (7) and O-rings
(18), (20) and (21).
Lubricate the moving parts.
Apply brake thread fluid on the threads of the U/J
cam (1) and the screw (17).
Tighten the cam (1) to 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft) and the
screw (17) to 50 Nm (37 lbf·ft).
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 139

TROUBLESHOOTING

PRELIMINARY CHECKS
When troubleshooting, the pressure and flow rate The above-described preliminary checks assume
test must be carried out in a systematic manner that the failure is not linked to the engine perform-
and the results analyzed. ance.
In this way, the trouble may be identified immedi- Having performed these checks and failed to locate
ately and accurately. the cause of the malfunction, the following proce-
dures should be adopted:
If short-cuts, assumptions and guesses are made,
unnecessary component disassembly or replace- - if possible, operate the backhoe attachment and
ment could result. make notes of its operating characteristics. Move
each cylinder control lever so that the cylinders
Follow the step-by-step procedures outlined below.
move from the fully extended to the fully retracted
As a first step in the fault finding procedure, several position;
preliminary checks should be made. - compare the operating characteristics in the pre-
These checks are important because, once they ceding stage with the malfunctions listed hereun-
have been performed, they need no longer be con- der.
sidered as a possible cause of the immediate or
reported malfunction.
Check that the hydraulic oil is at the correct level
and of the correct specification.
Check the loader, backhoe or any additional acces-
sory such as hydraulic bucket, hammers etc., for
correct assembly or installation and additionally for
signs of external damage that might cause gross
misalignment of structural members.
Check in more detail for other mechanical damage
such as kinked, twisted, worn or decayed hoses,
damaged cylinders and bent elements.
Do not forget to check underneath the unit for dam-
aged steel tubes, particularly if the unit has been
known to have operated in arduous conditions,
been grounded, or bogged down.
Ensure optimum operating temperature of the
hydraulic oil is achieved.
Perform the system pressure and rear pump relief
valve pressure tests.
140 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

TROUBLESHOOTING (WITH “REXROTH” CONTROL VALVES)


GENERAL

TROUBLE CAUSE ACTION


All systems fail to operate. Pump drive inoperative. Check and repair as necessary.
Low oil level. Check and top up.
Restricted pump suction line. Inspect the suction line and the tank
and repair as necessary.
Slow operation or loss of Worn pump. Perform pump performance test and
power in all systems. replace/reseal as necessary.
Restricted pump suction line. Inspect the suction line and the tank
and repair as necessary.
Load sensing pressure relief valve Make a system pressure test.
incorrectly adjusted.
Hydraulic speed solenoid valve Make a system pressure test.
inoperative.

LOADER ATTACHMENT

TROUBLE CAUSE ACTION


The lifting system fails to Valve spool leaking. Examine lift section of loader control
operate, is slow or loses valve assembly for wear or scoring.
power. Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
Bucket fails to operate, is The relief valves are stuck open, set to Check the bucket system relief valve.
slow or has loss of power. a too low value or there is a leak in the
seat.
Valve spool leaking. Examine bucket section of loader
control valve assembly for wear or
scoring.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damage.
Cylinder leak (spools in Damaged piston barrel. Examine/reseal piston and gland.
neutral). Internal valve leak. Examine appropriate valve section of
loader control valve assembly for wear
or scoring.
Hesitation in the raising Load check valve between control Disassemble and inspect.
movement of the loader valve sections damaged.
attachment or of the
bucket cylinders when the
control is initially actuated.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 141

BACKHOE
Refer to the following backhoe fault finding chart after first considering the preceding charts. This chart should
only be referred to if the supply system is operating normally, thereby confirming that the hydraulic supply sys-
tems and the pump are correctly operating. See also “Fault finding hydraulic pump”.

TROUBLE CAUSE ACTION


The lifting system is Lifting system relief valve stuck open, Test the pressure of the lifting system
inoperative, is too slow, set too low or seat leaking. relief valve.
loses power or does not Valve spool leaking. Examine lift section of backhoe control
hold. valve assembly for wear and scoring.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
The digging control fails to Digging system relief valve (piston Test the pressure of the digging
operate, is slow or loses end) stuck open, set too low or seat system relief valve.
power. leaking.
Valve spool leaking. Examine digging section of backhoe
control valve assembly for wear and
scoring.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
The digging control fails to The bucket relief valve (rod end) is Test the pressure of the bucket relief
operate, is slow or loses stuck open, set to a too low value or valve.
power. there is a leak in the seat.
Valve spool leaking. Examine bucket section of backhoe
control valve assembly for wear and
scoring.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
The telescopic dipper fails The telescopic dipper system relief Test the pressure of the telescopic
to operate, is slow or loses valve (piston end) is stuck open, set to dipper relief valve.
power. a too low value or there is a leak in the
seat.
Valve spool leaking. Examine telescopic dipper section of
backhoe control valve assembly for
wear and scoring.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
Stabilizer pads leaking. Stabilizer relief valve leaking. Inspect and overhaul the stabilizer
relief valve.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
142 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

SWING

TROUBLE CAUSE ACTION


Right or left swing is Swing system relief valves not Test the swing system relief valve.
inoperative, is too slow or seating, set too low or seat leaking.
loses power. Valve spool leaking. Examine swing section of backhoe
control valve assembly for wear or
scoring.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
The swing fails to slow Built-in sliding limiter damaged. Disassemble and inspect.
down (bearing stop) at Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
stroke end. damage.
The swing does not stop The system relief valve (return side) is Test the swing system relief valve.
when the control lever stuck open, set to a too low value or
returns to neutral (one there is a leak in the seat.
direction only). Valve spool leaking. Examine swing section of backhoe
control valve assembly for wear or
scoring.
Cylinder leak (spools in Internal valve leak. Examine appropriate valve section of
neutral). backhoe control valve assembly for
wear or scoring.
Piston seals leaking or cylinder barrel Examine/reseal piston and gland.
damaged.
A system temporarily Load check valve between control Disassemble and inspect.
lowers when given the valve sections damaged.
control to lift.
SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM 143

HYDRAULIC PUMP

TROUBLE CAUSE ACTION


System noisy. Worn or damaged pump gears or Make a hydraulic pump performance
pressure plates. test.
Aeration: air entering the systems at: Make a hydraulic pump performance
suction tube, pump shaft, fittings or test.
cylinder ring nuts.
Cavitation: system restrictions in the Make a visual check and/or a
suction line or in the tank filter. hydraulic pump performance test.
Water in the system. Visual check.
The system relief valve vibrates. Check system relief valve, adjust/
overhaul as necessary.
Vibrations in the lines. Visual check.
Cold hydraulic oil. Check the hydraulic oil operating
temperature.
Wrong oil type. Investigate/drain and top up.
Hydraulic oil drain through Tank overfilled. Check hydraulic oil level.
tank breather. Aeration: air entering the system at: Make a hydraulic pump performance
suction tube, pump shaft, fittings or test.
cylinder ring nuts.
Cavitation: Restriction of the suction Make a visual check and/or a
filter in the tank. hydraulic pump performance test.
Oil heating. Low oil quantity. Fill the tank.
Contaminated oil. Drain the tank and refill with clean oil.
Too high/low setting of the relief valve. Drain the tank and refill with clean oil.
Test relief valves.
Oil in system too light. Drain the tank and refill with oil with
the correct viscosity.
Oil cooler fins obstructed. Clean the oil cooler.
Oil leaks through the shaft Worn shaft seal. Replace shaft seal and inspect pump.
seal.
Foamy oil. Low oil level. Fill the tank.
Air in the suction system. Check/tighten suction line.
Wrong oil type. Drain and refill with correct oil.
144 SECTION 35 - HYDRAULIC SYSTEM

NOTES:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 39 - CHASSIS

DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................. 3

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF COMPONENTS .................................................................................... 6


COMPONENTS WITHIN THE CHASSIS .................................................................................................... 6
COMPONENTS OF THE LOWER PART OF THE CHASSIS ..................................................................... 7
COMPONENTS ATTACHED OUTSIDE THE CHASSIS........................................................................... 11
COMPONENTS OF THE UPPER PART ................................................................................................... 12
2 SECTION 39 - CHASSIS
SECTION 39 - CHASSIS 3

DESCRIPTION
The chassis of the Backhoe Loader is manufactured
as a one-piece unit, on which the main assemblies
are attached, or which supports the main assem-
blies.

TYPES
Some kinds of chassis are available, which differ
from each other according to some main character-
istics of the Backhoe Loader.
Loader attachment:
- “straight” loader arm (2WS);
- “bent” loader arm (2WS-TC and 4WS).
Backhoe attachment:
- Center pivot: the backhoe attachment is directly
connected to the chassis and cannot shift laterally;
- Sideshift: the backhoe attachment is installed on a
sideshift support and can shift laterally on the
chassis guides.
Steering:
- 2 wheel steering (2WS);
- 4 wheel steering (4WS).
4 SECTION 39 - CHASSIS

2WS CENTER PIVOT CHASSIS

4WS CENTER PIVOT CHASSIS

2WS SIDESHIFT CHASSIS


SECTION 39 - CHASSIS 5

2WS-TC SIDESHIFT CHASSIS

4WS SIDESHIFT CHASSIS


6 SECTION 39 - CHASSIS

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF COMPONENTS

COMPONENTS WITHIN THE CHASSIS

ENGINE
Supported by 2 rubber silent blocks and held in Remove:
position by 2 support brackets.
- the air filter;
The brackets are welded to the frame on either side - the engine guard;
of the engine.
- the radiator and the relevant hoses (or pivot it for-
wards if possible);
S WARNING S - the front support grid (if necessary).
Since they are fastened to each other, the engine
and the transmission operate as a one-piece unit. If Disconnect:
separated in the machine they are not self support- - the cable for supply pump throttle and electric
ing and will collapse causing injury or damage to shut-off;
the machine.
- the engine wiring harness;
TRANSMISSION - the fuel tank connection and the recovery/return
Attached to the rear side of the engine and sup- hoses;
ported by means of brackets provided with rubber - the relevant hoses (plug all ports as required) of
silent blocks. the hydraulic pump;
To make repairs that require disassembly of the - the transmission lever;
transmission or engine it will be necessary to - the transmission wiring harness connectors.
remove the engine/transmission as a complete unit
from the chassis.
To remove the engine/transmission from the
machine, it will be necessary to carry out some
operations.
SECTION 39 - CHASSIS 7

COMPONENTS OF THE LOWER PART OF THE CHASSIS

FRONT AXLE
The front axle is attached to the underside of the
chassis by 6 through screws (2WS) or 4 through
screws (4WS).
To remove front axle from the machine see
“REMOVAL FROM MACHINE” in SECTION 25 -
FRONT AXLES.

REAR AXLE
The rear axle is attached to the frame at the rear of
the machine by 4 through screws.
To remove rear axle from the machine see
“REMOVAL FROM MACHINE” in SECTION 27 -
REAR AXLE.
8 SECTION 39 - CHASSIS

CARDAN SHAFTS
2WS

1. Front axle
2. Front cardan shaft
3. Screw [tightening torque 33 ÷ 39 Nm (24 ÷ 29 lbf·ft)]
4. Bracket
5. Bracket
6. Screw [tightening torque 35 ÷ 41 Nm (26 ÷ 30 lbf·ft)]
7. Rear cardan shaft
8. Rear axle
SECTION 39 - CHASSIS 9

4WS

1. Front axle
2. Bracket
3. Screw [tightening torque 35 ÷ 41 Nm (26 ÷ 30 lbf·ft)]
4. Front cardan shaft
5. Bracket
6. Screw [tightening torque 35 ÷ 41 Nm (26 ÷ 30 lbf·ft)]
7. Rear cardan shaft
8. Rear axle
10 SECTION 39 - CHASSIS

COUNTERWEIGHT

It is installed under the chassis in the front section of


the machine with two screws.
There are different types of counterweights:
2WS (A):
1. Standard counterweight ......... 127.3 kg (281 lb)
2. Medium counterweight .............. 370 kg (816 lb)
3. Big counterweight ................ 483.7 kg (1066 lb)

4WS (B):
4. Standard counterweight ......... 125.5 kg (276 lb)
5. Medium counterweight .............. 333 kg (733 lb)
SECTION 39 - CHASSIS 11

COMPONENTS ATTACHED OUTSIDE THE CHASSIS

TANKS
The hydraulic oil tank (1) and the fuel tank (2) are
attached to the chassis under the cab, respectively
to the right-hand and left-hand side of the machine.
When drained of their contents, both tanks can be
removed from the machine, disconnecting the rel-
evant hoses and removing the fastening screws
[tightening torque of 85 Nm (63 lbf·ft)].
IMPORTANT: make sure that all inlets and pipes are
plugged or blanked off to prevent the dirt from enter-
ing them.
12 SECTION 39 - CHASSIS

COMPONENTS OF THE UPPER PART


CAB

A. Front coupler 6. Nut


B. Rear coupler 7. Retaining screw
C. Cab skirts 8. Washer
1. Main frame 9. Cab floor
2. Anti-vibration 10. Cab support (rear)
3. Dampener 11. Support
4. Washer 12. Bushing
5. Washer 13. Cab support (front)
SECTION 39 - CHASSIS 13

The cab frame is a one-piece unit, mounted on top


of the chassis.
To remove the cab it is necessary to carry out differ-
ent operations, listed below.
Remove the cab skirts (S) all around the cab.
Disconnect the two electric connectors from the
main harness and engine harness.
Remove the two front fixing screws (7) between the
cab floor and the cab support (13) (detail A).
Remove the two rear fixing screws (7) between the
cab floor and the rear supports (10) on the main
frame (1) (detail B).
Disconnect the two steering cylinder hoses (left
side).
Disconnect the pump - power steering valve hose.
Disconnect the power steering valve - oil tank hose.
Disconnect the load sensing valve hose.
Disconnect the stabilizers cables (mechanical ver-
sion).
Disconnect the parking brake cable.
Disconnect the water - heater hoses (after water dis-
charge).
Disconnect the air conditioning hoses (after coolant
drain).
Disconnect the transport lock cable (mechanical
version).
Disconnect the telescopic dipper control pedal
(mechanical version).
Turn the knobs and the boots of the various levers
(front and rear)
Lift the cab with the crane after its anchorage to lift-
ing hook.
IMPORTANT: when lifting the cab ensure the
hydraulic brake tanks are not caught and damaged
on the loader support frame.
14 SECTION 39 - CHASSIS

NOTES:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

DESCRIPTION ................................................................................................................................................. 3

2WS STEERING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................... 4

4WS STEERING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................... 7

POWER STEERING ....................................................................................................................................... 11


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 11
COMPONENTS ......................................................................................................................................... 13
DISASSEMBLY.......................................................................................................................................... 15
ASSEMBLY................................................................................................................................................ 18
2 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 3

DESCRIPTION
The steering system has the following features:
- double-acting steering cylinder;
- oil tank in common with the main hydraulic sys-
tem;
- a hydraulic pump located on the rear part of the
transmission;
- steering (or power steering) control valve located
on the steering wheel’s column.
The oil is taken from the tank and reaches the
pump.
The front pump flow is directed to the loader and
backhoe attachment control valves.
Thanks to the presence of a flow divider, the rear
pump delivery guarantees priority oil delivery to the
steering system.
The flow divider includes a load-sensing valve and a
steering system pressure relief valve.
According to the machine model, the steering sys-
tem can be of 2 types:
- 2WS steering system;
- 4WS steering system.
4 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

2WS STEERING SYSTEM

1. Flow divider 5. Oil filter


2. Power steering 6. By-pass valve
3. Hydraulic tank 7. Radiator
4. Return manifold 8. Front axle
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 5

OPERATION
Power steering - Neutral position

Pump pressure Trapped oil


Stand-by pressure Return to oil tank

When the steering wheel is held still, the leaf springs


return and hold the power steering spool in neutral
position.
This ensures that no more oil is supplied to the
steering cylinder.
The spool also traps the oil in the steering cylinder
and allows the oil in the sensing lines to return to the
tank, thus allowing the priority flow divider to move
to the left.
6 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

Power steering - Turning right

Pump pressure Trapped oil


Metered pressure Return to oil tank

When the steering wheel is turned, the movement As the metering unit is turned by the drive shaft, it
of the power steering spool forms a series of pas- directs a measured quantity of oil along another set
sages. of passages in the spool then from these to the
steering cylinder.
During right turn, oil flows through the spool along a
groove and into a passage in the housing which Return oil from the other side of the cylinder is
leads to the metering unit. A gallery is also lined up directed through the spool to a return passage in
to allow pressure oil to flow down the sensing line the housing.
to the priority flow divider.
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 7

4WS STEERING SYSTEM

1. Flow divider 6. By-pass valve


2. Power steering 7. Radiator
3. Hydraulic tank 8. Front axle
4. Return manifold 9. 4WS steering control valve
5. Oil filter 10. Rear axle
8 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

4WS STEERING CONTROL VALVE


The valve is located on the rear axle.
Remove the four hoses and the two fastening
screws.
Remove the valve.
Draw a diagonal line across the complete valve
block this will assist in the correct reassembly later.
The valve consists of a central manifold block which
all input and output pipes are attached to.
On each side of this block is a solenoid valve.
The solenoid valves have two positions: both of
these positions are working positions and there is
no neutral point.
Each spool is detented and therefore the solenoids
are only energized momentarily to move the spool.
On the end of each solenoid is an emergency hand
operating pin which moves the control spool without
energizing the solenoid.
The switching of the steering valve is normally con-
trolled by a microprocessor located underneath the
right hand side console.
Components
1. Solenoid knob
2. Solenoid
3. Control spool
4. Block
5. Central block
6. Fixing screws
7. Piston
8. O-ring
9. O-ring
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 9

OPERATION

In the position shown both spools have been


moved by solenoids (2b) and (3b).
The detents on the (a) side of the solenoid hold the
spool in this position until another solenoid is
pulsed.
10 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

The spool in valve (3) was last moved by solenoid


(3b): oil flowing in from P3 flows through the internal
galleries of the spool and exits at port A3.
From here, oil enters valve (2), whose spool was
last moved by solenoid (2b).
Oil flows through port P2 and exits through port T2,
cutting off flow to the rear steering cylinder.
Now the oil returns in valve (3), entering through
port B3 and flowing out through port T3. From here,
oil enters the front steering cylinder.

The three modes of steering are as follows:

Front wheel only steering

Front and rear wheel steer

Front and rear wheel crab

The solenoids energized are shown in the table


below.
These are also the pins which need to be pressed
when changing steering mode manually in an emer-
gency.
X = Energized
O = Not Energized

3a 3b 2a 2b

2WS O X O X

2WS X O O X

4WS O X X O

CRAB X O X O
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 11

POWER STEERING
The power steering consists of a metering and
emergency pump that includes:
- a gearwheel with fixed stator with inner teeth and
a rotor with outer teeth;
- a 4-way rotary control valve consisting of an outer
sleeve and an inner selection rotor;
- a rotor connected to the steering wheel by means
of the steering column, which can be of two types,
fixed or adjustable;
- a cardan shaft which is mechanically tied to the
gearwheel and to the outer sleeve, and allows the
transmission’s movement;
- a set of centering springs between the outer
sleeve and the inner rotor.

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
L. Left control port (steering cylinder)
R. Right control port (steering cylinder)
P. Inlet to steering pump
T. Outlet to oil tank
LS. Outlet to steering pump
12 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

2WS (with variable-flow-rate pump)


Model ........................................................................................................................ EATON P/N 403 -8754-04
Displacement ............................................................................................................. 160 cm3/rev (9.76 in3/rev)
Shock valve adjustment ......................................................................................................... 235 bar (3408 psi)
Load-sensing pressure relief valve adjustment...................................................................... 175 bar (2538 psi)
2WS (with gear pump)
Model ........................................................................................................................ EATON P/N 403 -8754-08
Displacement ............................................................................................................. 160 cm3/rev (9.76 in3/rev)
Shock valve adjustment ......................................................................................................... 235 bar (3408 psi)
Load-sensing pressure relief valve adjustment...............................................................................................No
4WS
Model ........................................................................................................................ EATON P/N 403 -7754-04
Displacement ............................................................................................................. 160 cm3/rev (9.76 in3/rev)
Shock valve adjustment ......................................................................................................... 235 bar (3408 psi)
Load-sensing pressure relief valve adjustment...................................................................... 175 bar (2538 psi)
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 13

COMPONENTS
14 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

A. Anticavitation valve 19. Seal ring


B. Manual check valve 20. Gasket
C. Inlet check valve 21. O-ring
D. Cylinder relief valve 22. Seal
E. Load-sensing relief valve 23. Bearing cup
F. Inlet relief valve 24. Bearing
1. Screw 25. Bearing cup
2. Cover 26. Spring
3. O-ring 27. Spacer
4. Spring 28. Sleeve
5. Plug 29. Plug
6. Ball 30. O-ring
7. Rotor/stator gear 31. Spring
8. Plate 32. Poppet
9. Shaft 33. O-ring
10. Power steering unit 34. O-ring
11. Valve seat 35. Ball
12. Ball 36. Pin
13. Ball holder 37. Spacer
14. O-ring 38. Valve seat
15. Spring 39. Poppet
16. Plug 40. Spring
17. Cross pin 41. O-ring
18. Spool 42. Plug
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 15

DISASSEMBLY
Cleanliness is extremely important when repairing
the power steering.
Work in a clean area.
Before disconnecting the lines, thoroughly clean the
area.
Use a wire brush to remove foreign material and
debris.
Use protective material on vice jaws.
Power steering unit distortion can result if jaws are
over-tightened.
M = mark

Loosen and remove the screws (1).


Remove the cap (2).
Remove the O-ring (3).

Remove the rotor / stator gear (7).


Remove the O-ring (34).
Remove the spacer (37).
16 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

Remove the shaft (9).


Remove the plate (8).
Remove the O-ring (33) from the power steering
unit (10).

Carefully remove the anti-cavitation valve (A) and


the manual check valve (B) from the holes of the
screws by tipping.

Carefully remove the spool-sleeve (18) assembly


from the power steering unit (10), keeping it vertical.
Extract the pin (17) from the spool (18) and sleeve
(28) assembly.

S CAUTION S
Do not lift the spool-sleeve assembly inside the
power steering unit (10).
Slowly rotate the spool-sleeve assembly to remove
it from the power steering unit.

Remove the bearing race (25), the bearing (24) and


the bearing race (23) from the power steering unit
(10).
Remove the seal ring (19).
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 17

Partially push the spool (18) on the end of the


sleeve, then carefully remove the centering springs
(26) from the spool (18).
The power steering with low input torque uses four
centering springs (26) and two spacers (27).
The standard input torque power steering uses six
centering springs.
M = mark
S1 = low torque springs
S2 = standard springs
NOTE: do not remove any valves other than the
manual check valve and the anti-cavitation valves.
All other valves are factory preset and are non-serv-
iceable.
18 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

ASSEMBLY
Check all mating surfaces.
If any parts have scratches or burrs, the power
steering must be replaced.
The use of parts with scratches or burrs can cause
leakage and is therefore not recommended.
Clean all metal parts in clean solvent.
Blow dry with air.
Do not wipe dry with cloth or paper towel because
lint or other matter can get into the hydraulic system
and cause damage.
Do not use grit paper or file or grind these parts.
Lubricate all seals, replace all old seals with new
seals and do not use an excessive quantity of lubri-
cant on the seals of the rotor / stator gear.
Carefully assemble the spool (18) and the sleeve
(28) so that spring slots line up correctly. Rotate
spool while sliding parts together.
M = marks
Test for free rotation.
The spool should rotate smoothly in the sleeve with
finger tip force applied to its end.
Align the spool and the sleeve making reference to
the relevant marks (M).

The centering springs (26) for power steering with


low input torque (S1) have four arched springs with
two flat spacers (27) in the center.
The centering springs (26) for power steering with
standard input torque (S2) have six arched springs.
Position centering springs so that the notches line
up, and arched center sections are nested together.
Next, with spring notches facing sleeve, insert one
end of entire spring set into spring installation tool.
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 19

Compress the extended end of the spring set and


push it into the spool (18) - sleeve (28) assembly.
Keep pressure on spring ends while withdrawing
installation tool and pushing forward on springs at
same time.
Central springs set in spring slots. Seat springs
down evenly and flush with upper surface of spool
(28) and sleeve (18).

Insert the pin (17) through the spool (18) - sleeve


(28) assembly until the pin is within the outside
diameter of the sleeve.

Lubricate the seal ring (19).


Install the bearing races (23), (25) and the bearing
(24).
20 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

Position the spool (18) - sleeve (28) assembly so


that the splined end of the spool enters the power
steering body first.

S CAUTION S
While inserting the spool-sleeve assembly, make
sure that the parts do not tilt out of position. Gently
push the assembly into place with a slight rotation,
holding the pin so that it does not come out and
gets stuck in the internal groove.

Completely insert the spool-sleeve assembly into


the body.
With aligned spool-sleeve assembly, check for free
rotation by turning the assembly with fingertip force
applied to the end.
Position the power steering unit (10) in a vice.
Lightly clamp on the edges of the mounting area; do
not over-tighten the jaws.
NOTE: make sure that the spool and the sleeve are
flush or slightly below the unit’s surface.
Clean the upper surface of the unit.

Install the O-ring (33).


Install the anti-cavitation valves (A) and the manual
check valve (B).
Install the plate (8). Align the holes in the plate (8)
with the threaded holes in the unit (10).
SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM 21

Rotate the spool and sleeve assembly until the pin


is parallel with the port’s face.
Install the shaft (9), making sure it is engaged with
pin (17).
To guarantee proper alignment, mark the shaft (see
reference L2).
When marking the shaft, note the relationship
between slotted end and splined end.
Lubricate and install the O-ring (34).
The lubrication will hold the seal in place.
Note the parallel relationship of reference lines L1,
L2, L3 and L4.
Lubricate and install the O-ring (3).
Remove the cap (2).

Screw in the 7 screws (1).


Pretighten the screws to a tightening torque of 17 Nm
(12 lbf·ft).
Then tighten the screws to a tightening torque of
35 ÷ 45 Nm (26 ÷ 33 lbf·ft) in the sequence shown
in the figure.

Check for proper timing by turning the spool clock-


wise and feeling pressure in the “R” port.
22 SECTION 41 - STEERING SYSTEM

NOTES:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR


CONDITIONING

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS....................................................................................................................... 3
GENERAL.................................................................................................................................................... 3

CAB HEATING.................................................................................................................................................. 5
CONTROLS ................................................................................................................................................. 5
OPERATION................................................................................................................................................ 6
OVERHAUL ................................................................................................................................................. 9
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................... 11

AIR CONDITIONING ...................................................................................................................................... 12


PRINCIPLES OF AIR CONDITIONING ..................................................................................................... 12
CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................... 17
OPERATION.............................................................................................................................................. 18
FAULT FINDING AND TESTING............................................................................................................... 25
FLUSHING THE SYSTEM......................................................................................................................... 43
DRAINING THE SYSTEM ......................................................................................................................... 45
CHARGING THE SYSTEM........................................................................................................................ 46
OVERHAUL ............................................................................................................................................... 47

COMPRESSOR .............................................................................................................................................. 52
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS................................................................................................................ 52
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION .............................................................................................................. 53
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 56
TROUBLESHOOTING............................................................................................................................... 65
2 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 3

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

GENERAL
ENGINE RADIATOR COOLANT
Antifreeze - Ambra Agriflu.......................................................................................................12 litres (2.64 gal)
Water ......................................................................................................................................12 litres (2.64 gal)
System type ........................................................... Pressurized FULL FLOW by-pass with expansion chamber

FAN BELT DEFLECTION


Natural suction ........................................................................................................ 13 ÷ 19 mm (0.51 ÷ 0.75 in)
Turbocharged.......................................................................................................... 10 ÷ 16 mm (0.39 ÷ 0.63 in)

THERMOSTAT
Opening starts at.......................................................................................................................... 82 °C (179 °F)
Fully open at ................................................................................................................................ 95 °C (203 °F)
Radiator cap.............................................................................................................................. 0.90 bar (13 psi)

MOUNTING SCREW TORQUE


Coolant/hot water hose connections...........................................................................................5 Nm (3.7 lbf·ft)
Air hose connections...................................................................................................................5 Nm (3.7 lbf·ft)
Heater housing to floor fastening screws.................................................................................6.2 Nm (4.6 lbf·ft)

COOLANT
Type .................................................................................................................................................... HFC 134a
Coolant quantity ............................................................................................................................ 1.2 kg (2.6 lb)

COMPRESSOR OIL
Type .........................................................................................................SP20 (PAG type, viscosity index 100)
Oil change amount................................................................................................................. 135 cm3 (8.24 in3)

CHECK CONDITIONS
Air inlet temperature.................................................................................................................. 37.8 °C (100 °F)
Rated air inlet humidity ................................................................................................................................ 40%
Evaporation temperature ................................................................................................................. 0 °C (32 °F)
Overheating ..................................................................................................................................... 5 °C (41 °F)
Inlet air speed ...............................................................................................1.0 - 2.0 - 3.0 m/s (3.3-6.6-9.9 ft/s)
Condensation temperature .............................................................................. 58 °C (136 °F) (16 absolute bar)
Undercooling.................................................................................................................................... 2 °C (35 °F)
4 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

PERFORMANCE
Performance calculated at 1 m/s (3.28 ft) [191.72 m3/h (6769.31 ft3)]
Exchanged heat ................................................................................................. 5.48 kW 4718.28 kcal/h
Air outlet temperature......................................................................... 5.64 °C (42.15 °F)
Air side load loss ............................................................................................. 2.97 daPa 0.30 mmH20
(0.00431 psi) (0.012 inH20)
Coolant side load loss ....................................................................................... 13.1 kPa 0.13 bar (1.9 psi)
Performance calculated at 2.0 m/s (6.56 ft) [383.4 m3/h (13537.22 ft3)]
Exchanged heat ................................................................................................. 9.29 kW 7998.69 kcal/h
Air outlet temperature....................................................................... 10.30 °C (50.54 °F)
Air side load loss ............................................................................................. 9.34 daPa 0.95 mmH20
(0.0135 psi) (0.037 inH20)
Coolant side load loss ....................................................................................... 32.7 kPa 0.33 bar (4.8 psi)
Performance calculated at 3.0 m/s (9.84 ft) [575.1 m3/h (20305.83 ft3)]
Exchanged heat ............................................................................................... 12.00 kW 10332.00 kcal/h
Air outlet temperature....................................................................... 13.70 °C (56.66 °F)
Air side load loss ........................................................................................... 18.30 daPa 1.87 mmH20
(0.0265psi) (0.074 inH20)
Coolant side load loss ..................................................................................... 51.20 kPa 0.51 bar (7.4 psi)
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 5

CAB HEATING
The cab is heated by a radiator mounted below the
cab seat, which is supplied hot water from the
engine coolant system.
A blower motor mounted behind the cab radiator is
used to transfer the heat into the cab.

CONTROLS
Heater blower control
The three-speed blower is controlled by means of a
knob (1) on the instrument console, to the right of
the operator’s seat.
Turn clockwise to the first position for slow speed.
A further clockwise rotation selects medium and
fast speeds.
The blower draws outside air from beneath the cab
floor and blows it into the cab through a filter.
Temperature control
The temperature of the air coming from the radiator
is adjusted by rotating the control knob (2), which
opens or closes the radiator valve, thus increasing
or decreasing the water flow as required.
Turn clockwise to increase the temperature of the
air coming from the heater.
By rotating counterclockwise, the temperature is
decreased.
6 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

OPERATION
CAB AIR FILTER
Before servicing the air filter situated under the
operator’s seat, switch off the blower and close all
windows and one door.
Forcibly close the other door.
The resulting back pressure will dislodge loose dirt
from the underside of the filters.
To remove the filter (1), release the retaining straps
(2) and remove the filter element.
Ensure the element, and sealing faces are not dam-
aged on removal.
IMPORTANT: in humid conditions, such as occur
on most early mornings, do not switch on the blower
prior to servicing the filters. Damp particles drawn
into the filter may solidify and prove difficult to
remove without washing.
The filter element is made of specially treated paper
with a sealing strip bonded to the outer face.
Clean this element by blowing with compressed air
from the clean side through to the dirty side. The
compressed air should not exceed 2 bar (29 psi)
and the air line nozzle should be at least 300 mm
(11.8 in) from the element.

HEATER RADIATOR
The heater radiator (1) is fitted in a housing under
the cab seat to guarantee a uniform distribution of
warm or cold air flow.
IMPORTANT: to ensure a good flow of air through
the heater radiator the filter should be cleaned more
frequently when operating in extremely dusty condi-
tions.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 7

AIR FLOW DIFFUSERS


Air flow diffusers are connected to the heater con-
tainer and receive air from the blower motor, to
direct warm or cold air onto the windscreen and
side windows or to the cab interior as required.
Each diffuser may be swivelled and adjusted to con-
trol the flow of air.
To open a diffuser, press one side of the disc and
turn it, as required, to direct the air flow.
The diffusers are located as follows:
- two on the top of the main dashboard (A);
- two on the front edge of the front instrument panel
(E);
- two to the rear of the operator seat (C);
- two under the seat, one in front, the other on the
rear (D);
- two on the cab posts, right and left (B);
- two on the ceiling, in front and back of operator’s
head (F).
NOTE: the diffusers (B) and (F) are mounted only
when air conditioning (optional) is fitted.
8 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

ELECTRIC HEATER VALVE


The electric valve is equipped with a software that,
each time the supply of the cock is delayed (there-
fore also at backhoe loader start), carries out the
momentary positioning of the cock to “completely
closed” and returns to the position set by the tem-
perature regulation handle located on the control
dashboard.
This enables the software to carry out a self-control
on the cock drive so as to always obtain an optimal
regulation of the ball for the water flow.
This is part of the cock normal operation and is not
to be considered as a fault.
Valve release
IMPORTANT: the release of the valve has to be per-
formed if this valve remains idle for long periods.
Carry out this operation observing the following pro-
cedure:
- disconnect the electric connectors (1);
- loosen the screws (2) and extract the electric
valve (3) from the evaporator;
- loosen and remove the screws (4);

- separate the driving unit (5) from the cock (6);


- by means of a wrench, turn the pin (A) of the cock
to unlock it.

S WARNING S
Once this operation is complete, reset pin (A) in the
correct start position.

Reinstall the heater valve, repeating the previously


carried out operations in reverse order.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 9

OVERHAUL
IMPORTANT: when overhauling the heating system
remember that, with the engine running or shortly
after it is turned off, the system will be at engine
temperature and therefore the water will be hot and
under pressure.
To carry out the different checks and operations, it
is necessary to drain the system.
To drain the cooling system, disconnect either hose
at the union tee (1) found behind the engine oil filter,
mounted to the left-hand side of the engine.

RADIATOR CHECK
With the system drained, remove the heater radia-
tor hose connections, the attaching screws and
remove the radiator from the vehicle.
Inspect the radiator (2).
Check that the water flows freely through the heater
line (otherwise, clear any obstruction).
Fins must be free from debris and not damaged:
clean and/or repair.
Clean the heater radiator using compressed air not
exceeding 7 bar (102 psi) taking care not to dam-
age the radiator fins.
Make sure that the radiator is not leaking under
pressure.
Clean the chamber with a damp, cloth and re-
assemble the housing filter element with the seal
facing the inside of the cover.
10 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

BLOWER MOTOR CHECKS


The blower motor (3) can be removed by removing
the attaching screws and disconnecting the electric
connector.
Check that the fan operates correctly.
Otherwise, check the fuse and the continuity of the
fan motor. If defective, replace the blower unit as an
assembly.

HEATING VALVE
To service the control valve (4), disconnect the
hoses and the control tie rod and remove it.
Check its operation and replace it, if worn.

CONTROL PANEL
Check for the correct operation of the control knobs
(5) and (6).
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 11

TROUBLESHOOTING
Items that may cause trouble are listed in the table
below. Anyway, as a general rule, we recommend
carrying out some preliminary checks.
Ensure water flow to the heater radiator is steady
and all air has been removed from the system.
Hoses are unrestricted and not leaking.
Check the electric connections are good and the
blower motor is operational.
The operating cable to the heater valve and valve is
operational.

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Dust enters the cab. Improper seal around filter element. Check the seal condition.
Blocked filter. Clean or replace the filter.
Defective filter. Replace the filter.
Excessive air leak(s) around doors Repair and Seal air leak(s).
and windows.
Blower motor air flow low. Blocked filter or recirculation filter. Clean or replace the filter(s).
Heater radiator core blocked. Clean radiator core thoroughly.
Blower motor not working. Fuse blown. Replace fuse.
Cab does not heat up. Engine not reaching operating Replace the temperature switch.
temperature. Thermostat stuck open.
Heater hose from engine to cab Ensure water flow to heater radiator
radiator, kinked or blocked. is adequate and not restricted.
Cab does not cool. Heater control turned on. Turn the temperature control knob
fully counterclockwise for maximum
cooling.
Heater control valve stuck in open Free up valve or change as required.
position.
Temperature not stable. Low engine coolant. Top up coolant recovery tank.
12 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

AIR CONDITIONING

PRINCIPLES OF AIR CONDITIONING


The function of the air conditioning system is to
improve the operator’s comfort by cooling down the
air temperature inside the cab and reducing the
humidity level.
In order to achieve this heat transfer the following
principals of heat generation and transfer are
applied within the air conditioning system.
When two bodies with a different temperature come
together, heat is transferred from one to the other.
On air conditioning systems, an evaporator is used
to maintain the low temperature of the coolant,
which absorbs the heat from the air within the cab.

When a gas is pressurized the temperature of the


gas will rise.
In air conditioning systems the increase in pressure
is achieved using a compressor.

When a gas is cooled it will condense into a liquid.


In the air conditioning system a condenser is used
to cool the gas and the resulting liquid is stored in a
receiver dryer.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 13

When a liquid is atomized through an orifice, the


temperature of the resultant vapour will lower.
The low temperature of the atomized liquid will then
absorb heat from its surrounding.
On air conditioning systems, coolant is atomized
using an expansion valve.
C
14 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

OPERATING DIAGRAM

1. Expansion valve-atomizes liquid coolant before 3. Compressor-compresses and raises tempera-


passing to evaporator ture of coolant gas
2. Evaporator-absorbs heat from air in cab 4. Condenser and receiver dryer-converts coolant
from gas to a liquid
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 15

LOW PRESSURE SIDE HIGH PRESSURE SIDE

EXPANSION
VALVE

LOW
TEMPERATURE
LIQUID ATOMIZED HIGH PRESSURE
AT A LOWER LIQUID FILTERED
TEMPERATURE AND MOISTURE
REMOVED

RECEIVER DRYER

LOWER
TEMPERATURE
EVAPORATOR
HIGH PRESSURE
LIQUID

CONDENSER
WARM LOW
PRESSURE
VAPOUR

HIGH
TEMPERATURE
HIGH PRESSURE
VAPOUR

COMPRESSOR

HEAT FROM INSIDE HEAT MOVES TO


CAB MOVES TO OUTSIDE AIR FROM
REFRIGERANT REFRIGERANT

Air conditioning flow diagram

It can now be seen that the principal components of Refrigerant is drawn into the compressor as a cool,
an air conditioning system are: low pressure vapour which is compressed and then
pumped out as a hot, high pressure vapour to the
- Refrigerant
condenser.
- Compressor
As the hot, high pressure vapour passes through
- Condenser
the condenser core it gives off heat to the cooler
- Receiver dryer outside air, being drawn past the fins by the engine
- Expansion valve cooling fan.
- Evaporator
16 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

By giving off heat to the outside air, the vapour is


condensed to a liquid which moves under high pres-
sure to the receiver dryer where it is stored until
released to the evaporator by the temperature sens-
ing expansion valve.
As liquid coolant passes through the metered orifice
in the expansion valve the coolant changes from a
high pressure liquid to a low pressure atomized liq-
uid with a lower temperature.
This low pressure, low temperature, atomized liquid
enters the evaporator coils and absorbs heat from
the cab warm air blown across the coils and fins by
the cab blower motor.
The coolant now changes from a cold low pressure
atomized liquid to a warm low pressure vapour and
leaves the evaporator outlet, moving to the suction
(low pressure) side of the compressor to repeat the
cycle.
As this heat loss is taking place, moisture (humidity)
in the cab air will condense on the outside of the
evaporator and drain off as water through the drain
hoses attached to the evaporator drain pan, thereby
reducing the humidity level of the cab.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 17

CONTROLS
CONTROLS (B90B)
The air conditioning control can be adjusted to
obtain the desired temperature in the cab.
To activate air conditioning, turn the selector (2).
Upon activation, the lamp (3) turns on. The selector
(1) allows choosing the ideal temperature according
to your requirements.
Positioning selector (1) to “0” and turning selector
(2) you will obtain more or less cold according to the
selector (2) position.
By positioning selector (1) to any other position dif-
ferent from “0”, you will obtain instead a mixture of
warm and cold air and the desired climate inside the
cab.
NOTE: the air conditioning can be operated only if
the ventilation selector (4) is not set to the stop posi-
tion.
Turn the selector (4) for air capacity according to
your requirements.

CONTROLS
(B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)
The air conditioning control can be adjusted to
obtain the desired temperature in the cab.
To activate air conditioning, turn the selector (2).
Upon activation, the lamp (4) on the side instrument
cluster turns on. The selector (1) allows choosing
the ideal temperature according to your require-
ments.
Positioning selector (1) to “0” and turning selector
(2) you will obtain more or less cold according to the
selector (2) position.
By positioning selector (1) to any other position dif-
ferent from “0”, you will obtain instead a mixture of
warm and cold air and the desired climate inside the
cab.

NOTE: the air conditioning can be operated only if


the ventilation selector (3) is not set to the stop posi-
tion.
Turn the selector (3) for air capacity according to
your requirements.
18 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

OPERATION
COOLANT
To achieve the absorption and the release of heat
which is, in essence, the function of an air condi- S WARNING S
tioning system, requires the use of a suitable “cool- HFC 134a can be dangerous if improperly handled.
ant” a liquid that has a relatively low temperature Therefore it is important the following warning and
boiling point, plus certain desirable safety and sta- directions are adhered to.
bility features. Never expose any part of the air-conditioner system
to flame or excessive heat because of risk of fire or
The coolant used in the air conditioning system is
explosion, and the production of phosgene gas.
coolant HFC 134a.
Never disconnect or disassemble any part of the air-
NOTE: to help protect the environment legislation conditioning system as escaping coolant can cause
has been introduced in most territories banning the frostbite.
release into the atmosphere of refrigerants, includ-
ing HFC 134a. All service procedures contained in
this manual can be carried out without the need to
S WARNING S
If coolant should contact the skin use the same
release coolant into the atmosphere.
treatment as for frostbite.
In order to prevent the incorrect type of coolant Warm the area with your hand or lukewarm water
being charged to the system the service valves fit- 32 °C (89.6 °F), cover the area loosely with a band-
ted to the Backhoe Loader and necessary to con- age to protect affected area against infection and
nect up coolant recovery, evacuation and recycling/ consult a doctor immediately.
re-charging equipment will be of two different sizes If coolant should contact the eyes wash immedi-
as recognized and specified by the air conditioning ately in cold clean water for at least 5 minutes and
industry. consult a doctor immediately.

S WARNING S
Coolant HFC 134a is not compatible with coolant R-
12. Do not try to replace coolant HFC 134a with cool-
ant R-12 or to test the system using instruments or
tools previously used with R12, as the system could
get damaged.

HFC 134a coolant is stable at all operating temper-


atures and able to absorb great quantities of heat.
The boiling point of HFC 134a is -22 °C (-7.6 °F) at
atmospheric pressure.
If the pressure is increased, HFC 134a will read-
ily vaporize to absorb heat at temperatures
between -11.7 °C (10.94 °F) at 1.9 bar (28 psi)
and 0 °C (32 °F) at 2.9 bar (42 psi) in the evapo-
rator.
At higher pressures, HFC 134a will condense and
give off heat at temperatures between 48 °C
(118.4 °F) at 12.4 bar (180 psi) and 58 °C
(136.4 °F) at 15.85 bar (230 psi) in the condenser.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 19

COMPRESSOR
The compressor is mounted on the left-hand side of
the engine and is belt driven by the crankshaft pul-
ley.
The compressor separates the low and high pres-
sure sides of the system and has two functions:
- raising the coolant temperature by compressing
to a higher degree of temperature than the ambi-
ent (outside air) temperature;
- circulating the required volume of coolant through
the system.
The compressor is a 7-cylinder wobble plate unit,
housed in a die-cast aluminium housing.
The drive to the wobble plate comes from the pul-
ley, through the clutch to the main driveshaft.
Attached to the driveshaft, there is a cam rotor
which oscillates the wobble plate.
The wobble plate is prevented from rotating by a
static gear engaging with teeth formed in the face of
the plate.
The seven pistons are connected to the wobble
plate by rods located in ball sockets.
Refrigerant is drawn in on the downward stroke of a
piston through the reed valves located either end of
the cylinder assembly.
Refrigerant enters the cylinder assembly through a
gallery in the outer circumference of the cylinder
assembly.
During the upward stroke, the piston compresses
the coolant and expels it through another reed valve
into an inner gallery in the cylinder and, from here,
out into the coolant system.
The compressor is lubricated with a Polyalklene
Glycol (PAG) oil Type SP20. This oil can be mixed
with coolant and is carried around in the coolant
system itself.
During the operation of the air conditioning system,
the compressor is activated by a clutch which
engages or disengages it as required.
20 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The air conditioner temperature adjusting sensor is
mounted on the blower motor.
It is a device which turns the compressor clutch on
and off to maintain a constant average evaporator
temperature and senses the evaporator tempera-
ture using a thermistor (1).
The sensor compares the voltage of the thermistor,
which depends on the temperature of the evapora-
tor, with the voltage across the potentiometer of the
“in-cab” temperature control switch.
The switch upon comparing the two voltages deter-
mines whether the compressor clutch should be
switched “on” or “off” in order to maintain the
desired in cab temperature control.

LOW-PRESSURE CUT-OUT SENSOR


The low-pressure (1) sensor is on the upper part of
the filter, situated in front of the radiator.
The purpose of the sensor is to shut off the com-
pressor in case of low pressure in the cooling sys-
tem.
Low coolant pressure may occur due to a faulty
expansion valve, icing up of the expansion valve
orifice or coolant loss.
Low coolant pressure may result in damage to the
compressor pump.
The low-pressure sensor is set by the Manufacturer.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 21

CONDENSER
The condenser (1), located at the front of the
machine in front of the engine radiator consists of a
number of turns of continuous coil mounted in a
series of thin cooling fins to provide a maximum of
heat transfer in a minimum amount of space.
The condenser receives the hot, high pressure
coolant vapour from the compressor.
The hot vapour passes through the condenser coils
and outside air is drawn through the condenser by
the engine cooling fan.
Heat moves from the hot coolant vapour into the
cooler outside air flowing across the condenser
coils and fins.
When the coolant vapour reaches the pressure and
temperature that will induce a change of state, a
large quantity of heat is transferred to the outside
air and the coolant changes to a high pressure
warm liquid.
The warm liquid coolant continues onto the
receiver/drier where it is filtered and desiccated, to
remove any moisture, before passing through an
outlet line to the thermostatic expansion valve.

RECEIVER DRYER
The receiver/dryer (1) stores the liquid coolant to
make sure that a steady flow to the expansion valve
is maintained also under extremely different operat-
ing conditions.
The drier contains a desiccant (molecular sieve)
which absorbs any moisture within the system, and
a filter which prevents the entry of foreign particles.
NOTE: any moisture in the air conditioning system
is extremely harmful. Moisture not absorbed by the
dehydrator will circulate with the coolant and drop-
lets may collect and freeze in the thermostatic
expansion valve orifice. This action will block the
coolant flow and stop the cooling action. Moisture
will also react with coolant HFC 134a and the lubri-
cant to form a corrosive acid.
The desiccant can only absorb a limited amount of
moisture before reaching saturation point. Because
of this, after any system component replacement or
repairs requiring entry into the system, the receiver/
dryer should be replaced.
22 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

EXPANSION VALVE
The expansion valve (1) is located underneath the
evaporator in the pressure line coming from the
receiver/dryer and performs the following functions:
- metering action
(a metering orifice changes the liquid coolant from
a high-pressure low-temperature liquid to a low-
pressure, lower-temperature atomized liquid);
- modulating action
(a thermostatically controlled valve within the
expansion valve body controls the volume of liq-
uid coolant passing through the orifice and makes
sure that the coolant is fully vaporized within the
evaporator; the liquid coolant could damage the
compressor reed valves or freeze the pistons);
- control action
(the valve responds to changes in the cooling
requirements; when an increased cooling is
required, the valve opens to increase the coolant
flow, and when less cooling is required, the valve
closes and decreases the coolant flow).

Operation
All of the needed temperature sensing and pressure
sensing functions are consolidated into this basic
unit and no external tubes are required for these
purposes.
The coolant from the condenser and receiver dryer
enters the thermostatic expansion valve as a high
pressure warm liquid.
Upon passing through the ball and spring controlled
metering orifice, the pressure and temperature of
the coolant is reduced and the coolant leaves the
thermostatic expansion valve as a low pressure,
lower temperature atomized liquid.
The atomized liquid now passes through the evapo-
rator where it absorbs heat before returning via the
expansion valve to the compressor as a warm low
pressure vapour.
There are two coolant passages in the valve.
One passage is in the coolant line from the con-
denser to the evaporator and contains the ball and
spring type orifice valve.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 23

The other passage is in the coolant line from the


evaporator to the compressor and contains the
valve’s temperature sensing element.
Liquid coolant flow from the condenser and receiver
dryer is controlled by a push-rod forcing the orifice
valve ball off its seat and the spring exerting pres-
sure on the ball to keep it on its seat.
During stabilized (vehicle shutdown) conditions, the
pressure on the bottom of the expansion valve dia-
phragm rises above the pressure on the top of the
diaphragm allowing the valve spring to close the ori-
fice.
When the system is started, the pressure on the bot-
tom of the diaphragm lowers rapidly, allowing the
orifice to open and metre atomized liquid coolant to
the evaporator where it begins to vaporize.
Suction from the compressor draws the vaporized
coolant out of the evaporator and back through a
gallery in the top of the valve which asses the tem-
perature sensor.
The temperature sensor reacts to variations in cool-
ant gas pressure returning from the evaporator.
When heat from the passenger compartment is
absorbed by the coolant the pressure of the gas
increases causing a differential pressure above and
below the temperature sensor diaphragm.
The diaphragm reacts to this pressure differential
and a push rod forces the ball in the expansion
valve orifice further off its seat.
This reaction allows an increase in the atomized
coolant to flow through the valve, to the evaporator,
so that more heat can be absorbed by the air condi-
tioning system.
Similarly when the temperature of the gas returning
from the evaporator decreases the pressure of the
gas decreases.
This causes the diaphragm to react accordingly and
allow the ball in the orifice to move closer towards its
seat thus reducing the flow of coolant through the
valve to the evaporator.
24 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

EVAPORATOR
The evaporator is located beneath the cab seat and
consists of a number of turns of continuous coils
mounted in a series of thin cooling fins to provide a
maximum of heat transfer in a minimum amount of
space.
Low temperature coolant in the evaporator absorbs
heat from the hotter air in the operator’s compart-
ment, thereby cooling the air.

An intake grille is located on the left side of the seat


base.
A portion of the air flow will recirculate through the
evaporator.

AIR FILTER
The blower fan draws warm air from outside the cab
through the intake filter (2) below the cab floor and a
ready cooled dehumidified air through the recircula-
tion grille (1).
The air passes over the evaporator then into the
cab through the six louvered diffusers.
Two diffusers are located on the front instrument
panel to direct air onto the windshield.
Two are located at the base of the rear posts to
direct air onto the rear window.
Two additional vents are located at the front and
rear of the seat base to direct air at the operator’s
feet.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 25

TROUBLESHOOTING AND TESTING


Overhaul of the air conditioning system should only PRELIMINARY CHECKS
be undertaken by a certified specialist refrigeration
Always conduct the preliminary fault finding checks
engineer using a comprehensive air conditioning
before performance testing the system.
test kit, including a gas leak detector, suitable for
HFC 134a coolant gas. Run the engine at 1000-1200 rpm for 10 minutes
with the air conditioner set to maximum cooling and
S WARNING S the blower at high speed.
Before dismantling an air conditioning system for Check that the heater temperature control is
repair the gas within the system must be dis- switched OFF.
charged and recovered using a certified recovery Check that the blower fan is operating at all
unit designed for the type of coolant gas used in the speeds.
system.
NEVER release coolant gas into the atmosphere. Check that the compressor clutch engages when
ALWAYS wear safety goggles and gloves when the temperature control switch is turned from OFF
servicing any part of the air conditioning system. to ON position. A clicking sound indicates the clutch
is engaging. If the clutch fails to operate it may indi-
To prevent the entry of any foreign material, it is cate an electric problem in the high low pressure
necessary to observe some precautions. cut out switches or malfunction of the electric drive
Ensure all tools, gauges, hoses and replacement clutch on the compressor.
parts are kept clean and dry and are suitable for the Check the engine cooling fan is drawing cool air
type of coolant gas used in the system. through the condenser.
Clean all hoses and fittings before disconnecting. Check the compressor drive belt tension.
Cap or plug all openings when disconnected. Check the condenser core and grid is clean and
When adding lubricating oil to the system always free of obstruction.
uncap and re-cap the oil container immediately Check the cab air filter is clean and free of obstruc-
before and after use. Always ensure the oil remains tion.
free of moisture.
Check the evaporator fins are not plugged or
excessively dirty.
26 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

1. Low side gauge 6. Test hose to low side service connector


2. High side gauge 7. Shut-off valve
3. Shut-off valve 8. Low pressure (suction) side service valve
4. Test hose to high side service connector 9. High pressure (discharge) side service valve
5. Centre hose (not used)

Performance testing the air conditioning sys- Operating precautions


tem
IMPORTANT: always ensure the shut-off valves
The manifold gauge set is the most important tool are closed (turn clockwise until seated) during all
used in testing and servicing the air conditioning test operations.
system. In the closed position, coolant circulates around the
valve stems to the gauges. Therefore, when the
NOTE: for Dealers who posses the latest design
manifold gauge set is connected into a system,
level of coolant recovery, recycling and recharging
pressure is registered on both gauges.
station, these gauges are an integral part of the
machine. - NEVER open the HIGH SIDE shut off valve when
the system is operating.
The following instructions for performance testing
the air conditioning system is based on the use of - ALWAYS open the LOW SIDE shut off valve
the gauge set shown. The principal of operation is when adding coolant.
however similar when testing the system using a
recovery and recharging station with integral
gauges.
When using this type of equipment always consult
the manufacturers operating instructions.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 27

Attaching the gauge set to the loader backhoe Re-check that both the high and low side shut off
valves on the manifold gauge set are fully closed.
S WARNING S Run the engine at 1000 ÷ 1200 rpm.
To avoid personal injury, stop the loader backhoe
Turn the heater temperature control OFF.
engine during connection of the manifold gauge set.
Operate the system at maximum cooling, with the
Check that the gauge set shut off valves are closed blower fan at high speed for 10 minutes to stabilize
(turned fully clockwise). all components.
Connect the high side gauge hose (normally red) to Check the manifold low pressure gauge reading
the high pressure (discharge) side service valve is within the specified range of approximately
and the low side gauge hose (normally blue) to the 0.28 ÷ 2.48 bar (4.06 ÷ 35.97 psi).
low pressure (suction) side service valve on the
loader backhoe. Ensure the hose connections are Check the manifold high pressure gauge reading
fully tightened. and compare the reading to the pressure indicated
on the pressure temperature chart below.
IMPORTANT: prior to connection of the manifold
Measure and compare the temperature of conditioned
gauge set, identify the suction (low pressure) and
air entering the cab through the louvered air diffusers
discharge (high pressure) service gauge ports. The
with the ambient air at the air intake filters on the out-
high pressure service valve is always in the line
side of the cab.
from the compressor to the condenser.
If the system is operating correctly the conditioned air
The high and low pressure service valves on the
entering the cab should be 6 - 9 °C (42.8 - 48.2 °F)
loader backhoe are spring loaded valve and will be
cooler than the ambient temperature of the outside
automatically opened when the test hose is con-
air.
nected.
If it is confirmed that the system is not operating
NOTE: the test hose must incorporate a valve
correctly refer to the fault diagnostic charts and per-
depressor to actuate this type of valve.
formance test gauge reading examples on the fol-
The service valves have a protective cap. This cap lowing pages for possible corrective action.
must be removed for test gauge connections and
replaced when service operations are completed. S WARNING S
Test procedure A significant amount of coolant vapour may have
After the manifold gauge set has been connected condensed to a liquid at the service fitting at the high
and before pressure tests can be made, the system side of the compressor. Use a cloth or other protec-
must be stabilized as follows: tive material when disconnecting the manifold hose
from this fitting to prevent personal injury to hands
Apply the parking brake, check the gearshift levers and face.
are in neutral and close the cab windows and
doors.

APPROXIMATE HIGH PRESSURE GAUGE READINGS

Ambient air temperature High pressure gauge reading


°C (°F) bar (psi)
27 (80.6) 10.0 / 11.6 (145 / 168)
29 (84.2) 11.2 / 12.7 (162 / 184)
32 (89.6) 12.3 / 13.8 (178 / 200)
35 (95) 13.3 / 15.2 (193 / 220)
38 (100.4) 14.5 / 16.7 (210 / 242)
41 (105.8) 16.0 / 18.3 (232 / 265)
43 (109.4) 17.3 / 20.0 (251 / 290)
28 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

PERFORMANCE TEST DIAGNOSIS


Pressure gauge values: Low pressure - Low
High pressure - Low

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Evaporator air not cold. Low coolant charge. Perform leak tests and repair.
Drain the system.
Charge system, re-test system.
Evaporator air warm. Very low coolant charge. Perform leak tests and repair.
Drain the system.
Charge system, re-test system.
Evaporator air cool but not Expansion valve not permitting Check expansion valve as follows:
sufficiently cold. sufficient flow. Set for maximum cooling.
Low pressure switch Stuck valve. Low pressure gauge should lower
cutting out. slowly.
Expansion valve to If expansion valve is defective:
evaporator tube shows
considerable condensation Discharge the system.
or frost. Replace the expansion valve.
Too cold to touch. Drain the system.
Charge the system.
Re-test.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 29

PERFORMANCE TEST DIAGNOSIS CHART


Pressure gauge values: Low pressure - High
High pressure - High

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Evaporator air warm. Improper operation of condenser. Inspect for dirty condenser restricting
Liquid line hot (condenser air flow and cooling.
outlet to expansion valve Check operation of condenser cooling
tube). fans. Repair or replace as needed.
High pressure switch Overcharged with coolant. Check for overcharge as follows:
cutting out.
Air in the system. Stop the engine. Recover and recycle
the charge using correct recovery
equipment.
Recharge the system with the correct
quantity of coolant, replacing any lost
lubricant. Recheck performance of air
conditioning system.
Evaporator air not cold. Expansion valve allowing too much Check expansion valve as follows:
coolant to flow through the evaporator.
Set for maximum cooling.
Low pressure gauge should lower
slowly.
If expansion valve is defective:
Discharge the system.
Replace the expansion valve.
Drain the system.
Charge the system.
Re-test.

PERFORMANCE TEST DIAGNOSIS CHART


Pressure gauge values: Low pressure - Low
High pressure - High

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Insufficient cooling. Restriction in liquid line. Discharge the system.
Replace receiver/drier.
Inspect all lines and tubing from
compressor outlet to expansion valve.
Replace if needed.
Drain the system.
Charge the system.
Re-test.
30 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

PERFORMANCE TEST DIAGNOSIS CHART


Pressure gauge values: Low pressure - High
High pressure - Low

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Evaporator air not cold. Internal leak in compressor (reed Discharge the system.
valves, gasket, worn or scored piston Replace the compressor.
rings or cylinder).
Drain the system.
Charge the system.
Re-test.

PERFORMANCE TEST DIAGNOSIS CHART


Pressure gauge values: Low pressure - Normal
High pressure - Normal

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Insufficient cooling. System low on charge. Air or Perform leak test.
Low pressure reading does moisture present in system. Discharge the system.
not fluctuate with changes in Repair leaks.
temperature control switch
Replace receiver/drier.
(pressure should lower until
compressor cycles). Check oil level.
Evaporator air not cold. Drain the system.
Charge the system.
Re-test.

PERFORMANCE TEST DIAGNOSIS CHART


Pressure gauge values: Low pressure - High
High pressure - Normal

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Compressor cycles ON and Defective temperature control Stop engine and shut off air
OFF too frequently. (thermostatic) switch. conditioning.
Replace temperature control switch.
Re-test system and check
compressor cycling.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 31

EXAMPLES OF MANIFOLD GAUGE READINGS AND INTERPRETATIONS


The following examples show typical low and high pressure gauge readings obtained when performance test-
ing the air conditioning system with an ambient temperature of 35 °C (95 °F).
The recommended corrective action is based on a similar fault as identified in the performance test diagnosis
charts.
Performance test example 1

1. High side low 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low-pressure side low
4. Not used

Problem Repair leaks. (Discharge and recover the coolant


from the system; replace lines or components).
Little or no cooling.
Check compressor oil to ensure no loss.
Cause
Drain the system.
Coolant slightly low.
Charge the system.
Conditions*
Performance test the system.
Too low pressure on low-pressure side.
Diagnostic
The gauge should read 1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi).
System coolant is low. May be caused by a small
leak.
Too low pressure on high-pressure side.
NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
The gauge should read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi). perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
Evaporator air not cold. For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
chart.
Corrective procedures
Leak test the system.
32 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Performance test example 2

1. High side low 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low-pressure side normal
4. Not used

Problem Corrective procedures


Insufficient cooling. Leak test the system.
Cause Discharge and recover the coolant from the sys-
tem.
Refrigerant excessively low.
Repair leaks.
Conditions*
Check compressor oil to ensure no loss.
Low side pressure very low.
Drain the system.
The gauge should read 1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi).
Charge the system.
Too low pressure on high-pressure side.
Performance test the system.
The gauge should read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi).
Diagnostic
Evaporator air warm.
System coolant is extremely low. A serious leak is
Low pressure switch cutting out.
indicated.
NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
chart.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 33

Performance test example 3

1. High side normal 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low-pressure side low
4. Not used

Problem Corrective procedures


Insufficient cooling. Leak test the system. Give special attention to the
compressor seal area.
Cause
Discharge and recover the coolant from the sys-
Air in the system.
tem.
Conditions*
Repair leaks.
Low side pressure reading does not change when
Replace receiver/drier.
compressor cycles ON and OFF.
Check compressor oil to ensure no loss.
High side pressure slightly high or slightly low. The
gauge should read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi). Drain the system.
Evaporator air not cold. Charge the system.
Performance test the system.
Diagnostic
Air or moisture in system. System not fully charged.
NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
chart.
34 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Performance test example 4

1. High side low 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low side high
4. Not used

Problem Corrective procedures


Insufficient cooling. Replace the compressor.
Cause Diagnostic
Compressor malfunction. Internal leak in compressor caused by worn or
scored pistons, rings, or cylinders.
Conditions*
Low side pressure too high. The gauge should read NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi). perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
Too low pressure on high-pressure side. The gauge ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
should read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi). chart.
Evaporator air not cold.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 35

Performance test example 5

1. High side high 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low side high
4. Not used

Problem At this point, operate the system and check its per-
formance.
Little or no cooling. Engine overheats in some
cases. If still unsatisfactory, proceed as follows:
Cause - discharge and recover the coolant from the sys-
tem;
Condenser not functioning properly.
- remove the condenser, clean and flush it to
Conditions* ensure a free flow of coolant. Otherwise, if the
Low side pressure too high. The gauge should read condenser appears to be particularly dirty or
1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi). obstructed, replace it;
High side pressure too high. The gauge should - replace the receiver/drier;
read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi). - drain the system and recharge it with the correct
Liquid line hot. quantity of coolant;
- carry out the performance test of the system.
Evaporator air warm.
Diagnostic
High pressure switch cutting out.
Lack of cooling caused by pressure that is too high
Corrective procedures on the high side, resulting from improper operation
Check belt. Loose or worn drive belts could cause of condenser. (Coolant charge may be normal or
excessive pressures in the compressor head. excessive).
Look for clogged passages between the condenser NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
fins and coil, or other obstructions that could reduce perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
condenser airflow. For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
If engine is overheating replace engine thermostat
chart.
and radiator pressure cap.
36 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Performance test example 6

1. High side normal 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low-pressure side normal
4. Not used

Problem Corrective procedures


Little or no cooling. Discharge and recover the coolant from the sys-
tem.
Cause
Replace receiver/drier.
Large amount of air in system.
Drain the system.
Conditions*
Charge the system.
Low side pressure too high. The gauge should read
1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi). Performance test the system.
Too low pressure on high-pressure side. The gauge Diagnostic
should read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi). Air in the system. Air and humidity contained in it
Evaporator air not cold. contaminate the system: therefore, it will operate
incorrectly.
NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
chart.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 37

Performance test example 7

1. High side high 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low side hide
4. Not used

Problem If the test indicates that the expansion valve is


defective, proceed as follows:
Little or no cooling.
- discharge and recover the coolant from the sys-
Cause
tem;
Improper operation of thermostatic expansion valve - replace the expansion valve;
(stuck open).
- drain the system;
Conditions*
- charge the system;
Low side pressure too high. The gauge should read - carry out the performance test of the system.
1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi).
Diagnostic
High side pressure too high. The gauge should
Thermostatic expansion valve is allowing too much
read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi).
coolant to flow through the evaporator coils. Valve
Evaporator air warm. may be stuck open.
Evaporator and suction hose (to compressor) sur- NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
faces show considerable moisture. perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
Corrective procedures For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
Check for sticking expansion valve as follows: chart.
- operate the system at maximum cooling;
- check the low-pressure side gauge. The pressure
should lower slowly.
38 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Performance test example 8

1. High side low 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low-pressure side low
4. Not used

Problem - operate the system at maximum cooling;


Insufficient cooling. - check the low-pressure side gauge. The pressure
should lower slowly.
Cause
If the previous procedure indicates that the expan-
Improper operation of thermostatic expansion valve sion valve is defective, proceed as follows:
(stuck open).
- discharge the system;
Conditions*
- replace the expansion valve;
Low side pressure too low (zero or vacuum). The - drain the system;
gauge should read 1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi).
- charge the system;
High side pressure low. The gauge should read - carry out the performance test of the system.
13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi).
Diagnostic
Evaporator air cool, but not sufficiently cold.
Expansion valve is not permitting a sufficient flow of
Evaporator inlet pipe surface shows considerable coolant. May be caused by valve stuck in restricted
moisture or frost. or closed position.
Low pressure switch cutting out. NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
Corrective procedures perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
Place finger on expansion valve to evaporator tube.
ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
If too cold to touch, proceed as follows:
chart.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 39

Performance test example 9

1. High side low 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low-pressure side low
4. Not used

Problem
Little or no cooling. If the test indicates that the expansion valve is
defective, proceed as follows:
Cause
- discharge and recover the coolant from the sys-
Restriction in high side of system.
tem;
Conditions* - replace the expansion valve;
Too low pressure on low-pressure side. The gauge - drain the system;
should read 1 ÷ 2 bar (14.5 ÷ 29 psi).
- charge the system;
Too low pressure on high-pressure side. The gauge - carry out the performance test of the system.
should read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 - 215 psi).
Diagnostic
NOTE: a normal or high reading of the high side
Thermostatic expansion valve is allowing too much
pressure gauge under these conditions indicates
coolant to flow through the evaporator coils. Valve
the system is overcharged or the condenser or
may be stuck open.
receiver/dryer is too small.
NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
Evaporator only slightly cool.
perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
Liquid line and receiver/dryer are cool to touch and For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
show frost or considerable moisture. ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
Corrective procedures chart.

Check for sticking expansion valve as follows:


- operate the system at maximum cooling;
- check the low-pressure side gauge. The pressure
should lower slowly.
40 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Performance test example 10

1. High side normal 5. Low side hose connected to low side service
2. High side hand valve closed connector
3. High side hose connected to high side service 6. Low side hand valve closed
connector 7. Low side gauge
4. Not used Compressor cycles on at 2.3 bar (33.36 psi)
Compressor cycles off at 1.9 bar (27.56 psi)

Problem Corrective procedures


Compressor cycles (cuts in and out) too rapidly. Stop engine and shut off air conditioning.
Cause Replace thermostatic switch with switch of same
type.
Thermostatic switch defective.
Make sure the switch’s temperature sensor is
Conditions*
installed in the same position and depth (in evapo-
Low-pressure side readings are too high during rator core) as previous.
both ON and OFF compressor cycles and between
Performance test the system.
cycles.
Diagnostic
Readings should be:
Defective thermostatic switch.
0.8 ÷ 1.0 bar (11.60 ÷ 14.50 psi) - OFF cycle
2.5 ÷ 2.7 bar (36.26 ÷ 39.16 psi) - ON cycle NOTE: * test procedure based upon ambient tem-
perature of 35 °C (95 °F).
1.7 ÷ 1.9 bar (24.65 ÷ 27.56 psi) - between cycles For proper high side gauge reading for other ambi-
The pressure on the high-pressure side is normal. The ent temperatures, refer to the pressure temperature
gauge should read 13.3 ÷ 14.8 bar (193 ÷ 215 psi). chart.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 41

LEAK TESTING, DISCHARGING AND CHARGING THE AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM


Leak testing
To perform a leak test if coolant leakage is sus-
pected, use a leak detector following the manufac-
turer’s instructions.
Leak detectors use light or sound dependent upon
the type used to alert the operator of a leak. If the
leak detector’s sensitivity is adjustable, be sure you
calibrate the detector according to the manufac-
turer’s instructions before use.
When using a leak detector, keep in mind that a
very slight amount of leakage in the compressor
pulley area is normal and does not necessarily indi-
cate a repair is required.
When a leak is located, follow these steps.
- Discharge the system using a certified coolant
recovery system.
- Repair the leak.
- Drain the system.
- Partially charge the system with 400 g (0.88 lb) of
coolant.
- Check system for leaks.
- Fully charge the system.
Always check the system for leaks as a final test
after evacuating and before recharging. Refer to
“Evacuating the system”.
Discharging the system
Legislation has been introduced banning the
release of coolant into the atmosphere.
Whenever overhauling the air conditioning system
or performing other tasks which require the air con-
ditioning system to be dismantled it is necessary to
discharge the coolant gas before commencing
repair.
Before you can dismantle an air conditioning sys-
tem for repairs, you must discharge and recover the
coolant using a certified recovery unit in accord-
ance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
Shown is a combined coolant recovery, evacuation
and recycling/charging station. This equipment
removes HFC 134a coolant from the air condition-
ing system, recycles and recharges all in one hook
up.
The unit is designed to be used with the manifold
gauge set built into the control panel.
42 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

1. Built in manifold gauge set 3. Low side (suction) service valve (blue hose)
2. Recovery/recharging unit 4. High side (discharge) service valve (red hose)

Other recovery systems are available where the ting and the blue (low side) hose to the low side
manifold gauges are not an integral part of the (suction) fitting.
machine. When this type of equipment is used a
NOTE: if a unit requiring the manifold gauge set is
separate manifold gauge set must be used.
being used, the low and high sides of the manifold
The following is a summary of the steps for dis- set are connected to the low and high sides of the
charging the system using a recovery/recycling loader backhoe air conditioning system. The hose
unit. from the recovery unit is then connected to the
manifold centre port.
S WARNING S To recover coolant, open both high and low side
Never discharge coolant gas into the atmosphere. valves on the control panel or the valves on the
Always wear safety goggles and gloves when work- manifold gauge set if being used.
ing with coolant. Only use authorized coolant tanks.
Open the valves labelled “gas” and “liquid” on the
IMPORTANT: always follow the manufactures recovery unit coolant tank.
instructions when operating recovery equipment. Plug in the unit’s power cord.
Run the vehicle’s air conditioning system for a few
minutes. Operate the recovery system in accordance with
the manufacturers instructions.
Set up the recovery unit following manufacturer’s
instructions. Ensure that the units red (high side) The compressor will shut off automatically when the
hose is connected to the high side (discharge) fit- recovery is complete.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 43

FLUSHING THE SYSTEM

1. High side gauge 5. Low side hose


2. High side shut-off valve 6. Low side shut-off valve
3. High side hose 7. Low side gauge
4. Centre service hose

Air conditioning systems may occasionally become


contaminated with solid particles. This contamina-
tion may be the result of allowing dirt to enter the
system while it was open, from aluminium corrosion
or sludge, or from disintegrated compressor reed
plates. Contamination of this nature can result in
plugged evaporators, condensers and expansion
valves.
Flush system with dry nitrogen.
Each individual component must be flushed after
disconnecting every hose fitting.
The compressor and expansion valve can not be
flushed, therefore, the compressor should be disas-
sembled and cleaned or replaced and the expan-
sion valve should be replaced. When flushing the
system always replace the receiver/drier.
44 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

NOTE: for flushing the air conditioning system,


never use any solvent other than the special flush-
ing solvent specifically produced for air conditioning
systems. Always follow the manufacturer’s recom-
mendations and directions for using the flushing
equipment and solvent.
Re-assemble and evacuate the system to remove
air and moisture as described in “Evacuating the
System”.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 45

DRAINING THE SYSTEM


IMPORTANT: a system in which coolant has been If a combined recovery/evacuation unit is to be
recovered to facilitate repairs must be drained used attach the unit to the air conditioning system
before new coolant is filled in. in accordance with the manufacturers instructions.
Air and moisture are removed by evacuating the Be sure to read all installation and operating
system using a vacuum pump. instructions carefully before starting the unit.
The automatic recycling, recharge and evacuation After starting the evacuation cycle, note the low
stations or evacuating and charging stations availa- side gauge to be sure the system pulls down into a
ble throughout the air conditioning industry incorpo- vacuum.
rate a vacuum pump within the assembly. If this
Time the evacuation for a minimum of 30 minutes
type of equipment is not available a separate vac-
from the point when lowest vacuum is attained.
uum pump and manifold gauge set must be used.
Thirty minutes later when the low side gauge
As the system is evacuated the boiling point of any attains the lowest steady vacuum, stop the evacua-
moisture within the system is similarly lowered. As tion process.
the vacuum increases the boiling reduces to below
that of the ambient temperate and the moisture is NOTE: the vacuum pump achieves ultimate vac-
subsequently boiled away. uum with the vented exhaust valve closed. Do not
evacuate too quickly as oil may be drawn from the
The relationship of system vacuum to the boiling
system.
temperature at which the water vapour is removed
from the system is as follows: Check the system by closing the gauge shut-off
valves, turning the vacuum pump off and noting the
low side gauge reading. A loss of more than 5 cm
System System Temperature
(1.97 in) of vacuum in 5 minutes indicates either a
vacuum vacuum
leak or moisture in the system.
In mercury Cm (in) of °C (°F)
If the gauge needle remains stationary and the vac-
mercury
uum is maintained for 3-5 minutes, close both the
28.0 71.0 (28.9) 38 (100.4) high and low side manifold hand valves, turn off
and disconnect the centre hose from the pump. The
28.9 73.4 (29.0) 27 (80.6)
system is now ready for charging.
29.4 74.6 (29.4) 16 (60.8) If a leak is detected, charge the system with
29.7 75.4 (29.7) 5 (41) approximately 400 g (0.88 lb) of coolant, see charg-
ing the system and locate the leak using a leak
29.8 75.7 (29.8) -7 (19.4) detector.
29.9 75.9 (29.9) -18 (-0.4) Once the leak is located discharge and recover the
coolant in the system, repair the leak, then repeat
the evacuation procedure.
NOTE: for every 305 m (1000 ft) above sea level,
the vacuum gauge reading must be corrected by
adding 2.54 cm (1 in) of mercury to compensate for
the change in atmospheric pressure.
IMPORTANT: be sure the system is completely dis-
charged as coolant will damage the vacuum pump.
If the manifold gauge set is being used connect the
low and high sides of the manifold to the low and
high sides of the vehicle air conditioning system as
described for discharging the system.
Connect the manifold centre hose to the vacuum
pump suction port as per the manufacturers
instructions.
Fully open both the low and high side gauge shut
off valves.
46 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

CHARGING THE SYSTEM


IMPORTANT: make sure that there are no leaks in If the coolant charge will not completely transfer to
the system and that the system has been fully the air conditioning system, recover and recharge
drained. Observe all safety recommendations when the system.
handling coolant HFC 134a, see “Precautions when Close the high and low side valves on the unit con-
Handling coolant HFC 134a” in this Section. trol panel, or on the gauge assy if being used, and
Ensure the charging unit is correctly connected to test the air conditioning as described in the para-
the loader backhoe air conditioning system in graph relevant to the performance test of the air
accordance with the manufacturers instructions. conditioning system.
If a charging unit, in conjunction with the manifold
NOTE: after charging a system use the following
gauge set is used, open the high and low side hand
start up procedure to ensure the lubricating oil is
valves on the manifold.
properly dispersed around the system.
Charge the system with 0.75 kg (1.65 lb) of coolant
- Ensure air conditioning is switched OFF.
as per the manufacturers instructions.
- Start the engine and bring speed down to idle.
If the charging rate becomes very slow close the
- Turn the air conditioning ON and allow system to
high side valve carefully, start the loader backhoe
operate for at least one minute before increasing
and set engine speed to idle. Turn ON the air condi-
engine speed.
tioning so that the compressor can pull the remain-
der of the coolant into the system.

1. Built in manifold gauge set 3. Low side (suction) service valve (blue hose)
2. Recovery/recharging unit 4. High side (discharge) service valve (red hose)
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 47

OVERHAUL

S WARNING S
Before disconnecting components in the air condi-
tioning system the coolant gas must be discharged
and recovered using a certified recovery system.
Refer to Discharging the system. Do Not discharge
the gas into the atmosphere.

If an air conditioning component is to be replaced


during a system overhaul it is necessary to drain
any coolant oil that has collected in the component
being replaced into a clean calibrated container.
A volume of clean coolant oil equivalent to that
removed from the replaced component must then
be added to the new item before being installed onto
the loader backhoe.
Upon completion of the repair evacuate, recharge,
leak test and performance test the system to ensure
correct operation.

EXPANSION VALVE
The expansion valve is not a serviceable item and
must be replaced if defective.
Fully discharge the air conditioning system.
Remove the seat to gain access to the valve.
To gain access to the expansion valve partially lift
the evaporator core from its position in the cab floor.
Remove the screw securing the inlet and outlet con-
nections to the valve and pull valve from tubing.
Replace the O-ring seals and lubricate with coolant
oil prior to installing the valve using disassembly
procedure in reverse.
Evacuate, leak test and recharge the system.
48 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

EVAPORATOR
Discharge and recover coolant gas using certified
recovery systems.
Remove the seat and cover plate to reveal evapora-
tor assembly (1).
Remove temperature cycling control thermocouple.
Disconnect tubing to expansion valve.
Remove evaporator.
Check the evaporator assembly fins for damage.
Straighten fins if necessary.
Clean the evaporator core of all foreign material to
be sure it is free of obstructions.
Check the evaporator assembly for indications of
coolant leakage. If damage or leaks are evident,
replace the evaporator core.
If a new evaporator is to be installed drain the cool-
ant oil in the evaporator into a clean calibrated con-
tainer.
Measure the quantity of oil obtained and add the
same quantity of new coolant oil directly into the
replacement evaporator core.
Install evaporator using disassembly procedure in
reverse.
Evacuate, leak test and recharge the system.

ADJUSTING SENSOR OF AIR CONDITIONER


TEMPERATURE
Remove the seat mounting plate.
The temperature adjusting sensor (2) is mounted to
the side of the blower motor assembly.
Carefully pull and disconnect the switch wiring at the
connector.
Remove temperature control switch and replace as
required.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 49

LOW-PRESSURE CUT-OUT SENSOR


With the engine OFF check continuity across the
switch contacts.
If the sensor (1) indicates an open circuit, replace it
as described below.
IMPORTANT: the sensor cannot be replaced with-
out discharging the system.
Remove the sensor by unscrewing it from the valve.
Replace with new switch and connect to harness.

BLOWER MOTOR ASSEMBLY


The blower motor (2) can if required be removed
without discharging the system as follows:
Remove the cab seat mounting plate.
NOTE: take care not to damage hoses during this
operation. If the cab heater hoses restrict move-
ment of the housing drain the heater assembly and
disconnect the hoses.
Disconnect the motor wiring connector block.
Remove the remaining motor securing screws and
withdraw motor.
Re-assembly follows the disassembly procedure in
reverse.

RECEIVER DRYER
The receiver/dryer (1) cannot be overhauled and
must be replaced as an assembly. The receiver/
dryer assembly should be replaced if it is suspected
that moisture is in the system.
The receiver dryer must also be replaced if the sys-
tem has been discharged and the air conditioning
joints disconnected.
Discharge and reclaim coolant gas using certified
recovery systems.
Disconnect the hoses and switch and remove the
dryer from the loader backhoe.
Drain the coolant oil from the receiver dryer into a
clean calibrated container. Measure the quantity of
oil obtained and add the same quantity of new cool-
ant oil directly into the new item.
Cap and plug all fittings to prevent any dirt entering
the system.
Install a new receiver dryer.
50 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

CONDENSER
Loosen and remove the fixing screws (2). Remove
the front grill (1).

Unscrew and remove the nut (3). Remove the horn


(4). Unscrew and remove the nut (5). Remove the
fuel cooler (6).

Unscrew and remove the fixing upper nut (7) and


loosen the fixing lower nut. Move the dryer filter (8)
to the right side.

Unscrew and remove the nuts (9).


SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 51

Move the condenser (10) forward.


Clean the condenser (10) by compressor air.

AIR FILTER
Before servicing the filter (1), switch off the blower
and close all windows and one door.
Slam the final door closed and the resulting back
pressure will dislodge most of the loose dirt from the
underside of the filter.
Remove the filter (1) and clean it by blowing with
compressed air not exceeding 2 bar (29 psi).
IMPORTANT: make sure you protect your face
before using compressed air.
Blow the dust from the upper surface through the
element to the lower surface. Hold the nozzle at
least 300 mm (11.8 in) from the element to prevent
damage to the paper pleats.
Clean both filter chambers with a damp, lint free
cloth.
Replace the filter element with the rubber seal
uppermost and re-install the covers.
52 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

COMPRESSOR

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Basic compressor specifications
Displacement ......................................................................................................................... 155 cm3 (9.46 in3)
Weight ............................................................................................................................................ 9.9 kg (22 lb)
Oil type ....................................................................................................................................................... SP20
Rotation.............................................................................................................................. CW (Clockwise only)
Compressor clutch and pulley air gap............................................................... 0.9 ÷ 0.8 mm (0.035 ÷ 0.031 in)
Belt tension
Measure at the widest gap ...... 10 mm (0.40 in) deflection with 1 kg (2.2 lb) force applied midway between the pulleys
Speed rating
Constant............................................................................................................................................... 6000 rpm
Downshift ............................................................................................................................................. 8000 rpm
Tightening torque
M8 armature retaining nut .....................................................................................17.7 ± 2.9 Nm (13 ± 2.1 lbf·ft)
M6 cylinder head screws.......................................................................................13.7 ± 2.9 Nm (10 ± 2.1 lbf·ft)
M8 cylinder head screws....................................................................................34.3 ± 4.9 Nm (25.3 ± 3.6 lbf·ft)
Clutch dust cover screw ...............................................................................................9 ± 2 Nm (6.6 ± 1.5 lbf·ft)
Oil filler plug .......................................................................................................19.6 ± 4.9 Nm (14.5 ± 3.6 lbf·ft)
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 53

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION

REMOVAL
Discharge the air conditioning system. Disconnect
the wiring harness of the compressor (12) from the
wiring harness of the engine.
Disconnect tubing to compressor.
Remove the washer (7) and the screw (1).
Remove the protective guard (13). Remove the
screw (11).

Remove the nut (14) and the screw (9).


54 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Remove the washers (5), the nut (6), the screw (2)
and the block (8).
Remove the screw (1), the washers (3) and the belt
tensioner (4).
Remove the screw (10), the washers (2) and the
compressor (12).

INSTALLATION
To install, follow the removal procedure in reverse
order.
Torque the fastening screws to 40 ÷ 51 Nm
(29 ÷ 38 lbf·ft).
NOTE: it is recommended that a new receiver/drier
assembly is installed after any system component
replacement or any repair that requires entry into
the system.
Drain the oil from the new compressor to be fitted
into a clean container, or if the old compressor is to
be refitted, obtain a new can of coolant oil.
Calculate the amount of oil to be installed and refill
the compressor.
Reconnect the hoses to the compressor and tighten
all screws and hoses.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 55

BELT ADJUSTMENT
The compressor drive belt (1) can be tensioned by
rotating the idler arm (2).
Slacken the idler arm screw and adjust the arm to a
belt deflection of 16 mm (0.63 in).
Once adjusted re-torque the tension arm screw to
33.9 Nm (25 lbf·ft).

OVERHAUL
Before any internal repair is done, drain the oil from
the compressor:
Remove the oil plug and drain as much oil as possi-
ble into a suitable container.
Remove the caps (if present) from suction and dis-
charge ports.
Drain oil from the section and discharge ports into
suitable container while turning the shaft clockwise
only with a socket wrench on the armature retaining
nut.

Measure and record the amount of oil discharged.


Inspect the oil for signs of contamination such as
discoloration of foreign material.
56 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


CLUTCH

1. Screw 6. Cover
2. Dust cover 7. Snap ring
3. Nut 8. Rotor
4. Plate 9. Snap ring
5. Shims 10. Coil

Disassembly
All clutch servicing should be done with the com-
pressor removed from the vehicle. Support the
compressor. If using a vice, do not hold on to the
housing.
If a dust cover (2) is present, remove the 3 or 6
screws (1) holding it in place and remove the cover.
If auxiliary sheet metal pulley is present, remove the
screws holding it in place.
Then remove pulley.
Attach the tool to the cover in front of the clutch disc
and remove the nut (3) using a wrench.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 57

Using the front plate tool and a prybar, hold the


clutch plate stationary.
Place the screw into the tool and by tightening the
screw onto the end of the shaft the front plate will be
extracted from the shaft.
If shims (5) are above shaft key, remove them now.
If shims (5) are below shaft key, the key and bearing
dust cover (if present) must be removed before
shims can be removed.
Remove dust cover (6) (if present). Use caution to
prevent distorting cover when removing it.
Remove shaft key by tapping loose with a flat blade
screwdriver and hammer.
Remove shims (5).
Use a pointed tool and a small screwdriver to pre-
vent the shims from binding on the shaft.
Remove the snap ring (7), remove the shaft key and
lift the pulley assembly from the compressor.

Check the rotor assembly (8) for wear and replace


the assembly as necessary.
58 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Remove the field coil wire retaining clip.

Remove the snap ring (9) of the coil.

Lift the coil (10) from the housing and replace as


required.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 59

Assembly
Install the coil (10), making sure that the wire is
located behind the clip on the outside of the body
and that the snap ring (9) is located in the groove.

Position the rotor (8) on the housing hub and care-


fully slide the rotor (8) down the shaft.

Install the snap ring (7).

Reposition the plate (4) and the retaining nut (3).


Tighten the nut to the prescribed torque of 18 Nm
(13 lbf·ft).
60 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Check the clearance between the plate (4) and


the rotor (8). This should be consistent around
the circumference and be between 0.4 ÷ 0.8 mm
(0.015 ÷ 0.031 in).
NOTE: if the air gap is not consistent, lightly pry up
on the counter weighted front plate at the low spots
or lightly tap down at the high spots.

If the clearance is not within specification, the shims


(5) under the front plate should be added or
removed, until the correct clearance is obtained.
NOTE: new shims are available in the following
sizes: 1.00, 0.50 and 0.13 mm (0.04, 0.02 and
0.005 in).

Reposition the dust cover (2), if present, and torque


the 3 or 6 screws (1).
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 61

COMPRESSOR

1. Shaft key 6. Gasket


2. Ring 7. Plate
3. Snap ring 8. Head gasket
4. Gasket 9. Cylinder head
5. Plug 10. Screw

Disassembly
Remove the armature plate, as detailed in the steps
of clutch disassembly.
Remove the shaft key (1) and the ring (2) to expose
the snap ring (3).
Remove the snap ring (3).

Insert the seal (A) remover/installer tool.


Turn the tool to engage the slots in the seal.
Pull up to remove and discard the seal (4).
62 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Assembly
Thoroughly clean the seal cavity in the hub.
Use “lint free” cloth only.
Ensure the new shaft seal O-ring is installed onto
the seal assembly.
Dip the new seal assembly in clean coolant oil and
attach to the seal remover/installer tool.

Completely insert the new seal (4).


NOTE: if remover/installer tool (A) is not available,
position the seal squarely in the hub and tap gently
until fully seated.

Install the snap ring (3).


If the snap ring has a bevelled edge, this should
face outwards.

Install the new ring (2) and push into position.


SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 63

Position the shims over the shaft and refit the shaft
key.
Reinstall the plate as described in clutch reassem-
bly.

CYLINDER HEAD
Disassembly
Drain the coolant oil from the compressor into a
clean graduated container.
Measure and record the quantity of oil obtained.
This information is required during installation of the
new or overhauled unit.
Remove the six cylinder head screws (10) and
using a hide mallet, gently tap the cylinder head (9)
free.
The use of a gasket scraper may also be required
to free the cylinder head from the compressor body.

If the plate (7) and/or cylinder head are to be


reused, carefully remove the gasket (8) using a suit-
able scraper.
64 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

Gently pry the plate (7) free from the cylinder block
and remove the gasket (6).
Inspect the plate (7) for damage.

Assembly
Coat the top of the valve plate with clean coolant oil
and reassemble the cylinder head following the
removal procedure in reverse order.
When installing the gaskets and valve plate ensure
they are correctly positioned over the locating pins
in the cylinder block.
Install the cylinder head screws and tighten using
the sequence shown.
Torque initially to 20 Nm (15 lbf·ft).
When the overhaul is complete add to the compres-
sor a volume of oil equivalent to that drained prior to
disassembly, or as the reclaim measured fill.
SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING 65

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Unusually high suction Valve plate test. Replace or repair:
pressure with unusually low Broken head or block gasket.
discharge pressure.
Broken or deformed reed valve.
Foreign substance under reed valve
or gasket.
Unusually low suction and Check for low coolant charge. Replace or repair:
discharge pressure. Shaft seal leak.
Compressor leak check. Cylinder head leak.
Gasket leak.
Leak check and diagnostic system. Oil filler plug leak.
Cracked cylinder block.
Front housing O-ring leak.
Intermittent or inoperative. Check belt tension. Replace.
Check clutch air gap. Adjust air gap.
Check clutch volts, amps, coil lead Replace or repair:
wire. Broken lead wire.
Internal clutch coil defect.
System ground (see system
manual).
Difficult start. Shaft turning smoothness test. Internal compressor failure.
Clutch engaged. Check compressor mounting Replace or repair.
components.
Check engine components. Replace or repair.
Check for intermittent or slipping Adjust air gap - defective coil.
clutch.
Check for proper coolant charge. Recharge and recheck.
Check clutch bearing. Replace rotor / armature assembly.
Oil level procedure. Fill to proper level.
Shaft turning smoothness test. Internal compressor failure.
Remove valve plate and inspect. Replace or repair:
Broken discharge valve reed or
retainer.
Broken suction valve reed.
Broken gasket.
“Chattering” disengaged Check air gap. Replace or repair:
clutch. Adjust air gap.
Defective clutch pulley or front plate.
66 SECTION 50 - CAB HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING

NOTES:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS .................................................................................................................................... 3


ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE ROPS (B90B) ...................................................................... 3
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE CAB (B90B) ....................................................................... 19
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE CAB
(B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC) ........................................................................................... 36
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHIFT CAB (B110B - B110BTC) ........................................................ 52
ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - 4WS POWERSHIFT CAB (B115B) .................................................................. 70

CONTROLS AND INSTRUMENTS ................................................................................................................ 88


FRONT INSTRUMENT PANEL ................................................................................................................. 88
SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER PANEL (B90B) ....................................................................................... 91
SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER PANEL (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B).................... 93
SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (B90B) .................................................................................................... 95
SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B) ................................ 97
ANTI-START SYSTEM .............................................................................................................................. 99

DIAGNOSTIC DISPLAY (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)................................................ 100


SYMBOLS................................................................................................................................................ 102
SETUP MENU ......................................................................................................................................... 103
PROCEDURE ABOUT SELF TEST ........................................................................................................ 104
ON BOARD ERROR CODE RETRIEVAL ............................................................................................... 105
BACKLIGHTING AND DIMMING............................................................................................................. 106
WORK HOURS........................................................................................................................................ 107
OPERATION............................................................................................................................................ 108
WARNING SYSTEM................................................................................................................................ 112
MAINTENANCE....................................................................................................................................... 113
WARNING MESSAGES .......................................................................................................................... 114

STARTING SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................... 121


OPERATION............................................................................................................................................ 121
STARTER MOTOR.................................................................................................................................. 124
2 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................. 129

ALTERNATOR .............................................................................................................................................. 131


TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 131
OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................ 131
COMPONENTS ....................................................................................................................................... 133
REMOVAL................................................................................................................................................ 134
PRELIMINARY CHECKS AND TESTS.................................................................................................... 135
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................................................................................................. 144

BATTERY...................................................................................................................................................... 145
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................................................. 145
OPERATION ............................................................................................................................................ 145
REPLACEMENT ...................................................................................................................................... 146
CHARGE AND ELECTROLYTE LEVEL CHECK .................................................................................... 147
CONNECTING A BOOSTER BATTERY ................................................................................................. 148
BATTERY MASTER SWITCH ................................................................................................................. 148

TROUBLESHOOTING .................................................................................................................................. 149


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 3

ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS

ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE ROPS (B90B)


FUSES AND RELAYS
K5 Low and main beam relay
Fuse
Rating Function
No. K6 Inner front work light relay
F1A K7 Inner rear work light relay
Engine stop, (+15) anti-theft device, “grid K8 Outer front work light relay
F1B 7.5 A
heater”
K9 Outer rear work light relay
F1C 10 A Stop light switch
K10 Reverse travel relay
Instrument power supply, switch control
F2A 15 A K11 Forward travel relay
lamps, pneumo-electric seat, buzzer

F2B K12 Hazard warning lights

F2C 15 A Pilot control

Rear right/front left side light, instrument


F3A 3A
backlighting

Rear left/front right side lights, number


F3B 3A
plate light

Front work light switch, ride control, 4x1


F3C 10 A
bucket

Forward travel, reverse travel, reverse


F4A 5A
travel alarm, gearshift control

Rear hammer button, sensor + bucket


F4B 10 A level solenoid valve, clutch disconnecting
buttons and differential lock

Backhoe attachment lock, backhoe


F4C 10 A attachment travel lock, rear work light
switch

F5A 15 A Inner front work lights

F5B 10 A Low beams


F5C 15 A Main beams

F6A 7.5 A Rotating beacon

F6B 7.5 A (+15) hazard warning light power supply


F6C 7.5 A Hand hammer, 4WD

(+30) power supply for hazard warning


F7A 10 A
lights, horn
F7B

F7C

F8A 15 A Outer rear work lights

F8B 15 A Outer front work lights


F8C 15 A Inner rear work lights

K1 Forward-reverse travel control relay

K2 Gear engaged alarm + parking brake activated relay

K3 Starting relay

K4 Bucket level solenoid valve relay


4 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

COMPONENTS

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION

A17 Antitheft unit EV12 4x1 bucket proportional solenoid valves


(optional)
B4 Air filter blocked switch
F208 Air conditioning fuse 10 A
B5 Fuel level sensor
F212 General fuse 80 A
B19 Reverse travel alarm
G1 Battery
B21 Pneumo-electric seat (optional)
G67 Alternator
B26 Bucket sensor
H217 Backhoe attachment lock warning light
B33 Engine rpm sensor (optional)
B66 Transmission oil high temperature switch HA2 Horn
B68 Engine water high temperature switch K209 Air conditioning relay
B69 Air conditioning pressure switch K211 Starting relay
B70 Engine water temperature sender K224 Differential lock relay
B73 Engine oil low pressure switch K226 4WD relay
B134 Stop light sensor K230 Hand hammer relay
B135 Stop light sensor KC Fuse and relay control unit
B218 Seat microswitch M64 Air conditioning motor
B219 Parking brake pressure switch M207 Starter motor
E2 Front left light P22 Side instrument
E3 Front right light P125 Front instrument cluster
E15 Rotating beacon S36 Rear hammer button
E16 Rotating beacon S47 Battery master switch
E17 Current intake S71 Starting panel
E38 Rear right work light S120 Warning switch
E40 Rear right work light (optional) S122 4WD switch (optional)
E44 Front right work light S123 Hand hammer switch (optional)
E45 Front right work light (optional) S126 Lights switch
E46 Rear left work light (optional) S127 Rotating beacon switch
E47 Rear left work light S130 Light-windshield wiper control lever
E50 Front left work light (optional) S132 Gearshift lever
E51 Front left work light S201 Ride control switch (optional)
E215 Rear left light S202 Front work light switch
E216 Number plate light S203 Rear work light switch
E214 Rear right light S204 Backhoe attachment travel lock switch
(optional)
S205 Backhoe attachment lock switch (optional)
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 5

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


S206 Rear windshield wiper and washer switch X14 General line - side instrument cluster line
(not used) interface connector
S222 Differential lock switch X15 General line - side instrument cluster line
interface connector
S205A Clutch disconnect button
X16 General line - side instrument cluster line
S260 Clutch disconnect button interface connector
ST3 4x1 bucket control lever X17 Antitheft connector
Y3 Fuel shut off solenoid valve X19 Reverse travel alarm connector
Y6 Forward travel solenoid valve X21 Seat connector (optional)
Y7 Reverse travel solenoid valve X22 Side panel connector
Y8 4WD solenoid valve (optional) X26 Bucket sensor connector
Y32 Backhoe hammer control valve (optional) X32 Backhoe attachment hammer connector
Y34 Ride control solenoid valve (optional) X33 Engine rpm sensor connector
Y35 Hand hammer control valve (optional) X34 Ride control connector
Y74 Differential lock solenoid valve X35 Hand hammer connector
Y202 Backhoe attachment travel solenoid valve X36 Backhoe attachment hammer button
Y203 Backhoe attachment lock solenoid valve connector
(optional) X38 Work light connector
Y206 Bucket level solenoid valve X40 Work light connector
X44 Work light connector

CONNECTORS X45 Work light connector


X46 Work light connector
NAME DESCRIPTION
X47 Work light connector
X1 General line - engine line interface
connector X50 Work light connector
X2 Grid heater connector (optional) X51 Work light connector
X3 Fuel pump shut-off connector X64 Air conditioning compressor connector
X4 Air filter pressure switch connector X68 Engine water high temperature switch
connector
X5 Fuel level sensor connector
X69 Air conditioning pressure switch connector
X6 Forward travel solenoid valve connector
X71 Starting panel connector
X7 Reverse travel solenoid valve connector
X72 Pilot line connector
X8 4WD solenoid valve connector
X73 Engine oil pressure switch connector
X9 General line - front instrument panel line
interface connector X74 Differential lock solenoid valve connector
X10 General line - solenoid valve line interface X80 Rotating beacon connector
connector
X81 Rotating beacon connector
X82 Control unit 10-way connector
6 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


X83 Relay 2-way connector XC4 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X121 Left light line / horn interface connector
XC5 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X124 Quick coupler connector
connector
X125 Front instrument connector
XC6 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X128 Optional connector connector
X130 Light / windshield wiper control lever XX Diode bridge connector
connector
X132 Gearshift lever connector
X151 Right light line interface connector
X140 Diode bridge connector
X201 Accelerator knob connector
X202 Backhoe attachment travel connector
X203 Backhoe attachment lock connector
X204 Horn button connector
X205 Clutch disengage button connector
X206 Bucket levelling connector
X207 Delivery doubling connector
X208 Quick coupler connector
X210 Diode connector
X211 Parking brake pressure switch connector
X212 Parking brake solenoid valve connector
X214 Right rear light connector
X215 Left rear light connector
X216 Number plate light connector
X222 Differential lock button connector
X260 Clutch disengage button connector
XC1 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
XC2 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
XC3 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 7

ENGINE LINE DIAGRAM


8 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SOLENOID VALVE LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 9
10 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 11

REAR LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


12 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 13

DIRECTION INDICATOR AND ROTATING BEACON LINE DIAGRAM


14 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

PNEUMO-ELECTRIC SEAT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 15

COLD START DIAGRAM


16 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

FRONT INSTRUMENT

REF. PIN FUNCTION SIGNAL


+12 J1 Positive (+12 V)
GND J2 Ground - Negative
S1 J3 Speedometer Sensor
L4 J4 Main beam lamp Positive
(blue)
L3 J5 Side light lamp (green) Positive
+ILL J6 Backlighting (+) + Light
L8 J7 Not used
L7 J8 Not used
L6 J9 Not used
L5 J10 Not used
L1 J11 Direction lamp (green) Positive
L2 J12 Not used
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 17

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

INSTRUMENT INPUT READING TOLERANCE INPUT CALIBRATION


TOLERANCE DIRECTION
0 Hz 0 rpm ±3° N/A Descending
Speedometer 307 Hz 1000 rpm N/A ± 60 rpm Ascending
736 Hz 2400 rpm N/A ± 60 rpm Ascending
240 Ohm Empty +0/-6° 230-240 Ohm Descending
Level fuel 102 Ohm 1/2 Tank ±3° 98 ÷ 108 Ohm Descending
33 Ohm Full +4/-2° 33 ÷ 42 Ohm Ascending
900 Ohm Point B +0/-6° N/A Descending
Transmission
temperature 106 °C (223 °F)
114 Ohm ±5° 111 ÷ 117 Ohm Ascending
(Red/green line)
700 Ohm Point A +0/-5° N/A Descending
Coolant
temperature 106 °C (Red/green
95 Ohm ±3° 93 ÷ 97 Ohm Ascending
line)
11 V Red/green left line ±3° 10.7 ÷ 11.3 V Descending
Battery charge
15.9 V Red/green right line ±5° 15.0 ÷ 15.6 V Ascending

INDICATOR READING RESISTANCE


Low fuel (lamp) 1/10 Tank 180 ÷ 200
Clutch disconnect temperature (alarm) 152 °C (306 °F) 70 ÷ 83
18 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

PIN NAME FUNCTION


1 Ignition 10 V - 16 V INPUT
2 Low oil pressure Low side switch input
3 Air filter restriction Low side switch input
4 Parking brake Low side switch input
5 Alternator/battery Alternator D+ input
6 Not used
7 Not used
8 Neutral High side switch input
9 Seat switch Low side switch input
10 Air conditioning system pressure High side switch input
11 Not used
12 Driving lights High side switch input
13 Not used
14 Not used
15 Engine pre-heat High side switch input
16 Not used
17 Not used High side switch input
18 Not used
19 Speedometer Alternator w input
20 Level fuel
21 Water temperature
22 Transmission temperature
23 Not used
24 Not used
25 Not used
26 Not used
27 Not used
28 Not used
29 Not used
30 Not used
31 Not used
32 Not used
33 Not used
34 Not used
35 Horn
36 Grounding Grounding
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 19

ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE CAB (B90B)


FUSES AND RELAYS
K1 Forward-reverse travel control relay

Fuse K2 Gear engaged + parking brake activated relay


Rating Function
No.
K3 Starting relay
F1A 15 A Rear windshield wiper and washer
K4 Bucket level solenoid valve relay
Engine stop, (+15) anti-theft device, “grid
F1B 7.5 A K5 Low and main beam relay
heater”
K6 Inner front work light relay
F1C 10 A Stop light switch
K7 Inner rear work light relay
Instrument power supply, switch control
F2A 15 A
lamps, pneumo-electric seat, buzzer K8 Outer front work light relay
F2B 15 A Air conditioning K9 Outer rear work light relay
F2C 15 A Pilot control K10 Reverse travel relay
Rear right/front left-side lights, instrument K11 Forward travel relay
F3A 3A
backlighting, air conditioning switch
K12 Hazard warning lights
Rear left/front right side lights, number
F3B 3A
plate light

Front work light switch, ride control, 4x1


F3C 10 A
bucket

Forward travel, reverse travel, reverse


F4A 5A
travel alarm, gearshift control

Rear hammer button, sensor + bucket


F4B 10 A level solenoid valve, clutch disconnecting
buttons and differential lock

Backhoe attachment lock, backhoe


F4C 10 A attachment travel lock, rear work light
switch

F5A 15 A Inner front work lights

F5B 10 A Low beams


F5C 15 A Main beams

F6A 7.5 A Rotating beacon

F6B 7.5 A (+15) hazard warning light power supply


F6C 7.5 A Hand hammer, 4WD

(+30) power supply for hazard warning


F7A 10 A
lights, horn
F7B 10 A Electric socket, radio, cab lighting

F7C 6A Front windshield wiper

F8A 15 A Outer rear work lights

F8B 15 A Outer front work lights


F8C 15 A Inner rear work lights
20 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

COMPONENTS

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION

A17 Antitheft unit E46 Rear left work light (optional)

A53 Radio (optional) E47 Rear left work light

A131 Flasher control unit E50 Front left work light (optional)

B4 Air filter blocked switch E51 Front left work light

B5 Fuel level sensor E121 Front left light

B19 Reverse travel alarm E122 Front right light

B21 Pneumo-electric seat (optional) E215 Rear left light

B26 Bucket sensor E216 Number plate light

B33 Engine rpm sensor E214 Rear right light

B34 Stop light sensor EV12 4x1 bucket proportional solenoid valves
(optional)
B35 Stop light sensor
F208 Air conditioning fuse 10 A
B66 Transmission oil high temperature switch
F212 General fuse 80 A
B68 Engine water high temperature switch
G1 Battery
B69 Air conditioning pressure switch
G67 Alternator
B70 Engine water temperature sender
H217 Backhoe attachment lock warning light
B73 Engine oil low pressure switch (optional)
B134 Stop light sensor HA2 Horn
B135 Stop light sensor K209 Air conditioning relay
B211 Parking brake pressure switch K211 Starting relay
B218 Seat microswitch K224 Differential lock relay
B219 Parking brake pressure switch K225 Parking brake relay
BS1 Right speaker (optional) K226 4WD relay
BS2 Left speaker (optional) K227 Transmission disconnect relay with parking
E2 Front left light brake engaged

E3 Front right light K230 Hand supply relay

E15 Rotating beacon KC Fuse and relay control unit

E16 Rotating beacon M4 Rear windshield wiper motor

E17 Current intake M5 Front windshield wiper motor

E18 Cab lighting M7 Front windshield washer pump

E38 Rear right work light M9 Optional blower motor

E40 Rear right work light (optional) M64 Air conditioning motor

E44 Front right work light M207 Starter motor

E45 Front right work light (optional) P22 Side instrument


P125 Front instrument cluster
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 21

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


S36 Rear hammer button Y207 Double delivery solenoid valve (optional)
S47 Battery master switch Y212 Parking brake solenoid valve
S71 Starting panel CONNECTORS
S120 Warning switch
NAME DESCRIPTION
S122 4WD switch (optional)
X1 General line - engine line interface
S123 Hand hammer switch (optional) connector
S126 Lights switch X2 Optional grid heater connector
S127 Rotating beacon switch X3 Fuel pump shut-off connector
S130 Light-windshield wiper control lever X4 Air filter pressure switch connector
S132 Gearshift lever X5 Fuel level sensor connector
S201 Ride control switch (optional) X6 Forward travel solenoid valve connector
S202 Front work light switch X7 Reverse travel solenoid valve connector
S203 Rear work light switch X8 4WD solenoid valve connector
S204 Backhoe attachment travel lock switch X9 General line - front instrument panel line
(optional) interface connector
S205 Backhoe attachment lock switch (optional) X10 General line - solenoid valve line interface
connector
S206 Rear windshield wiper-washer switch
X12 General line - upper cab line interface
S222 Differential lock switch
connector
S260 Clutch disconnect button
X14 General line - side instrument cluster line
S205A Clutch disconnect button interface connector

ST3 4x1 bucket control lever X15 General line - side instrument cluster line
interface connector
X55 Current intake
X16 General line - side instrument cluster line
Y3 Fuel shut off solenoid valve interface connector
Y6 Forward travel solenoid valve X17 Antitheft connector
Y7 Reverse travel solenoid valve X19 Reverse travel alarm connector
Y8 4WD solenoid valve (optional) X21 Seat connector (optional)
Y32 Backhoe hammer control valve (optional) X22 Side panel connector
Y34 Ride control solenoid valve (optional) X26 Bucket sensor connector
Y35 Hand hammer control valve (optional) X32 Backhoe attachment hammer connector
Y74 Differential lock solenoid valve X33 Engine rpm sensor connector
Y202 Backhoe attachment travel solenoid valve X34 Ride control connector
Y203 Backhoe attachment lock solenoid valve X35 Hand hammer connector
(optional)
X36 Backhoe attachment hammer button
Y206 Bucket level solenoid valve connector
22 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


X38 Work light connector X128 Optional connector
X39 Rear windshield wiper connector X130 Light / windshield wiper control lever
connector
X40 Work light connector
X131 Flasher control unit connector
X41 Optional blower connector
X132 Gearshift lever connector
X43 Rotating beacon connector
X133 Right light line interface connector
X44 Work light connector
X140 Diode bridge connector
X45 Work light connector
X201 Accelerator knob connector
X46 Work light connector
X202 Backhoe attachment travel connector
X47 Work light connector
X203 Backhoe attachment lock connector
X49 Front windshield wiper connector
X204 Horn button connector
X50 Work light connector
X205 Clutch disengage button connector
X51 Work light connector
X206 Bucket levelling connector
X53 Radio connector (brown)
X207 Delivery doubling connector
X54 Radio connector (black)
X208 Quick coupler connector
X55 Current intake
X210 Diode connector
X56 Front windshield washer connector
X211 Parking brake pressure switch connector
X57 Rear windshield washer connector
X212 Parking brake solenoid valve connector
X64 Air conditioning compressor connector
X214 Right rear light connector
X67 Alternator connector
X215 Left rear light connector
X68 Engine water high temperature switch
connector X216 Quick coupler connector
X69 Air conditioning pressure switch connector X218 Seat safety microconnector
X71 Starting panel connector X220 Air conditioning connector
X72 Pilot line connector X222 Differential lock button connector
X73 Engine oil pressure switch connector X260 Clutch disengage button connector
X74 Differential lock solenoid valve connector XC1 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X80 Rotating beacon connector
XC2 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X81 Rotating beacon connector connector
X82 Control unit 10-way connector XC3 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X83 Relay 2-way connector connector

X110 Air conditioning connector XC4 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X111 Air conditioning connector
XC5 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X121 Left light line / horn interface connector connector
X124 Quick coupler connector XC6 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X125 Front instrument connector
XX Diode bridge connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 23

ENGINE LINE DIAGRAM


24 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SOLENOID VALVE LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 25
26 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 27

REAR LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


28 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 29

WINDSHIELD WIPER - WASHER LINE DIAGRAM


30 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

HEATER AND RADIO LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 31

AIR CONDITIONER SCHEMATIC

S Evaporator box S45 11-way connector


1 3rd speed relay 9 Potentiometer
2 Fuse 25 A 10 Speed switch
3 Blower motor 11 Temperature switch
4 1 and 2 speed resistor 12 12 V light
5 Electric cock A 2-way waterproof connection
X111 9-way connector B 5-way waterproof connection
X110 2-way power connector
32 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

COLD START LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 33

FRONT INSTRUMENT

REF. PIN FUNCTION SIGNAL


+12 J1 Positive (+12 V)
GND J2 Ground - Negative
S1 J3 Speedometer Sensor
L4 J4 Main beam lamp Positive
(blue)
L3 J5 Side light lamp (green) Positive
+ILL J6 Backlighting (+) + Light
L8 J7 Not used
L7 J8 Not used
L6 J9 Not used
L5 J10 Not used
L1 J11 Direction lamp (green) Positive
L2 J12 Not used
34 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

INSTRUMENT INPUT READING TOLERANCE INPUT CALIBRATION


TOLERANCE DIRECTION
0 Hz 0 rpm ±3° N/A Descending
Speedometer 307 Hz 1000 rpm N/A ± 60 rpm Ascending
736 Hz 2400 rpm N/A ± 60 rpm Ascending
240 Ohm Empty +0/-6° 230-240 Ohm Descending
Level fuel 102 Ohm 1/2 Tank ±3° 98 ÷ 108 Ohm Descending
33 Ohm Full +4/-2° 33 ÷ 42 Ohm Ascending
900 Ohm Point B +0/-6° N/A Descending
Transmission
temperature 106 °C (223 °F)
114 Ohm ±5° 111 ÷ 117 Ohm Ascending
(Red/green line)
700 Ohm Point A +0/-5° N/A Descending
Coolant
temperature 106 °C (223 °F)
95 Ohm ±3° 93 ÷ 97 Ohm Ascending
(Red/green line)
11 V Red/green left line ±3° 10.7 ÷ 11.3 V Descending
Battery charge
15.9 V Red/green right line ±5° 15.0 ÷ 15.6 V Ascending

INDICATOR READING RESISTANCE


Low fuel (lamp) 1/10 Tank 180 ÷ 200
Coolant temperature (alarm) 152 °C (306 °F) 70 ÷ 83
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 35

PIN NAME FUNCTION


1 Ignition 10 V - 16 V INPUT
2 Low oil pressure Low side switch input
3 Air filter restriction Low side switch input
4 Parking brake Low side switch input
5 Alternator/battery Alternator D+ input
6 Not used
7 Not used
8 Neutral High side switch input
9 Seat switch Low side switch input
10 Air conditioning system pressure High side switch input
11 Not used
12 Driving lights High side switch input
13 Not used
14 Not used
15 Engine pre-heat High side switch input
16 Not used
17 Not used High side switch input
18 Not used
19 Speedometer Alternator w input
20 Level fuel
21 Water temperature
22 Transmission temperature
23 Not used
24 Not used
25 Not used
26 Not used
27 Not used
28 Not used
29 Not used
30 Not used
31 Not used
32 Not used
33 Not used
34 Not used
35 Horn
36 Grounding Grounding
36 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHUTTLE CAB


(B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC)
FUSES AND RELAYS
K5 Low and main beam relay
Fuse
Rating Function
No. K6 Inner front work light relay
F1A 15 A Rear windshield wiper and washer K7 Inner rear work light relay
Engine stop, (+15) anti-theft device, K8 Outer front work light relay
F1B 7.5 A
parking brake, (+15) ECU power supply
K9 Outer rear work light relay
F1C 10 A Stop light switch
K10 Reverse travel relay
Side instrument power supply, switch
F2A 15 A K11 Forward travel relay
control lamps

F2B 15 A Air conditioning K12 Direction indicator flashing

F2C 15 A Pilot control

Rear right/front left side light, instrument


F3A 3A
backlighting

Rear left/front right side lights, number


F3B 3A
plate light

Front work light, ride control, 4x1 bucket,


F3C 10 A
quick coupler switch

Forward travel, reverse travel, reverse


F4A 5A
travel alarm, gearshift control
Rear hammer button, sensor + bucket
F4B 10 A level solenoid valve, clutch disconnecting
buttons and differential lock
Backhoe attachment lock, backhoe
F4C 10 A attachment travel lock, rear work light
switch

F5A 15 A Inner front work lights

F5B 10 A Low beams

F5C 15 A Main beams


F6A 7.5 A Rotating beacon

F6B 7.5 A (+15) hazard warning light power supply

F6C 7.5 A Hand hammer, 4WD


(+30) power supply for hazard warning
F7A 10 A
lights, horn

F7B 10 A Electric socket, radio, cab lighting

F7C 6A Front windshield wiper

F8A 15 A Outer rear work lights

F8B 15 A Outer front work lights

F8C 15 A Inner rear work lights

K1 Forward-reverse travel control relay

K3 Starting relay

K4 Bucket level solenoid valve relay


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 37

COMPONENTS

NAME DESCRIPTION
NAME DESCRIPTION
E121 Front left light
A1 Right speaker (optional)
E133 Front right light
A2 Left speaker (optional)
E144 Lock indicator lamp (optional)
A14 Antitheft unit
F1 Main fuse
A53 Radio (optional)
F402 Engine control unit fuse
A106 Engine control unit
F403 Blower fuse
A131 Flasher control unit
F31 Diagnostic fuse
B4 Air filter pressure switch
F112 Air conditioning fuse
B5 Fuel level sensor
B24 Accelerator knob F113 Water in fuel sensor fuse

B25 Foot accelerator G1 Battery

B26 Bucket sensor G67 Alternator

B30 Parking brake H7 Reverse travel alarm

B33 Speed sensor H26 Lock indicator lamp

B34 Port left microswitch H32 Alarm (optional)

B35 Port right microswitch H121 Horn

B66 Transmission oil temperature sensor K102 Start control relay

B69 Air conditioning pressure switch K103 Starting

B107 Water in fuel sensor K104 Engine start relay

B134 Stop light sensor K105 Air conditioning relay

B159 Stop light sensor K224 Differential lock relay

E15 Rotating beacon K225 Parking brake relay

E16 Rotating beacon K226 4WD relay

E17 Current intake K227 Additional relay

E18 Cab lighting K230 Hand hammer relay

E27 Number plate light M1 Starter motor

E28 Rear left light M39 Rear windshield wiper-washer pump motor

E29 Rear right light M41 Blower motor (optional)

E38 Rear right work light M49 Front windshield wiper-washer motor

E40 Rear right work light (optional) M56 Front windshield wiper-washer pump

E44 Front right work light M57 Rear windshield wiper-washer pump

E45 Front right work light (optional) M64 Air conditioning compressor

E46 Rear left work light (optional) P1 Side instrument cluster panel

E47 Rear left work light P125 Front instrument panel

E50 Front left work light (optional) R2 Grid heater resistor

E51 Front left work light S15 Start switch


S36 Rear hammer button (optional)
38 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

NAME DESCRIPTION CONNECTORS

S120 Warning switch NAME DESCRIPTION


S122 4WD switch X1 General line - engine line interface
S123 Hand hammer switch connector

S126 Lights switch X2 Preheating connector (optional)

S127 Rotating beacon switch X4 Air filter sensor connector

S130 Light-windshield wiper control lever X5 Fuel level sensor connector

S132 Gearshift lever X6 Forward travel solenoid valve connector

S135 Rear travel lock switch (optional) X7 Reverse travel alarm connector

S136 Menu scroll switch X8 4WD solenoid valve connector

S137 Rear work light switch X9 General line - front line interface connector

S138 Rear pump switch X10 General line - solenoid valve line interface
connector
S139 Display enter switch
X12 General line - cab interface connector
S140 Backhoe attachment travel lock switch
(optional) X14 Antitheft connector

S141 Front work light switch X15.1 Start switch connector

S142 Ride control switch (optional) X15.2 Start switch connector

S204 Rear horn button X17 Seat connector (optional)

S205 Clutch disconnect button X21 Diagnostic connector

S210 Clutch disconnect button X24 Accelerator knob connector

S222 Differential lock switch X25 Foot accelerator connector

SB1 Battery master switch X26 Loader attachment sensor connector

ST3 4x1 bucket control lever X27 Number plate light connector

X55 12 V socket X28 Rear left light connector

Y6 Forward travel solenoid valve X29 Rear right light connector

Y8 4WD solenoid X32 Optional buzzer connector

Y12 Proportional solenoid valves X33 Speedometer sensor connector

Y34 Ride control solenoid valve X34 Ride control connector

Y35 Hand hammer solenoid valve X35 Hand hammer solenoid valve connector

Y74 Differential lock solenoid valve X36 Backhoe attachment hammer button
connector
Y200 Reverse travel solenoid valve
X37 Right rear light connector
Y202 Backhoe attachment travel solenoid valve
X38 Work light connector
Y203 Backhoe attachment travel lock solenoid
valve X39 Rear windshield wiper motor connector

Y206 Bucket level solenoid valve X40 Work light connector

Y207 Delivery doubling solenoid valve X41 Blower motor connector

Y261 Hand hammer solenoid valve X42 Front right direction indicator connector
X43 Rotating beacon connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 39

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


X44 Work light connector X133 Right light connector
X45 Work light connector X134 Stop switch connector
X46 Work light connector X135 Stop switch connector
X47 Work light connector X140 Diode bridge connector
X48 Rear left light connector X144 Lock control lamp connector
X49 Front windshield wiper connector X200 Reverse travel solenoid valve connector
X50 Work light connector X201 Accelerator knob connector
X51 Work light connector X202 Backhoe attachment travel connector
X52 Front left direction indicator connector X203 Bucket transport lock solenoid valve
connector
X53 Radio connector
X204 Horn switch connector
X54 Radio connector
X205 Clutch disengage button connector
X56 Windshield wiper motor connector
X206 Bucket levelling connector
X57 Windshield wiper motor connector
X207 Delivery doubling solenoid valve connector
X64 Air conditioning connector
X210 Clutch disengage connector
X67 Alternator connector
X211 Parking brake pressure switch connector
X69 Air conditioning pressure switch connector
X212 Parking brake solenoid valve connector
X72 Pilot control connectors
X220 Air conditioning connector
X74 Differential lock connector
X222 Differential lock button connector
X80 Rotating beacon connector
X261 Backhoe attachment hammer solenoid
X81 Rotating beacon connector
valve connector
X87 General line - left side instrument cluster
X402 Engine control unit fuse connector
line interface connector
X403 Blower fuse connector
X88 General line - right side instrument cluster
line interface connector XST1 Side instrument connector
X106 Engine control unit connector XST2 Side instrument connector
X107 Water in fuel connector XC1 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X110 Air conditioning connector
XC2 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X111 Air conditioning connector
connector
X112 Air conditioning fuse connector
XC3 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X113 Water in fuel fuse connector connector
X121 Left light/horn connector XC4 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X124 Quick coupler connector
XC5 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X125 Front instrument connector
connector
X128 Optional connector
XC6 Fuse and relay control unit interface
X130 Light / windshield wiper control lever connector
connector
XX Diode connector
X131 Flasher control unit connector
X132 Gearshift lever connector
40 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

ENGINE LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 41

SOLENOID VALVE LINE DIAGRAM


42 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 43

LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


44 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

REAR WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 45

WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


46 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 47

HEATER AND RADIO LINE DIAGRAM


48 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

AIR CONDITIONING LINE DIAGRAM

S Evaporator box S45 11-way connector


1 3rd speed relay 9 Potentiometer
2 Fuse 25 A 10 Speed switch
3 Blower motor 11 Temperature switch
4 1 and 2 speed resistor 12 12 V light
5 Electric cock A 2-way waterproof connection
X111 9-way connector B 5-way waterproof connection
X110 2-way power connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 49

FRONT INSTRUMENT

REF. PIN FUNCTION SIGNAL


+12 J1 Positive (+12 V)
GND J2 Ground - Negative
S1 J3 Speedometer Sensor
Main beam lamp
L4 J4 Positive
(blue)
L3 J5 Side light lamp (green) Positive
+ILL J6 Backlighting (+) + Light
L8 J7 Not used
L7 J8 Not used
L6 J9 Not used
L5 J10 Not used
L1 J11 Direction lamp (green) Positive
L2 J12 Not used
50 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

INSTRUMENT INPUT READING TOLERANCE


320 Ohm Empty - minimum reading +0 / -2°
Level fuel 185 Ohm Right - edge of red band ± 3° (Ref)
6.5 Ohm Full - maximum reading +4 / -0°
193 Ohm ON ± 5 Ohm
Low fuel level (lamp)
185 Ohm OFF ± 5 Ohm
Speedometer Can message 0-3000 RPM ± 50 RPM
Can message Minimum reading 65 °C (149 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Coolant temperature Can message Left edge of red band 106 °C (223 °F) ± 2 °C (± 35.6 °F)
Can message Maximum reading 112 °C (234 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
11 V Right edge of lower red band ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Battery charge
16 V Edge of upper red band ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
385 Ohm Minimum reading 75 °C (167 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Transmission
149 Ohm Left edge of red band 105 °C (221 °F) ± 2 °C (± 35.6 °F)
temperature
112 Ohm Maximum reading 115 °C (239 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 51

CN1 CN2
PIN FUNCTION NOTE PIN FUNCTION NOTE
1 Not used 1 Keep alive power Need to fuse at 1
2 Key on power Wake up ampere without
disconnect
3 In gear input Digital input
2 Not used
4 Driving lights Digital input
3 Can Bus line input
5 Front work lights Digital input
4 Can Bus line input
6 Rear work lights Digital input
5 Not used
7 Not used
6 Buzzer
8 Not used
7 Starter motor lock 40 Ohm relay =
9 Not used 300 mA
10 Air conditioning Digital input 8 Not used
pressure
9 Not used
11 Display switch input Digital input
10 Not used
12 Menu confirmation Digital input
switch input 11 Not used

13 UP switch input Digital input 12 Not used

14 DOWN switch input Digital input 13 Fuel level gauge Resistance

15 Cranking Digital input 14 Transmission Thermistor


temperature
16 Clogged air filter Digital input
15 Not used
17 Not used
16 Foot accelerator 0.5 ÷ 4.5 V
18 Parking brake Digital input
17 Accelerator knob 0.5 ÷ 4.5 V
19 Not used
18 Foot accelerator Output monitored
20 Minimum Digital input for diagnostics
confirmation switch
19 Accelerator knob Output monitored
21 Decelerator button Digital input for diagnostics
22 Not used 20 Foot accelerator
23 Not used 21 Accelerator knob
24 Not used 22 Not used
25 Transmission oil Digital input 23 Not used
pressure
24 Alternator excitation
26 Not used
25 Not used
26 Ground Digital input
52 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - POWERSHIFT CAB (B110B - B110BTC)


FUSES AND RELAYS

Fuse K1A Flasher


Rating Circuit
No.
K3 Starting relay
F1A 15 A Rear windshield wiper and washer
K4 Bucket level solenoid valve relay
F1B 7.5 A (+15) anti-theft device
K5 Low and main beam relay
4WD, transmission disconnection and
F1C 10 A K6 Inner front work light relay
differential lock
K7 Inner rear work light relay
Instrument power supply, switch lamps,
F2A 15 A
pneumo-electric seat K8 Outer front work light relay
F2B 15 A Air conditioning K9 Outer rear work light relay
F2C 15 A Pilot control K10 Optional relay
Rear right/front left side light, instrument
F3A 3A
backlighting

Rear left/front right side lights, number


F3B 3A
plate light

Front work light switch, ride control, 4x1


F3C 10 A
bucket

F4A 7.5 A Stop light switch

Rear hammer button, bucket level


F4B 10 A
solenoid valve + sensor

Backhoe attachment lock, backhoe


F4C 10 A attachment travel lock, backhoe
attachment travel lock switch

F5A 15 A Inner front work lights


F5B 10 A Low beams

F5C 15 A Main beams

F6A 15 A Rotating beacon

F6B 7.5 A (+15) hazard warning light power supply

F6C 7.5 A Quick coupler

(+30) power supply for hazard warning


F7A 10 A
lights, horn

F7B 10 A Electric socket, radio, cab lighting

F7C 6A Front windshield wiper


F8A 15 A Outer rear work lights

F8B 15 A Outer front work lights

F8C 15 A Inner rear work lights


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 53

COMPONENTS

NAME DESCRIPTION
NAME DESCRIPTION
A1 Right speaker (optional) E133 Front right light

A2 Left speaker (optional) E144 Lock indicator lamp

A53 Radio (optional) F1 General fuse

A106 Engine control unit F602 ECU control unit fuse

A131 Flasher control unit F603 Blower fuse

A401 Transmission control unit F31 Diagnostic socket fuse

B4 Air filter pressure switch F112 Air conditioning fuse

B5 Fuel level sensor F113 Water in fuel fuse

B24 Accelerator knob G1 Battery

B25 Foot accelerator G67 Alternator

B26 Bucket sensor H7 Reverse travel alarm

B30 Parking brake H26 Lock indicator lamp

B66 Transmission oil temperature switch H32 Buzzer (optional)

B69 Air conditioning pressure switch HA2 Horn

B107 Water in fuel sensor H14 Transmission disconnect relay

B108 Transmission temperature sensor K102 Relay for start signal from the control unit

B109 Pressure switch K103 Starting relay

B112 Speed sensor K104 Engine start relay

E15 Rotating beacon K105 Air conditioning relay

E16 Rotating beacon K225 Parking brake relay

E18 Cab lighting K227 4WD switch control lamp relay

E27 Number plate light K228 Additional relay

E28 Rear left light K230 Hand hammer relay

E29 Rear right light M1 Starter motor

E38 Rear left work light M39 Rear windshield wiper motor

E40 Rear left light (optional) M41 Blower motor (optional)

E44 Front right work light M49 Front motor

E45 Front right work light (optional) M56 Front windshield wiper motor

E46 Rear left work light (optional) M57 Rear windshield wiper motor

E47 Rear left work light M64 Air conditioning compressor

E50 Front left work light (optional) P1 Side panel

E51 Front left work light P2 Front panel

E121 Front left light P3 4x1 bucket control lever


R2 Resistor
54 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


S0 Battery master switch Y35 Hand hammer solenoid valve
S15 Starting panel Y100 Forward travel solenoid valve
S34 Left door switch Y101 Reverse travel solenoid valve
S35 Right door switch Y102 PWM 1/3 solenoid valve
S36 Hand hammer button (optional) Y103 PWM 2/4 solenoid valve
S120 Warning switch Y104 Solenoid valve S13
S122 4WD switch Y105 Solenoid valve S24
S123 Hand hammer switch (optional) Y113 4WD solenoid
S124 Transmission automatic - manual Y114 Differential lock solenoid valve
operating switch
Y202 Backhoe attachment travel solenoid valve
S126 Lights switch
Y203 Backhoe attachment lock solenoid valve
S127 Rotating beacon switch
Y206 Bucket level solenoid valve
S130 Light-windshield wiper control lever
Y207 Delivery doubling solenoid valve
S134 Stop light switch
Y209 Backhoe attachment hand hammer
S135 Backhoe attachment travel lock switch solenoid valve
(optional)
S136 Menu scroll switch
CONNECTORS
S137 Rear work light switch
S138 Motor - rear windshield washer switch NAME DESCRIPTION
S139 Display enter switch X1 General line - engine line interface
connector
S140 Backhoe attachment travel lock switch
(optional) X2 Resistor connector
S141 Front work light switch X4 Air filter pressure switch connector
S142 Ride control switch (optional) X5 Fuel level sensor connector
S159 Stop light switch X7 Reverse travel alarm connector
S204 Rear horn button X9 General line - front instrument panel line
interface connector
S301 Differential lock switch
X10 General line - solenoid valve line interface
S400 Gearshift lever connector
S205A Front horn button X12 General line - cab line interface connector
S205B Clutch disconnect button X14 Antitheft connector
X14 Antitheft unit X15 Starting key switch connector
X17 Seat microswitch (optional) X17 Seat connector (optional)
X55 12 V socket X21 Diagnostic connector
X128 Optional
Y12 4X1 bucket proportional solenoid valves
Y34 Ride control solenoid valve
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 55

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


X23 General line - front instrument panel line X66 Transmission oil temperature sensor
interface connector connector
X24 Hand hammer connector X67 Alternator connector
X25 Foot accelerator connector X69 Air conditioning pressure switch connector
X26 Bucket sensor connector X72 Pilot control interface connectors
X27 Number plate light connector X87 General line - left side instrument cluster
line interface connector
X28 Rear left light connector
X88 General line - left side instrument cluster
X29 Rear right light connector line interface connector
X31 Flasher control unit connector X101 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X32 Alarm connector (optional) X102 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X35 Hand hammer connector X103 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X36 Backhoe attachment hammer button X104 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
connector
X105 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X37 Right rear light connector
X106 Engine control unit connector
X38 Work light connector
X107 Water in fuel connector
X39 Rear windshield wiper motor connector
X108 “Carraro” line transmission temperature
X40 Work light connector sensor connector
X41 Blower motor connector X109 “Carraro” line pressure switch connector
X42 Front right direction indicator connector X110 Air conditioning connector
X43 Rotating beacon connector X111 Air conditioning connector
X44 Work light connector X112 “Carraro” line engine rpm sensor
X45 Work light connector connector

X46 Work light connector X113 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector

X47 Work light connector X114 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector

X48 Rear left light connector X121 Front instrument panel line / left light line /
horn interface connector
X49 Front windshield wiper connector
X125 Front instrument connector
X50 Work light connector
X128 Optional connector
X51 Work light connector
X130 Light / windshield wiper control lever
X52 Front left direction indicator connector connector
X53 Radio connector X133 Front instrument panel line - right light line
interface connector
X54 Radio connector
X134 Stop connector
X55 Current intake
X159 Stop connector
X56 Front windshield wiper motor connector
X201 Manual accelerator knob connector
X57 Rear windshield wiper motor connector
X64 Air conditioning compressor connector
56 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


X202 Backhoe attachment travel connector XC3 Fuse and relay control unit connector
X203 Backhoe attachment lock connector XC4 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X204 Horn button connector
XC5 Fuse and relay control unit connector
X205 Transmission disconnect connector and
horn button XC6 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X206 Bucket levelling connector
XST1 Side instrument connector
X207 Delivery doubling connector
XST2 Side instrument connector
X208 Quick coupler connector
XX Diode interface connector
X209 Backhoe attachment hammer connector
X211 Parking brake pressure switch connector
X212 Parking brake solenoid valve connector
X220 Air conditioning connector
X301 Differential lock button connector
X400 Gearshift lever connector
X401 Transmission control unit connector
X402 Transmission solenoid valve line -
transmission line interface connector
X403 Transmission solenoid valve line -
transmission line interface connector
X404 Front instrument panel line - transmission
line interface connector
X405 Front instrument panel line - transmission
line interface connector
X406 Diode interface connector
X407 Quick coupler connector
X408 Front instrument panel line - general line
interface connector
X409 Front instrument panel line - transmission
line interface connector
X602 Engine control unit fuse connector
X603 Blower fuse connector
XC1 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
XC2 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 57

ENGINE LINE DIAGRAM


58 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SOLENOID VALVE LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 59
60 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 61

REAR WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


62 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 63

TRANSMISSION CONTROL UNIT LINE DIAGRAM


64 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 65

HEATER AND RADIO LINE DIAGRAM


66 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

AIR CONDITIONING LINE DIAGRAM

S Evaporator box S45 11-way connector


1 3rd speed relay 9 Potentiometer
2 Fuse 25 A 10 Speed switch
3 Blower motor 11 Temperature switch
4 1 and 2 speed resistor 12 12 V light
5 Electric cock A 2-way waterproof connection
X111 9-way connector B 5-way waterproof connection
X110 2-way power connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 67

FRONT INSTRUMENT

REF. PIN FUNCTION SIGNAL


+12 J1 Positive (+12 V)
GND J2 Ground - Negative
S1 J3 Speedometer Sensor
Main beam lamp
L4 J4 Positive
(blue)
L3 J5 Side light lamp (green) Positive
+ILL J6 Backlighting (+) + Light
L8 J7 Not used
L7 J8 Not used
L6 J9 Not used
L5 J10 Not used
L1 J11 Direction lamp (green) Positive
L2 J12 Not used
68 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

INSTRUMENT INPUT READING TOLERANCE


320 Ohm Empty - minimum reading +0 / -2°
Level fuel 185 Ohm Right - edge of red band ± 3° (Ref)
6.5 Ohm Full - maximum reading +4 / -0°
193 Ohm ON ± 5 Ohm
Low fuel level (lamp)
185 Ohm OFF ± 5 Ohm
Speedometer Can message 0-3000 RPM ± 50 RPM
Can message Minimum reading 65 °C (149 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Coolant temperature Can message Left edge of red band 106 °C (223 °F) ± 2 °C (± 35.6 °F)
Can message Maximum reading 112 °C (234 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
11 V Right edge of lower red band ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Battery charge
16 V Edge of upper red band ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
385 Ohm Minimum reading 75 °C (167 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Transmission
149 Ohm Left edge of red band 105 °C (221 °F) ± 2 °C (± 35.6 °F)
temperature
112 Ohm Maximum reading 115 °C (239 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 69

CN1 CN2
PIN FUNCTION NOTE PIN FUNCTION NOTE
1 Not used 1 Keep alive power Need to fuse at 1
2 Key on power Wake up ampere without
disconnect
3 In gear input Digital input
2 Not used
4 Driving lights Digital input
3 Can Bus line input
5 Front work lights Digital input
4 Can Bus line input
6 Rear work lights Digital input
5 Not used
7 Not used
6 Buzzer
8 Not used
7 Starter motor lock 40 Ohm relay =
9 Not used 300 mA
10 Air conditioning Digital input 8 Not used
pressure
9 Not used
11 Display switch input Digital input
10 Not used
12 Menu confirmation Digital input
switch input 11 Not used

13 UP switch input Digital input 12 Not used

14 DOWN switch input Digital input 13 Fuel level gauge Resistance

15 Cranking Digital input 14 Transmission Thermistor


temperature
16 Clogged air filter Digital input
15 Not used
17 Not used
16 Foot accelerator 0.5 ÷ 4.5 V
18 Parking brake Digital input
17 Accelerator knob 0.5 ÷ 4.5 V
19 Not used
18 Foot accelerator Output monitored
20 Minimum Digital input for diagnostics
confirmation switch
19 Accelerator knob Output monitored
21 Decelerator button Digital input for diagnostics
22 Not used 20 Foot accelerator
23 Not used 21 Accelerator knob
24 Not used 22 Not used
25 Transmission oil Digital input 23 Not used
pressure
24 Alternator excitation
26 Not used
25 Not used
26 Ground Digital input
70 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

ELECTRIC DIAGRAMS - 4WS POWERSHIFT CAB (B115B)


RELAY FUSES
K1A Flasher

Fuse K3 Starting relay


Rating Function
No.
K4 Bucket level solenoid valve relay
F1A 15 A Rear windshield wiper and washer
K5 Low and main beam relay
F1B 7.5 A (+15) anti-theft device
K6 Inner front work light relay
4WD, transmission disconnection and
F1C 10 A K7 Inner rear work light relay
differential lock
K8 Outer front work light relay
Instrument power supply, switch lamps,
F2A 15 A
pneumo-electric seat K9 Outer rear work light relay
F2B 15 A Air conditioning K10 Optional relay
F2C 15 A Pilot control

Rear right/front left side light, instrument


F3A 3A
backlighting

Rear left/front right side lights, number


F3B 3A
plate light

Front work light switch, ride control, 4x1


F3C 10 A
bucket

F4A 7.5 A Stop light switch

Rear hammer button, bucket level


F4B 10 A
solenoid valve + sensor

Backhoe attachment lock, backhoe


F4C 10 A attachment travel lock, backhoe
attachment travel lock switch

F5A 15 A Inner front work lights


F5B 10 A Low beams

F5C 15 A Main beams

F6A 15 A Rotating beacon

F6B 7.5 A (+15) hazard warning light power supply

F6C 7.5 A Quick coupler

(+30) power supply for hazard warning


F7A 10 A
lights, horn

F7B 10 A Electric socket, radio, cab lighting

F7C 6A Front windshield wiper


F8A 15 A Outer rear work lights

F8B 15 A Outer front work lights

F8C 15 A Inner rear work lights


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 71

COMPONENTS

NAME DESCRIPTION
NAME DESCRIPTION
A1 Right speaker (optional) E50 Front left work light (optional)

A2 Left speaker (optional) E51 Front left work light

A53 Radio (optional) E121 Front left light

A95 Steering control unit E133 Front right light

A106 Engine control unit E144 Lock indicator lamp

A131 Flasher control unit F1 General fuse

A401 Transmission control unit F602 ECU control unit fuse

B4 Air filter pressure switch F603 Blower fuse

B5 Fuel level sensor F31 Diagnostic socket fuse

B24 Accelerator knob F112 Air conditioning fuse

B25 Foot accelerator F113 Water in fuel fuse

B26 Bucket sensor G1 Battery

B30 Parking brake G67 Alternator

B66 Transmission oil temperature switch H7 Reverse travel alarm

B69 Air conditioning pressure switch H26 Lock indicator lamp

B97 Front axle sensor H32 Buzzer (optional)

B98 Rear axle sensor HA2 Horn

B107 Water in fuel sensor H14 Transmission disconnect relay

B108 Transmission temperature sensor K102 Relay for start signal from the control unit

B109 Pressure switch K103 Starting relay

B112 Speed sensor K104 Engine start relay

E15 Rotating beacon K105 Air conditioning relay

E16 Rotating beacon K227 4WD switch control lamp relay

E18 Cab lighting K230 Hand hammer relay

E27 Number plate light M1 Starter motor

E28 Rear left light M39 Rear windshield wiper motor

E29 Rear right light M41 Blower motor (optional)

E38 Rear left work light M49 Front motor

E40 Rear left light (optional) M56 Front windshield wiper motor

E44 Front right work light M57 Rear windshield wiper motor

E45 Front right work light (optional) M64 Air conditioning compressor

E46 Rear left work light (optional) P1 Side panel

E47 Rear left work light P2 Front panel


P3 4x1 bucket control lever
72 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


R2 Resistor Y91 Round steering solenoid valve
S0 Battery master switch Y92 Crab steering solenoid valve
S15 Starting panel Y93 4WS steering solenoid valve
S34 Left port microswitch Y94 2WS steering solenoid valve
S35 Right port microswitch Y100 Forward travel solenoid valve
S36 Hand hammer button (optional) Y101 Reverse speed solenoid valve
S120 Warning switch Y102 PWM 1/3 solenoid valve
S122 4WD switch Y103 PWM 2/4 solenoid valve
S123 Hand hammer switch (optional) Y104 Solenoid valve S13
S124 Transmission automatic - manual Y105 Solenoid valve S24
operating switch
Y113 4WD solenoid
S126 Lights switch
Y114 Differential lock solenoid valve
S127 Rotating beacon switch
Y202 Backhoe attachment travel solenoid valve
S130 Light-windshield wiper control lever
Y203 Backhoe attachment lock solenoid valve
S134 Stop light switch
Y206 Bucket level solenoid valve
S135 Backhoe attachment travel lock switch
(optional) Y207 Delivery doubling solenoid valve

S136 Menu scroll switch Y209 Backhoe attachment hand hammer


solenoid valve
S137 Rear work light switch
S138 Motor - rear windshield washer switch
CONNECTORS
S139 Display enter switch
S140 Backhoe attachment travel lock switch NAME DESCRIPTION
(optional)
X1 General line - engine line interface
S141 Front work light switch connector
S142 Ride control switch (optional) X2 Resistor connector
S159 Stop light switch X4 Air filter pressure switch connector
S204 Rear horn button X5 Fuel level sensor connector
S400 Gearshift lever X7 Reverse travel alarm connector
S205A Front horn button X9 General line - front instrument panel line
interface connector
S205B Clutch disconnect button
X10 General line - solenoid valve line interface
X14 Antitheft unit connector
X17 Seat microswitch (optional) X12 General line - cab line interface connector
X55 12 V socket X14 Antitheft connector
Y12 4X1 bucket proportional solenoid valves
Y34 Ride control solenoid valve
Y35 Hand hammer solenoid valve
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 73

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


X15 Starting key switch connector X55 Current intake
X17 Seat connector (optional) X56 Front windshield wiper motor connector
X21 Diagnostic connector X57 Rear windshield wiper motor connector
X23 General line - front instrument panel line X64 Air conditioning compressor connector
interface connector
X66 Transmission oil temperature sensor
X24 Hand hammer connector connector
X25 Foot accelerator connector X67 Alternator connector
X26 Bucket sensor connector X69 Air conditioning pressure switch connector
X27 Number plate light connector X72 Pilot control interface connectors
X28 Rear left light connector X87 General line - left side instrument cluster
line interface connector
X29 Rear right light connector
X88 General line - left side instrument cluster
X31 Flasher control unit connector line interface connector
X32 Alarm connector (optional) X91 Steering solenoid valve connector
X34 Ride control connector X92 4WS steering solenoid valve connector
X35 Hand hammer connector X93 4WS crab steering solenoid valve
X36 Backhoe attachment hammer button connector
connector X94 2WS steering solenoid valve connector
X37 Right rear light connector X95 Steering control unit connector
X38 Work light connector X96 Steering control unit connector
X39 Rear windshield wiper motor connector X97 Front axle sensor connector
X40 Work light connector X98 Rear axle sensor connector
X41 Blower motor connector X101 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X42 Front right direction indicator connector X102 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X43 Rotating beacon connector X103 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X44 Work light connector X104 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X45 Work light connector X105 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
X46 Work light connector X106 Engine control unit connector
X47 Work light connector X107 Water in fuel connector
X48 Rear left light connector X108 “Carraro” line transmission temperature
X49 Front windshield wiper connector sensor connector

X50 Work light connector X109 “Carraro” line pressure switch connector

X51 Work light connector X110 Air conditioning connector

X52 Front left direction indicator connector X111 Air conditioning connector

X53 Radio connector X112 “Carraro” line engine rpm sensor


connector
X54 Radio connector
X113 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector
74 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

NAME DESCRIPTION NAME DESCRIPTION


X114 “Carraro” line solenoid valve connector X409 Front instrument panel line - transmission
line interface connector
X121 Front instrument panel line / left light line /
horn interface connector X602 Engine control unit fuse connector
X125 Front instrument connector X603 Blower fuse connector
X130 Light / windshield wiper control lever XC1 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector connector
X133 Front instrument panel line - right light line XC2 Fuse and relay control unit interface
interface connector connector
X134 Stop connector XC3 Fuse and relay control unit connector
X159 Stop connector XC4 Fuse and relay control unit interface
connector
X201 Manual accelerator knob connector
XC5 Fuse and relay control unit connector
X202 Backhoe attachment travel connector
XC6 Fuse and relay control unit connector
X203 Backhoe attachment lock connector
XST1 Side instrument connector
X204 Horn button connector
XST2 Side instrument connector
X205 Transmission disconnect connector and
horn button XX Diode interface connector
X206 Bucket levelling connector
X207 Delivery doubling connector
X208 Quick coupler connector
X209 Backhoe attachment hammer connector
X220 Air conditioning connector
X262 Diode bridge connector
X400 Gearshift lever connector
X401 Transmission control unit connector
X402 Transmission solenoid valve line -
transmission line interface connector
X403 Transmission solenoid valve line -
transmission line interface connector
X404 Front instrument panel line - transmission
line interface connector
X405 Front instrument panel line - transmission
line interface connector
X406 Diode interface connector
X408 Front instrument panel line - general line
interface connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 75

ENGINE LINE DIAGRAM


76 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SOLENOID VALVE LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 77
78 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 79

REAR WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


80 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WORK LIGHT LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 81

TRANSMISSION CONTROL UNIT LINE DIAGRAM


82 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER LINE DIAGRAM


SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 83

HEATER AND RADIO LINE DIAGRAM


84 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

AIR CONDITIONING LINE DIAGRAM

S Evaporator box S45 11-way connector


1 3rd speed relay 9 Potentiometer
2 Fuse 25 A 10 Speed switch
3 Blower motor 11 Temperature switch
4 1 and 2 speed resistor 12 12 V light
5 Electric cock A 2-way waterproof connection
X111 9-way connector B 5-way waterproof connection
X110 2-way power connector
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 85

FRONT INSTRUMENT

REF. PIN FUNCTION SIGNAL


+12 J1 Positive (+12 V)
GND J2 Ground - Negative
S1 J3 Speedometer Sensor
Main beam lamp
L4 J4 Positive
(blue)
L3 J5 Side light lamp (green) Positive
+ILL J6 Backlighting (+) + Light
L8 J7 Not used
Crab steering control
L7 J8 Negative
lamp (green)
Front steering control
L6 J9 Negative
lamp (green)
4WS steering control
L5 J10 Negative
lamp (green)
Direction indicator
L1 J11 Positive
lamp (green)
L2 J12 Not used
86 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

INSTRUMENT INPUT READING TOLERANCE


320 Ohm Empty - minimum reading +0 / -2°
Level fuel 185 Ohm Right - edge of red band ± 3° (Ref)
6.5 Ohm Full - maximum reading +4 / -0°
193 Ohm ON ± 5 Ohm
Low fuel level (lamp)
185 Ohm OFF ± 5 Ohm
Speedometer Can message 0-3000 RPM ± 50 RPM
Can message Minimum reading 65 °C (149 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Coolant temperature Can message Left edge of red band 106 °C (223 °F) ± 2 °C (± 35.6 °F)
Can message Maximum reading 112 °C (234 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
11 V Right edge of lower red band ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Battery charge
16 V Edge of upper red band ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
385 Ohm Minimum reading 75 °C (167 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
Transmission
149 Ohm Left edge of red band 105 °C (221 °F) ± 2 °C (± 35.6 °F)
temperature
112 Ohm Maximum reading 115 °C (239 °F) ± 3 °C (± 37.4 °F)
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 87

CN1 CN2
PIN FUNCTION NOTE PIN FUNCTION NOTE
1 Not used 1 Keep alive power Need to fuse at 1
2 Key on power Wake up ampere without
disconnect
3 In gear input Digital input
2 Not used
4 Driving lights Digital input
3 Can Bus line input
5 Front work lights Digital input
4 Can Bus line input
6 Rear work lights Digital input
5 Not used
7 Not used
6 Buzzer
8 Not used
7 Starter motor lock 40 Ohm relay =
9 Not used 300 mA
10 Air conditioning Digital input 8 Not used
pressure
9 Not used
11 Display switch input Digital input
10 Not used
12 Menu confirmation Digital input
switch input 11 Not used

13 UP switch input Digital input 12 Not used

14 DOWN switch input Digital input 13 Fuel level gauge Resistance

15 Cranking Digital input 14 Transmission Thermistor


temperature
16 Clogged air filter Digital input
15 Not used
17 Not used
16 Foot accelerator 0.5 ÷ 4.5 V
18 Parking brake Digital input
17 Accelerator knob 0.5 ÷ 4.5 V
19 Not used
18 Foot accelerator Output monitored
20 Minimum Digital input for diagnostics
confirmation switch
19 Accelerator knob Output monitored
21 Decelerator button Digital input for diagnostics
22 Not used 20 Foot accelerator
23 Not used 21 Accelerator knob
24 Not used 22 Not used
25 Transmission oil Digital input 23 Not used
pressure
24 Alternator excitation
26 Not used
25 Not used
26 Ground Digital input
88 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

CONTROLS AND INSTRUMENTS

FRONT INSTRUMENT PANEL

1. DIRECTION INDICATOR LAMP 4. “FOUR WHEEL STEER” (4WS) STEER INDI-


This lamp turns on when the direction indicators CATOR LAMP
are working. This lamp turns on when 4 wheel steer mode is
2. SIDE LIGHT AND LOW BEAM INDICATOR selected and phased.
LAMP 5. “ROAD” (4WS) STEER INDICATOR LAMP
This indicator lamp turns on when the side This lamp turns on when 2 wheel steer mode is
lights or the low beams are on. selected and phased.
3. MAIN BEAM INDICATOR LAMP
This indicator lamp turns on when the main
beams are on.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 89

6. “CRAB” (4WS) STEER INDICATOR LAMP 12. 2WD/4WD SWITCH


This lamp turns on when crab steer mode is This switch is used to engage or disengage the
selected and phased. 4WD function.
This switch has two positions:
NOTE: if the three lamps turn on at once, this
- First position (powershuttle) (by pushing but-
means there is a problem with the electric circuit.
Consult your Dealer. ton on the right ):
rear wheel drive and braking on rear wheels
7. TACHOMETER for all gears (lamp off).
The tachometer shows travel speed in kilome-
tres per hour (km/h) and miles per hour (mph). - First position (powershift) (by pushing button
on the right ):
8. ROTATING BEACON SWITCH
This switch is used to turn the rotating beacon rear wheel drive with braking only on rear
on or off. wheels (only in first and second gear) (lamp
off);
9. LIGHT SWITCH four wheel drive and braking (in third and
This switch has three positions: fourth gear) (lamp on).
- The first position is OFF (control lamp off).
- Second position (by pushing button on the
- Second position, by pressing the symbol side
left ):
(first click) the instrument cluster panel is
powered, the side lights and the low beam 4 wheel drive and braking on 4 wheels
indicator lamp are turned on (control lamp (lamp on).
on). 13. MANUAL MODE SELECTION SWITCH (Pow-
- Third position, by pressing the symbol side ershift transmission)
again (second click), the high beams are In situations where manual gearshifting (up or
enabled and the low beams and the low downshift) is required, the automatic gearshift
beam indicator lamp are turned on (control of the powershift transmission can be overrid-
lamp on). den by means of this switch.
10. HAZARD LIGHT SWITCH NOTE: changing gears up or down must always be
Press the control down to locked position. The done using the powershift transmission lever.
direction indicators and the control will flash When the manual mode is no longer required,
simultaneously. Press the control down again to place the switch back to the OFF position to
turn off the direction indicators and the indicator return to automatic gearshifting.
lamp.
11. HAND-HELD AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC
ATTACHMENT SWITCH (Optional)
This switch has two positions:
- The first position is OFF (control lamp on).
- The second position is ON and enables the
auxiliary hydraulic attachments (control lamp
off).
90 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

CALIBRATION OF SPEEDOMETER
According to the model and tires fitted, it may be
necessary to calibrate the front instrument.
This calibration is required when fitting a new instru-
ment or if a change of tires takes place, and can be
performed by adjusting the settings of the switch
block, mounted behind the console.

Each switch numbered from 1 to 8 mounted in the


block should be turned ON = or OFF .
8
Switch positions: 7
6
1 = ON
5
0 = OFF 4
3
2
on 1

F28666

TIRE - ROLLING FREQUENCY AT 50 km/h SWITCH POSITIONS


CIRCUMFERENCE 1-2-3-4-5-6-7-8
4065 - 4335 2055 1-1-1-1-0-1-0-0
3810 - 3911 2245 1-1-1-0-1-0-1-0
4065 - 4335 2310 1-1-1-0-1-1-1-0
3810 - 3911 2522 1-1-0-0-0-0-0-1
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 91

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER PANEL (B90B)

1. FRONT WORK LIGHT SWITCH 3. ROLL-OVER PROTECTION SWITCH


This switch has three positions: (Optional)
- The first position is OFF (control lamp off). This switch is used to engage or disengage the
- Second position, by pressing the symbol side roll-over protection device.
(first click), the outer front work lights are When the operator is about to start working with
turned on (control lamp on). the backhoe attachment in conditions which
could cause the machine to roll over, he/she
- Third position, by pressing the symbol side
must activate the roll-over protection device by
again (second click), the inner front work
pressing the switch (ON position and lamp
lights are turned on too (control lamp on).
turned on).
2. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SWITCH (Available) In this condition, the audible alarm will sound by
2. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT CAR- means of the buzzer when the pressure switch,
RIAGE LOCKING SWITCH (Sideshift version) installed on the backhoe attachment boom cyl-
It allows locking (control lamp on) or unlocking inder, detects a pressure exceeding the follow-
(control lamp off) the sliding carriage the back- ing values:
hoe attachment is mounted on. 2WS = 116 bar (17 psi)
4WS = 126.5 bar (18 psi)
NOTE: the switch is located in this position only
if the machine is equipped with the “Hydraulic
handling of the backhoe sideshift carriage”.
92 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

4. “GLIDE RIDE” SWITCH (Optional) 11. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT CAR-


The “glide ride” system control improves the RIAGE LOCKING SWITCH (Sideshift version)
machine comfort during travel, regardless of It allows locking (control lamp on) or unlocking
the type of terrain and with the loader bucket (control lamp off) the sliding carriage the back-
full or empty. hoe attachment is mounted on.
It reduces forward and rearward pitching when
NOTE: the switch is located in this position only
moving rearwards or forwards and when carry-
if the machine is without the “Hydraulic handling
ing loads, at the same time increasing produc-
of the backhoe sideshift carriage”.
tivity and operator comfort.
It also reduces impact forces to the machine 11. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT CAR-
during operation. Do not use this system while RIAGE MOVING SWITCH (Sideshift version)
operating the loader attachment. (Optional)
This button allows hydraulically moving the
S WARNING S backhoe attachment towards the track sides.
Never operate the “glide ride” system control when Press the button side with the symbol to move
the loader arm and loader bucket are maintaining the backhoe attachment to the left side of the
the front of the machine raised off the ground. The track.
machine could fall and cause serious or fatal injury. Press the button side without symbol to move
the backhoe attachment to the right side of the
5. LOADER ATTACHMENT LOCK VALVE track (track sides are referred to the travel
SWITCH (Optional) direction of the machine).
This switch has two positions: The button has a control lamp which turns on
- First position (control lamp off) condition with when the backhoe attachment sideshift car-
blocked valves. riage locking switch (2) is disconnected.
- Second position (control lamp on), by press- 12. REAR WORK LIGHT SWITCH
ing the side with the symbol, the valves are This switch has three positions:
released. - The first position is OFF (control lamp off).
6. SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER - Second position, by pressing the symbol side
7. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SWITCH (Available) (first click), the outer rear work lights are
8. AUXILIARY BACKHOE ATTACHMENT turned on (control lamp on).
SWITCH (Optional) 13. Third position, by pressing the symbol side
9. REAR WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER again (second click), the inner rear work lights
SWITCH are turned on too (control lamp on).
When this switch is pressed, the windshield
wiper is activated and will continue operating
until the switch is returned to the OFF position.
The windshield washer is operated by further
pressing and holding the switch.
When the switch is released, the washer stops
and the wiper starts operating again.
10. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LOCKING SWITCH
(Optional)
The switch is used to lock (control lamp on) or
unlock (control lamp off) the backhoe attach-
ment safety hook in preparation for road travel.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 93

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER PANEL (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)

1. FRONT WORK LIGHT SWITCH 3. ROLL-OVER PROTECTION SWITCH


This switch has three positions: (Optional)
- The first position is OFF (control lamp off). This switch is used to engage or disengage the
- Second position, by pressing the symbol side roll-over protection device. When the operator
(first click), the outer front work lights are is about to start working with the backhoe
turned on (control lamp on). attachment in conditions which could cause the
machine to roll over, he/she must activate the
- Third position, by pressing the symbol side
roll-over protection device by pressing the
again (second click), the inner front work
switch (ON position and lamp turned on).
lights are turned on too (control lamp on).
In this condition, the audible alarm will sound by
2. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SWITCH (Available) means of the buzzer when the pressure switch,
2. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT CAR- installed on the backhoe attachment boom cyl-
RIAGE LOCKING SWITCH (Sideshift version) inder, detects a pressure exceeding the follow-
It allows locking (control lamp on) or unlocking ing values:
(control lamp off) the sliding carriage the back- 2WS = 116 bar (17 psi)
hoe attachment is mounted on. 4WS = 126.5 bar (18 psi)
NOTE: the switch is located in this position only
if the machine is equipped with the “Hydraulic
handling of the backhoe sideshift carriage”.
94 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

4. “GLIDE RIDE” SWITCH (Optional) 11. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT CAR-


The “glide ride” system control improves the RIAGE LOCKING SWITCH (Sideshift version)
machine comfort during travel, regardless of It allows locking (control lamp on) or unlocking
the type of terrain and with the loader bucket (control lamp off) the sliding carriage the back-
full or empty. hoe attachment is mounted on.
It reduces forward and rearward pitching when
NOTE: the switch is located in this position only
moving rearwards or forwards and when carry-
if the machine is without the “Hydraulic handling
ing loads, at the same time increasing produc-
of the backhoe sideshift carriage”.
tivity and operator comfort.
It also reduces impact forces to the machine 11. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT CAR-
during operation. Do not use this system while RIAGE MOVING SWITCH (Sideshift version)
operating the loader attachment. (Optional)
This button allows hydraulically moving the
S WARNING S backhoe attachment towards the track sides.
Never operate the “glide ride” system control when Press the button side with the symbol to move
the loader arm and loader bucket are maintaining the backhoe attachment to the left side of the
the front of the machine raised off the ground. The track.
machine could fall and cause serious or fatal injury. Press the button side without symbol to move
the backhoe attachment to the right side of the
5. LOADER ATTACHMENT LOCK VALVE track (track sides are referred to the travel
SWITCH (Optional) direction of the machine).
This switch has two positions: The button has a control lamp which turns on
- First position (control lamp off) condition with when the backhoe attachment sideshift car-
blocked valves. riage locking switch (2) is disconnected.
- Second position (control lamp on), by press- 12. REAR WORK LIGHT SWITCH
ing the side with the symbol, the valves are This switch has three positions:
released. - The first position is OFF (control lamp off).
6. SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER - Second position, by pressing the symbol side
7. UP/DOWN SWITCH (first click), the outer rear work lights are
By means of this control, it is possible to scroll turned on (control lamp on).
through the menu or data options shown on the 13. Third position, by pressing the symbol side
diagnostic display. again (second click), the inner rear work lights
8. MENU ENTER SWITCH are turned on too (control lamp on).
By means of this control it is possible to display
and confirm the menu options shown on the
display.
9. REAR WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER
SWITCH
When this switch is pressed, the windshield
wiper is activated and will continue operating
until the switch is returned to the OFF position.
The windshield washer is operated by further
pressing and holding the switch.
When the switch is released, the washer stops
and the wiper starts operating again.
10. BACKHOE ATTACHMENT LOCKING SWITCH
(Optional)
The switch is used to lock (control lamp on) or
unlock (control lamp off) the backhoe attach-
ment safety hook in preparation for road travel.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 95

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (B90B)

1. AIR CONDITIONER INDICATOR LAMP 6. AIR FILTER RESTRICTION LAMP


(Optional) This warning lamp turns on when the air filter
This lamp turns on when the air conditioner is element needs to be cleaned or replaced.
working. 7. LOW FUEL LEVEL WARNING LAMP
2. ENGINE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP This warning lamp turns on when the fuel level
This warning lamp turns on and the audible is low. You have approximately an hour to fill
warning device sounds when the engine oil the fuel tank.
pressure is too low.
NOTE: when the starter switch key is in the ON
3. “GRID HEATER” LAMP (Optional) position, all lamps turn on and the instrument
If the machine is equipped with a “grid heater”, buzzer sounds for 5 seconds. Afterwards, the
wait for the indicator lamp to turn off before lamps turn off and only lamp (3) remains on. The
starting the engine. gauges (8) and (9) set to position.
4. BATTERY CHARGE WARNING LAMP
8. FUEL LEVEL GAUGE
This warning lamp turns on when the alternator/
This gauge shows the quantity of fuel in the fuel
fan belt is broken or when the alternator is not
tank.
charging the battery.
5. PARKING BRAKE INDICATOR LAMP
This indicator lamp turns on when the parking
brake lever is in the raised position (wheels
braked).
96 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

9. BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR


This indicator shows the state of charge of the
battery. At normal charge the needle should be
in the grey area. If the needle is in the left red
area, this shows that the battery charge is
insufficient or that the alternator is not charging
the battery. If the needle is in the right red area,
this indicates excessive battery charge which
may cause damage to the battery.
10. HOURMETER
The hourmeter shows the number of hours and
tenths of hours the engine has been function-
ing. It also makes it possible to determine when
servicing operations are due.
11. TACHOMETER
The tachometer shows the engine speed in
revolutions per minute.
The figures indicated must be multiplied by
100.
Each intermediate mark shows a value of
100 rpm.
We recommend not to reach the red line.
12. TRANSMISSION OIL TEMPERATURE
GAUGE
This gauge shows the transmission oil temper-
ature. When the temperature is normal, the
needle is in the grey area. If the needle is in the
red area, change down to a lower gear. If the
needle still remains in the red area, stop
machine travel, place the gearshift lever and
the direction-of-travel control lever in neutral
position and let the engine run at 1000 rpm. If
this operation does not enable the oil tempera-
ture to be reduced, check the gearbox oil level
and make sure that the radiator and oil cooler
are perfectly clean.
13. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE GAUGE
This gauge shows the temperature of the
engine coolant solution. When the temperature
is normal, the needle is in the grey area. If the
needle is in the red area, the audible warning
sounds.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 97

SIDE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)

1. CAUTION MASTER LAMP 5. PARKING BRAKE INDICATOR LAMP


This lamp signals a not critical caution. This indicator lamp turns on when the parking
When this caution is active, it is necessary to brake lever is in the raised position (wheels
change the operating mode, plan a down time braked).
to carry out maintenance or, if the fault contin- 6. AIR FILTER RESTRICTION LAMP
ues, consult your dealer. This warning lamp turns on when the air filter
This lamp turns on at the same time of lamps element needs to be cleaned or replaced.
(2), (4), (6) and (8).
7. AIR CONDITIONER INDICATOR LAMP
2. ENGINE OIL PRESSURE WARNING LAMP (Optional)
This warning lamp turns on and the audible This lamp turns on when the air conditioner is
warning device sounds when the engine oil working.
pressure is too low.
8. “GRID HEATER” LAMP (Optional)
3. STOP MASTER LAMP If the machine is equipped with a “grid heater”,
The stop master lamp signals a critical caution. wait for the indicator lamp to turn off before
When this lamp turns on, stop the machine starting the engine.
immediately and shut off the engine.
If this is not the case, the machine can get dam-
aged or accidents may occur.
4. BATTERY CHARGE WARNING LAMP
This warning lamp turns on when the alternator/
fan belt is broken or when the alternator is not
charging the battery.
98 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

9. LOW FUEL LEVEL WARNING LAMP


This warning lamp turns on when the fuel level
is low. You have approximately an hour to fill
the fuel tank.
NOTE: when the starter switch key is in the ON
position, all lamps turn on and the instrument
buzzer sounds for 5 seconds. Afterwards, the
lamps turn off and only lamp (2) remains on. The
gauges (10) and (11) set to position.
10. FUEL LEVEL GAUGE
This gauge shows the quantity of fuel in the fuel
tank.
11. BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR
This indicator shows the state of charge of the
battery. At normal charge the needle should be
in the grey area. If the needle is in the left red
area, this shows that the battery charge is
insufficient or that the alternator is not charging
the battery. If the needle is in the right red area,
this indicates excessive battery charge which
may cause damage to the battery.
12. DIAGNOSTIC DISPLAY
By means of this display it is possible to visual-
ize the various data of diagnostics. The service
hours are also indicated.
13. TACHOMETER
The tachometer shows the engine speed in rev-
olutions per minute.
The figures indicated must be multiplied by 100.
Each intermediate mark shows a value of
100 rpm.
We recommend not to reach the red line.
14. TRANSMISSION OIL TEMPERATURE
GAUGE
This gauge shows the transmission oil temper-
ature. When the temperature is normal, the
needle is in the grey area. If the needle is in the
red area, change down to a lower gear. If the
needle still remains in the red area, stop
machine travel, place the gearshift lever and
the direction-of-travel control lever in neutral
position and let the engine run at 1000 rpm. If
this operation does not enable the oil tempera-
ture to be reduced, check the gearbox oil level
and make sure that the radiator and oil cooler
are perfectly clean.
15. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE GAUGE
This gauge shows the temperature of the
engine coolant solution. When the temperature
is normal, the needle is in the grey area. If the
needle is in the red area, the audible warning
sounds.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 99

ANTI-START SYSTEM

F28667

A. M38 Immobiliser E. Starter motor


B. Electronic key socket with LED F. + 15 key positive
C. 2 piece electronic key G. Electronic key
D. + 50 to ignition

WIRE FUNCTION CONNECTION


No.
1 (+15) Key positive Connected to the +12 V full ignition supply
2 (+30) Permanent + 12 V power supply Connected to the wire from the battery positive
3 (-31) Negative power supply Connected to the vehicle negative at two independent
points
5-6 Immobilization relay No. 2 Connected in line with the wire controlling the starter
motor relay/solenoid - Minimum 500 mA maximum 10 A
capacity
7-8-9 Immobilization relay No. 1 Connected in line with the cable controlling the ignition
or the fuel system - minimum capacity 500 mA,
maximum capacity 10 A
100 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

DIAGNOSTIC DISPLAY (B100B - B100BTC - B110B - B110BTC - B115B)


The diagnostic display (1) is located in the middle of
the side instrument cluster (4).
The diagnostic switches are the following:

- MENU SCROLL SWITCH (2)


Use this UP/DOWN switch to scroll through the
menus.
NOTE: push the arrow at start up to display engine
rpm on the display.

- DISPLAY ENTER SWITCH (3)


Use this switch to select and confirm a service
menu.
The Diamond icon, or top portion of the switch, is
used to select displays.
The 90° arrow icon or bottom portion of the switch,
is used to enter selected choices.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 101

Using the display switches, you will be able to scroll


through the following:
- battery voltage;
- backhoe loader hours;
- setup.

Features adjustable during setup:


- backlighting dimming and contrast control,
- maintenance/service interval customization;
- storage of error codes;
- “grid heater” presence:
it is possible to select or deselect the “grid heater”
option;
- low temperature idle speed setting:
when the engine coolant temperature is below
10 °C (50 °F), the unit will change from a normal
low idle to a low temperature idle which can be
adjusted between 975 and 1500 rpm. The
default setting is 1000 rpm;
- high idle speed setting (2500 rpm maximum).
102 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

SYMBOLS
Hydraulic oil filter blocked
Work hours

Transmission oil pressure too high


Maintenance

Battery charging failure


Maintenance heavy (hours)
HEAVY

1000

Contaminated fuel
Maintenance light (hours)
LIGHT

500

Malfunction
Stored error code

Back-light dimming
Grid heater

Battery voltage too high


Engine speed

n/min
Battery voltage too low
Engine area of fault

Engine intake air filter blocked

Charge air temperature too high

Engine coolant level too low

Engine coolant temperature too high

Engine oil pressure too low

Brake fluid level too low

Parking brake engaged

Put the shuttle lever into neutral


position
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 103

SETUP MENU

Dimmer

Increase O
Decrease P

Increase
Decrease
Service
interval

Increase
Decrease

Stored error
code

3-second scroll unless the switch is


pressed

“Grid heater”
presence Select / Deselect

Low and high Increase O


idle speed
Decrease P

HARDWARE
P/N Increase O
Hardware code
ID Decrease P
VER

SOFTWARE
P/N O Press Enter to make the value flash and then set up
Software code
ID P Press Enter to make the value stop flashing
VER

F36739
104 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

PROCEDURE ABOUT SELF TEST

Z    Power up LCD and show


work hours for 10 seconds
Any of the above at with ignition low Maximum foot
accelerator: X.X.
Minimum foot 113/111
accelerator: X.X. field

 
Go to menu
Maximum accelerator
knob: X.X. 125/120
Minimum accelerator field
Normal “Key ON” Z   
knob: X.X.

 
Z   
Initiate Self test
Accelerator pedal %:
XXX 113/122
field
Any of the keys above and with “Key ON” Accelerator knob %: XXX

Check:
Step 1: Lamps switch on at full intensity. 100 mA < Current draw < 1amp  

Requested engine rpm: 98/88


Step 2: Lamps switch off after 2 seconds. XXX field
10 mA < Current draw < 1
mA
 
Step 3: Wait 2 seconds.

Check: Fuel level: XX.X 117/120


Step 4: Instrument backlighting turns on at full intensity. 100 mA < Current draw < 1 A Fuel tank: XX field

 
Step 5: Lamps switch off after 2 seconds.
10 mA < Current draw < 100 mA
Voltage: XX.X
116/124
Transmission oil field
Step 6: Wait 2 seconds. temperature: XX

 
Step 7: Sweep all 5 gauges to maximum angle.
Makes sure that needles can
move freely and have proper
position Brakes: XXX 102/92
Step 8: 2 seconds after maximum angle sweep to red border. Engine rpm: XXXX field

Step 9: 2 seconds after red-green border is reached move to Makes sure that needles are  
properly calibrated to
second red border for voltage.
applique
Radiator water
107/123
temperature XXX field
Step 10: Park all gauges and start LCD test. Air temperature XXX

 
Step 11: When LCD test is complete sound alarm for 2 seconds.

Engine oil temperature:


XXX 122/126
field
Fuel temperature: XXX
Step 12: The following is shown on the LCD display until the key is turned to OFF or the cycle
ends. All gauges and lamps should work as normal and engine will be able to be started.

SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 105

ON BOARD ERROR CODE RETRIEVAL


Z

Stored error code

Z Page 1/6
CODE 3059 3-second scroll unless
the up/down button is
↵ OCCURRENCE 3 pressed
TIME 1004.5

Page 2/6
CODE 3009
OCCURRENCE 2
TIME 1010.6

Page 3/6
CODE 1018
Occurrence counter will be incremented on transition from OCCURRENCE 1
inactive to active status. Status has to be stored in EEPROM
TIME 1024.5
and checked at key on. Only the hour count of the last
occurrence will be stored per SAE convention.
Page 4/6
CODE 3022
OCCURRENCE 1
HOUR 969 .4

Page 5/6
CODE 3113
OCCURRENCE 2
TIME 1050.6

Page 6/6
CODE 1003
OCCURRENCE 3
TIME 1076.4
106 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

BACKLIGHTING AND DIMMING


A proper and uniform backlighting for matrix, gauge DIMMING LAW
pointer and symbols shall be provided.
The dimming adjustment is done through the setup
Separate backlighting electronics shall be provided menu, it can be used in single.
for matrix and symbols-gauge pointers. The back- In single step mode, the luminance level go from
lighting will be achieved by LEDs and dimming shall min to max value in 10 steps.
be provided through the setup menu selections.
The luminance levels of display and gauges always
The backlighting shall go at its maximum level varies in parallel.
when the front, rear and driving lights are off.
The cluster switches between day and night lumi-
The gauges backlighting dimming is switched on
nance levels using the work and driving light status,
when the cluster sees a HIGH level on front work
and is able to manage the display and gauges inde-
lights, rear work lights or driving lights for more then
pendently using the same law and customer set-
100 ms.
ting.
The lamps intensity is decreased when side lights Only the night settings can be adjusted since the
are activated. The 2 different luminance levels are day setting of the display is 100% intensity.
defined as 100% during daytime use and 50%
when backlighting is active. During dimming setup the matrix shows the dim-
ming symbol together with the percentage of lumi-
The display intensity of luminance will be 6 cd/m2
nance: its value varies using a step of 10%.
(not dimmed).
The dimming symbol appears when the proper
The maximum available luminance spread will be menu is selected and stays on the matrix for at
30%. least 2 seconds.
To avoid dark zones the maximum difference of The dot matrix visualization will be as follows:
intensity of luminance between closed points is 15%.
Note that the matrix backlighting may go to 0 by
customer selection.
The lamps and the audible alarm will warn the cus-
tomer of an alarm condition occurring. The default value is 80% and the may go to zero if
set by the customer.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 107

WORK HOURS
In order to allow service or the customer to view - once in the adjustment mode the meaning of the
vehicle hours of operation, it will not be necessary arrow UP switch is “increase hourmeter value”,
to have the key. and the meaning of arrow DOWN switch is
“decrease hourmeter value”. Single switch pres-
By pressing the menu enter/display scroll switch,
sure will increase or decrease the value of one
with the key turned to OFF, the instrument cluster
unit (6 min). Continuous switch pressure will
panel will activate and display the service hours for
increase or decrease the value continuously (1
10 seconds.
every 300 milliseconds): when the value reaches
The hourmeter increments when the engine is a multiple of 10, the increment/decrement rate is
running (rpm> 600). The hours are displayed 10 units every 300 ms; when the value reaches a
starting from 0.0 until 210,554,060.7 using an multiple of 100, the rate is 100 units every 300
interval of 6 minutes. ms; when the value reaches a multiple of 1000,
In case of battery disconnection, the cluster can the rate is 1000 units every 300 ms.
lose 0.1 hour or 6 minutes max.
During continuous setting the value stops flashing.
WORK HOURS SETTING
Once the operator has reached the desired value
In order to allow service to install a new Vehicle
press and hold down the arrow UP and display
Control Module (VCM) on an old vehicle, it is possi-
switches for 15 seconds to end setting procedure.
ble to increase (no decrease will be allowed) the
hour to the same setting as the original. It is not possible to set a value lower than the cur-
rent one, and the procedure can be repeated three
To modify the hourmeter value, execute the follow-
times in the cluster life.
ing procedure:
- select the hourmeter function on the display;
- press and hold depressed for 15 seconds “arrow
UP” and “display” until the value shown on dis-
play starts to blink (1 Hz, duty 50%);

Work hours

Power up LCD and show work hours


for 10 seconds
Any of the above at with ignition low

To save the new value


Hourmeter setting

0.1, 1, 10, 100 or 1000 hours


step depending on
With the key turned to ON, press for 15 continuous time pressed
seconds
Blinking to indicate ability to edit To exit without saving
values

Value may only increase for the hourmeter. While setting the value it can be decreased due to
operator overshoot, but the value can not be stored if it is below the current stored value. Pressing
DISPLAY will exit without saving. ENTER must be pressed to store the modified value in protected
memory.
108 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

OPERATION
Auto wake up at every 600 ms for sensing a With the key OFF, all indicators set to the parking
change in ENTER, DISPLAY, UP or DOWN switch position. The parking position is hard to obtain with
status will be provided. Upon sensing of one of the internal stops of the stepper motor. With the key
those inputs transition, the cluster has to wake up. ON, follow the procedure below.
As a general rule, at engine start-up, it is necessary
to deactivate all alarms and instrument gauges,
unless an error is detected on the starting line.

Needle collision
control at key-on
At key-on drive all
needles CCW for 1
second

Vibration, service,
TRUE
transport or If RTZ is observed
battery loss can on all 5 gauges
generate a FALSE

FALSE
Remove power from gauges:
- engine coolant
- fuel level

Drive gauges until they reach:


- tachometer
- transmission temp
- battery voltage

Drive gauges:
- engine coolant
- fuel level
Start all normal
display functions
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 109

TACHOMETER ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE INDICATOR


The tachometer accuracy should be less than or A stepper motor will drive coolant temperature
equal ±50 rpm. gauge. The gauge accuracy should be less than or
equal 3%. Needle calibration has never to be lost
The above-specified tolerances must be respected
for any external condition.
in all operating ranges (temperature, voltage, etc.).
A stepper motor will drive the tachometer. INSTRUMENT TEMPERATURE
Needle calibration has never to be lost for any
Gauge indication range +65 to +112 °C
external condition.
(+149 to +234 °F)
The message to be used is EEC1.
Green field +65 to +106 °C
(+149 to 223 °F)
EEC1 MESSAGE INSTRUMENT
POSITION Red field +106 to +112 °C
(+223 to 234 °F)
0000 0 rpm
0001 => FFFD According to the value The message to be used is engine temperature.
Green field 0 - 2500 rpm
ENGINE INSTRUMENT
Red field 2500 - 3000 rpm TEMPERATURE POSITION
FFFF 0 rpm MESSAGE
00 => FD According to the logic
above
The behaviour of the gauge in case of faulty sensor
will be to return to the parked position. FE Minimum value
Since this signal is a function of the engine control- FF Minimum value
ler the appropriate warning lamp and lamp will be
illuminated.
An audible alarm must sound when the engine tem-
During cranking, the needle movement shall be fro- perature exceeds 106 °C (223 °F).
zen in order to inhibit any spurious movement of it.
In case the sender is disconnected, the gauge has
to go to 65 °C (149 °F) position.
Reconnecting the sensor the gauge has to return to
the correct position.
Both the movements have to be uniform.
The behaviour of the gauge in case of faulty sensor
will be to return to the parked position.
Since this signal is a function of the engine control-
ler the appropriate warning lamp and lamp will be
illuminated.
During cranking, the needle movement shall be fro-
zen in order to inhibit any spurious movement of it.
110 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

VOLTMETER GAUGE TRANSMISSION OIL TEMPERATURE GAUGE


The voltmeter will indicate the voltage of the vehicle The oil temp gauge indicates transmission oil tem-
electric system. perature from 75 °C to 115 °C (167 to 239 °F).
This gauge is broken up into two ranges, green and
This gauge will have three operating ranges: two
red. The green field goes from 75 °C to 106 °C (167
reds and one green.
to 223 °F).
One red range will indicate low voltage. The red zone is from 105 °C to 115.5 °C (221 to
The other red will indicate high voltage. 240 °F).
This gauge will be connected to a sensor that will
The green range will indicate normal operating volt- provide a specific resistance to correlate to a spe-
age. cific oil temperature.
The bottom of the scale is 9 V.
Low voltage range 11 V or less. INSTRUMENT TEMPERATURE

The pointer will be ±3° of the bold centerline indi- Gauge indication range +75 to +115 °C
cating 11 V. (+167 to +239 °F)

The normal operating range will vary between 11 Green field +75 to +106 °C
and 16 V. (+167 to+ 223 °F)
High voltage range 16 V or more. Red field +105 to +115.5 °C
(+221 to +240 °F)
The pointer will be ±3° of the bold centerline indi-
cating 16 V.
The top of the scale will be 18 V. - 5 V = 75 °C (167 °F).
The centerline of the pointer will be at ±2 angular
A stepper motor will drive the voltmeter gauge. degrees from the centerline of the bold reference
The gauge accuracy should be less than or equal 3%. mark that indicates this temperature.
Needle calibration has never to be lost for any - 2.6 V = 93.3 °C (200 °F).
external condition. The centerline of the pointer will be at ±3 angular
degrees from the centerline of the bold reference
Loss of voltmeter sensor will be the loss of the mark that indicates this temperature.
internal VCM A/D converter.
- 2.05 V = 115.5 °C (240 °F).
During cranking, the needle movement shall be fro- The centerline of the pointer will be at ±2 angular
zen in order to inhibit any spurious movement of it. degrees from the centerline of the bold reference
A/D accuracy is specified as ±180 mV during self mark that indicates this temperature.
test operation. The same range of temperature is used for power-
shift and powershuttle transmissions.
The gauge will move by 9 angular degrees at key-
on in the clockwise position, to replicate the current
instrument cluster behaviour.
This is necessary due to the cool temperatures
present when the unit is working in backhoe posi-
tion. In case the sender is disconnected, the gauge
has to go down to home position.
Reconnecting the sensor will make the error code
inactive and the gauge has to return to the correct
position.
Both the movements have to be uniform.
A stepper motor will drive the transmission oil tem-
perature gauge. The gauge accuracy should be
less than or equal ±2%.
Needle calibration has never to be lost for any
external condition. During cranking, the needle
movement shall be frozen in order to inhibit any
spurious movement of it.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 111

FUEL LEVEL GAUGE


When a certain low fuel level is reached, the rele-
vant “low fuel” lamp will be lit according to the fol-
lowing logic.
The filtering of the data read is obtained with a hys-
teresis on the resistance value joined to a delay
time of 2 seconds.
Ohmic parameter threshold and delay time value
must be kept in NVM.
Lamp activation depends on values used for needle
movement; this means that at key-on the low fuel
level warning is active if the cluster sees a resist-
ance value greater the table below.

Resistance values
The fuel level gauge will indicate the fuel level of the
vehicle tank.
The gauge dial will be divided into two ranges: red
and green.
The red range will indicate a low fuel zone. The
green range will indicate a non-low fuel zone.
This gauge will be connected to a sensor that will
provide specific a resistance to correlate to a spe-
cific fuel tank level.

TANK SIZE EMPTY VALUE (X) RED-GREEN FULL VALUE (Z) INDICATED FUEL
BORDER (Y) LEVEL
133 litres 320 Ohm 186 Ohm 6.5 Ohm 30% with 18
(29.25 gal) angular degrees of
gauge motion

- X = empty. The centerline (CL) of the pointer will In case the sender is disconnected, the gauge has
be at +0° / -2° angular degrees from the center- to go down in empty position.
line of this empty mark. Reconnecting the sensor the gauge has to return to
- Y = red - green threshold. The centerline (CL) of the correct position.
the pointer will be at +/-3 angular degrees from
Both the movements have to be uniform.
the centerline of this “half” mark.
- Z = full. The centerline (CL) of the pointer will be A stepper motor will drive fuel level gauge.
at +4/-0 angular degrees from the centerline of The gauge accuracy should be less than or equal
this “full” mark. ±2%.
Needle calibration has never to be lost for any
external condition.
During cranking, the needle movement shall be fro-
zen in order to inhibit any spurious movement of it.
112 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WARNING SYSTEM
The diagnostic has to inform the operator regarding ALARM ACTIVATION
all the operating conditions of the loader backhoe
Non Critical
which are out of range.
A failure is present but the operator can continue
These conditions are different from each other: his work: the purpose is to warn him regarding the
- warnings; presence of the fault. This will be a 1 second beep
- error codes; every 30 seconds.

- faults in the system; Critical


- required action. A serious fault that can affect either the safety of
the operator or the damage of the loader backhoe
is present: the operator shall stop the loader back-
We can define warnings as all those situations that hoe. This will be a continuous alarm.
could be dangerous for the loader backhoe or for
Action Required
the operator.
The system is asking for a certain manoeuvre from
The diagnostic will move the display to the red the operator in order to return to the normal func-
range or will activate the buzzer. tionality. This will be a continuous alarm.
The display will show the symbol indicating the cur- Safety
rent problem.
The system purpose is to warn the operator regard-
There are conditions in which the diagnostic ing the presence of a dangerous situation for his
detects one of its sensors out of order: in this case safety. This will be a continuous alarm.
it will generate an error code.
General Sound
According to the severity of the failure, it will control
There are certain conditions in which it is necessary
the relevant warning lamp and the audible alarm:
to activate an audible alarm. This is a one second
the display will display the appropriate Icon
beep to draw the operators attention to the cluster.
together with the error code number.
If it is necessary to inform the operator that he/she
has done an incorrect manoeuvre, or that he/she Whenever an audible alarm activation is related to
must perform a special operation (required action), an icon visualization, this icon should remain dis-
the diagnostics will display an icon again or will played at least for 4 seconds in order to give the
activate the relevant buzzer. possibility to the operator to understand the cause
of the alarm activation.
When many warnings with different priority occur,
the audible alarm is related to the higher priority
warning.
When a warning activates with an audible alarm dif-
ferent from the current one, the corresponding icon
must be displayed simultaneously.
If a warning lamp dedicated to a function is associ-
ated to the activation cause of the audible alarm,
the warning lamp will activate together with the
audible alarm.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 113

MAINTENANCE
Two different kinds of maintenance will be availa- HEAVY MAINTENANCE
ble:
From 10 hours before the set value, display on the
- light maintenance; display the “heavy maintenance symbol” at every
- heavy maintenance. key on and should last for 1 second after cranking.
After cranking after this, the last selected icon will
LIGHT MAINTENANCE be visualized on the display. The hours shown will
be the hours when light maintenance is required,
From 2 hours before the set value, display on the
not the standard hours displayed by the hourmeter.
display the “light maintenance symbol” at every key
on for 1 second after cranking; after this, the last
selected icon will be visualized on the display. The
HEAVY
hours shown will be the hours when light mainte-
1000
nance is required, not the standard hours displayed
by the hourmeter. Amber-coloured lighting
The interval can be set between 50 and 500 hours
in steps of 100 (0.0, 500, 600, 700, 800, 900,
LIGHT
1000). The 0.0 setting turns the heavy maintenance
500
feature off.
Amber-coloured lighting
The interval can be set between 50 and 500 hours
in steps of 50 (0.0, 50, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300,
350, 400, 450, 500). The 0.0 setting turns the light
maintenance feature off.

DISPLAY FUNCTION

When the hourmeter reaches the light service interval

3 seconds

3 seconds
LIGHT

500

GREEN AMBER
Audible alarm for 1 second when displaying either service interval for the first time

When the hourmeter reaches the heavy service interval

3 seconds

HEAVY 3 seconds

1000
GREEN AMBER

Audible alarm for 1 second when displaying either service interval for the first time

Since heavy maintenance contains light maintenance the following will be shown:
500 - Light
1000 - Heavy
1500 - Light
2000 - Heavy
The service indicator message will be cleared with a single key cycle
114 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

WARNING MESSAGES

Function Lamp Alarm Lamp Display Condition DTC SA Description Priority Colour
lamp

Engine
Coolant Coolant
coolant
STOP Continuous above 111 °C 1002 VCM temperature 3 Red
temperature
for 5 seconds signal - too high
too high

Engine oil Oil pressure


pressure too STOP Continuous 3028 ECU sensor - 3 Red
low pressure too low

The engine
Switch
Transmission must be running
closed to
oil pressure STOP Continuous 1008 VCM with switch 3 Red
ground for 25
too low closed for 25
seconds
seconds

Timeout of CAN
DTC for 200
Malfunction STOP Continuous 3334 ECU message TCS1 3 Red
ms
Speed

Timeout of CAN
DTC for 200
Malfunction STOP Continuous 3339 ECU message TCS1 3 Red
ms
Speed

5 seconds
Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1051 ECU 3 Red
message
message

5 seconds
Timeout of CAN
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1052 VCM 3 Red
message EEC3
message

25 seconds
Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1053 ECU 3 Red
message
message

5 seconds Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1054 VCM message engine 3 Red
message temperature

5 seconds Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1055 VCM message inlet/ 3 Red
message exhaust

5 seconds Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1056 VCM message engine 3 Red
message fluid

5 seconds Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1057 VCM message 3 Red
message electric system
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 115

Function Lamp Alarm Lamp Display Condition DTC SA Description Priority Colour
lamp

5 seconds
Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1058 VCM 3 Red
CAN message
message

5 seconds Time-out of
Malfunction STOP Continuous without 1059 VCM message 3 Red
message Display

Transmission Transmission
Transmission oil
oil oil above
STOP Continuous 1009 VCM temperature 3 Red
temperature 115 °C for 5
limit reached
too high seconds

Generic Only display


DTC’s 3000 -
message from STOP Continuous with display 3 Red
3366
the engine request

One touch idle


AUTO N/A VCM 3 Red
active
n/min

Continuous, Switch This prevents


Parking brake
if vehicle is in closed to N/A VCM damaging the 3 Red
engaged
gear ground parking brake

One second
Engine oil Pressure
alarm upon
pressure too depends on 3032 ECU 3 Amber
activation per
high speed
key cycle

One second
Battery
alarm upon Battery voltage
voltage too 3051 ECU 3 Amber
activation per too high
high
key cycle

One second Supply


Battery
alarm upon source above Battery voltage
voltage too 1014 VCM 3 Amber
activation per 16 V for 5 above 16 V
high
key cycle seconds

Battery One second


charge alarm upon Battery voltage
3052 ECU 3 Amber
voltage too activation per too low
low key cycle

One second Supply


Battery
alarm upon source below Battery voltage
voltage too 1015 VCM 3 Amber
activation per 11 V for 5 below 11 V
low
key cycle seconds

One second Alternator L+


Alternator Alternator
alarm upon terminal
unable to 1050 VCM unable to 3 Amber
activation per under 1.5 V
charge charge
key cycle for 5 seconds
116 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

Function Lamp Alarm Lamp Display Condition DTC SA Description Priority Colour
lamp

One second IVS not


Accelerator Foot accelerator
alarm upon changing
pedal signal 1010 VCM sensor - not 3 Amber
activation per state in 300
out of range plausible
key cycle ms

One second Throttle


Accelerator Foot accelerator
alarm upon above 95%
pedal signal 1011 VCM sensor -signal 3 Amber
activation per of input for 5
out of range above range
key cycle sec.

One second Throttle


Accelerator Foot accelerator
alarm upon below 5% of
pedal signal 1012 VCM sensor -signal 3 Amber
activation per input for 5
out of range below range
key cycle sec.

One second
Accelerator Foot accelerator
alarm upon
pedal signal 1013 VCM sensor - no 3 Amber
activation per
out of range signal
key cycle

One second Foot accelerator


Accelerator Accelerator
alarm upon sensor - shorted
pedal signal above 5,3 V 1029 VCM 3 Amber
activation per high to battery
out of range for 5 seconds
key cycle voltage

One second Voltage Foot accelerator


Accelerator
alarm upon below 200 sensor - shorted
pedal signal 1030 VCM 3 Amber
activation per mV for 5 low to battery
out of range
key cycle seconds voltage

One second
Foot Voltage Foot accelerator
alarm upon
accelerator above 5.2 V 1023 VCM supply voltage 3 Amber
activation per
supply 5 V for 5 seconds too high
key cycle

One second
Foot Voltage Foot accelerator
alarm upon
accelerator below 4,8 V 1024 VCM supply voltage 3 Amber
activation per
supply 5 V for 5 seconds too low
key cycle

One second Foot accelerator


Foot Voltage
alarm upon supply shorted
accelerator above 5,3 V 1025 VCM 3 Amber
activation per high to battery
supply 5 V for 5 seconds
key cycle voltage

One second Voltage Foot accelerator


Foot
alarm upon below 200 supply voltage
accelerator 1026 VCM 3 Amber
activation per mV for 5 shorted low to
supply 5 V
key cycle seconds ground

One second Throttle Accelerator


Accelerator
alarm upon above 95% knob sensor -
knob signal 1035 VCM 3 Amber
activation per of input for 5 signal above
out of range
key cycle sec. range
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 117

Function Lamp Alarm Lamp Display Condition DTC SA Description Priority Colour
lamp

One second Throttle Accelerator


Accelerator
alarm upon below 5% of knob sensor -
knob signal 1036 VCM 3 Amber
activation per input for 5 signal above
out of range
key cycle sec. range

One second
Accelerator Accelerator
alarm upon
knob signal 1037 VCM knob sensor - 3 Amber
activation per
out of range no signal
key cycle

One second Accelerator


Accelerator Voltage
alarm upon knob sensor -
knob signal above 5,3 V 1038 VCM 3 Amber
activation per shorted high to
out of range for 5 seconds
key cycle battery voltage

One second Voltage Accelerator


Accelerator
alarm upon below 200 knob sensor -
knob signal 1039 VCM 3 Amber
activation per mV for 5 shorted low to
out of range
key cycle seconds ground

One second
Accelerator Voltage Accelerator
alarm upon
knob supply above 5.2 V 1031 VCM knob supply 3 Amber
activation per
5V for 5 seconds voltage too high
key cycle

One second
Accelerator Voltage Accelerator
alarm upon
knob supply below 4.8 V 1032 VCM knob supply 3 Amber
activation per
5V for 5 seconds voltage too low
key cycle

One second Accelerator


Accelerator Voltage
alarm upon knob supply
knob supply above 5,3 V 1033 VCM 3 Amber
activation per voltage shorted
5V for 5 seconds
key cycle high

One second Voltage Accelerator


Accelerator
alarm upon below 200 knob supply
knob supply 1034 VCM 3 Amber
activation per mV for 5 voltage shorted
5V
key cycle seconds low

Boost
One second
Boost air temperature Engine over
alarm upon
temperature over 1018 VCM operating boost 3 Amber
activation per
too high 95 °C for 5 air temperature
key cycle
seconds

Engine Engine over


Coolant
coolant Lamp Alarm LCD operating
deleted
above 107 °C 1019 VCM Green
temperature deleted deleted coolant
for 5 seconds
too high temperature

Engine
Coolant
coolant Lamp Alarm LCD
deleted
3007 ECU temperature 3 Green
temperature deleted deleted
signal high
too high
118 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

Function Lamp Alarm Lamp Display Condition DTC SA Description Priority Colour
lamp

Transmission One second


Coolant
oil Lamp alarm upon LCD Gauge entered
deleted
above 105 °C 1020 VCM 3 Green
temperature activation per deleted red area
for 5 seconds
above 105 °C key cycle

One second Fuel over


Fuel Excessive fuel
alarm upon
temperature 82 °C for 5 1021 VCM operating 3 Amber
activation per
too high seconds temperature
key cycle

One second Fuel


Fuel
alarm upon temperature
temperature 3015 ECU 3 Amber
activation per signal source
too high
key cycle high

One second
Fuel Fuel
alarm upon
temperature 3016 ECU temperature 3 Amber
activation per
too high signal no signal
key cycle

One second Switch


Clogged air alarm upon closed to Air filter
1001 VCM 3 Amber
filter activation per ground for 5 threshold
key cycle seconds

One second
Fuel
alarm upon Display
contaminated 1022 VCM 3 Amber
activation per message
with water
key cycle

One second
Engine RPM
Engine over alarm upon Engine over
over 2750 for 1040 VCM 3 Amber
speed activation per speed warning
5 sec.
key cycle

Engine RPM
Engine over Engine over
STOP Continuous over 3000 for 1041 VCM 3 Red
speed speed fault
5 sec.

One second Fuel sender


Fuel sender
Fuel level alarm upon shorted low -
below 2 ohm 1044 VCM 3 Amber
sensor activation per instrument in
for 5 seconds
key cycle stand-by

One second Input is Fuel sender


Fuel level alarm upon switched open circuit -
1045 VCM 3 Amber
sensor activation per battery for 5 instrument in
key cycle seconds stand-by
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 119

Function Lamp Alarm Lamp Display Condition DTC SA Description Priority Colour
lamp

Transmission
One second Transmission
Transmission temperature
alarm upon temperature
temperature sender below 1047 VCM 3 Amber
activation per sender shorted
sensor 3 ohm for 5
key cycle low
seconds

Engine
Mechanical One second Engine
temperature
engine alarm upon temperature
sender below 1067 VCM 3 Amber
temperature activation per sender shorted
3 ohm for 5
sensor key cycle low
sec

One second
General Only display
alarm upon DTC’s 3000 -
display VCM with display 3 Amber
activation per 3366
message request
key cycle

One second Low fuel - must


Low fuel alarm upon stay on for
VCM 5 Amber
warning activation per remaining key
key cycle cycle

Hour meter
9001 VCM Internal error 5 Green
plausibility

Hour meter
RAM
9002 VCM Internal error 5 Green
checksum
failure

Receive buffer
9003 VCM Internal error 5 Green
overflow

EEPROM
checksum
failure, 9004 VCM Internal error 5 Green
hourmeter
location 1

EEPROM
checksum
failure, 9005 VCM Internal error 5 Green
hourmeter
location 2

EEPROM
checksum
failure, 9006 VCM Internal error 5 Green
hourmeter
location 3

Abnormal
reset
9007 VCM Internal error 5 Green
watchdog
timeout
120 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

Function Lamp Alarm Lamp Display Condition DTC SA Description Priority Colour
lamp

One second
A/D fault foot alarm upon
9008 VCM 5 Amber
throttle activation per
key cycle

One second
A/D fault foot alarm upon
9009 VCM 3 Amber
throttle power activation per
key cycle

One second
A/D fault hand alarm upon
9010 VCM 3 Amber
throttle activation per
key cycle

One second
A/D fault foot alarm upon
9011 VCM 3 Amber
throttle activation per
key cycle

One second
A/D fault fuel alarm upon
9012 VCM 3 Amber
level activation per
key cycle
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 121

STARTING SYSTEM

OPERATION CHECKING THE STARTER MOTOR SYSTEM


The system includes a key switch, a reinforced wir- To troubleshoot the starter motor system rapidly
ing, a starter motor and a relay-solenoid valve and easily, it is recommended that a battery-starter
assembly. motor testing device (quick discharge) be used,
which includes a 0 - 20 V voltmeter and a 0 - 500 A
The starter motor has a built-in solenoid valve and ammeter to detect problems in the starter motor
a positive engagement drive system. system.
When the key switch is operated with the forward Use a testing device in accordance with the manu-
and reverse travel lever in neutral position, the facturer’s instructions.
solenoid coils are energized and cause the piston
to be magnetically drawn inside the solenoid. If a testing device of the type indicated is not availa-
ble, use a standard 0 - 20 V voltmeter and a 0 - 500 A
This movement causes the drive pinion to mesh
ammeter to check the operation of the starter motor
with the ring gear on the engine flywheel. on the vehicle.
When the pinion touches the ring gear, the piston of Before testing:
the solenoid valve closes a series of contacts ena-
bling the battery to directly power all four field coils, - check that the battery is fully charged.
thus providing full power to the starter motor. - check that no wire of the starting system is cut or
The starter motor contains a single set of contacts stripped and that the connections are not loose.
and a solenoid valve piston, which completely - check that the motor is not seized.
closes the contacts, even if the teeth of the pinion
are not perfectly aligned with the teeth of the ring
gear.
In this case, a spring is compressed and forces the
complete engagement of the pinion as soon as the
starter motor starts rotating.
Once the ignition is turned off, the solenoid and the
starter motor are de-energized.
The solenoid’s recoil spring causes the drive pinion
to be uncoupled and the contacts of the solenoid to
reopen.
122 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

Current draw on the starter motor system


Disconnect the ground cable (negative) from the
battery (3).
Disconnect the positive cable from the battery on
the solenoid of the starter motor. Connect the posi-
tive cable of the ammeter (1) to the positive terminal
of the battery and the negative cable to the input
terminal of the solenoid.
Reconnect the ground cable (negative) of the bat-
tery to the negative terminal of the battery.
Connect the positive cable of the voltmeter (2) to
the positive terminal of the battery and the negative
cable of the voltmeter to the negative terminal of the
battery.
Disconnect the injection pump fuel inlet cut-off wire
from the solenoid.
Start the motor and observe the values indicated by
the voltmeter and ammeter. The voltage must
remain steady at around 12 V with a current draw of
250 to 300 A.
If the current draw is within the indicated range, the
starter motor (4) is operating correctly.
If the voltage drops during the test, refer to chapter
“Resistance on the system of the starter motor sys-
tem”.
If the current draw is higher than the specified
range, check the system as indicated below.
If tests of the starting system have proved satisfac-
tory, the starter motor is defective and must be
removed in order to identify the source of the prob-
lem.
If the current draw is less than the specified range,
the starter motor is defective and must be removed
in order to identify the source of the problem.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 123

RESISTANCE ON THE SYSTEM OF THE STARTER MOTOR


(Voltage lowering)
If the current draw is excessive, it is necessary to
check the system according to the voltage drop
occurring between its single components.
IMPORTANT: disconnect the injection pump fuel
inlet cut-off wire from the solenoid.
Positive cable of the battery
Connect the positive cable of the voltmeter (1) to
the positive terminal of the battery (2).
Connect the negative cable of the voltmeter (1) to
the battery terminal of the starter motor solenoid
valve (3).
Start the starter motor and observe the reading on
the voltmeter. If the voltage drop exceeds 0.2 V,
check and retighten the cable connections. Check
the voltage again. If it is still excessive, replace the
cable.

Starter motor connections to ground


Connect the positive cable of the voltmeter (1) to
the body of the starter motor (2).
Connect the negative cable of the voltmeter (1) to
the motor block (3).
Start the starter motor and observe the reading on
the voltmeter. If the voltage drop exceeds 0.2 V,
check and retighten the cable connections, check
the ground connections between the starter motor
clamp and the undercarriage.

Ground cable of the battery


Connect the positive cable of the voltmeter (1) to
the motor block (2).
Connect the negative cable of the voltmeter (1) to
the negative terminal of the battery (3).
Start the starter motor and observe the reading on
the voltmeter. If the voltage drop exceeds 0.2 V,
check and retighten the ground cable connections.
Check the voltage again. If it is still excessive,
replace the ground cable.
124 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

STARTER MOTOR
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Manufacturer .............................................................................................................................................Denso
Voltage .........................................................................................................................................................12 V
Rated power............................................................................................................................................. 2.7 kW
Starting system .......................................................................................................................................Positive
Operating time.............................................................................................................................................. 30 s
Direction of rotation .................................................................................... Clockwise seen from the pinion side
Weight ......................................................................................................................................... 8.4 kg (18.5 lb)
Maximum consumption without load at 11 V and 3000 rpm minimum ...................................... 200 A maximum
Maximum consumption with a torque of 19.6 Nm (14.5 lbf·ft) at 8 V and 1130 rpm minimum . 600 A maximum
Maximum consumption when shimming at 3 V with a torque of 39.2 Nm (568 lbf·ft) minimum ......1400 A maximum

MAIN COMPONENTS
1. Motor
2. Induction coils
3. Armature
4. Commutator
5. Brush assembly
6. Pinion gear
7. Intermediate pinion
8. Solenoid
9. Clutch
10. Drive pinion
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 125
126 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

1. Shim
2. Bearing
3. Armature
4. Bearing
5. Coils housing
6. Protection
7. Brush spring
8. Brush assembly
9. Disc
10. Cover
11. Screw
12. Screw
13. Drain
14. Screw
15. Protection
16. Gasket
17. Washer
18. Nut
19. Rod
20. Connection assembly
21. Screw
22. Connection assembly
23. Nut
24. Ring
25. Roller
26. Cage
27. Pinion
28. Ball
29. Spring
30. Drain
31. Screw
32. Washer
33. O-ring
34. Flange
35. Pinion, rings and spring assembly
36. O-ring
37. Bearing
38. Bearing
39. Spring
40. Shaft
41. Body
42. Clutch assembly
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 127

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION


Disconnect the ground cable (negative) from the
battery.
Remove the rear protection cover and disconnect all
cables connected to the starter motor.
Remove the three retaining screws of the starter
motor and remove the starter motor.
To install the starter motor again, proceed in the
reverse order to that of removal.

TEST BENCH CHECK


Check
NOTE: before carrying out the test, check that the
battery is fully charged then obtain a battery-starter
motor testing device (quick discharge) and a carbon
cell (variable load resistance).
Lock the starter motor in a vice with soft jaws.
Connect the negative cable (4) of the battery to the
mounting flange of the starter motor.
Connect a short cable (6) between the solenoid bat-
tery wire and the terminals of the solenoid switch.
Connect the positive cable of the voltmeter (3) to
the positive terminal of the battery and the negative
cable to the negative terminal of the battery, the
positive cable of the ammeter (1) to the positive ter-
minal of the battery and the negative terminal the
solenoid valve battery or to the starter motor clamp.
Install a tachometer (5) at the end of the armature
shaft. Activate the starter motor by adjusting the car-
bon cell (2) to obtain a voltage of 11 V.
When the armature is rotating at 3000 rpm, the max-
imum current draw must not exceed 200 A.
If the starter motor does not operate in these condi-
tions, check that the field coils are not grounded,
that the armature is not rubbing and that its shaft is
not deformed.
128 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

Armature
The surface of the commutator must be clean and
without traces of burns. If necessary, remove traces
of burns using fine sandpaper. Do not use emery
cloth. Then, clean the commutator with a cloth
soaked in gasoline.
After rectifying the commutator, polish it with fine
sandpaper, then wipe it with a cloth soaked in gaso-
line.
NOTE: make sure not to graze the metal of the com-
mutator during rectification of insulating notches.
The resistance of the armature insulation may be
checked by connecting an ohmmeter (1) between
the blades of the commutator (2) and the armature
shaft (3). The resistance must be infinite (no conti-
nuity).
To check that the armature is not short-circuited, a
special device for armatures must be used. The
other solution is to replace the armature.
If the circumference of the armature has come into
contact with the starter pole shoes, the bearings of
the armature are probably excessively worn out.
First check that the starter pole shoes have been
tightened and that the armature rotates without any
concentric defect. If necessary, replace the arma-
ture bearings.
Field coils
To check the resistance of the field coil insulation,
connect an ohmmeter (1) between the brushes of
each induction coil (2) and a clean unpainted area
of the body (3). The resistance must be infinite (no
continuity).
To check the continuity of the field coils, connect
an ohmmeter between the brushes of each induc-
tion coil and the main supply terminal (the thick-
est braided wire). The resistance must be equal
to 1 MW.
If the field coils are defective, the entire assembly
consisting of the body and the field coils must be
replaced.
Drive pinion
The drive pinion must only rotate clockwise. If the
pinion is seized or turns in both directions or if its
teeth are damaged, change the complete drive
assembly.
NOTE: if the teeth of the drive pinion are damaged,
also check the teeth of the engine flywheel ring
gear.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 129

TROUBLESHOOTING
STARTING SYSTEM
The motor does not start when the starter switch key is operated and the transmission is in the neutral position.

Is the battery properly charged?


NO Charge or replace the battery.
YES
Check the starter motor wiring. Are there bad
connections, cut or stripped cables? YES Repair or replace the cables.

NO

Is the starter motor seized? YES Repair or replace the starter motor.

NO
Operate the starter switch key. Is there Does the solenoid
a voltage of +12 V on the (white) input Windings, brush or starter
YES make a “clicking” YES
wire of the starting solenoid valve motor mechanism possibly
sound?
(terminal 30)? defective.
NO
NO

Check the starter motor relay (K01). Can you hear


the relay operate after operating the starter switch Solenoid possibly
key? defective. Remove the
starter motor and inspect.
NO

Remove the connector from the relay (K01). Is there a voltage of +12 V
at terminal 86 (white/black) after the starter switch key is operated? YES Replace the relay.

NO

Check the starter motor safety relay (K3). Can one hear the relay
operate after operating the reverse travel lever?
NO

Remove the connector from relay K3. Is there a voltage of +12 V at


YES Replace the relay.
terminal 86 (white/black) after the reverse travel lever is operated?
NO
Are the cable wires of the reverse travel lever properly Reconnect the wires to the
NO
connected? switch.
YES

Does the reverse travel lever switch operate correctly? NO Replace the switch.
YES
Check the main power supply
Are the indicators on the instrument panel correctly lighted between the battery and the
after operating the key switch? NO
starter motor key. Pin 2 (red
YES wire) of the ignition key
connector.
Are the cable wires of the key switch connected correctly?

YES NO

Replace the key switch. Reconnect the wires to the key switch.
130 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

STARTER MOTOR

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


The starter motor does not run Too low specific density and Inspect the battery.
(the magnetic switch makes no battery level.
operating noise).
Poor ignition switch system Replace the wiring harness and the
connection or contact. ignition switch.
Malfunction of the coil or of the Replace the magnetic switch.
magnetic switch pull-in piston.
The starter motor does not run Too low specific density and Inspect the battery.
(the magnetic switch makes an battery level.
operating noise).
Poor start-up system contact. Repair the wiring harness.
Poor magnetic switch contact. Replace the magnetic switch.
Motor malfunction (e.g. short Repair or replace the motor
circuit, brush wear). assembly.
The starter motor runs too slowly. Poor magnetic switch contact. Replace the magnetic switch.
Motor malfunction (e.g. short Repair or replace the motor
circuit, brush wear). assembly.
The starter motor running cannot The pinion gear does not engage Repair or replace the clutch and the
crank the engine. with the ring gear. control lever.
Sliding clutch. Replace the clutch.
Anomalous noise. Anomalous bushing wear. Replace the bushing.
Wear on pinion gear or ring gear Replace the clutch and the ring gear.
tooth tips.
Poor pinion gear sliding. Lubricate or replace the clutch.
The pinion gear springs. Poor ignition switch return. Replace the ignition switch.
Field coil loss. Pinion gear disengagement fault Replace the magnetic switch.
caused by a coil short circuit in
Magnetic switch coil burnt, etc.
the magnetic switch.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 131

ALTERNATOR

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Manufacturer............................................................................................................................................. Denso
Rated voltage............................................................................................................................................... 12 V
Polarity .................................................................................................................... Negative terminal grounded
Current ........................................................................................................................................................ 90 A
Minimum charging speed..................................................................................................................... 1400 rpm
Maximum speed................................................................................................................................... 9000 rpm
Operating temperature.................................................................................... -30 °C to 90 °C (-435 to 1305 °F)
Direction of rotation.................................................................................... Clockwise seen from the pulley side
Regulated voltage at 5000 rpm with 10 A at 25 °C (362 °F) ...........................................................14.2 - 14.8 V
Maximum load that can be applied at terminal L ........................................................................12 V, 3.4 W x 6

OPERATION
The alternator, installed on the motor, on the front
RH side of the vehicle, is driven by the crankshaft
pulley with the help of a belt.
The alternator contains built-in regulators.
Current draw on the starter motor system:
When the ignition key is turned, a current of low
intensity is sent by the battery to the field winding of
the rotor (terminal IG).
At this stage, the indicator lamp (terminal L) turns
on and the rotor is partially magnetized.
When the motor starts and the partially magnetized
rotor rotates inside the stator, a three-phase alter-
nating current is generated (terminal B+). 1. Ground connection
2. Terminal P: motor tachometer
A constant portion of this current is transformed into
a direct current by three excitation diodes installed 3. Terminal L: charge indicator
in the rectifier. 4. Terminal B+: charge +12 V
The direct current is sent as reinforcement through 5. Terminal IG: +12 V after ignition (10 A fuse)
the field winding of the rotor.
Using this method an increase in the magnetic field
of the rotor is obtained, as well as a rapid rise in the
voltage and current generated at the output.
The luminosity of the indicator lamp decreases
when the voltage generated at the output is increas-
ing (terminal L).
The indicator lamp goes out when the voltage at ter-
minal “L” is equal to that of the battery.
The voltage continues to increase up to the value
predefined by the regulator.
In case the alternator belt is broken, the voltage
does not accumulate in the alternator and the load
indicator lamp remains lighted to indicate the prob-
lem.
132 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

DIAGRAM OF THE CHARGING SYSTEM

1. Alternator 6. Battery
2. Output winding 7. Key switch
3. Rectifier 8. Charge indicator
4. Regulator 9. Speedometer
5. Starter motor
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 133

COMPONENTS

1. Front housing 16. Sealing ring


2. Rear housing 17. Sealing ring
3. Rectifier 18. Washer
4. Brush holder 19. Screw
5. Regulator 20. Electric terminal
6. Rear protective 21. Screw
7. Insulation ring 22. Bearing
8. Insulation ring 23. Flange
9. Screw 24. Flange
10. Screw 25. Stator
11. Nut 26. Stud screw
12. Nut 27. Bearing
13. Rotor 28. Plate
14. Pulley 29. Screw
15. Pulley nut
134 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

REMOVAL
Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
Disconnect the battery cable (1) from terminal B+
(2).
Disconnect the connector (3).

Free the tension roller (4) using a suitable wrench,


then remove the belt (5).
Remove the screw (6) and the nut (7).
Remove the screw (8).
Remove the alternator (9).
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 135

PRELIMINARY CHECKS AND TESTS


To prevent damage to components of the alternator PRELIMINARY CHECKS
charging circuit, the following precautions must be
Before undertaking an electric inspection, check
taken during maintenance:
the charging system and the electric system care-
- NEVER connect or disconnect a charging system fully.
connection, including the battery, when the motor Check the state of cables and the tightening of con-
is running. nections.
- NEVER dead short to ground any component of
the charging circuit. Battery check
- ALWAYS disconnect the ground cable from the Check each cell of the battery with a hydrometer.
battery (negative) to recharge the battery on the
The battery must be charged at least 70% and be in
vehicle using a battery charger.
good condition.
- ALWAYS respect the polarity when installing the
battery on the vehicle or when using an auxiliary Drive belt check
battery to start the motor. Check that the belt and the pulley of the alternator
IMPORTANT: connect the positive cable to the are clean, without any trace of oil and grease and
positive terminal and the negative cable to the neg- that they are in good condition.
ative terminal. Indicator lamp check
Turn the ignition key and check that the charge indi-
cator is well lit.
If it is not fully lighted, check its bulb.
If the bulb is OK, check the alternator wire connec-
tions as described in the “Preliminary tests” section
below.
If the indicator lamp is lighted, start the motor and
run it at a speed that is higher than the idling speed.
The indicator lamp must turn off.
If the indicator lamp does not turn off, turn off the
motor and disconnect the ground cable L.
If the indicator lamp goes out, an alternator compo-
nent is defective.
Follow the instructions given in the “Checking the
alternator components” section below.
If the indicator lamp stays lighted, look for a dead
short to ground between the terminal “L” cable and
the indicator lamp.
136 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

PRELIMINARY TESTS
The preliminary tests may be carried out without
removing the charging system components; these
tests help check the following items:
- Connections of the alternator cables
- Charging current and regulated voltage of the
alternator
- Voltage drops in the alternator charging system
- Maximum flow of the alternator
Required devices:
- Voltmeter (0 - 30 V, moving coil)
- Millivoltmeter (0 - 1 V)
- Ammeter (0 - 110 A, moving coil)
- Variable resistance of 1.5 Ohm, 110 A
NOTE: most testing instruments sold in shops group
together several measurement functions in a single
device. Use these devices in accordance with the
manufacturer’s instructions.

CHECKING THE CONNECTIONS OF THE


ALTERNATOR CABLES
Disconnect the battery.
Disconnect the terminals B+ (2) and L (3) from the
alternator.
Reconnect the battery and turn the ignition key
without starting the motor. Connect a voltmeter (4)
between each terminal (B+ or L) and the ground (1).
The voltmeter must show the battery voltage.
If there is no battery voltage, the external cable has
a continuity fault; in this case, check the entire sys-
tem and carry out the necessary repairs.
Connect the terminal L indicator lamp wire to the
ground. The indicator lamp should turn on.
Disconnect the battery and reconnect the cables to
the alternator.
NOTE: if the indicator lamp does not turn on after
reconnecting the cable to the alternator, the regula-
tor of the alternator or the rotor systems are defec-
tive. Make sure that terminal L is clean, then check
the components of the alternator as indicated in this
chapter.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 137

CHECKING THE CHARGING CURRENT AND


THE REGULATED VOLTAGE
Make sure that all electric components are powered
off and that the ignition is turned off (key on “off”).
Disconnect the negative terminal from the battery
and disconnect terminal B+ (4) from the alternator.
Connect an ammeter (1) between the disconnected
cable (3) and terminal B+ of the alternator.
Connect a voltmeter (2) between terminal B+ of the
alternator and the ground.
Reconnect the battery. Start the motor and run it at
a speed of 2000 rpm. Observe the values shown on
the ammeter and the voltmeter.
The voltage shown on the voltmeter should at first
be very high and then should stabilize between
14.2 - 14.8 V when the value on the ammeter
drops below 10 A.
If the voltmeter stabilizes at a voltage greater than
14.8 V, the regulator of the alternator needs to be
replaced.
On the other hand, if the voltmeter stabilizes below
14.2 V, a component of the alternator is defective or
the resistance in the external connections of the
charging circuit is too high.
If the ammeter indicates zero amps, an alternator
component is defective.
Turn off the motor and carry out the operations
described in the “Checking the alternator compo-
nents”.
138 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

CHECK OF VOLTAGE DROPS IN CHARGING


SYSTEM
Voltage drop on insulated side
Make sure that the starter switch key is turned to
OFF.
Disconnect the negative cable from the battery and
disconnect cable B+ (1) from the alternator.
Connect a millivoltmeter (4) between the positive
terminal of the battery and cable B+ (5) (positive
side on cable).
Connect an ammeter (2) between terminal B+ of the
alternator and cable B+ (negative side on cable).
Reconnect the negative cable of the battery and
connect a variable resistance (3) between the bat-
tery terminals by adjusting the cursor to the mini-
mum current draw (maximum resistance).
Start the motor and increase its speed to 2000 rpm.
Gradually reduce the resistance until the ammeter
shows 90 A.
Observe the millivoltmeter, which must not indicate
a value that is greater than 400 millivolts.
If the value exceeds 400 millivolts, the resistance of
the external system is too high. If the output value of
the alternator is not sufficient and the millivoltmeter
indicates a value that is less than 400 millivolts, an
alternator component is defective.
Carry out the operations described in the “Checking
the alternator components”.
Stop the engine.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 139

Voltage lower on ground side


Make sure that the starter switch key is turned to
OFF.
Check the system as for the previous test, but con-
nect the millivoltmeter (4) between the negative ter-
minal of the battery and the alternator body
(negative side towards the body).
NOTE: make sure that the variable resistance (3) is
in the minimum current draw position (maximum
resistance).
Start the motor and increase its speed to 2000 rpm.
Gradually reduce the resistance until the ammeter
(2) shows 90 A.
Observe the millivoltmeter, which must not indicate
a value that is greater than 200 millivolts.
If the value exceeds 200 millivolts, the resistance of
the external system is too high.
If the output value of the alternator is not sufficient
and the millivoltmeter indicates a value that is less
than 200 millivolts, an alternator component is
defective.
Carry out the operations described in the “Checking
the alternator components”.
Stop the engine.

CHECKING THE MAXIMUM OUTPUT OF THE


ALTERNATOR
Make sure that the starter switch key is turned to
OFF.
Disconnect the negative cable from the battery and
disconnect cable B+ (5) from the alternator.
Connect an ammeter (2) between terminal B+ (1) of
the alternator and the disconnected cable B+ (neg-
ative side towards the cable).
Connect a voltmeter (4) between terminal B+ of the
alternator and the ground.
Reconnect the battery, start the motor and increase
its speed to 2000 rpm.
Gradually reduce the resistance (3) until the amme-
ter shows 90 A.
Observe the voltmeter, which must not indicate a
value that is less than 14.2 V.
If the value lowers below 14.2 V, an alternator com-
ponent is defective.
Carry out the operations described in the “Checking
the alternator components”.
140 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

CHECKING THE ALTERNATOR COMPONENTS


Checking of components must be done only if the
PRELIMINARY TESTS reveal an alternator defect
which relates to the following components:
- regulator;
- continuity of the rotor field winding;
- brushes, springs and slip rings.
NOTE: these checks may be carried out without
removing the alternator from the vehicle.
The alternator must be removed to check the other
components of the alternator.
Refer to the “Removal” section in this chapter.
IMPORTANT: before disconnecting the cables from
the alternator, make sure that the starter switch key
is turned to OFF and that the negative cable of the
battery is disconnected.

Required devices:
- 12 V battery;
- multimeter;
- 2.2 W test lamp.

CHECKING THE ROTOR AND THE RELEVANT


FIELD SYSTEM
Disconnect all cables from the alternator.
Connect a 12 V battery and a 2.2 W test lamp (2) in
series between terminal L (1) and the alternator
body (negative side on body).
The test lamp must turn on.
If the lamp does not turn on, the rotor system is
defective.
Check the brushes, the slip rings and the continuity
of the rotor field windings.
If the inspection reveals that these components are
in good condition, the defect may be due to the reg-
ulator.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 141

CHECKING THE CONTINUITY OF THE ROTOR


FIELD WINDING
Remove the regulator with the brush holder.
Connect an ohmmeter (3) between the two slip
rings (2). The resistance must be 2.6 ohms at 20 °C
(68 °F).
If the resistance is not correct, replace the rotor (1)
as described in the “Removal” section below.

RECTIFIER - CHECKING THE POSITIVE /


NEGATIVE DIODES
Check each of the six diodes separately.
Connect a multimeter (2) in series with one of the
diodes. Place one wire of the multimeter on the con-
necting pin (1) of the diode and the other wire on
the plate where the diode is installed.
Note down the value of the resistance indicated by
the multimeter. Reverse the wires of the multimeter.
The multimeter should indicate infinite resistance
(open circuit) only during the first half of the test. If
this check reveals that a diode is defective, replace
the entire rectifier.

RECTIFIER - CHECKING THE EXCITATION


DIODES
Check each of the excitation diodes separately.
Connect a multimeter (2) in series on the excitation
diode module. Place the negative wire on terminal L
(1) and the other wire on the connection of each
excitation diode (3).
Note down the value of the resistance indicated by
the multimeter. Reverse the wires of the multimeter.
The multimeter should indicate infinite resistance
(open circuit) only during the first half of the test. If
this check reveals that a diode is defective, replace
the entire rectifier.
142 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

STATOR - CHECKING THE CONTINUITY OF THE


WINDING
Check each excitation diode separately by proceed-
ing as follows:
Connect the wires of the ohmmeter (3) between
wires A, B and C (2). The resistance between each
of the wires must be low (0.1 W).
If the resistance is greater than this value, it indi-
cates a possible break in the winding, i.e. an open
circuit.
A lower value (0.0. for example) indicates a short
circuit in the winding.
If the result of this check is not satisfactory, replace
the stator (1) and its casing.

STATOR - CHECKING THE INSULATION


Check the insulation of each winding with respect to
the alternator casing.
There must not be any continuity between the wind-
ing and the casing.
If the ohmmeter (2) indicates any value other than
an open circuit, replace the entire stator (1).

ROTOR CHECK
Before checking the rotor components, inspect the
slip rings to make sure that they are in good condi-
tion.
- Check that the slip rings are clean and smooth.
If necessary, clean them with a cloth soaked in
gasoline.
If the slip rings are burnt, scrape them with very
fine sandpaper (do not use emery cloth) and wipe
them.
NOTE: make sure that the sandpaper is sufficiently
fine in order to obtain a perfect finish of the slip ring
surfaces and avoid premature wear of the brushes.
- If the slip rings are excessively worn, replace the
rotor.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 143

ROTOR - CHECKING THE CONTINUITY OF THE


FIELD WINDING
Connect an ohmmeter (3) between the two slip
rings (2). The resistance must be 2.6 ohms at 20 °C
(68 °F).
If the resistance is incorrect, replace the rotor (1).

ROTOR - CHECKING THE INSULATION OF THE


FIELD WINDING
Using an ohmmeter (3), measure the resistance
between each slip ring (2) and the rotor terminals
(1).
The resistance should always be infinite.
If a resistance is not infinite, replace the rotor.
144 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT CAUSE ACTION


Not recharged. Recharging system interrupted Check the connections of the
(warning lamp, fuse, connector, recharging system, clean and
etc.). tighten the alternator and battery
terminals.
Voltage regulator inefficient. Replace the part.
Rotor winder interrupted. Replace the part.
Worn brushes. Replace the part.
Recharge insufficient. Slackened fan belt. Supply the correct voltage.
Voltage regulator faulty. Replace the part.
Excessive wear of rotor rings or Replace the part.
brushes.
Short-circuited diodes. Replace the part.
Short-circuited stator winders or Replace the part.
rotor winder.
Excessive recharge. Loose system connections. Check the connections of battery
terminals, starter motor terminals
and alternator.
Voltage regulator inefficient. Replace the part
Ground connection faulty. Check connections for leaks.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 145

BATTERY
For the loader backhoe models two different kinds of installation are provided:
- with one battery;
- with two batteries (for cold climates).

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Single battery
Voltage:........................................................................................................................................................ 12 V
Capacity (20 h):.......................................................................................................................................... 95 Ah
Discharge current:...................................................................................................................................... 900 A
Weight with electrolyte: ................................................................................................................... 25 kg (55 lb)
Double battery
Voltage:........................................................................................................................................................ 12 V
Capacity (20 h):.......................................................................................................................................... 60 Ah
Discharge current:...................................................................................................................................... 600 A
Weight with electrolyte: ................................................................................................................ 17 kg (37.5 lb)

OPERATION
All models feature one or two 12 V, negative The battery is constructed in such a manner that
ground, “maintenance free” lead calcium (Pb-Ca) each cell contains positive and negative plates
type battery. placed alternatively next to each other.
IMPORTANT: “Maintenance Free” means that Each positive plate is separated from a negative
under normal charging conditions the battery does plate by a non conducting porous envelope separa-
not lose water from the electrolyte. Conditions that tor.
may cause water loss include prolonged charging If any of the positive plates should make contact
above 14.4 V where gassing occurs as it with negative plates within a cell, the cell will short
approaches full charge. This can be caused by a circuit and suffer irreparable damage.
faulty charging system or boost/recovery charging
equipment. All of the positive plates are welded to a bus-bar,
The battery has four major functions: forming a positive terminal and all of the negative
plates are welded to a similar bus-bar forming a
- to provide a source of current for starting, lighting negative terminal.
and instrumentation;
Each positive plate is composed of a lead grid with
- to help control the voltage in the electric system;
lead peroxide pasted into the grid openings.
- to provide current when the electric consumption
exceeds the alternator output; The negative plates are composed of a lead grid
with spongy lead pasted into the grid openings.
- to support quiescent loads from radio and micro-
processor memory. The plates are submerged in a liquid electrolyte
solution of diluted sulphuric acid.
146 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

REPLACEMENT
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Lower the loader attachment to the ground.
Place the backhoe attachment in the road travel
position.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.

S WARNING S
Never reverse the battery terminals. Connect the
positive cable to the positive terminal (+) and the
negative cable to the negative terminal (-).
When disconnecting the battery cables, always dis-
connect the negative cable (-) first.
When reconnecting the battery cables, always con-
nect the negative (-) cable last.
Never short-circuit the battery terminals with metal
objects.
Never touch the battery terminals with your hands.
This could generate an electrolysis inside the
human body and damage the body’s vital organs.

Place the battery switch in the OFF position.


Remove the battery master switch support (6) with-
out disconnect the battery cables.
Remove the terminal covers and disconnect the
cables, first from the negative terminal (1) then the
positive terminal (2).
Remove the nuts and washers (3), the clamping bar
(4) and the brackets (5) and remove the old battery.
Install the new battery.
Install the brackets (5), the clamping bar (4) and the
washers and nuts (3).
Clean the cables and the connecting terminals and
coat them with grease.
Connect the cables, first to the positive terminal (2),
then the negative terminal (1) and install the termi-
nal covers.
Reassemble the battery master switch support (6).
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 147

CHARGE AND ELECTROLYTE LEVEL CHECK

S WARNING S S WARNING S
The battery electrolyte generates severe burns. Before carrying out any welding on the machine or
The battery contains sulphuric acid. Avoid any con- repair work on the electric circuit, disconnect the
tact with the skin, eyes or clothing. battery and disconnect the B+ and D+ wires on the
alternator. When reconnecting, check the wire
Antidote:
markings.
EXTERNAL: rinse well with water, removing any
soiled clothing. CHARGE CHECK
INTERNAL: avoid vomiting. Drink water to rinse Measure the density of the acid of the single cells
your mouth. Consult a doctor. with a commonly available measuring device.
EYES: rinse thoroughly with water for 15 minutes The measured values (see table below) indicate
and get prompt medical attention. the charge status of the battery.
When working with batteries, always wear gloves, When measuring, the temperature of the acid
protection goggles and suitable clothes. should be +20 °C (68 °F), if possible.

S WARNING S ELECTROLYTE CONCENTRATION


Never touch the battery terminals with your hands.
in kg/dm3 (lb/ft3) Charge
This could generate an electrolysis inside the
human body and damage the body’s vital organs. Normal Tropical
1.28 (80) 1.23 (77) good
S WARNING S 1.20 (75) 1.12 (70) reduced: charge
Batteries produce explosive gases. To prevent any
risk of explosion, observe the following instructions: 1.12 (70) 1.08 (67) low: immediately charge
- place the battery switch in the OFF position;
- when disconnecting the battery cables, always
ELECTROLYTE LEVEL CHECK
disconnect the negative cable (-) first;
Remove the vent plugs and check the level in each
- when reconnecting the battery cables, always
battery cell.
connect the negative (-) cable last;
The level should come up to 6 mm (0.24 in) above
- never short-circuit the battery terminals with
the separator plates.
metal objects;
Add distilled water if necessary.
- do not weld, grind or smoke near a battery.
Keep open flames away and do not smoke near
batteries. Always provide good ventilation when
charging a battery or using a battery in an enclosed
space.
148 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

CONNECTING A BOOSTER BATTERY

S WARNING S
When the electrolyte of a battery is frozen, it can
explode if you attempt to charge the battery or if
you try to start the engine using a booster battery.
Always keep the battery charged to prevent the
electrolyte freezing.

S WARNING S
Connecting jumper cables wrongly or short-
circuiting battery terminals can cause an accident.
Connect the jumper cables following the instruc-
tions in this manual.

IMPORTANT: make sure that the voltage of the


booster batteries is the same as that of the machine
system (12 V).

Open the battery box and then remove the tool box.
Remove the terminal covers.
Connect the positive (+) jumper cable to the positive
(+) terminal of the machine’s battery.
Connect the negative (-) jumper cable to one of the
fastening screws (1) of tank.
Start the engine
First disconnect the negative (-) jumper cable, then
disconnect the positive (+) jumper cable from the
booster battery.
Install the terminal covers.
Install the tool box and close the battery box.

BATTERY MASTER SWITCH

S WARNING S
The battery master switch must be switched off at
the end of each working day, for machine service or
for any operations on the electric system.
It acts as an anti-theft device when the cab doors
and windows are locked.

The battery master switch (1) is located in the bat-


tery compartment and is used to completely discon-
nect the battery from the electric system.
When the battery master switch has an inclination of
45°, the circuit is disconnected.
When the master switch is in vertical position, the 1
circuit is connected.
SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM 149

TROUBLESHOOTING

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

The electric system is Loose or oxidised battery Check that the battery voltage with
inoperative. connections. open circuit is at least 12.6 V.

Clean and tighten the connections. Check the electrolyte level and
Sulphated batteries. density.

Battery isolator switch off. Restore the battery isolator switch.

The main connection fuse of the Find the reason of the failure and
machine is blown. replace the connection fuse.

Starter motor speed too low, Loose or corroded connections. Clean and tighten loose
the engine cranks slowly. connections.

Low battery output voltage. Check that the battery voltage with
open circuit is at least 12.6 V.
Check the electrolyte level and
density.

Incorrect viscosity of the engine oil. Use an oil with correct viscosity for
the temperature conditions.

Starter motor inoperative. Transmission gearshift lever Move gearshift lever to neutral.
engaged.

Loose or corroded connections. Clean and tighten loose


connections.

Dead batteries. Charge or replace the batteries.

The charge indicator lamp Low engine idle speed. Increase idle speed.
stays on with the engine
running. Loose belt. Check belt tension.

Malfunctioning battery. Check that the battery voltage with


open circuit is at least 12.6 V.
Check the electrolyte level and
density.

Malfunctioning alternator. Check the alternator and repair, if


necessary.
150 SECTION 55 - ELECTRIC SYSTEM

FAULT POSSIBLE CAUSE ACTION

Batteries will not charge. Loose or corroded battery Clean and tighten the connections.
connections.

Sulphated batteries. Check that the battery voltage with


open circuit is at least 12.6 V.
Check the electrolyte level and
density.

Loose or worn belt. Check the automatic belt tensioner.


If necessary, replace the belt.

The charge indicator flashes, Malfunctioning alternator. Check the alternator and repair, if
indicating excessive charging necessary.
voltage.
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 82 - LOADER

LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROLS............................................................................................................. 4


LOADER ATTACHMENT OPERATION ...................................................................................................... 4
4x1 LOADER BUCKET CONTROL (Optional) ............................................................................................ 7
LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROL LOCK
(Specific to certain countries) ............................................................................................................... 8

LOADER BUCKET SELF-LEVELLING............................................................................................................. 9

LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT.................................................................................................... 12


LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT
(B90B - B100B - B110B)..................................................................................................................... 12
LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT
(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B) ......................................................................................................... 14

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF LOADER BUCKET .............................................................................. 15


LOADER BUCKET (B90B - B100B - B110B) ............................................................................................ 15
LOADER BUCKET (B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B)................................................................................. 16
LOADER BUCKET WITH FORKS (Optional) ............................................................................................ 17
BUCKET TEETH REPLACEMENT............................................................................................................ 18

LOADER REMOVAL....................................................................................................................................... 19
LOADER ATTACHMENT (B90B - B100B - B110B) .................................................................................. 19
LOADER ATTACHMENT
(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B) ......................................................................................................... 21
2 SECTION 82 - LOADER
SECTION 82 - LOADER 3

The loader assy consists essentially of an arm hinged to the loader backhoe chassis, on which is installed a
linkage moving the bucket frontally.
Three kinds of loader arm are provided:

- straight loader arm (2WS);

- bent loader arm (2WS-TC);

- bent loader arm (4WS).


4 SECTION 82 - LOADER

LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROLS

S WARNING S
Before starting the engine, make sure you are fully
aware of the location and the function of each con-
trol. Operating the controls wrongly can cause seri-
ous physical injury.

S WARNING S
Before using the controls make sure that the opera-
tor’s seat is correctly adjusted in the loader attach-
ment position.

WITH STANDARD LOADER BUCKET


Located on the right of the steering wheel, this nine
position lever operates all the loader attachment
controls.
The speed of movement of each control depends on
the angle to which the lever is tilted. In the interme-
diate position, two movements can be obtained
simultaneously.

WITH 4x1 LOADER BUCKET


The function of the lever is identical to that of the
machine fitted with the standard loader bucket, with
the addition of the clam control.

LOADER ATTACHMENT OPERATION


NEUTRAL AND HOLD
With the lever in the neutral/hold position (0), the
attachment movement can be stopped.
As soon as the lever is released, it automatically
returns to the neutral position (0) and the attach-
ment remains in the position where it was when
movement stopped.
SECTION 82 - LOADER 5

RAISING THE LOADER ATTACHMENT


With the lever in position (1), the attachment rises.

LOWERING THE LOADER ATTACHMENT


With the lever in position (2), the attachment lowers.

LOADER BUCKET FLOAT CONTROL


With the lever in position (3), the bucket follows the
contours of the ground without it being necessary to
operate the lever.
NOTE: in this position the lever does not automati-
cally return to neutral when it is released. It is nec-
essary to move it manually.
6 SECTION 82 - LOADER

FILLING THE LOADER BUCKET


With the lever in position (4), the bucket rolls back
(fills).

DUMPING THE LOADER BUCKET


With the lever in position (5), the bucket rolls for-
ward (dumps).

AUTOMATIC RETURN TO LOADER BUCKET


FILLING
With the lever in position (6), the attachment lowers
and, simultaneously, the bucket places itself to the
digging position.
NOTE: it is possible to adjust the tilt angle for bucket
filling.
SECTION 82 - LOADER 7

4x1 LOADER BUCKET CONTROL (Optional)


This control operates the opening and closing of the
4x1 bucket clam.
This control is proportional:
When releasing the roller (7), it automatically returns
to the initial position (neutral) and the bucket
remains in the position where it was when move-
ment stopped.
When shifting the roller (7) forward: the loader
bucket clam closes (A).
When shifting the roller (7) backward: the loader
bucket clam opens (B).
4x1 loader bucket control roller detent proce-
dure
The operator may install a detent position for the
4x1 bucket operation.
This position alters operation in order to allow the
operator to lock the switch in the open circuit posi-
tion, so that this position is held until the operator
unlocks the switch.
The standard position of the switch is with the open
U shape pointing upwards. In this configuration, the
switch will automatically spring back to the neutral
position when released, from any position.
To set the detent position to the bucket open posi-
tion, it is necessary to remove the top of the switch,
rotating it by 180°.
Remove the screw (2) of the roller (1) using a small
phillips screwdriver.
8 SECTION 82 - LOADER

Lift and remove the top portion (3) of the roller


switch, rotate it by 180° and tighten the screw in the
top portion of the roller.
NOTE: the open U shape must point downwards.
Carefully restore the screw (2) into place and do not
overtighten.
Test the switch by lifting it up into detent position
before restoring the cap into place. The switch
should lock into position.
In this condition, the 4x1 loader bucket control roller
is locked. To unlock it, it is necessary to rotate the
top portion again and take it back to its initial posi-
tion.

LOADER ATTACHMENT CONTROL LOCK


(Specific to certain countries)
This pin (1), located next to the control lever, is used
to lock the attachment controls.
To lock the controls, remove the pin from its housing
and install it in the specially provided hole in the
console.

S WARNING S
Before leaving the operator’s compartment, under-
taking any road travel or working with the backhoe
attachment, place the pin in locking position.
SECTION 82 - LOADER 9

LOADER BUCKET SELF-LEVELLING


The self-levelling linkage mounted on the right hand
loader arm and frame automatically controls the
angle of the loader bucket during the raising cycle of
the lift arms to maintain a constant bucket level.
There is no self-levelling during the lowering cycle.
Self-levelling begins when the tube (2) on the loader
arm contacts the bell crank (1) and lifts the vertical
linkage rod (3).
The tie rod then moves the bucket spool to the
dump position to level the bucket.

AUTOMATIC SELF-LEVELLING CONTROL


ADJUSTMENT
Lower the loader attachment to the ground.
Disconnect the vertical tie rod (3) at the lower bell
crank.
Raise the loader attachment so that the lower
bucket pin is 800 mm (31.5 in) above the ground,
and fully turn over the bucket to the rear.

Rotate the bell crank (1) until it touches the tube (2)
on the loader arm. Make sure the lower bell crank
arm is directed upwards.
Adjust the length of the vertical rod (3) so that, when
re-connected, the end of the loader arm tube
remains in contact with the bell crank.
Securely tighten the lock nuts on a vertical tie rod.
10 SECTION 82 - LOADER

“RETURN TO DIG” DEVICE - 2WS


The “return to dig” device is an electrically activated
feature which enables the operator to automatically
return the bucket to a level digging position for a fur-
ther work cycle, with one simple movement of the
control lever (3).
Whenever the bucket is rolled forward to dump the
return to dig electric circuit is completed and the
solenoid on the bucket spool is energised.
When the loader bucket control lever (3) is moved
diagonally left to the return to dig position (2) the
electromagnet will hold the bucket spool in the roll
back position until the bucket is in the level digging
position at which time the indicator on the rod of the
bucket self-levelling linkage will pass in front of the
sensor which de-energises the electromagnet on
the bucket spool enabling the spool to return to the
neutral position.

Return to dig sensor - Adjustment


The “return to dig” device consists of an electromag-
net mounted on the bucket spool, a sensor (1)
mounted on top of the loader arm and a pointer
attached to the tube of the bucket self-levelling link-
age.
Place the bucket on the ground in the preferred dig-
ging position.
Adjust the position of the sensor such that when the
bucket is in digging position and loader arms are
lowered, half (50%) of the sensor face is obscured
by the self-levelling linkage pointer.
Ensure the face of the sensor (1) is 3 - 6 mm
(0.12 - 0.24 in) from the pointer (2) on the self-
levelling linkage.
As a visual aid for the operator, while seated in the
cab, the pointer mounted on the loader arm can be
seen to align with the pointer on the self-levelling
linkage, when the loader arms are lowered and the
bucket is in the level digging position.
SECTION 82 - LOADER 11

“RETURN TO DIG” SYSTEM - 4WS


The “return to dig” device is an electrically activated
feature which enables the operator to automatically
return the bucket to a level digging position for a fur-
ther work cycle, with one simple movement of the
control lever (3).
Whenever the bucket is rolled forward to dump the
return to dig electric circuit is completed and the
solenoid on the bucket spool is energised.
When the loader bucket control lever (3) is moved
diagonally left to the return to dig position (2) the
electromagnet will hold the bucket spool in the roll
back position until the bucket is in the level digging
position at which time the indicator on the rod of the
bucket linkage will pass in front of the sensor which
de-energises the electromagnet on the bucket spool
enabling the spool to return to the neutral position.

Return to dig sensor - Adjustment


The “return to dig” device consists of an electromag-
net mounted on the loader bucket control valve
spool, a sensor (1) mounted on top of the loader
arm and a pointer attached to the tube of the bucket
self-levelling linkage.
Place the bucket on the ground in the preferred dig-
ging position.
Check the dimensions of 88.5 mm (3.5 in) and 7.5 mm
(0.3 in) are maintained as shown.
Make sure that the sensor (1) is 6 mm (0.24 in) from
the tie rod (2).
As a visual aid for the operator, while seated in the
cab, the pointer mounted on the loader arm can be
seen to align with the pointer on the return to dig
linkage, when the loader arms are lowered and the
bucket is in the level digging position.
12 SECTION 82 - LOADER

LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT

LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT


(B90B - B100B - B110B)
Located on the left-hand side of the loader attach-
ment, this safety strut enables the loader attach-
ment to be locked in the raised position in case of
defects in the system.

LOCKED POSITION
Completely raise the loader attachment. Stop the
engine and remove the starter key.
Remove the split pin (1) and the lock pin (2).

Place the strut (3) on the cylinder rod and install the
pin (2) and the split pin (1) back into the holes in the
strut.

S WARNING S
It is mandatory to install the safety strut when carry-
ing out any operation requiring the loader attach-
ment to be in the raised position.
SECTION 82 - LOADER 13

UNLOCKED POSITION
Remove the split pin (1) and the lock pin (2).

Remove the strut (3) from the attachment and install


the pin (1) and the split pin (2) back into the holes in
the strut.
Start the engine and lower the loader attachment.
14 SECTION 82 - LOADER

LOADER ATTACHMENT SAFETY STRUT


(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B)
Located on the left-hand side of the loader attach-
ment, this safety strut enables the loader attach-
ment to be locked in the raised position in case of
defects in the system.

LOCKED POSITION
Completely raise the loader attachment. Stop the
engine and remove the starter key.
Remove the split pins (1) and the safety strut (2)
from the arm. Put the split pins back in place.
Place the strut (2) on the cylinder rod and fasten it
by means of the fastening flip (3).

S WARNING S
It is mandatory to install the safety strut when carry-
ing out any operation requiring the loader attach-
ment to be in the raised position.

UNLOCKED POSITION
Remove the flip (3) and the strut (2) from the cylin-
der rod.

Install the safety strut (2) on the loader arm by


means of the split pins (1).
Start the engine and lower the loader attachment.
SECTION 82 - LOADER 15

REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF LOADER BUCKET

LOADER BUCKET (B90B - B100B - B110B)


REMOVAL
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Lower the bucket to the ground in dump position
(tilted completely forward).
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
If the machine is fitted with a 4x1 bucket, release the
pressure from the bucket circuit.
Remove the fastening screws, then remove the pins
(1).

S WARNING S
Always wear eye protection when using a tool
which might project metal particles. Use a hammer
with a soft face, such as copper, for pins assembly/
disassembly.

(4x1 bucket) disconnect and plug the hydraulic sup-


ply lines.
Start the engine.
Operate the attachment controls so as to release
the bucket.
Reverse the machine from the bucket.

INSTALLATION
Make sure all bushings are completely clean.
Remove any dirt or foreign matter, if necessary.
Start the engine.
Use the attachment controls to engage the attach-
ment between the bucket lugs.
Install the arm/bucket pins (1) and then install the
relevant retaining screws.
Use the bucket controls to align the connecting rod
orifices with the bucket lugs.
Stop the engine and remove the starter switch key.
(4x1 bucket) release the pressure from the bucket
circuit.
Install the rod/bucket pins (2), and then install the
relevant retaining screws.
(4x1 bucket) remove the plugs and reconnect the
hydraulic lines.
16 SECTION 82 - LOADER

LOADER BUCKET (B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B)


REMOVAL
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Lower the bucket to the ground in dump position
(tilted completely forward).
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
If the machine is fitted with a 4x1 bucket, release the
pressure from the bucket circuit.

Remove the retaining rings and pins, then drive out


the pins (1).

S WARNING S
Always wear eye protection when using a tool
which might project metal particles. Use a hammer
with a soft face, such as copper, for pins assembly/
disassembly.

(4x1 bucket) disconnect and plug the hydraulic sup-


ply lines.
Start the engine.
Operate the attachment controls so as to release
the bucket.
Reverse the machine from the bucket.

INSTALLATION
Make sure all bushings are completely clean.
Remove any dirt or foreign matter, if necessary.
Start the engine.
Use the attachment controls to engage the attach-
ment between the bucket lugs.
Reinstall the arm/bucket pins (1) and then install the
relevant retaining pins and rings.
Use the bucket controls to align the connecting rod
holes (3) with the bucket lugs.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
(4x1 bucket) release the pressure from the bucket
circuit.
Install the rod/bucket pins (2) and then install the rel-
evant retaining pins and rings.
(4x1 bucket) remove the plugs and reconnect the
hydraulic lines.
SECTION 82 - LOADER 17

LOADER BUCKET WITH FORKS (Optional)

S WARNING S
The forks are heavy, so use great care when swing-
ing them into their working and stowage position.

INSTALL FORKS IN WORKING POSITION


Move the bucket to a level and firm ground.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Raise the parking brake lever.
Remove the retained pin and the pin (1).
Lower the fork (2) manually and carefully until it is
laying in position against the bucket cutting edge.
IMPORTANT: the forks must be laying against the
cutting edge of the bucket, and never against bucket
teeth.

Install the pin (1) and the safety pin.


Repeat the same operations for the other fork.
Slide the forks until they are suitably spaced for the
intended job.
IMPORTANT: the two forks must be positioned at
the same distance from the centre of the bucket.
IMPORTANT: never use the forks to lift the
machine.

S WARNING S
When using the forks with a 4x1 bucket, never
attempt to use the bucket jaw opening function.
18 SECTION 82 - LOADER

INSTALL THE FORKS IN REST POSITION


Rest the loader bucket on a level and firm ground.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key. Disen-
gage the parking brake lever.
Remove the retained pin and the pin (1).
Tilt the fork (2) manually and carefully until it is rear-
wards into transport position.

Reinstall the pin (1) and the safety pin into their
housing.
NOTE: if necessary, slide the fork to the side to
bring it into its housing.
Repeat the same operations for the other fork.
IMPORTANT: the forks must be securely retained in
their proper storage position using the pins and split
pins provided for this purpose. If forks are not cor-
rectly secured, they can cause serious injury.

BUCKET TEETH REPLACEMENT


Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Position the loader bucket so that the bucket teeth
can be replaced.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Loosen and remove the screws (2) with the nuts (3).
Extract the tooth (1).
Clean the area around the tooth.
Assemble the new tooth (1).
Screw in and tighten the screws (2) with the nuts (3).
SECTION 82 - LOADER 19

LOADER REMOVAL

LOADER ATTACHMENT (B90B - B100B - B110B)


Remove the loader bucket (see procedure
described previously).
Disconnect the self-levelling linkage rod (3) from the
bell crank (1).
Strap the linkage rod (2) to loader arm.

Disconnect the loader lift cylinder rod end retaining


pin (4).
Lower the lift cylinder onto the chassis.
Disconnect the hoses of the bucket cylinder and the
pipes of the 4x1 bucket, where fitted.
IMPORTANT: examine pipework to ensure that any
clamps securing the hoses to the loader arms have
also been released.

Support loader using a suitable sling.


20 SECTION 82 - LOADER

Install the loader pivot screw retainer 380000723.

Using heavy duty socket remove the pivot screw.

Ensure loader is properly supported and remove the


bar (5).

Remove the loader from the machine.


SECTION 82 - LOADER 21

INSTALLATION
For installation, follow the removal procedure in
reverse order.
When assembling the fastening screws, tighten to a
torque of 500 Nm (369 lbf·ft).

LOADER ATTACHMENT
(B100BTC - B110BTC - B115B)
Remove the loader bucket (see procedure
described previously).
Fully retract bucket cylinders and raise arm until lift
cylinder pivots can be seen above engine guard.
Place a suitable stand under the end of the arm to
take the weight.
Switch off the engine and relieve hydraulic pressure.

Remove the safety rings (2) and the pins and then
drive out the pins (1).
Lower the lift cylinders carefully onto the chassis.
22 SECTION 82 - LOADER

Remove the snap rings (3) and drive out the pins
(4).
Lower the arms onto the lift cylinders.

Disconnect and cap the lift cylinder hoses (5) at the


top of the loader arm on each side of the machine
and disconnect the return to dig sensor cable (7) on
the right hand side.
If the 4x1 bucket is fitted disconnect and cap hose
(6) on each side of the loader.

Support loader using a suitable sling.

Remove the safety ring and pins and then pull out
the pin (8).
SECTION 82 - LOADER 23

Remove the loader from the machine.

INSTALLATION
For installation, follow the removal procedure in
reverse order.
24 SECTION 82 - LOADER

NOTES:
B90B - B90BLR
B100B - B100BLR - B100BTC
B110B - B110BTC
B115B

SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION................................................................................................................... 3

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROLS.......................................................................................................... 6


BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MECHANICAL CONTROLS ............................................................................ 7
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT HYDRAULIC CONTROLS ............................................................................. 17
BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT (Sideshift version) ...................................................................... 23

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY .................................................................................................. 25


CENTER PIVOT BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY.................................................................. 25
SIDESHIFT BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY.......................................................................... 28
BACKHOE BUCKET REPLACEMENT...................................................................................................... 30
BUCKET TEETH REPLACEMENT............................................................................................................ 31
DIPPER REMOVE ..................................................................................................................................... 32

TELESCOPIC DIPPER REVISION................................................................................................................. 35


OVERHAUL ............................................................................................................................................... 35

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT HYDRAULIC HANDLING ................................................................................... 38


CONTROLS ............................................................................................................................................... 38
HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM ............................................................................................................................ 38
HANDLING CYLINDER ............................................................................................................................. 39
DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY............................................................................................................. 40
2 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 3

DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION


Loader backhoes are available with center pivot or
sideshift backhoe attachment.
On center pivot machines the backhoe pivots on a
fixed central point at the rear of the machine.
Independently operated stabilizers are attached to
the base of the chassis and pivot about an arc to
raise or lower each side of the machine.

On sideshift machines the backhoe is attached to a


carriage hydraulically clamped to the machine
frame.
This allows the operator to reposition the carriage
on the frame and to adjust the position of the back-
hoe attachment to suit the operating conditions.
The machine is raised using two vertical stabilisers
attached to each side of the machine.

Each stabilizer is independently operated using:


- levers (1) and (2) on mechanical control loader
backhoes;

- control levers (3) and (4) on “pilot” control loader


backhoes.
4 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

The backhoe attachment is locked in position during


transport using a hydraulically and mechanically
operated lock (5).

The lock is operated by the lever (6) or the switch


(7).

The backhoe on the mechanical control models is


controlled using two main control levers.
There are three configuration types for 2-lever con-
trol systems (8) and (9), as described on the follow-
ing pages.
A four-lever system installed by the Dealer is also
available as optional accessory.

The backhoe on the hydraulic control models is con-


trolled using two rear hydraulic control levers (10)
and (11).
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 5

Machines may be fitted with an optional telescopic


dipper which can be operated simultaneously with
other boom, dipper and bucket movements.

The telescopic dipper on the manually controlled


models is controlled by a pedal (12) located in the
rear part of the cab.

The telescopic dipper on pilot control modes, is con-


trolled using the two buttons (13) and (14) on the left
hydraulic control lever.
6 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT CONTROLS


NOTE: the instruments represented may not exactly
correspond to the instruments on your machine.
IMPORTANT: before using the backhoe attachment,
make sure that the backhoe attachment sideshift
carriage lock switch (3) is in the OFF position and
that the lock hook has been disengaged (4), either
by means of the lever (2) or the switch (1).
IMPORTANT: whenever the backhoe attachment is
used, the machine must be resting on the stabiliz-
ers.

S WARNING S
Check control functions before operating the
machine. Failure to check control pattern before
operating can cause unexpected machine move-
ment, death or serious injury.

S WARNING S
Any uncontrolled movement of the machine can
cause an accident. Before turning the operator’s
seat to the backhoe attachment working position, it
is essential to place the direction-of-travel control
lever and the powershuttle gearshift lever in the
neutral position and immobilize the machine by
means of the parking brake lever.

S WARNING S
Before using the backhoe controls, make sure that
the operator’s seat is correctly adjusted in the back-
hoe attachment position.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 7

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT MECHANICAL


CONTROLS
STABILIZER MECHANICAL CONTROLS
IMPORTANT: whenever the backhoe attachment is
used, the machine must be resting on the stabiliz-
ers.
Left-hand stabilizer left-hand control lever
This lever has three positions:
Position (0): neutral. This position stops the move-
ment of the left-hand stabilizer. As soon as the lever
is released, it automatically returns to the neutral
position (0) and the left-hand stabilizer stops raising
or lowering.
Position (1): the left-hand stabilizer lowers.
Position (2): the left-hand stabilizer rises.
Right-hand stabilizer right-hand control lever
This lever has three positions:
Position (0): neutral. This position stops the move-
ment of the right-hand stabilizer. As soon as the
lever is released, it automatically returns to the neu-
tral position (0) and the right-hand stabilizer stops
raising or lowering.
Position (1): the right-hand stabilizer lowers.
Position (2): the right-hand stabilizer rises.
NOTE: to raise or lower the two stabilizers at the
same time, operate the two levers simultaneously.
IMPORTANT: before machine travel or before using
the loader attachment, make sure the stabilizers are
completely raised.
During road travel, the stabilizers must be com-
pletely raised and immobilized by means of the pins
provided for that purpose.
Locking the stabilizer mechanical controls (spe-
cific to certain countries)
This pin (1), located in front of the stabilizer control
levers, is used to lock the stabilizer controls.
To lock the controls, remove the pin from its housing
and install it in the specially provided hole in the
console.

S WARNING S
Before leaving the operator’s compartment, under-
taking any road travel or working with the backhoe
attachment, place the pin in locking position.
8 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

ATTACHMENT MECHANICAL CONTROLS


These control levers are used to operate the back-
hoe attachment. The speed of movement of each
control depends on the angle to which the lever is
tilted. In the intermediate position, two movements
can be obtained simultaneously.
Four backhoe attachment control configurations
exist, depending on the country concerned:
- standard configuration;
- ISO configuration;
- four lever pattern configuration;
- cross-pattern configuration.
The operating pattern of the control levers is differ-
ent. Check which configuration you have on your
machine.
Standard configuration
Backhoe boom and backhoe attachment swing left-
hand control lever
This lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (A): the boom lowers.
Position (B): the boom rises.
Position (C): the backhoe attachment swings to the
left.
Position (D): the backhoe attachment swings to the
right.
Backhoe dipper and backhoe bucket right-hand
control lever
This lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (E): the backhoe dipper extends.
Position (F): the backhoe dipper retracts.
Position (G): the backhoe bucket closes.
Position (H): the backhoe bucket opens.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 9
10 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

ISO configuration
Backhoe dipper and backhoe attachment swing left-
hand control lever
This lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (A): the backhoe dipper extends.
Position (B): the backhoe dipper retracts.
Position (C): the backhoe attachment swings to the
left.
Position (D): the backhoe attachment swings to the
right.
Backhoe boom and backhoe bucket right-hand con-
trol lever
This lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (E): the boom lowers.
Position (F): the boom rises.
Position (G): the backhoe bucket closes.
Position (H): the backhoe bucket opens.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 11
12 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

Four-lever pattern configuration


Lever (1) for dipper
This lever has three positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (A): the backhoe dipper extends.
Position (B): the backhoe dipper retracts.
Lever (2) for boom
This lever has three positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (C): the boom rises.
Position (D): the boom lowers.
Lever (3) for backhoe bucket
This lever has three positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (E): the backhoe bucket closes.
Position (F): the backhoe bucket opens.
Lever (4) for backhoe attachment swing
This lever has three positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (G): the backhoe attachment swings to the
right.
Position (H): the backhoe attachment swings to the
left.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 13
14 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

Cross-pattern configuration
Backhoe boom and backhoe attachment swing left-
hand control lever
This lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (A): the boom lowers.
Position (B): the boom rises.
Position (C): the backhoe attachment swings to the
left.
Position (D): the backhoe attachment swings to the
right.
Backhoe dipper and backhoe bucket right-hand
control lever
This lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the lever is released, it automatically returns to the
neutral position (0) and the attachment remains in
the position where it was when movement stopped.
Position (E): the backhoe dipper extends.
Position (F): the backhoe dipper retracts.
Position (G): the backhoe bucket closes.
Position (H): the backhoe bucket opens.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 15
16 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

TELESCOPIC DIPPER MECHANICAL CONTROL


PEDAL (Optional)
This pedal (A) has three positions:
Position (0): neutral. This position enables the
movement of the telescopic dipper to be stopped.
The pedal automatically returns to this position as
soon as it is released.
Position (1): the telescopic dipper extends.
Position (2): the telescopic dipper retracts.
Before using this pedal make sure that the tele-
scopic dipper is mechanically unlocked.
NOTE: operating the backhoe attachment control
levers and this pedal simultaneously will enable
numerous possibilities of progressive functioning.

AUXILIARY ATTACHMENT CONTROL PEDAL


(Optional)
This pedal (1) is located to the right of the backhoe
attachment controls and is used for operating the
auxiliary attachment, such as a hydraulic hammer.

LOCKING THE BACKHOE ATTACHMENT


MECHANICAL CONTROLS (Specific to certain
countries)
This pin (1), located in front of the stabilizer control
levers, is used to lock the backhoe attachment con-
trols.
To lock the controls, remove the pin from its housing
and install it in the specially provided hole in the
console.

S WARNING S
Before leaving the operator’s compartment, under-
taking any road travel or working with the backhoe
attachment, place the pin in locking position.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 17

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT HYDRAULIC CONTROLS

1. CONTROL ENABLE SWITCH: when set to ON 6. TELESCOPIC DIPPER CONTROLS: (propor-


(control lamp on), this switch allows enabling all tional controls): press the right-hand button to
hydraulic controls of the backhoe attachment. extend the telescopic dipper.
2. LEFT-HAND HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVER: Press the left-hand button to retract the tele-
the left-hand hydraulic control lever controls scopic dipper.
attachment swing and the boom or the dipper 7. WRIST RESTS: the wrist rests may be adjusted
(depending on the control pattern adopted). to the required height.
3. RIGHT-HAND HYDRAULIC CONTROL 8. HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVER SUPPORT
LEVER: the right-hand hydraulic control lever ANGLE ADJUSTMENT: these controls are
controls the bucket and the boom or the dipper used for the fore/aft and left/right adjustment of
(depending on the control pattern adopted). the arm.
NOTE: the operating speed depends on the angle 9. HORN BUTTON: (momentary action control).
of movement of the control levers. In intermediate 10. CONTROLS OF AUXILIARY BIDIRECTIONAL
position, two movements may be obtained simulta- ATTACHMENT (If fitted): proportional buttons
neously. for the activation of the additional attachment.
4. STABILIZER CONTROLS: the right-hand con- 11. DECELERATOR BUTTON: by pressing this
trol is for the right-hand stabilizer and the left- button, the engine rpm sets to low idle. During
hand control is for the left-hand stabilizer. this phase, the accelerator knob and pedal are
disabled.
5. CONTROL PATTERN CHANGE SWITCH: this
By pressing the button again, the engine rpm is
switch is used for changing the standard control
restored and the accelerator knob and pedal
pattern to the ISO pattern.
are functional again.
18 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

CONTROL ENABLE SWITCH


This control is located on the right-hand control
lever.
This switch has three positions:
- position OFF: (lamp off) all controls will deactivate;
- position (1): by pressing the upper side (lamp off),
the stabilizers will activate;
- position (2): by pressing the upper side (lamp on)
again, all controls will activate.

S WARNING S
After using the attachment or before leaving the
machine, always tilt the switch to OFF by pressing
the lower side of the switch (lamp off). Never forget
this basic safety requirement.

NOTE: when starting the engine, the position OFF


for disabled controls is automatically selected.

CONTROL PATTERN CHANGE SWITCH (BOOM


OR DIPPER)
Located on the right-hand hydraulic control lever,
this switch is fitted with a locking device.
The switch is used to change from standard pattern
to ISO version, or vice versa.
To unlock the switch, push the locking device
upwards and at the same time press the top of the
switch (1). In this position, the switch turns on and
the controls are in ISO pattern.
The boom and dipper controls on the hydraulic con-
trol levers are now inverted.
Press the bottom of the switch (1) to lock and return
to standard pattern operation.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 19

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT HYDRAULIC


CONTROLS
Standard configuration
Backhoe boom and backhoe attachment swing left-
hand hydraulic control lever
This hydraulic control lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the hydraulic control lever is released, it automati-
cally returns to the neutral position (0) and the
attachment remains in the position where it was
when movement stopped.
Position (A): the boom lowers.
Position (B): the boom rises.
Position (C): the backhoe attachment swings to the
left.
Position (D): the backhoe attachment swings to the
right.

Backhoe dipper and backhoe bucket right-hand


control lever
This hydraulic control lever has five positions:
Position (0): neutral/hold. This position enables the
attachment movement to be stopped. As soon as
the hydraulic control lever is released, it automati-
cally returns to the neutral position (0) and the
attachment remains in the position where it was
when movement stopped.
Position (E): the backhoe dipper extends.
Position (F): the backhoe dipper retracts.
Position (G): the backhoe bucket closes.
Position (H): the backhoe bucket opens.
20 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

STABILIZER HYDRAULIC CONTROLS


These controls are located on the left-hand hydrau-
lic control lever and may be operated independently
or simultaneously. These controls are proportional,
and therefore, the stabilizer speed may vary.
IMPORTANT: whenever the backhoe attachment is
used, the machine must be resting on the stabiliz-
ers.

Left-hand stabilizer left-hand control lever


This lever has four positions:
Position (0): neutral. This position stops the move-
ment of the left-hand stabilizer. As soon as the lever
is released from positions (1) or (2), it automatically
returns to the neutral position (0) and the left-hand
stabilizer stops raising or lowering.
When held in position (1): the left-hand stabilizer
lowers.
When held in position (2): the left-hand stabilizer
rises.
Position (3): stabilizer auto-up feature.

Right-hand stabilizer right-hand control lever


This lever has four positions:
Position (0): neutral. This position stops the move-
ment of the right-hand stabilizer. As soon as the
lever is released from positions (1) or (2), it automat-
ically returns to the neutral position (0) and the right-
hand stabilizer stops raising or lowering.
When held in position (1): the right-hand stabilizer
lowers.
When held in position (2): the right-hand stabilizer
rises.
Position (3): stabilizer auto-up feature.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 21

Auto-up feature (Center pivot version) (Optional)


Position (3): when the levers are momentarily pulled
back to this position and then released, they return
to the neutral position and the stabilizers automati-
cally rise to road travel position, thereby leaving
your hand free for other duties. To stop the auto-
matic rise at any time, push or pull the levers; the
rise of the stabilizers stops.
NOTE: the machines not provided with the optional
auto-up feature still have the relevant detent posi-
tion, but this does not affect the stabilizer operation
in any way.
IMPORTANT: before machine travel or before using
the loader attachment, make sure the stabilizers are
completely raised.
IMPORTANT: during road travel, the stabilizers
must be completely raised and immobilized by
means of the pins provided for that purpose.

TELESCOPIC DIPPER CONTROLS (Optional)


Press and hold down the right-hand button (1) to
extend the telescopic dipper. As soon as the button
is released the dipper stops and remains in the posi-
tion it occupied when the button was released.
Press and hold down the left-hand button (2) to
retract the telescopic dipper. As soon as the button
is released the dipper stops and remains in the posi-
tion it occupied when the button was released.
By pressing button (3), it is possible to set the
engine rpm to idle run disabling accelerator handle
and accelerator pedal. By pressing again button (3)
the engine rpm are restored and the accelerator
handle and accelerator pedal as well.
Before using these controls, make sure the tele-
scopic dipper is mechanically unlocked.
NOTE: operating the backhoe attachment control
levers and these controls simultaneously will enable
numerous possibilities of progressive functioning.
22 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

AUXILIARY BI-DIRECTIONAL CONTROLS (Optional)


Press and hold the left-hand button (1) to let the oil
flow out of the left-hand side of the boom.
Press and hold the left-hand button (2) to let the oil
flow out of the right-hand side of the boom.

HYDRAULIC CONTROL LEVER SUPPORT


ADJUSTMENTS
Fore and aft
Press the two levers (1), then tilt the hydraulic con-
trol levers to the desired position.
Once the desired position is reached, release the
two levers (1).

Left and right


Loosen the two knobs (2) located in front of each
hydraulic control lever support, then tilt the supports
to the required position.
Once the adjustment has been carried out, tighten
the two knobs (2).
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 23

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT SIDESHIFT


(Sideshift version)
To dig alongside a building or fence, etc., it is possi-
ble to shift the backhoe attachment sideways to the
right or the left.

MECHANICAL HANDLING
Place the backhoe attachment to the left if you want
to shift the attachment to the right, or place it to the
right if you want to shift it to the left, then place the
attachment on the ground.
Press the backhoe attachment sideshift unlocking
switch (1). The switch lamp turns on (ON position).

Operate the backhoe attachment controls alter-


nately so as to slide the sideshift carriage sideways.
Once the attachment is in the side position required,
swing it round into alignment with the machine.
Work on the opposite side of the sideshift carriage
as much as possible. Otherwise, reduce the load in
the bucket for better stability.
Press the backhoe attachment sideshift locking
switch (1). The switch lamp turns off (OFF position).
IMPORTANT: except when the sideshift carriage is
being moved, the switch (1) must always be in the
OFF position. Never use the backhoe attachment
with the sideshift carriage unlocked.
24 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

HYDRAULIC HANDLING
Press the backhoe attachment sideshift unlocking
switch (1). The switch lamp turns on (ON position).
For handling, press:
- the button (2) side with the symbol to move the
backhoe attachment to the left side of the track;
- the button (2) side without symbol to move the
backhoe attachment to the right side of the track.
NOTE: track sides are referred to the travel direc-
tion of the machine.
Press the backhoe attachment sideshift locking
switch (1). The switch lamp turns off (OFF position).
IMPORTANT: except when the sideshift carriage is
being moved, the switch (1) must always be in the
OFF position. Never use the backhoe attachment
with the sideshift carriage unlocked.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 25

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY

CENTER PIVOT BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY


Park the machine on a flat surface and position the
backhoe on the ground.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Lower stabilizers sufficiently and however ensure


that the rear tyres are in contact with the ground to
remove the weight from the rear wheels.
IMPORTANT: the rear wheels must remain in con-
tact with the ground.
26 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

On machines fitted with telescopic dipper install


locking pin in transport hole (1).
Fully retract telescopic dipper.

Fully retract dipper cylinder and lower boom until


bucket is firmly resting on the ground.
Support the backhoe using suitable stand and hoist
capable of carrying 1500 Kg (3307 lb).
Stop the engine and move the control levers through
all operating positions to relieve the pressure from
the system.
Re-check that backhoe elements are fully sup-
ported.
Disconnect all hoses that travel through the swing
support reach the backhoe.

Unscrew and remove the nut (2) to disconnect the


backhoe lock (3).

Loosen and remove the nut (4) and the screw (5).
Extract the pin (6) of the swing cylinder.
Repeat the operation with both swing cylinders.
Loosen and remove the nut (7) and the screw (8).
Extract the lower pin (9) from the swing support
using a hammer.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 27

Loosen and remove the screw (10).


Remove the upper pin (11) of the swing support.

Now it is possible to remove from the machine the


backhoe assembly.
28 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

SIDESHIFT BACKHOE ATTACHMENT DISASSEMBLY


Park the machine on a flat surface and position the
backhoe on the ground.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Lower stabilizers sufficiently and however ensure


that the rear tyres are in contact with the ground to
remove the weight from the rear wheels.
IMPORTANT: the rear wheels must remain in con-
tact with the ground.

On machines fitted with telescopic dipper install


locking pin in transport hole (1).
Fully retract telescopic dipper.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 29

Fully retract dipper cylinder and lower boom until


bucket is firmly resting on the ground.
Support the backhoe using suitable stand and hoist
capable of carrying 1500 Kg (3307 lb).
Turn off engine, then move backhoe control levers
through all operating positions to relieve pressure in
the system.
Re-check that backhoe elements are fully sup-
ported.
Disconnect all hoses that travel through the swing
bracket reach the backhoe.

Unscrew and remove the nut (2) to disconnect the


backhoe lock (3).

Loosen and remove the nut (4) and the screw (5).
Extract the pin (6) of the swing cylinder.
Repeat the operation with both swing cylinders.
Loosen and remove the nut (7) and the screw (8).
Extract the lower pin (9) from the swing support
using a hammer.

Loosen and remove the screw (10).


Remove the upper pin (11) of the swing support.

Now it is possible to remove from the machine the


backhoe assembly.
30 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

BACKHOE BUCKET REPLACEMENT


REMOVAL
Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Lower the stabilizers and place the bucket on the
ground.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Remove the lock rings and pins and the rod/bucket
link pin (1).

S WARNING S
Always wear eye protection when using a tool
which might project metal particles.

Start the engine.


Retract the bucket cylinder rod.
Operate the attachment controls so that the dipper/
bucket pin is not supporting the load of the dipper.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Remove the lock rings and pins and the arm/bucket
link pin (2).
Start the engine.
Operate the attachment controls so as to disconnect
the dipper from the bucket.

INSTALLATION
Start the engine.
Extend the bucket cylinder rod to bring the connect-
ing rod to their housing.
Reinstall the rod/bucket link pin (1), then install the
lock rings and pins.
Slightly raise the attachment, then operate the
bucket and dipper control to align the dipper hole
with the bucket lugs.
Reinstall the arm/bucket link pin (2), then install the
lock rings and pins.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 31

BACKHOE BUCKET DIGGING ANGLE


It is possible to change the backhoe bucket opening
angle, depending on the work which is to be carried
out.
Position (1): bucket maximum power.
Position (2): enables the bucket to open by 10°
more and, therefore, to dig vertical side trenches
closer to the machine.

BUCKET TEETH REPLACEMENT


Move the machine to a level and firm ground.
Position the backhoe bucket so that the bucket teeth
can be replaced.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and gearshift lever
in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Stop the engine and remove the starter key.
Loosen and remove the screws (2) with the nuts (3).
Extract the tooth (1).
Clean the area around the tooth.
Assemble the new tooth (1).
Screw in and tighten the screws (2) with the nuts (3).
32 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

DIPPER REMOVE
Park the machine on a level, firm surface and posi-
tion the backhoe on the ground.

S WARNING S
Always support the structural members so that they
will be stable and safe to work around.

Lower stabilizers sufficiently to remove the weight


from the rear wheels.
IMPORTANT: the rear wheels must remain in con-
tact with the ground.

Install the locking pin in transport hole (1) [on


machines fitted with telescopic dipper].
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 33

Lower the backhoe to the ground and support using


a suitable stand.
Turn off engine, then move backhoe control levers
through all operating positions to relieve pressure in
the system.

Disconnect the hoses to the dipper cylinders.


Arm hoses:
- telescopic dipper;

- standard dipper.

Support the dipper cylinder, unscrew and remove


the screw (2), slide out the pin (3).
Lower cylinder onto boom. Use suitable cylinder
supports to ensure weight of cylinder does not dam-
age hydraulic tubes attached to the dipper.
34 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

Support the dipper using suitable hoist.


Unscrew and remove the screw (4), slide out the pin
(5) and carefully lower dipper to the ground.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 35

TELESCOPIC DIPPER REVISION

OVERHAUL
INSPECTION OF GUIDE PADS
Park the machine on level ground and retract the
telescopic dipper.
Position the dipper on a suitable stand with the
bucket raised from the ground.
Clean the area around the pads.

Inspect each upper guide pad and if the chamfered


edge (1) on the corner of the pads is no longer visi-
ble the pads have worn beyond their limit and must
be replaced.
If pads do not require replacement visually check if
the gap between the inner part of the dipper and
upper guide pad is greater than 1.5 mm (0.06 in).
If the gap is greater than 1.5 mm (0.06 in) the guide
pads must be adjusted.
36 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

ADJUSTMENT OF GUIDE PADS


Position the dipper in the vertical position.
Count the number of shims behind the adjusting
screws on the left and right hand sides of the dipper
to determine which side has the most shims.
Remove one shim from behind an adjusting screw
on the side of the dipper which contains the most
shims.
Reassemble the screw and tighten it to a tightening
torque of 350 ÷ 400 Nm (258 ÷ 295 lbf·ft).
Do NOT overtorque the screw.
Repeat the procedure for the remaining three
screws on the same side of the dipper.
Recheck the gap.
If the gap remains greater than 1.5 mm (0.06 in)
remove a shim from behind each of the adjusting
screws on the opposite side of the dipper.
After performing an adjustment apply a coat of Dry
Moly-coat grease to the slide rails of the dipper.
NOTE: when all shims have been removed the
guide pads must be replaced.

REPLACEMENT OF GUIDE PADS


To replace the guide pads it is necessary to sepa-
rate the inner and outer parts of the telescopic dip-
per using either of the following procedures which
are dependent on workshop facilities.
Procedure No. 1
Park the machine on level ground and lower the
loader attachment bucket.
Lower stabilizers sufficiently to remove the weight
from the rear wheels.
IMPORTANT: the rear wheels must remain in con-
tact with the ground.
Position the dipper on a suitable stand.
Attach hoist to inner part of the dipper.
Disconnect the hose connections to the bucket and
the telescopic dipper cylinders.
Remove the telescopic dipper cylinder pin (1) and
separate the inner and the outer parts of the tele-
scopic dipper.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 37

Loosen and remove the screws (2).


Remove the guide pads (3).
Install new pads and apply thread sealant part to the
retaining screws.
Tighten to a torque of 29 ÷ 31 Nm (21.4 ÷ 22.9 lbf·ft).
Do not over tighten or damage to the threaded
inserts may occur.
Re-assemble the inner and the outer parts of the tel-
escopic dipper.
Place 5 shims beneath the heads of each adjusting
screw.
Adjust guide pads as described previously.
Procedure No. 2
This procedure requires the use of a loading dock or
service pit.
Park the machine with backhoe positioned over
loading dock or service pit.
Place the loader bucket on the ground and lower
stabilizers sufficiently to remove the weight from the
rear wheels.
Attach suitable hoist to top of inner section of dipper
and position boom so that dipper is hanging verti-
cally.
Disconnect the hose connections to the bucket and
the telescopic dipper cylinders.
Remove the telescopic dipper cylinder retaining pin.
Slowly lower hoist allowing inner and outer parts of
telescopic dipper to separate.
Loosen and remove the screws (2).
Remove the guide pads (3).
Install new guide pads and apply thread sealant to
the retaining screws.
Tighten to a torque of 29 ÷ 31 Nm (21.4 ÷ 22.9 lbf·ft).
Do not over tighten or damage to the threaded
inserts may occur.
Position new lower guide pads in the outer part of
the telescopic dipper.
Re-assemble the inner and the outer parts of the tel-
escopic dipper.
Place 5 shims beneath the heads of each adjusting
screw.
Adjust guide pads as described previously.
38 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

BACKHOE ATTACHMENT HYDRAULIC HANDLING


A unit enabling the hydraulic handling of the side-
shift carriage which supports the backhoe attach-
ment may be installed on the machine.

CONTROLS
Press the backhoe attachment sideshift unlocking
switch (1). The switch lamp turns on (ON position).
For handling, press:
- the button (2) side with the symbol to move the
backhoe attachment to the left side of the track;
- the button (2) side without symbol to move the
backhoe attachment to the right side of the track.
NOTE: track sides are referred to the travel direc-
tion of the machine.
IMPORTANT: except when the sideshift carriage is
being moved, the switch (1) must always be in the
OFF position. Never use the backhoe attachment
with the sideshift carriage unlocked.

HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM

A. Backhoe attachment control valve


B. Union tee of main load-sensing line from back-
hoe attachment control valve
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 39

HANDLING CYLINDER

1. Stroke
2. Completely retracted
40 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY


SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 41

1. M14 x 210 hex screw 28. Straight fitting


(Tightening torque = 85 ÷ 115 Nm) 29. Straight fitting
2. Washer 30. Hose
3. Plate 31. Hose
4. Pin 32. Union tee
5. Snap ring 33. Straight fitting
6. M14 nut 34. Reduction gear
7. Support 35. Elbow fitting
8. Shoe 36. Switch
9. Shim 37. Electric wiring harness
10. Handling cylinder assy 38. M14 x 50 hex screw
11. M8 x 25 hex screw (Tightening torque = 135 ÷ 183 Nm)
12. Washer 39. Washer
13. Bracket 40. Spacer
14. M8 x 35 hex screw 41. Spacer
15. Bracket 42. Snap ring
16. Hose 43. Pin
17. Hose 44. Cylinder support
18. Hose 45. Handling cylinder
19. Washer 46. M8 x 14 hex screw
20. M8 nut 47. Shim
21. Bracket 48. Washer
22. M6 x 14 screw 49. Shoe
23. Washer 50. Shim
24. M8 x 30 screw 51. Fitting
25. Valve 52. M12 x 20 socket head screw
26. Straight fitting 53. Shoe
27. Straight fitting
42 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

Move the machine to a level and firm ground, away


from any soft ground, excavations and poorly
shored cavity.
Lower the loader attachment to the ground.
Lower the backhoe attachment to the ground and
put it in a safe position in order to prevent
unintentional and dangerous movements during the
following assembly operations.
Lower the stabilizers to the ground.
Activate the backhoe attachment travel lock.
Place the direction-of-travel lever and the gearshift
lever in neutral position.
Immobilize the machine by means of the parking
brake.
Stop the engine and remove the starter switch key.
Release the hydraulic pressure by operating the
control levers in all directions. On hydraulically
controlled machines, turn the key to ON and release
the pressure by moving the hydraulic control levers
in all directions.
Place some wedges under the wheels so as to
prevent the machine from moving.
Disconnect the electric system by disconnecting the
battery master switch.
Support the backhoe attachment support sideshift
carriage by means of a relevant support, suitable to
support its weight.
In case the mechanical “backhoe attachment
transport lock” is installed on the machine, it is
necessary to disassemble the support of this device.
Loosen and remove the 6 screws (A) with the
relevant washers (B) and the nuts (C) fastening the
backhoe attachment support sideshift carriage (D).
Disassemble the top plate (E).
Keep the screws, the washers and the nuts just
removed, because they must be used again during
assembly operations.
Make sure the backhoe attachment is in a safe
position and that it is not subject to unintentional and
dangerous movements.
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 43

Now it is possible to install the whole cylinder


assembly.
Carry out this assembly operation respecting the
following procedure:
Z insert the pads (8) into the relevant seats in the
cylinder support (F);
Z place the whole cylinder assembly (10) onto the
rear crosspiece of the machine frame;
Z to correctly place the cylinder assembly, it is
necessary to respect the tolerance between the
backhoe attachment support sideshift carriage
(D) and the guide (G) of the frame crosspiece,
which must be 0.25 ÷ 0.75 mm (0.009 ÷
0.029 in) (in order to do so, it is necessary to
insert some temporary shims into this space,
which shall be removed after fastening the
whole cylinder assembly);
Z if necessary, install the shims (9);
Z now it is possible to block the whole cylinder
assembly (10) by reassembling the 6 screws
with the relevant washers and the nuts,
previously removed; tighten the screws to a
tightening torque of 750 ÷ 800 Nm
(553.1 ÷ 590 lbf·ft).

On the left stabilizer, install the support (7) and the


plate (3), fastening them by means of the 4
M14x120 screws (1) with the relevant ø14 washers
(2) and the M14 nuts (6).
Do not tighten the screws yet.
Fasten the rod (H) of the cylinder assembly to the
support (7) by means of the pin (4) and the 2 snap
rings (5).
Now tighten the M14x120 screws (1) to a tightening
torque of 85 ÷ 115 Nm (62.69 ÷ 84.81 lbf·ft).
44 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

Preassemble the valve (25):


tighten the 2 straight fittings (29) in the ports “A” and
“B” to a tightening torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft);
screw on the straight fitting (28) into port “LS” and
tighten it to a torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft);
screw on the straight fitting (26) into port “T” and
tighten it to a torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft);
screw on the straight fitting (27) into port “P” and
tighten it to a torque of 55 Nm (40.56 lbf·ft).
Install the valve (25) together with its fittings onto
the bracket (21) and fasten it by means of the two
M6x14 screws (22).
Tighten the two M6x14 screws (22) to a tightening
torque of 13 Nm (9.58 lbf·ft).
Install the bracket (21) complete with valve (25) in
the lower part of the frame crosspiece.
Fasten the bracket (21) by means of the two M8x30
screws (24) and the relevant ø8 washers (23).
The installation of the bracket (21) complete with
valve (25) is different if the following variants are
also present on the machine:
Z “swing dampening” variant (U);
Z “hydraulic quick coupler” variant (V).
SECTION 84 - BACKHOE 45

Access the backhoe control valve (I).


Screw on the union tee (32) into port “LS” and
tighten it to a torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft).
Screw on the straight fitting (33) into port “T” and
tighten it to a torque of 55 Nm (40.56 lbf·ft).
Screw on the fitting (34) into port “P” and tighten it to
a torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft).
Screw on the elbow (35) onto the fitting (34) and
tighten it to a tightening torque of 40 Nm
(29.50 lbf·ft).
Install the hoses connecting the valve (25) and the
backhoe control valve (I):
Z connect the hose (16) to port “T” of the valve
(tightening torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft)) and to
port “T” of the backhoe control valve (tightening
torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft));
Z connect the hose (17) to port “P” of the valve
(tightening torque of 55 Nm (40.56 lbf·ft)) and to
port “P” of the backhoe control valve (tightening
torque of 55 Nm (40.56 lbf·ft));
Z connect the hose (18) to port “LS” of the valve
(tightening torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft)) and to
port “LS” of the backhoe control valve
(tightening torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft)).

Install the hoses connecting the valve (25) and the


whole cylinder assembly (10):
Z Connect the hose (30) to port “A” (tightening
torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft)) and the hose (31)
to port “B” (tightening torque of 40 Nm
(29.50 lbf·ft)) of the valve (25);

Z connect the hose (30) to port “C1” (tightening


torque of 40 Nm (29.50 lbf·ft)) and the hose (31)
to port “C2” (tightening torque of 40 Nm
(29.50 lbf·ft)) in block (K) of the whole cylinder
assembly;
Z fasten the hoses (30) and (31) to the frame by
means of the brackets (13) and (15);
fasten the bracket (15) to the frame using the
M8x35 screw (14) and the relevant ø8 washer
(12) and (19) and the M8 nut (20);
fasten the bracket (13) to the bracket (15) using
the M8x25 screw (11) and the relevant ø8
washer (12).
46 SECTION 84 - BACKHOE

Once the installation of the hydraulic components is


finished, it is necessary to assemble the switches
and the electric wiring harness of the “backhoe
hydraulic sideshift” unit.
Lay the wiring harness between the valve, the
backhoe attachment control valve and the side
instrument cluster in the cab.
Inside the cab it is necessary to temporarily remove
the side instrument cluster (Y), loosening the
relevant fasteners (Y1).
Remove the plug from the left side of the side
instrument cluster (Y).
Move the switch (J) of the “backhoe attachment
transport lock” from the right to the left side of the
side instrument cluster (Y), in the position where the
plug has been previously removed.
Connect the switch (J) to the 2 connectors X-140.1
and X-140.2 of the new electric wiring harness of
the “backhoe hydraulic sideshift” unit (37).
On the right side of the side instrument cluster (Y),
instead of the switch (J) for “backhoe attachment
transport lock”, install the new button (36).
Connect the button (36) to the 2 connectors X-200.1
and X-200.2 of the new electric wiring harness of
the “backhoe hydraulic sideshift” unit (37).
Reassemble the side instrument cluster (Y).

You might also like